blob: 60345a26ea326aaec3bd2fcc7e547c93fd3090f5 [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau1db55792020-11-05 17:20:35 +01005 version 2.4
Willy Tarreauf8e32182023-02-14 16:57:13 +01006 2023/02/14
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007
8
9This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010specified above. It does not provide any hints, examples, or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012The summary below is meant to help you find sections by name and navigate
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040016 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
18 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
19 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020020 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outputs) with 3
22 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to emphasize the difference between
23 inputs and outputs when they may be ambiguous. If you add sections,
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020024 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020025
26
27Summary
28-------
29
301. Quick reminder about HTTP
311.1. The HTTP transaction model
321.2. HTTP request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100331.2.1. The request line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200341.2.2. The request headers
351.3. HTTP response
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100361.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200371.3.2. The response headers
38
392. Configuring HAProxy
402.1. Configuration file format
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200412.2. Quoting and escaping
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200422.3. Environment variables
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100432.4. Conditional blocks
442.5. Time format
452.6. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020046
473. Global parameters
483.1. Process management and security
493.2. Performance tuning
503.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100513.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200523.5. Peers
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200533.6. Mailers
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +0200543.7. Programs
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +0100553.8. HTTP-errors
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +0200563.9. Rings
William Lallemand0217b7b2020-11-18 10:41:24 +0100573.10. Log forwarding
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020058
594. Proxies
604.1. Proxy keywords matrix
614.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
62
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100635. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200645.1. Bind options
655.2. Server and default-server options
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +0200665.3. Server DNS resolution
675.3.1. Global overview
685.3.2. The resolvers section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020069
Julien Pivotto6ccee412019-11-27 15:49:54 +0100706. Cache
716.1. Limitation
726.2. Setup
736.2.1. Cache section
746.2.2. Proxy section
75
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200767. Using ACLs and fetching samples
777.1. ACL basics
787.1.1. Matching booleans
797.1.2. Matching integers
807.1.3. Matching strings
817.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
827.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
837.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
847.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
857.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200867.3.1. Converters
877.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
887.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
897.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
907.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
917.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +0200927.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200937.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020094
958. Logging
968.1. Log levels
978.2. Log formats
988.2.1. Default log format
998.2.2. TCP log format
1008.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01001018.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +01001028.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001038.3. Advanced logging options
1048.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
1058.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
1068.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
1078.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
1088.4. Timing events
1098.5. Session state at disconnection
1108.6. Non-printable characters
1118.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
1128.8. Capturing HTTP headers
1138.9. Examples of logs
114
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001159. Supported filters
1169.1. Trace
1179.2. HTTP compression
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +02001189.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +01001199.4. Cache
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02001209.5. fcgi-app
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +01001219.6. OpenTracing
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200122
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020012310. FastCGI applications
12410.1. Setup
12510.1.1. Fcgi-app section
12610.1.2. Proxy section
12710.1.3. Example
12810.2. Default parameters
12910.3. Limitations
130
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020013111. Address formats
13211.1. Address family prefixes
13311.2. Socket type prefixes
13411.3. Protocol prefixes
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200135
1361. Quick reminder about HTTP
137----------------------------
138
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100139When HAProxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200140fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
141on almost anything found in the contents.
142
143However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
144formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
145correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
146
147
1481.1. The HTTP transaction model
149-------------------------------
150
151The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100152to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100153from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client through the
154connection, the server responds, and the connection is closed. A new request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200155will involve a new connection :
156
157 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
158
159In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
160establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
161by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
162length.
163
164Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
165to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
166however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
167response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
168header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
169
170 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
171
172Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
173power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
174but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200175a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200176
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100177Another improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200178keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
179second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
180page :
181
182 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
183
184This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
185latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
186correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
187the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100188server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200189
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100190The next improvement is the multiplexed mode, as implemented in HTTP/2. This
191time, each transaction is assigned a single stream identifier, and all streams
192are multiplexed over an existing connection. Many requests can be sent in
193parallel by the client, and responses can arrive in any order since they also
194carry the stream identifier.
195
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100196By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
197connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
198leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100199start of a new request. When it receives HTTP/2 connections from a client, it
200processes all the requests in parallel and leaves the connection idling,
201waiting for new requests, just as if it was a keep-alive HTTP connection.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200202
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200203HAProxy supports 4 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100204 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
205 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +0100206 everything else is forwarded with no analysis (deprecated).
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100207 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200208 - close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100209
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100210
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200211
2121.2. HTTP request
213-----------------
214
215First, let's consider this HTTP request :
216
217 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100218 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200219 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
220 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
221 3 User-agent: my small browser
222 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
223 5 Accept: image/png
224
225
2261.2.1. The Request line
227-----------------------
228
229Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
230
231 - a METHOD : GET
232 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
233 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
234
235All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
236which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
237followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
238is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
239desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
240the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
241
242The URI itself can have several forms :
243
244 - A "relative URI" :
245
246 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
247
248 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
249 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
250
251 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
252
253 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
254
255 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
256 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
257 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
258 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
259 must accept this form too.
260
261 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
262 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
263 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100264
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200265 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
266 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
267 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
268 other protocols too.
269
270In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
271mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
272on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
273It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
274specific to the language, framework or application in use.
275
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100276HTTP/2 doesn't convey a version information with the request, so the version is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100277assumed to be the same as the one of the underlying protocol (i.e. "HTTP/2").
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100278
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200279
2801.2.2. The request headers
281--------------------------
282
283The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
284beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
285an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
286Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
287values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
288encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
289the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
290define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
291
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100292Contrary to a common misconception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200293their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100294"Connection:" header). In HTTP/2, header names are always sent in lower case,
Willy Tarreau253c2512020-07-07 15:55:23 +0200295as can be seen when running in debug mode. Internally, all header names are
296normalized to lower case so that HTTP/1.x and HTTP/2 use the exact same
297representation, and they are sent as-is on the other side. This explains why an
298HTTP/1.x request typed with camel case is delivered in lower case.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200299
300The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
301that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
302is one valid form of empty line.
303
304Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
305headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
306about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
307application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
308
309Important note:
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000310 As suggested by RFC7231, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200311 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
312 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
313 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
314
315
3161.3. HTTP response
317------------------
318
319An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
320messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
321
322 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100323 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200324 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
325 2 Content-length: 350
326 3 Content-Type: text/html
327
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200328As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
329codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
330response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100331continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
332the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
333following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
334sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
335(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
336correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
337such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
338state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -0400339over the same connection and that HAProxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100340if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
341information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200342
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200343
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003441.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200345------------------------
346
347Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
348
349 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
350 - a status code : 200
351 - a reason : OK
352
353The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100354 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (e.g. 100, 101)
355 - 2xx = OK, content is following (e.g. 200, 206)
356 - 3xx = OK, no content following (e.g. 302, 304)
357 - 4xx = error caused by the client (e.g. 401, 403, 404)
358 - 5xx = error caused by the server (e.g. 500, 502, 503)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200359
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000360Please refer to RFC7231 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100361"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200362found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
363messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
364or "Authentication Required".
365
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100366HAProxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200367
368 Code When / reason
369 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
370 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
371 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
372 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100373 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
374 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200375 400 for an invalid or too large request
376 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
377 accessing the stats page)
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200378 403 when a request is forbidden by a "http-request deny" rule
Florian Tham9205fea2020-01-08 13:35:30 +0100379 404 when the requested resource could not be found
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200380 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
Florian Tham272e29b2020-01-08 10:19:05 +0100381 410 when the requested resource is no longer available and will not
382 be available again
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -0400383 500 when HAProxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200384 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -0400385 501 when HAProxy is unable to satisfy a client request because of an
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +0100386 unsupported feature
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200387 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200388 when an "http-response deny" rule blocks the response.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200389 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
390 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
391 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
392
393The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3944.2).
395
396
3971.3.2. The response headers
398---------------------------
399
400Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
401the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
402details.
403
404
4052. Configuring HAProxy
406----------------------
407
4082.1. Configuration file format
409------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200410
411HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
412
413 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100414 - the configuration file(s), whose format is described here
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -0700415 - the running process's environment, in case some environment variables are
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100416 explicitly referenced
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200417
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100418The configuration file follows a fairly simple hierarchical format which obey
419a few basic rules:
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100420
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100421 1. a configuration file is an ordered sequence of statements
422
423 2. a statement is a single non-empty line before any unprotected "#" (hash)
424
425 3. a line is a series of tokens or "words" delimited by unprotected spaces or
426 tab characters
427
428 4. the first word or sequence of words of a line is one of the keywords or
429 keyword sequences listed in this document
430
431 5. all other words are all arguments of the first one, some being well-known
432 keywords listed in this document, others being values, references to other
433 parts of the configuration, or expressions
434
435 6. certain keywords delimit a section inside which only a subset of keywords
436 are supported
437
438 7. a section ends at the end of a file or on a special keyword starting a new
439 section
440
441This is all that is needed to know to write a simple but reliable configuration
442generator, but this is not enough to reliably parse any configuration nor to
443figure how to deal with certain corner cases.
444
445First, there are a few consequences of the rules above. Rule 6 and 7 imply that
446the keywords used to define a new section are valid everywhere and cannot have
447a different meaning in a specific section. These keywords are always a single
448word (as opposed to a sequence of words), and traditionally the section that
449follows them is designated using the same name. For example when speaking about
450the "global section", it designates the section of configuration that follows
451the "global" keyword. This usage is used a lot in error messages to help locate
452the parts that need to be addressed.
453
454A number of sections create an internal object or configuration space, which
455requires to be distinguished from other ones. In this case they will take an
456extra word which will set the name of this particular section. For some of them
457the section name is mandatory. For example "frontend foo" will create a new
458section of type "frontend" named "foo". Usually a name is specific to its
459section and two sections of different types may use the same name, but this is
460not recommended as it tends to complexify configuration management.
461
462A direct consequence of rule 7 is that when multiple files are read at once,
463each of them must start with a new section, and the end of each file will end
464a section. A file cannot contain sub-sections nor end an existing section and
465start a new one.
466
467Rule 1 mentioned that ordering matters. Indeed, some keywords create directives
468that can be repeated multiple times to create ordered sequences of rules to be
469applied in a certain order. For example "tcp-request" can be used to alternate
470"accept" and "reject" rules on varying criteria. As such, a configuration file
471processor must always preserve a section's ordering when editing a file. The
472ordering of sections usually does not matter except for the global section
473which must be placed before other sections, but it may be repeated if needed.
474In addition, some automatic identifiers may automatically be assigned to some
475of the created objects (e.g. proxies), and by reordering sections, their
476identifiers will change. These ones appear in the statistics for example. As
477such, the configuration below will assign "foo" ID number 1 and "bar" ID number
4782, which will be swapped if the two sections are reversed:
479
480 listen foo
481 bind :80
482
483 listen bar
484 bind :81
485
486Another important point is that according to rules 2 and 3 above, empty lines,
487spaces, tabs, and comments following and unprotected "#" character are not part
488of the configuration as they are just used as delimiters. This implies that the
489following configurations are strictly equivalent:
490
491 global#this is the global section
492 daemon#daemonize
493 frontend foo
494 mode http # or tcp
495
496and:
497
498 global
499 daemon
500
501 # this is the public web frontend
502 frontend foo
503 mode http
504
505The common practice is to align to the left only the keyword that initiates a
506new section, and indent (i.e. prepend a tab character or a few spaces) all
507other keywords so that it's instantly visible that they belong to the same
508section (as done in the second example above). Placing comments before a new
509section helps the reader decide if it's the desired one. Leaving a blank line
510at the end of a section also visually helps spotting the end when editing it.
511
512Tabs are very convenient for indent but they do not copy-paste well. If spaces
513are used instead, it is recommended to avoid placing too many (2 to 4) so that
514editing in field doesn't become a burden with limited editors that do not
515support automatic indent.
516
517In the early days it used to be common to see arguments split at fixed tab
518positions because most keywords would not take more than two arguments. With
519modern versions featuring complex expressions this practice does not stand
520anymore, and is not recommended.
521
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200522
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02005232.2. Quoting and escaping
524-------------------------
525
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100526In modern configurations, some arguments require the use of some characters
527that were previously considered as pure delimiters. In order to make this
528possible, HAProxy supports character escaping by prepending a backslash ('\')
529in front of the character to be escaped, weak quoting within double quotes
530('"') and strong quoting within single quotes ("'").
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200531
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100532This is pretty similar to what is done in a number of programming languages and
533very close to what is commonly encountered in Bourne shell. The principle is
534the following: while the configuration parser cuts the lines into words, it
535also takes care of quotes and backslashes to decide whether a character is a
536delimiter or is the raw representation of this character within the current
537word. The escape character is then removed, the quotes are removed, and the
538remaining word is used as-is as a keyword or argument for example.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200539
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100540If a backslash is needed in a word, it must either be escaped using itself
541(i.e. double backslash) or be strongly quoted.
542
543Escaping outside quotes is achieved by preceding a special character by a
544backslash ('\'):
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200545
546 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
547 \# to mark a hash and differentiate it from a comment
548 \\ to use a backslash
549 \' to use a single quote and differentiate it from strong quoting
550 \" to use a double quote and differentiate it from weak quoting
551
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100552In addition, a few non-printable characters may be emitted using their usual
553C-language representation:
554
555 \n to insert a line feed (LF, character \x0a or ASCII 10 decimal)
556 \r to insert a carriage return (CR, character \x0d or ASCII 13 decimal)
557 \t to insert a tab (character \x09 or ASCII 9 decimal)
558 \xNN to insert character having ASCII code hex NN (e.g \x0a for LF).
559
560Weak quoting is achieved by surrounding double quotes ("") around the character
561or sequence of characters to protect. Weak quoting prevents the interpretation
562of:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200563
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100564 space or tab as a word separator
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200565 ' single quote as a strong quoting delimiter
566 # hash as a comment start
567
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100568Weak quoting permits the interpretation of environment variables (which are not
569evaluated outside of quotes) by preceding them with a dollar sign ('$'). If a
570dollar character is needed inside double quotes, it must be escaped using a
571backslash.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200572
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100573Strong quoting is achieved by surrounding single quotes ('') around the
574character or sequence of characters to protect. Inside single quotes, nothing
575is interpreted, it's the efficient way to quote regular expressions.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200576
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100577As a result, here is the matrix indicating how special characters can be
578entered in different contexts (unprintable characters are replaced with their
579name within angle brackets). Note that some characters that may only be
580represented escaped have no possible representation inside single quotes,
581hence the '-' there:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200582
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100583 Character | Unquoted | Weakly quoted | Strongly quoted
584 -----------+---------------+-----------------------------+-----------------
585 <TAB> | \<TAB>, \x09 | "<TAB>", "\<TAB>", "\x09" | '<TAB>'
586 <LF> | \n, \x0a | "\n", "\x0a" | -
587 <CR> | \r, \x0d | "\r", "\x0d" | -
588 <SPC> | \<SPC>, \x20 | "<SPC>", "\<SPC>", "\x20" | '<SPC>'
589 " | \", \x22 | "\"", "\x22" | '"'
590 # | \#, \x23 | "#", "\#", "\x23" | '#'
591 $ | $, \$, \x24 | "\$", "\x24" | '$'
592 ' | \', \x27 | "'", "\'", "\x27" | -
593 \ | \\, \x5c | "\\", "\x5c" | '\'
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200594
595 Example:
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100596 # those are all strictly equivalent:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200597 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
598 log-format "%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r"
599 log-format '%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r'
600 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s %{-Q}r'
601 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s'\ %{-Q}r
602
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100603There is one particular case where a second level of quoting or escaping may be
604necessary. Some keywords take arguments within parenthesis, sometimes delimited
605by commas. These arguments are commonly integers or predefined words, but when
606they are arbitrary strings, it may be required to perform a separate level of
607escaping to disambiguate the characters that belong to the argument from the
608characters that are used to delimit the arguments themselves. A pretty common
609case is the "regsub" converter. It takes a regular expression in argument, and
610if a closing parenthesis is needed inside, this one will require to have its
611own quotes.
612
613The keyword argument parser is exactly the same as the top-level one regarding
Thayne McCombsf87e4f72021-10-04 01:02:58 -0600614quotes, except that the \#, \$, and \xNN escapes are not processed. But what is
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +0500615not always obvious is that the delimiters used inside must first be escaped or
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100616quoted so that they are not resolved at the top level.
617
618Let's take this example making use of the "regsub" converter which takes 3
619arguments, one regular expression, one replacement string and one set of flags:
620
621 # replace all occurrences of "foo" with "blah" in the path:
622 http-request set-path %[path,regsub(foo,blah,g)]
623
624Here no special quoting was necessary. But if now we want to replace either
625"foo" or "bar" with "blah", we'll need the regular expression "(foo|bar)". We
626cannot write:
627
628 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
629
630because we would like the string to cut like this:
631
632 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
633 |---------|----|-|
634 arg1 _/ / /
635 arg2 __________/ /
636 arg3 ______________/
637
638but actually what is passed is a string between the opening and closing
639parenthesis then garbage:
640
641 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
642 |--------|--------|
643 arg1=(foo|bar _/ /
644 trailing garbage _________/
645
646The obvious solution here seems to be that the closing parenthesis needs to be
647quoted, but alone this will not work, because as mentioned above, quotes are
648processed by the top-level parser which will resolve them before processing
649this word:
650
651 http-request set-path %[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
652 ------------ -------- ----------------------------------
653 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
654
655So we didn't change anything for the argument parser at the second level which
656still sees a truncated regular expression as the only argument, and garbage at
657the end of the string. By escaping the quotes they will be passed unmodified to
658the second level:
659
660 http-request set-path %[path,regsub(\"(foo|bar)\",blah,g)]
661 ------------ -------- ------------------------------------
662 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
663 |---------||----|-|
664 arg1=(foo|bar) _/ / /
665 arg2=blah ___________/ /
666 arg3=g _______________/
667
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +0500668Another approach consists in using single quotes outside the whole string and
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100669double quotes inside (so that the double quotes are not stripped again):
670
671 http-request set-path '%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]'
672 ------------ -------- ----------------------------------
673 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
674 |---------||----|-|
675 arg1=(foo|bar) _/ / /
676 arg2 ___________/ /
677 arg3 _______________/
678
679When using regular expressions, it can happen that the dollar ('$') character
680appears in the expression or that a backslash ('\') is used in the replacement
681string. In this case these ones will also be processed inside the double quotes
682thus single quotes are preferred (or double escaping). Example:
683
684 http-request set-path '%[path,regsub("^/(here)(/|$)","my/\1",g)]'
685 ------------ -------- -----------------------------------------
686 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("^/(here)(/|$)","my/\1",g)]
687 |-------------| |-----||-|
688 arg1=(here)(/|$) _/ / /
689 arg2=my/\1 ________________/ /
690 arg3 ______________________/
691
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -0400692Remember that backslashes are not escape characters within single quotes and
Thayne McCombsf87e4f72021-10-04 01:02:58 -0600693that the whole word above is already protected against them using the single
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100694quotes. Conversely, if double quotes had been used around the whole expression,
695single the dollar character and the backslashes would have been resolved at top
696level, breaking the argument contents at the second level.
697
Thayne McCombsf87e4f72021-10-04 01:02:58 -0600698Unfortunately, since single quotes can't be escaped inside of strong quoting,
699if you need to include single quotes in your argument, you will need to escape
700or quote them twice. There are a few ways to do this:
701
702 http-request set-var(txn.foo) str("\\'foo\\'")
703 http-request set-var(txn.foo) str(\"\'foo\'\")
704 http-request set-var(txn.foo) str(\\\'foo\\\')
705
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100706When in doubt, simply do not use quotes anywhere, and start to place single or
707double quotes around arguments that require a comma or a closing parenthesis,
Thayne McCombsf87e4f72021-10-04 01:02:58 -0600708and think about escaping these quotes using a backslash if the string contains
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100709a dollar or a backslash. Again, this is pretty similar to what is used under
710a Bourne shell when double-escaping a command passed to "eval". For API writers
711the best is probably to place escaped quotes around each and every argument,
712regardless of their contents. Users will probably find that using single quotes
713around the whole expression and double quotes around each argument provides
714more readable configurations.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200715
716
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007172.3. Environment variables
718--------------------------
719
720HAProxy's configuration supports environment variables. Those variables are
721interpreted only within double quotes. Variables are expanded during the
722configuration parsing. Variable names must be preceded by a dollar ("$") and
723optionally enclosed with braces ("{}") similarly to what is done in Bourne
724shell. Variable names can contain alphanumerical characters or the character
Amaury Denoyellefa41cb62020-10-01 14:32:35 +0200725underscore ("_") but should not start with a digit. If the variable contains a
726list of several values separated by spaces, it can be expanded as individual
727arguments by enclosing the variable with braces and appending the suffix '[*]'
728before the closing brace.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200729
730 Example:
731
732 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
733
734 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
735
736 user "$HAPROXY_USER"
737
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200738Some variables are defined by HAProxy, they can be used in the configuration
739file, or could be inherited by a program (See 3.7. Programs):
William Lallemanddaf4cd22018-04-17 16:46:13 +0200740
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200741* HAPROXY_LOCALPEER: defined at the startup of the process which contains the
742 name of the local peer. (See "-L" in the management guide.)
743
744* HAPROXY_CFGFILES: list of the configuration files loaded by HAProxy,
745 separated by semicolons. Can be useful in the case you specified a
746 directory.
747
748* HAPROXY_MWORKER: In master-worker mode, this variable is set to 1.
749
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500750* HAPROXY_CLI: configured listeners addresses of the stats socket for every
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200751 processes, separated by semicolons.
752
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500753* HAPROXY_MASTER_CLI: In master-worker mode, listeners addresses of the master
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200754 CLI, separated by semicolons.
755
William Lallemanda48f51b2023-02-21 14:07:05 +0100756* HAPROXY_STARTUP_VERSION: contains the version used to start, in master-worker
757 mode this is the version which was used to start the master, even after
758 updating the binary and reloading.
759
Willy Tarreaua46f1af2021-05-06 10:25:11 +0200760In addition, some pseudo-variables are internally resolved and may be used as
761regular variables. Pseudo-variables always start with a dot ('.'), and are the
762only ones where the dot is permitted. The current list of pseudo-variables is:
763
764* .FILE: the name of the configuration file currently being parsed.
765
766* .LINE: the line number of the configuration file currently being parsed,
767 starting at one.
768
769* .SECTION: the name of the section currently being parsed, or its type if the
770 section doesn't have a name (e.g. "global"), or an empty string before the
771 first section.
772
773These variables are resolved at the location where they are parsed. For example
774if a ".LINE" variable is used in a "log-format" directive located in a defaults
775section, its line number will be resolved before parsing and compiling the
776"log-format" directive, so this same line number will be reused by subsequent
777proxies.
778
779This way it is possible to emit information to help locate a rule in variables,
780logs, error statuses, health checks, header values, or even to use line numbers
781to name some config objects like servers for example.
782
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200783See also "external-check command" for other variables.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200784
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100785
7862.4. Conditional blocks
787-----------------------
788
789It may sometimes be convenient to be able to conditionally enable or disable
790some arbitrary parts of the configuration, for example to enable/disable SSL or
791ciphers, enable or disable some pre-production listeners without modifying the
792configuration, or adjust the configuration's syntax to support two distinct
793versions of HAProxy during a migration.. HAProxy brings a set of nestable
794preprocessor-like directives which allow to integrate or ignore some blocks of
795text. These directives must be placed on their own line and they act on the
796lines that follow them. Two of them support an expression, the other ones only
797switch to an alternate block or end a current level. The 4 following directives
798are defined to form conditional blocks:
799
800 - .if <condition>
801 - .elif <condition>
802 - .else
803 - .endif
804
805The ".if" directive nests a new level, ".elif" stays at the same level, ".else"
806as well, and ".endif" closes a level. Each ".if" must be terminated by a
807matching ".endif". The ".elif" may only be placed after ".if" or ".elif", and
808there is no limit to the number of ".elif" that may be chained. There may be
809only one ".else" per ".if" and it must always be after the ".if" or the last
810".elif" of a block.
811
812Comments may be placed on the same line if needed after a '#', they will be
813ignored. The directives are tokenized like other configuration directives, and
814as such it is possible to use environment variables in conditions.
815
816The conditions are currently limited to:
817
818 - an empty string, always returns "false"
819 - the integer zero ('0'), always returns "false"
820 - a non-nul integer (e.g. '1'), always returns "true".
Willy Tarreau42ed14b2021-05-06 15:55:14 +0200821 - a predicate optionally followed by argument(s) in parenthesis.
822
823The list of currently supported predicates is the following:
824
825 - defined(<name>) : returns true if an environment variable <name>
826 exists, regardless of its contents
827
Willy Tarreau58ca7062021-05-06 16:34:23 +0200828 - feature(<name>) : returns true if feature <name> is listed as present
829 in the features list reported by "haproxy -vv"
830 (which means a <name> appears after a '+')
831
Willy Tarreau6492e872021-05-06 16:10:09 +0200832 - streq(<str1>,<str2>) : returns true only if the two strings are equal
833 - strneq(<str1>,<str2>) : returns true only if the two strings differ
834
Willy Tarreau0b7c78a2021-05-06 16:53:26 +0200835 - version_atleast(<ver>): returns true if the current haproxy version is
836 at least as recent as <ver> otherwise false. The
837 version syntax is the same as shown by "haproxy -v"
838 and missing components are assumed as being zero.
839
840 - version_before(<ver>) : returns true if the current haproxy version is
841 strictly older than <ver> otherwise false. The
842 version syntax is the same as shown by "haproxy -v"
843 and missing components are assumed as being zero.
844
Willy Tarreau42ed14b2021-05-06 15:55:14 +0200845Example:
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100846
Willy Tarreau42ed14b2021-05-06 15:55:14 +0200847 .if defined(HAPROXY_MWORKER)
848 listen mwcli_px
849 bind :1111
850 ...
851 .endif
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100852
Willy Tarreau6492e872021-05-06 16:10:09 +0200853 .if strneq("$SSL_ONLY",yes)
854 bind :80
855 .endif
856
857 .if streq("$WITH_SSL",yes)
Willy Tarreau58ca7062021-05-06 16:34:23 +0200858 .if feature(OPENSSL)
Willy Tarreau6492e872021-05-06 16:10:09 +0200859 bind :443 ssl crt ...
Willy Tarreau58ca7062021-05-06 16:34:23 +0200860 .endif
Willy Tarreau6492e872021-05-06 16:10:09 +0200861 .endif
862
Willy Tarreau0b7c78a2021-05-06 16:53:26 +0200863 .if version_atleast(2.4-dev19)
864 profiling.memory on
865 .endif
866
Willy Tarreau7190b982021-05-07 08:59:50 +0200867Four other directives are provided to report some status:
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100868
Willy Tarreau7190b982021-05-07 08:59:50 +0200869 - .diag "message" : emit this message only when in diagnostic mode (-dD)
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100870 - .notice "message" : emit this message at level NOTICE
871 - .warning "message" : emit this message at level WARNING
872 - .alert "message" : emit this message at level ALERT
873
874Messages emitted at level WARNING may cause the process to fail to start if the
875"strict-mode" is enabled. Messages emitted at level ALERT will always cause a
876fatal error. These can be used to detect some inappropriate conditions and
877provide advice to the user.
878
879Example:
880
881 .if "${A}"
882 .if "${B}"
883 .notice "A=1, B=1"
884 .elif "${C}"
885 .notice "A=1, B=0, C=1"
886 .elif "${D}"
887 .warning "A=1, B=0, C=0, D=1"
888 .else
889 .alert "A=1, B=0, C=0, D=0"
890 .endif
891 .else
892 .notice "A=0"
893 .endif
894
Willy Tarreau7190b982021-05-07 08:59:50 +0200895 .diag "WTA/2021-05-07: replace 'redirect' with 'return' after switch to 2.4"
896 http-request redirect location /goaway if ABUSE
897
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100898
8992.5. Time format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200900----------------
901
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100902Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100903values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
904otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
905numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
906for every keyword. Supported units are :
907
908 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
909 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
910 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
911 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
912 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
913 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
914
915
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +01009162.6. Examples
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200917-------------
918
919 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
920 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
921 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
922 global
923 daemon
924 maxconn 256
925
926 defaults
927 mode http
928 timeout connect 5000ms
929 timeout client 50000ms
930 timeout server 50000ms
931
932 frontend http-in
933 bind *:80
934 default_backend servers
935
936 backend servers
937 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
938
939
940 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
941 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
942 global
943 daemon
944 maxconn 256
945
946 defaults
947 mode http
948 timeout connect 5000ms
949 timeout client 50000ms
950 timeout server 50000ms
951
952 listen http-in
953 bind *:80
954 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
955
956
957Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
958
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100959 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200960
961
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009623. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200963--------------------
964
965Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
966are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
967of them have command-line equivalents.
968
969The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
970
971 * Process management and security
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +0100972 - 51degrees-cache-size
973 - 51degrees-data-file
974 - 51degrees-property-name-list
975 - 51degrees-property-separator
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200976 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200977 - chroot
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200978 - cpu-map
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +0100979 - crt-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200980 - daemon
Willy Tarreau8a022d52021-04-27 20:29:11 +0200981 - default-path
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200982 - description
983 - deviceatlas-json-file
984 - deviceatlas-log-level
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200985 - deviceatlas-properties-cookie
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +0100986 - deviceatlas-separator
Amaury Denoyelled2e53cd2021-05-06 16:21:39 +0200987 - expose-experimental-directives
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900988 - external-check
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200989 - gid
990 - group
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +0200991 - h1-case-adjust
992 - h1-case-adjust-file
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +0100993 - h2-workaround-bogus-websocket-clients
994 - hard-stop-after
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +0100995 - insecure-fork-wanted
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +0100996 - insecure-setuid-wanted
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +0100997 - issuers-chain-path
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +0200998 - localpeer
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200999 - log
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +01001000 - log-send-hostname
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001001 - log-tag
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001002 - lua-load
Thierry Fournier59f11be2020-11-29 00:37:41 +01001003 - lua-load-per-thread
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +01001004 - lua-prepend-path
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001005 - mworker-max-reloads
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001006 - nbproc
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001007 - nbthread
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001008 - node
Amaury Denoyelle0f50cb92021-03-26 18:50:33 +01001009 - numa-cpu-mapping
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001010 - pidfile
Willy Tarreau119e50e2020-05-22 13:53:29 +02001011 - pp2-never-send-local
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001012 - presetenv
1013 - resetenv
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001014 - set-dumpable
Willy Tarreau13d2ba22021-03-26 11:38:08 +01001015 - set-var
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001016 - setenv
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001017 - ssl-default-bind-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001018 - ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites
Jerome Magninb203ff62020-04-03 15:28:22 +02001019 - ssl-default-bind-curves
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001020 - ssl-default-bind-options
1021 - ssl-default-server-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001022 - ssl-default-server-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001023 - ssl-default-server-options
1024 - ssl-dh-param-file
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01001025 - ssl-server-verify
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001026 - ssl-skip-self-issued-ca
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001027 - stats
1028 - strict-limits
1029 - uid
1030 - ulimit-n
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001031 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001032 - unsetenv
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001033 - user
1034 - wurfl-cache-size
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001035 - wurfl-data-file
1036 - wurfl-information-list
1037 - wurfl-information-list-separator
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001038
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001039 * Performance tuning
William Dauchy0a8824f2019-10-27 20:08:09 +01001040 - busy-polling
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02001041 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001042 - maxcompcpuusage
1043 - maxcomprate
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001044 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02001045 - maxconnrate
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001046 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02001047 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001048 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02001049 - maxsslrate
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001050 - maxzlibmem
Willy Tarreau85dd5212022-03-08 10:41:40 +01001051 - no-memory-trimming
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001052 - noepoll
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00001053 - noevports
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001054 - nogetaddrinfo
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001055 - nokqueue
1056 - nopoll
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00001057 - noreuseport
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001058 - nosplice
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +01001059 - profiling.tasks
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001060 - server-state-base
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +02001061 - server-state-file
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001062 - spread-checks
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001063 - ssl-engine
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001064 - ssl-mode-async
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001065 - tune.buffers.limit
1066 - tune.buffers.reserve
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001067 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +02001068 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01001069 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Christopher Faulet48110bc2023-02-20 14:33:46 +01001070 - tune.fail-alloc
Willy Tarreaubc52bec2020-06-18 08:58:47 +02001071 - tune.fd.edge-triggered
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02001072 - tune.h2.header-table-size
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001073 - tune.h2.initial-window-size
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02001074 - tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001075 - tune.http.cookielen
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001076 - tune.http.logurilen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001077 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +02001078 - tune.idle-pool.shared
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001079 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001080 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01001081 - tune.lua.maxmem
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001082 - tune.lua.service-timeout
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001083 - tune.lua.session-timeout
1084 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001085 - tune.maxaccept
1086 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001087 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02001088 - tune.pattern.cache-size
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02001089 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaua8e2d972020-07-01 18:27:16 +02001090 - tune.pool-high-fd-ratio
1091 - tune.pool-low-fd-ratio
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001092 - tune.rcvbuf.client
1093 - tune.rcvbuf.server
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01001094 - tune.recv_enough
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02001095 - tune.runqueue-depth
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +02001096 - tune.sched.low-latency
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001097 - tune.sndbuf.client
1098 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001099 - tune.ssl.cachesize
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001100 - tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size
1101 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
1102 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02001103 - tune.ssl.keylog
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001104 - tune.ssl.lifetime
1105 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02001106 - tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001107 - tune.vars.global-max-size
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01001108 - tune.vars.proc-max-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001109 - tune.vars.reqres-max-size
1110 - tune.vars.sess-max-size
1111 - tune.vars.txn-max-size
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001112 - tune.zlib.memlevel
1113 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001114
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001115 * Debugging
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001116 - quiet
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +02001117 - zero-warning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001118
1119
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011203.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001121------------------------------------
1122
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +0100112351degrees-data-file <file path>
1124 The path of the 51Degrees data file to provide device detection services. The
1125 file should be unzipped and accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
1126
1127 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
1128 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1129
113051degrees-property-name-list [<string> ...]
1131 A list of 51Degrees property names to be load from the dataset. A full list
1132 of names is available on the 51Degrees website:
1133 https://51degrees.com/resources/property-dictionary
1134
1135 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
1136 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1137
113851degrees-property-separator <char>
1139 A char that will be appended to every property value in a response header
1140 containing 51Degrees results. If not set that will be set as ','.
1141
1142 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
1143 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1144
114551degrees-cache-size <number>
1146 Sets the size of the 51Degrees converter cache to <number> entries. This
1147 is an LRU cache which reminds previous device detections and their results.
1148 By default, this cache is disabled.
1149
1150 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
1151 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1152
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001153ca-base <dir>
1154 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +01001155 relative path is used with "ca-file", "ca-verify-file" or "crl-file"
1156 directives. Absolute locations specified in "ca-file", "ca-verify-file" and
1157 "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001158
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001159chroot <jail dir>
1160 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
1161 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
1162 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
1163 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
1164 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001165 empty and non-writable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001166
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001167cpu-map [auto:]<process-set>[/<thread-set>] <cpu-set>...
1168 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process or a thread to a
1169 specific CPU set. This means that the process or the thread will never run on
1170 other CPUs. The "cpu-map" directive specifies CPU sets for process or thread
1171 sets. The first argument is a process set, eventually followed by a thread
1172 set. These sets have the format
1173
1174 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
1175
1176 <number>> must be a number between 1 and 32 or 64, depending on the machine's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001177 word size. Any process IDs above nbproc and any thread IDs above nbthread are
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001178 ignored. It is possible to specify a range with two such number delimited by
1179 a dash ('-'). It also is possible to specify all processes at once using
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +01001180 "all", only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like
1181 with the "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are
Amaury Denoyelle982fb532021-04-21 18:39:58 +02001182 CPU sets. Each CPU set is either a unique number starting at 0 for the first
1183 CPU or a range with two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Outside of
1184 Linux and BSDs, there may be a limitation on the maximum CPU index to either
1185 31 or 63. Multiple CPU numbers or ranges may be specified, and the processes
1186 or threads will be allowed to bind to all of them. Obviously, multiple
1187 "cpu-map" directives may be specified. Each "cpu-map" directive will replace
1188 the previous ones when they overlap. A thread will be bound on the
1189 intersection of its mapping and the one of the process on which it is
1190 attached. If the intersection is null, no specific binding will be set for
1191 the thread.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +01001192
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001193 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
1194 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value, 32 or 64 depending
1195 on the machine's word size.
1196
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001197 The prefix "auto:" can be added before the process set to let HAProxy
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001198 automatically bind a process or a thread to a CPU by incrementing
1199 process/thread and CPU sets. To be valid, both sets must have the same
1200 size. No matter the declaration order of the CPU sets, it will be bound from
1201 the lowest to the highest bound. Having a process and a thread range with the
1202 "auto:" prefix is not supported. Only one range is supported, the other one
1203 must be a fixed number.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001204
1205 Examples:
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001206 cpu-map 1-4 0-3 # bind processes 1 to 4 on the first 4 CPUs
1207
1208 cpu-map 1/all 0-3 # bind all threads of the first process on the
1209 # first 4 CPUs
1210
1211 cpu-map 1- 0- # will be replaced by "cpu-map 1-64 0-63"
1212 # or "cpu-map 1-32 0-31" depending on the machine's
1213 # word size.
1214
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001215 # all these lines bind the process 1 to the cpu 0, the process 2 to cpu 1
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001216 # and so on.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001217 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-3
1218 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-1 2-3
1219 cpu-map auto:1-4 3 2 1 0
1220
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001221 # all these lines bind the thread 1 to the cpu 0, the thread 2 to cpu 1
1222 # and so on.
1223 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-3
1224 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-1 2-3
1225 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 3 2 1 0
1226
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001227 # bind each process to exactly one CPU using all/odd/even keyword
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001228 cpu-map auto:all 0-63
1229 cpu-map auto:even 0-31
1230 cpu-map auto:odd 32-63
1231
1232 # invalid cpu-map because process and CPU sets have different sizes.
1233 cpu-map auto:1-4 0 # invalid
1234 cpu-map auto:1 0-3 # invalid
1235
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001236 # invalid cpu-map because automatic binding is used with a process range
1237 # and a thread range.
1238 cpu-map auto:all/all 0 # invalid
1239 cpu-map auto:all/1-4 0 # invalid
1240 cpu-map auto:1-4/all 0 # invalid
1241
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001242crt-base <dir>
1243 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
William Dauchy238ea3b2020-01-11 13:09:12 +01001244 path is used with "crtfile" or "crt" directives. Absolute locations specified
1245 prevail and ignore "crt-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001246
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001247daemon
1248 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
1249 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
Lukas Tribusf46bf952017-11-21 12:39:34 +01001250 disabled by the command line "-db" argument. This option is ignored in
1251 systemd mode.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001252
Willy Tarreau8a022d52021-04-27 20:29:11 +02001253default-path { current | config | parent | origin <path> }
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001254 By default HAProxy loads all files designated by a relative path from the
Willy Tarreau8a022d52021-04-27 20:29:11 +02001255 location the process is started in. In some circumstances it might be
1256 desirable to force all relative paths to start from a different location
1257 just as if the process was started from such locations. This is what this
1258 directive is made for. Technically it will perform a temporary chdir() to
1259 the designated location while processing each configuration file, and will
1260 return to the original directory after processing each file. It takes an
1261 argument indicating the policy to use when loading files whose path does
1262 not start with a slash ('/'):
1263 - "current" indicates that all relative files are to be loaded from the
1264 directory the process is started in ; this is the default.
1265
1266 - "config" indicates that all relative files should be loaded from the
1267 directory containing the configuration file. More specifically, if the
1268 configuration file contains a slash ('/'), the longest part up to the
1269 last slash is used as the directory to change to, otherwise the current
1270 directory is used. This mode is convenient to bundle maps, errorfiles,
1271 certificates and Lua scripts together as relocatable packages. When
1272 multiple configuration files are loaded, the directory is updated for
1273 each of them.
1274
1275 - "parent" indicates that all relative files should be loaded from the
1276 parent of the directory containing the configuration file. More
1277 specifically, if the configuration file contains a slash ('/'), ".."
1278 is appended to the longest part up to the last slash is used as the
1279 directory to change to, otherwise the directory is "..". This mode is
1280 convenient to bundle maps, errorfiles, certificates and Lua scripts
1281 together as relocatable packages, but where each part is located in a
1282 different subdirectory (e.g. "config/", "certs/", "maps/", ...).
1283
1284 - "origin" indicates that all relative files should be loaded from the
1285 designated (mandatory) path. This may be used to ease management of
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001286 different HAProxy instances running in parallel on a system, where each
Willy Tarreau8a022d52021-04-27 20:29:11 +02001287 instance uses a different prefix but where the rest of the sections are
1288 made easily relocatable.
1289
1290 Each "default-path" directive instantly replaces any previous one and will
1291 possibly result in switching to a different directory. While this should
1292 always result in the desired behavior, it is really not a good practice to
1293 use multiple default-path directives, and if used, the policy ought to remain
1294 consistent across all configuration files.
1295
1296 Warning: some configuration elements such as maps or certificates are
1297 uniquely identified by their configured path. By using a relocatable layout,
1298 it becomes possible for several of them to end up with the same unique name,
1299 making it difficult to update them at run time, especially when multiple
1300 configuration files are loaded from different directories. It is essential to
1301 observe a strict collision-free file naming scheme before adopting relative
1302 paths. A robust approach could consist in prefixing all files names with
1303 their respective site name, or in doing so at the directory level.
1304
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001305description <text>
1306 Add a text that describes the instance.
1307
1308 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
1309 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
1310 "<" and ">" characters.
1311
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001312deviceatlas-json-file <path>
1313 Sets the path of the DeviceAtlas JSON data file to be loaded by the API.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001314 The path must be a valid JSON data file and accessible by HAProxy process.
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001315
1316deviceatlas-log-level <value>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001317 Sets the level of information returned by the API. This directive is
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001318 optional and set to 0 by default if not set.
1319
Cyril Bonté0306c4a2015-10-26 22:37:38 +01001320deviceatlas-properties-cookie <name>
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001321 Sets the client cookie's name used for the detection if the DeviceAtlas
1322 Client-side component was used during the request. This directive is optional
1323 and set to DAPROPS by default if not set.
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +01001324
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001325deviceatlas-separator <char>
1326 Sets the character separator for the API properties results. This directive
1327 is optional and set to | by default if not set.
1328
Amaury Denoyelled2e53cd2021-05-06 16:21:39 +02001329expose-experimental-directives
1330 This statement must appear before using directives tagged as experimental or
1331 the config file will be rejected.
1332
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001333external-check
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001334 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks. This is
1335 disabled by default as a security precaution, and even when enabled, checks
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001336 may still fail unless "insecure-fork-wanted" is enabled as well. If the
1337 program launched makes use of a setuid executable (it should really not),
1338 you may also need to set "insecure-setuid-wanted" in the global section.
1339 See "option external-check", and "insecure-fork-wanted", and
1340 "insecure-setuid-wanted".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001341
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001342gid <number>
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -07001343 Changes the process's group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001344 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
1345 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001346 Note that if HAProxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +01001347 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001348 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001349
Willy Tarreau11770ce2019-12-03 08:29:22 +01001350group <group name>
1351 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
1352 See also "gid" and "user".
1353
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02001354h1-case-adjust <from> <to>
1355 Defines the case adjustment to apply, when enabled, to the header name
1356 <from>, to change it to <to> before sending it to HTTP/1 clients or
1357 servers. <from> must be in lower case, and <from> and <to> must not differ
1358 except for their case. It may be repeated if several header names need to be
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05001359 adjusted. Duplicate entries are not allowed. If a lot of header names have to
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02001360 be adjusted, it might be more convenient to use "h1-case-adjust-file".
1361 Please note that no transformation will be applied unless "option
1362 h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is
1363 specified in a proxy.
1364
1365 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
1366 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
1367 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
1368 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
1369 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
1370 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
1371 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
1372
1373 Applications which fail to properly process requests or responses may require
1374 to temporarily use such workarounds to adjust header names sent to them for
1375 the time it takes the application to be fixed. Please note that an
1376 application which requires such workarounds might be vulnerable to content
1377 smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
1378
1379 Example:
1380 global
1381 h1-case-adjust content-length Content-Length
1382
1383 See "h1-case-adjust-file", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
1384 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
1385
1386h1-case-adjust-file <hdrs-file>
1387 Defines a file containing a list of key/value pairs used to adjust the case
1388 of some header names before sending them to HTTP/1 clients or servers. The
1389 file <hdrs-file> must contain 2 header names per line. The first one must be
1390 in lower case and both must not differ except for their case. Lines which
1391 start with '#' are ignored, just like empty lines. Leading and trailing tabs
1392 and spaces are stripped. Duplicate entries are not allowed. Please note that
1393 no transformation will be applied unless "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client"
1394 or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is specified in a proxy.
1395
1396 If this directive is repeated, only the last one will be processed. It is an
1397 alternative to the directive "h1-case-adjust" if a lot of header names need
1398 to be adjusted. Please read the risks associated with using this.
1399
1400 See "h1-case-adjust", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
1401 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
1402
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001403h2-workaround-bogus-websocket-clients
1404 This disables the announcement of the support for h2 websockets to clients.
1405 This can be use to overcome clients which have issues when implementing the
1406 relatively fresh RFC8441, such as Firefox 88. To allow clients to
1407 automatically downgrade to http/1.1 for the websocket tunnel, specify h2
1408 support on the bind line using "alpn" without an explicit "proto" keyword. If
1409 this statement was previously activated, this can be disabled by prefixing
1410 the keyword with "no'.
1411
1412hard-stop-after <time>
1413 Defines the maximum time allowed to perform a clean soft-stop.
1414
1415 Arguments :
1416 <time> is the maximum time (by default in milliseconds) for which the
1417 instance will remain alive when a soft-stop is received via the
1418 SIGUSR1 signal.
1419
1420 This may be used to ensure that the instance will quit even if connections
1421 remain opened during a soft-stop (for example with long timeouts for a proxy
1422 in tcp mode). It applies both in TCP and HTTP mode.
1423
1424 Example:
1425 global
1426 hard-stop-after 30s
1427
1428 See also: grace
1429
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001430insecure-fork-wanted
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001431 By default HAProxy tries hard to prevent any thread and process creation
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001432 after it starts. Doing so is particularly important when using Lua files of
1433 uncertain origin, and when experimenting with development versions which may
1434 still contain bugs whose exploitability is uncertain. And generally speaking
1435 it's good hygiene to make sure that no unexpected background activity can be
1436 triggered by traffic. But this prevents external checks from working, and may
1437 break some very specific Lua scripts which actively rely on the ability to
1438 fork. This option is there to disable this protection. Note that it is a bad
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001439 idea to disable it, as a vulnerability in a library or within HAProxy itself
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001440 will be easier to exploit once disabled. In addition, forking from Lua or
1441 anywhere else is not reliable as the forked process may randomly embed a lock
1442 set by another thread and never manage to finish an operation. As such it is
1443 highly recommended that this option is never used and that any workload
1444 requiring such a fork be reconsidered and moved to a safer solution (such as
1445 agents instead of external checks). This option supports the "no" prefix to
1446 disable it.
1447
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001448insecure-setuid-wanted
1449 HAProxy doesn't need to call executables at run time (except when using
1450 external checks which are strongly recommended against), and is even expected
1451 to isolate itself into an empty chroot. As such, there basically is no valid
1452 reason to allow a setuid executable to be called without the user being fully
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001453 aware of the risks. In a situation where HAProxy would need to call external
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001454 checks and/or disable chroot, exploiting a vulnerability in a library or in
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001455 HAProxy itself could lead to the execution of an external program. On Linux
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001456 it is possible to lock the process so that any setuid bit present on such an
1457 executable is ignored. This significantly reduces the risk of privilege
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001458 escalation in such a situation. This is what HAProxy does by default. In case
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001459 this causes a problem to an external check (for example one which would need
1460 the "ping" command), then it is possible to disable this protection by
1461 explicitly adding this directive in the global section. If enabled, it is
1462 possible to turn it back off by prefixing it with the "no" keyword.
1463
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +01001464issuers-chain-path <dir>
1465 Assigns a directory to load certificate chain for issuer completion. All
1466 files must be in PEM format. For certificates loaded with "crt" or "crt-list",
1467 if certificate chain is not included in PEM (also commonly known as
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001468 intermediate certificate), HAProxy will complete chain if the issuer of the
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +01001469 certificate corresponds to the first certificate of the chain loaded with
1470 "issuers-chain-path".
1471 A "crt" file with PrivateKey+Certificate+IntermediateCA2+IntermediateCA1
1472 could be replaced with PrivateKey+Certificate. HAProxy will complete the
1473 chain if a file with IntermediateCA2+IntermediateCA1 is present in
1474 "issuers-chain-path" directory. All other certificates with the same issuer
1475 will share the chain in memory.
1476
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02001477localpeer <name>
1478 Sets the local instance's peer name. It will be ignored if the "-L"
1479 command line argument is specified or if used after "peers" section
1480 definitions. In such cases, a warning message will be emitted during
1481 the configuration parsing.
1482
1483 This option will also set the HAPROXY_LOCALPEER environment variable.
1484 See also "-L" in the management guide and "peers" section below.
1485
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01001486log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02001487 <facility> [max level [min level]]
Cyril Bonté3e954872018-03-20 23:30:27 +01001488 Adds a global syslog server. Several global servers can be defined. They
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001489 will receive logs for starts and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001490 configured with "log global".
1491
1492 <address> can be one of:
1493
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01001494 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001495 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
1496 port).
1497
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01001498 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
1499 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
1500 port).
1501
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001502 - A filesystem path to a datagram UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001503 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
1504 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001505 writable).
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001506
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001507 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may point
1508 to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered logs are used
1509 and one writev() call per log is performed. This is a bit expensive
1510 but acceptable for most workloads. Messages sent this way will not be
1511 truncated but may be dropped, in which case the DroppedLogs counter
1512 will be incremented. The writev() call is atomic even on pipes for
1513 messages up to PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least
1514 512 and which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
1515 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other processes.
1516 Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file descriptor may also be
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001517 directed to a file, but doing so will significantly slow HAProxy down
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001518 as non-blocking calls will be ignored. Also there will be no way to
1519 purge nor rotate this file without restarting the process. Note that
1520 the configured syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001521 for use with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
1522 format below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001523
1524 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1" and
1525 "fd@2", see above.
1526
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02001527 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond to an
1528 in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the "show events"
1529 command, which will also list existing rings and their sizes. Such
1530 buffers are lost on reload or restart but when used as a complement
1531 this can help troubleshooting by having the logs instantly available.
1532
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02001533 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
1534 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001535
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001536 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
1537 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
1538 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
1539 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
1540 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
1541 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
1542 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
1543 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
1544 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
1545 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001546 JSON-formatted logs may require larger values. You may also need to
1547 increase "tune.http.logurilen" if your request URIs are truncated.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001548
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001549 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
1550 one of the following :
1551
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01001552 local Analog to rfc3164 syslog message format except that hostname
1553 field is stripped. This is the default.
1554 Note: option "log-send-hostname" switches the default to
1555 rfc3164.
1556
1557 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format.
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001558 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
1559
1560 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
1561 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
1562
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02001563 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between
1564 angle brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID,
1565 date, time, process name and system name are omitted. This is
1566 designed to be used with a local log server.
1567
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001568 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
1569 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
1570 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
1571 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
1572 logger consumes.
1573
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02001574 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
1575 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
1576 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
1577 used with a local log server.
1578
1579 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
1580 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
1581 designed to be used with a local log server.
1582
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001583 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
1584 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
1585 used in containers or during development, where the severity only
1586 depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
1587
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02001588 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
1589 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
1590 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
1591 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must be
1592 set with <sample_size> parameter.
1593
1594 <sample_size>
1595 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
1596 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
1597 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
1598 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
1599 (see also <ranges> parameter).
1600
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001601 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001602
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001603 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
1604 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
1605 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
1606
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001607 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
1608 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
1609 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
1610 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001611
1612 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02001613 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
1614 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
1615 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
1616 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
1617 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
1618 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001619
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001620 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001621
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +01001622log-send-hostname [<string>]
1623 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
1624 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
1625 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
1626 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
1627 the logs.
1628
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001629log-tag <string>
1630 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
1631 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
1632 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01001633 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001634
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001635lua-load <file>
Thierry Fournier59f11be2020-11-29 00:37:41 +01001636 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file in the shared context
1637 that is visible to all threads. Any variable set in such a context is visible
1638 from any thread. This is the easiest and recommended way to load Lua programs
1639 but it will not scale well if a lot of Lua calls are performed, as only one
1640 thread may be running on the global state at a time. A program loaded this
1641 way will always see 0 in the "core.thread" variable. This directive can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001642 used multiple times.
1643
Thierry Fournier59f11be2020-11-29 00:37:41 +01001644lua-load-per-thread <file>
1645 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file into each started thread.
1646 Any global variable has a thread-local visibility so that each thread could
1647 see a different value. As such it is strongly recommended not to use global
1648 variables in programs loaded this way. An independent copy is loaded and
1649 initialized for each thread, everything is done sequentially and in the
1650 thread's numeric order from 1 to nbthread. If some operations need to be
1651 performed only once, the program should check the "core.thread" variable to
1652 figure what thread is being initialized. Programs loaded this way will run
1653 concurrently on all threads and will be highly scalable. This is the
1654 recommended way to load simple functions that register sample-fetches,
1655 converters, actions or services once it is certain the program doesn't depend
1656 on global variables. For the sake of simplicity, the directive is available
1657 even if only one thread is used and even if threads are disabled (in which
1658 case it will be equivalent to lua-load). This directive can be used multiple
1659 times.
1660
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +01001661lua-prepend-path <string> [<type>]
1662 Prepends the given string followed by a semicolon to Lua's package.<type>
1663 variable.
1664 <type> must either be "path" or "cpath". If <type> is not given it defaults
1665 to "path".
1666
1667 Lua's paths are semicolon delimited lists of patterns that specify how the
1668 `require` function attempts to find the source file of a library. Question
1669 marks (?) within a pattern will be replaced by module name. The path is
1670 evaluated left to right. This implies that paths that are prepended later
1671 will be checked earlier.
1672
1673 As an example by specifying the following path:
1674
1675 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?/init.lua
1676 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?.lua
1677
1678 When `require "example"` is being called Lua will first attempt to load the
1679 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example.lua script, if that does not exist the
1680 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example/init.lua will be attempted and the default
1681 paths if that does not exist either.
1682
1683 See https://www.lua.org/pil/8.1.html for the details within the Lua
1684 documentation.
1685
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001686master-worker [no-exit-on-failure]
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001687 Master-worker mode. It is equivalent to the command line "-W" argument.
1688 This mode will launch a "master" which will monitor the "workers". Using
1689 this mode, you can reload HAProxy directly by sending a SIGUSR2 signal to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001690 the master. The master-worker mode is compatible either with the foreground
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001691 or daemon mode. It is recommended to use this mode with multiprocess and
1692 systemd.
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001693 By default, if a worker exits with a bad return code, in the case of a
1694 segfault for example, all workers will be killed, and the master will leave.
1695 It is convenient to combine this behavior with Restart=on-failure in a
1696 systemd unit file in order to relaunch the whole process. If you don't want
1697 this behavior, you must use the keyword "no-exit-on-failure".
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001698
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001699 See also "-W" in the management guide.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001700
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001701mworker-max-reloads <number>
1702 In master-worker mode, this option limits the number of time a worker can
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001703 survive to a reload. If the worker did not leave after a reload, once its
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001704 number of reloads is greater than this number, the worker will receive a
1705 SIGTERM. This option helps to keep under control the number of workers.
1706 See also "show proc" in the Management Guide.
1707
Willy Tarreauf42d7942020-10-20 11:54:49 +02001708nbproc <number> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001709 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
1710 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
1711 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001712 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. When set to a value
1713 larger than 1, threads are automatically disabled. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
Willy Tarreauf42d7942020-10-20 11:54:49 +02001714 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. This directive is deprecated
1715 and scheduled for removal in 2.5. Please use "nbthread" instead. See also
1716 "daemon" and "nbthread".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001717
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001718nbthread <number>
1719 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001720 makes HAProxy run on <number> threads. This is exclusive with "nbproc". While
Willy Tarreau26f6ae12019-02-02 12:56:15 +01001721 "nbproc" historically used to be the only way to use multiple processors, it
1722 also involved a number of shortcomings related to the lack of synchronization
1723 between processes (health-checks, peers, stick-tables, stats, ...) which do
1724 not affect threads. As such, any modern configuration is strongly encouraged
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001725 to migrate away from "nbproc" to "nbthread". "nbthread" also works when
1726 HAProxy is started in foreground. On some platforms supporting CPU affinity,
1727 when nbproc is not used, the default "nbthread" value is automatically set to
1728 the number of CPUs the process is bound to upon startup. This means that the
1729 thread count can easily be adjusted from the calling process using commands
1730 like "taskset" or "cpuset". Otherwise, this value defaults to 1. The default
1731 value is reported in the output of "haproxy -vv". See also "nbproc".
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001732
Amaury Denoyelle0f50cb92021-03-26 18:50:33 +01001733numa-cpu-mapping
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001734 By default, if running on Linux, HAProxy inspects on startup the CPU topology
Amaury Denoyelle0f50cb92021-03-26 18:50:33 +01001735 of the machine. If a multi-socket machine is detected, the affinity is
1736 automatically calculated to run on the CPUs of a single node. This is done in
1737 order to not suffer from the performance penalties caused by the inter-socket
1738 bus latency. However, if the applied binding is non optimal on a particular
1739 architecture, it can be disabled with the statement 'no numa-cpu-mapping'.
1740 This automatic binding is also not applied if a nbthread statement is present
1741 in the configuration, or the affinity of the process is already specified,
1742 for example via the 'cpu-map' directive or the taskset utility.
1743
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001744pidfile <pidfile>
MIZUTA Takeshic32f3942020-08-26 13:46:19 +09001745 Writes PIDs of all daemons into file <pidfile> when daemon mode or writes PID
1746 of master process into file <pidfile> when master-worker mode. This option is
1747 equivalent to the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to
1748 the user starting the process. See also "daemon" and "master-worker".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001749
Willy Tarreau119e50e2020-05-22 13:53:29 +02001750pp2-never-send-local
1751 A bug in the PROXY protocol v2 implementation was present in HAProxy up to
1752 version 2.1, causing it to emit a PROXY command instead of a LOCAL command
1753 for health checks. This is particularly minor but confuses some servers'
1754 logs. Sadly, the bug was discovered very late and revealed that some servers
1755 which possibly only tested their PROXY protocol implementation against
1756 HAProxy fail to properly handle the LOCAL command, and permanently remain in
1757 the "down" state when HAProxy checks them. When this happens, it is possible
1758 to enable this global option to revert to the older (bogus) behavior for the
1759 time it takes to contact the affected components' vendors and get them fixed.
1760 This option is disabled by default and acts on all servers having the
1761 "send-proxy-v2" statement.
1762
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001763presetenv <name> <value>
1764 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1765 is NOT overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line
1766 in the configuration file sees the new value. See also "setenv", "resetenv",
1767 and "unsetenv".
1768
1769resetenv [<name> ...]
1770 Removes all environment variables except the ones specified in argument. It
1771 allows to use a clean controlled environment before setting new values with
1772 setenv or unsetenv. Please note that some internal functions may make use of
1773 some environment variables, such as time manipulation functions, but also
1774 OpenSSL or even external checks. This must be used with extreme care and only
1775 after complete validation. The changes immediately take effect so that the
1776 next line in the configuration file sees the new environment. See also
1777 "setenv", "presetenv", and "unsetenv".
1778
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001779stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001780 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
1781 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
1782 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
1783 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
1784 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
1785 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001786 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001787 word size (32 or 64). Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can
1788 be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum
1789 value. A better option consists in using the "process" setting of the "stats
1790 socket" line to force the process on each line.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001791
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001792server-state-base <directory>
1793 Specifies the directory prefix to be prepended in front of all servers state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001794 file names which do not start with a '/'. See also "server-state-file",
1795 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name".
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +02001796
1797server-state-file <file>
1798 Specifies the path to the file containing state of servers. If the path starts
1799 with a slash ('/'), it is considered absolute, otherwise it is considered
1800 relative to the directory specified using "server-state-base" (if set) or to
1801 the current directory. Before reloading HAProxy, it is possible to save the
1802 servers' current state using the stats command "show servers state". The
1803 output of this command must be written in the file pointed by <file>. When
1804 starting up, before handling traffic, HAProxy will read, load and apply state
1805 for each server found in the file and available in its current running
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001806 configuration. See also "server-state-base" and "show servers state",
1807 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name"
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001808
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001809set-dumpable
1810 This option is better left disabled by default and enabled only upon a
1811 developer's request. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly
1812 disabled by prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It has no impact on
1813 performance nor stability but will try hard to re-enable core dumps that were
1814 possibly disabled by file size limitations (ulimit -f), core size limitations
1815 (ulimit -c), or "dumpability" of a process after changing its UID/GID (such
1816 as /proc/sys/fs/suid_dumpable on Linux). Core dumps might still be limited by
1817 the current directory's permissions (check what directory the file is started
1818 from), the chroot directory's permission (it may be needed to temporarily
1819 disable the chroot directive or to move it to a dedicated writable location),
1820 or any other system-specific constraint. For example, some Linux flavours are
1821 notorious for replacing the default core file with a path to an executable
1822 not even installed on the system (check /proc/sys/kernel/core_pattern). Often,
1823 simply writing "core", "core.%p" or "/var/log/core/core.%p" addresses the
1824 issue. When trying to enable this option waiting for a rare issue to
1825 re-appear, it's often a good idea to first try to obtain such a dump by
1826 issuing, for example, "kill -11" to the "haproxy" process and verify that it
1827 leaves a core where expected when dying.
1828
Willy Tarreau13d2ba22021-03-26 11:38:08 +01001829set-var <var-name> <expr>
1830 Sets the process-wide variable '<var-name>' to the result of the evaluation
1831 of the sample expression <expr>. The variable '<var-name>' may only be a
1832 process-wide variable (using the 'proc.' prefix). It works exactly like the
1833 'set-var' action in TCP or HTTP rules except that the expression is evaluated
1834 at configuration parsing time and that the variable is instantly set. The
1835 sample fetch functions and converters permitted in the expression are only
1836 those using internal data, typically 'int(value)' or 'str(value)'. It's is
1837 possible to reference previously allocated variables as well. These variables
1838 will then be readable (and modifiable) from the regular rule sets.
1839
1840 Example:
1841 global
1842 set-var proc.current_state str(primary)
1843 set-var proc.prio int(100)
1844 set-var proc.threshold int(200),sub(proc.prio)
1845
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001846setenv <name> <value>
1847 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1848 is overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line in
1849 the configuration file sees the new value. See also "presetenv", "resetenv",
1850 and "unsetenv".
1851
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001852ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
1853 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1854 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001855 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 for all
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001856 "bind" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001857 is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1858 information and recommendations see e.g.
1859 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1860 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
1861 cipher configuration, please check the "ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites" keyword.
1862 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001863
1864ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1865 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1866 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default string
1867 describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated
1868 during the TLSv1.3 handshake for all "bind" lines which do not explicitly define
1869 theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001870 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1871 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1872 "ssl-default-bind-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "bind" keyword for more
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001873 information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001874
Jerome Magninb203ff62020-04-03 15:28:22 +02001875ssl-default-bind-curves <curves>
1876 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1877 the default string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve
1878 suite") that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format
1879 of the string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
1880 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
1881
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001882ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
1883 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1884 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
1885 keyword to see available options.
1886
1887 Example:
1888 global
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +02001889 ssl-default-bind-options ssl-min-ver TLSv1.0 no-tls-tickets
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001890
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001891ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
1892 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
1893 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001894 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 with the server,
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001895 for all "server" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001896 the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1897 information and recommendations see e.g.
1898 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1899 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/).
1900 For TLSv1.3 cipher configuration, please check the
1901 "ssl-default-server-ciphersuites" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword
1902 for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001903
1904ssl-default-server-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1905 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1906 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default
1907 string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are negotiated during
1908 the TLSv1.3 handshake with the server, for all "server" lines which do not
1909 explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001910 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1911 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1912 "ssl-default-server-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword for
1913 more information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001914
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001915ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
1916 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1917 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
1918 keyword to see available options.
1919
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001920ssl-dh-param-file <file>
1921 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1922 the default DH parameters that are used during the SSL/TLS handshake when
1923 ephemeral Diffie-Hellman (DHE) key exchange is used, for all "bind" lines
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001924 which do not explicitly define theirs. It will be overridden by custom DH
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001925 parameters found in a bind certificate file if any. If custom DH parameters
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001926 are not specified either by using ssl-dh-param-file or by setting them
1927 directly in the certificate file, pre-generated DH parameters of the size
1928 specified by tune.ssl.default-dh-param will be used. Custom parameters are
1929 known to be more secure and therefore their use is recommended.
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001930 Custom DH parameters may be generated by using the OpenSSL command
1931 "openssl dhparam <size>", where size should be at least 2048, as 1024-bit DH
1932 parameters should not be considered secure anymore.
1933
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02001934ssl-load-extra-del-ext
1935 This setting allows to configure the way HAProxy does the lookup for the
1936 extra SSL files. By default HAProxy adds a new extension to the filename.
William Lallemand089c1382020-10-23 17:35:12 +02001937 (ex: with "foobar.crt" load "foobar.crt.key"). With this option enabled,
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02001938 HAProxy removes the extension before adding the new one (ex: with
William Lallemand089c1382020-10-23 17:35:12 +02001939 "foobar.crt" load "foobar.key").
1940
1941 Your crt file must have a ".crt" extension for this option to work.
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02001942
1943 This option is not compatible with bundle extensions (.ecdsa, .rsa. .dsa)
1944 and won't try to remove them.
1945
1946 This option is disabled by default. See also "ssl-load-extra-files".
1947
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001948ssl-load-extra-files <none|all|bundle|sctl|ocsp|issuer|key>*
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001949 This setting alters the way HAProxy will look for unspecified files during
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02001950 the loading of the SSL certificates. This option applies to certificates
1951 associated to "bind" lines as well as "server" lines but some of the extra
1952 files will not have any functional impact for "server" line certificates.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001953
1954 By default, HAProxy discovers automatically a lot of files not specified in
1955 the configuration, and you may want to disable this behavior if you want to
1956 optimize the startup time.
1957
1958 "none": Only load the files specified in the configuration. Don't try to load
1959 a certificate bundle if the file does not exist. In the case of a directory,
1960 it won't try to bundle the certificates if they have the same basename.
1961
1962 "all": This is the default behavior, it will try to load everything,
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001963 bundles, sctl, ocsp, issuer, key.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001964
1965 "bundle": When a file specified in the configuration does not exist, HAProxy
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02001966 will try to load a "cert bundle". Certificate bundles are only managed on the
1967 frontend side and will not work for backend certificates.
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02001968
1969 Starting from HAProxy 2.3, the bundles are not loaded in the same OpenSSL
1970 certificate store, instead it will loads each certificate in a separate
1971 store which is equivalent to declaring multiple "crt". OpenSSL 1.1.1 is
1972 required to achieve this. Which means that bundles are now used only for
1973 backward compatibility and are not mandatory anymore to do an hybrid RSA/ECC
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02001974 bind configuration.
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02001975
1976 To associate these PEM files into a "cert bundle" that is recognized by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001977 HAProxy, they must be named in the following way: All PEM files that are to
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02001978 be bundled must have the same base name, with a suffix indicating the key
1979 type. Currently, three suffixes are supported: rsa, dsa and ecdsa. For
1980 example, if www.example.com has two PEM files, an RSA file and an ECDSA
1981 file, they must be named: "example.pem.rsa" and "example.pem.ecdsa". The
1982 first part of the filename is arbitrary; only the suffix matters. To load
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001983 this bundle into HAProxy, specify the base name only:
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02001984
1985 Example : bind :8443 ssl crt example.pem
1986
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001987 Note that the suffix is not given to HAProxy; this tells HAProxy to look for
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02001988 a cert bundle.
1989
1990 HAProxy will load all PEM files in the bundle as if they were configured
1991 separately in several "crt".
1992
1993 The bundle loading does not have an impact anymore on the directory loading
1994 since files are loading separately.
1995
1996 On the CLI, bundles are seen as separate files, and the bundle extension is
1997 required to commit them.
1998
William Dauchy57dd6f12020-10-06 15:22:37 +02001999 OCSP files (.ocsp), issuer files (.issuer), Certificate Transparency (.sctl)
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02002000 as well as private keys (.key) are supported with multi-cert bundling.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002001
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02002002 "sctl": Try to load "<basename>.sctl" for each crt keyword. If provided for
2003 a backend certificate, it will be loaded but will not have any functional
2004 impact.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002005
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02002006 "ocsp": Try to load "<basename>.ocsp" for each crt keyword. If provided for
2007 a backend certificate, it will be loaded but will not have any functional
2008 impact.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002009
2010 "issuer": Try to load "<basename>.issuer" if the issuer of the OCSP file is
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02002011 not provided in the PEM file. If provided for a backend certificate, it will
2012 be loaded but will not have any functional impact.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002013
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01002014 "key": If the private key was not provided by the PEM file, try to load a
2015 file "<basename>.key" containing a private key.
2016
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002017 The default behavior is "all".
2018
2019 Example:
2020 ssl-load-extra-files bundle sctl
2021 ssl-load-extra-files sctl ocsp issuer
2022 ssl-load-extra-files none
2023
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02002024 See also: "crt", section 5.1 about bind options and section 5.2 about server
2025 options.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002026
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01002027ssl-server-verify [none|required]
2028 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
2029 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
2030 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
2031
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02002032ssl-skip-self-issued-ca
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04002033 Self issued CA, aka x509 root CA, is the anchor for chain validation: as a
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02002034 server is useless to send it, client must have it. Standard configuration
2035 need to not include such CA in PEM file. This option allows you to keep such
2036 CA in PEM file without sending it to the client. Use case is to provide
2037 issuer for ocsp without the need for '.issuer' file and be able to share it
2038 with 'issuers-chain-path'. This concerns all certificates without intermediate
2039 certificates. It's useless for BoringSSL, .issuer is ignored because ocsp
William Lallemand9a1d8392020-08-10 17:28:23 +02002040 bits does not need it. Requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.2.
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02002041
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01002042stats maxconn <connections>
2043 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
2044 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
2045
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02002046stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
2047 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
2048 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
2049 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02002050 consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide for more
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +02002051 details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +02002052
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02002053 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
2054 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
2055 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02002056
2057stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
2058 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
2059 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +01002060 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02002061
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01002062strict-limits
2063 Makes process fail at startup when a setrlimit fails. HAProxy tries to set the
2064 best setrlimit according to what has been calculated. If it fails, it will
2065 emit a warning. This option is here to guarantee an explicit failure of
2066 HAProxy when those limits fail. It is enabled by default. It may still be
2067 forcibly disabled by prefixing it with the "no" keyword.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02002068
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002069uid <number>
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -07002070 Changes the process's user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002071 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
2072 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
2073 one. See also "gid" and "user".
2074
2075ulimit-n <number>
2076 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
2077 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
2078 option.
2079
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002080unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
2081 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
2082
2083 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
2084 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
2085 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
2086 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
2087 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002088 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before HAProxy chroots
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002089 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
2090 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
2091 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
2092 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
2093
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01002094unsetenv [<name> ...]
2095 Removes environment variables specified in arguments. This can be useful to
2096 hide some sensitive information that are occasionally inherited from the
2097 user's environment during some operations. Variables which did not exist are
2098 silently ignored so that after the operation, it is certain that none of
2099 these variables remain. The changes immediately take effect so that the next
2100 line in the configuration file will not see these variables. See also
2101 "setenv", "presetenv", and "resetenv".
2102
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002103user <user name>
2104 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
2105 See also "uid" and "group".
2106
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02002107node <name>
2108 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
2109
2110 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
2111 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
2112 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
2113 traffic.
2114
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01002115wurfl-cache-size <size>
2116 Sets the WURFL Useragent cache size. For faster lookups, already processed user
2117 agents are kept in a LRU cache :
2118 - "0" : no cache is used.
2119 - <size> : size of lru cache in elements.
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02002120
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01002121 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
2122 with USE_WURFL=1.
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01002123
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002124wurfl-data-file <file path>
2125 The path of the WURFL data file to provide device detection services. The
2126 file should be accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
2127
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002128 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002129 with USE_WURFL=1.
2130
2131wurfl-information-list [<capability>]*
2132 A space-delimited list of WURFL capabilities, virtual capabilities, property
2133 names we plan to use in injected headers. A full list of capability and
2134 virtual capability names is available on the Scientiamobile website :
2135
2136 https://www.scientiamobile.com/wurflCapability
2137
2138 Valid WURFL properties are:
2139 - wurfl_id Contains the device ID of the matched device.
2140
2141 - wurfl_root_id Contains the device root ID of the matched
2142 device.
2143
2144 - wurfl_isdevroot Tells if the matched device is a root device.
2145 Possible values are "TRUE" or "FALSE".
2146
2147 - wurfl_useragent The original useragent coming with this
2148 particular web request.
2149
2150 - wurfl_api_version Contains a string representing the currently
2151 used Libwurfl API version.
2152
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002153 - wurfl_info A string containing information on the parsed
2154 wurfl.xml and its full path.
2155
2156 - wurfl_last_load_time Contains the UNIX timestamp of the last time
2157 WURFL has been loaded successfully.
2158
2159 - wurfl_normalized_useragent The normalized useragent.
2160
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002161 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002162 with USE_WURFL=1.
2163
2164wurfl-information-list-separator <char>
2165 A char that will be used to separate values in a response header containing
2166 WURFL results. If not set that a comma (',') will be used by default.
2167
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002168 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002169 with USE_WURFL=1.
2170
2171wurfl-patch-file [<file path>]
2172 A list of WURFL patch file paths. Note that patches are loaded during startup
2173 thus before the chroot.
2174
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002175 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002176 with USE_WURFL=1.
2177
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021783.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002179-----------------------
2180
Willy Tarreaubeb859a2018-11-22 18:07:59 +01002181busy-polling
2182 In some situations, especially when dealing with low latency on processors
2183 supporting a variable frequency or when running inside virtual machines, each
2184 time the process waits for an I/O using the poller, the processor goes back
2185 to sleep or is offered to another VM for a long time, and it causes
2186 excessively high latencies. This option provides a solution preventing the
2187 processor from sleeping by always using a null timeout on the pollers. This
2188 results in a significant latency reduction (30 to 100 microseconds observed)
2189 at the expense of a risk to overheat the processor. It may even be used with
2190 threads, in which case improperly bound threads may heavily conflict,
2191 resulting in a worse performance and high values for the CPU stolen fields
2192 in "show info" output, indicating which threads are misconfigured. It is
2193 important not to let the process run on the same processor as the network
2194 interrupts when this option is used. It is also better to avoid using it on
2195 multiple CPU threads sharing the same core. This option is disabled by
2196 default. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly disabled by
2197 prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It is ignored by the "select" and
2198 "poll" pollers.
2199
William Dauchy3894d972019-12-28 15:36:02 +01002200 This option is automatically disabled on old processes in the context of
2201 seamless reload; it avoids too much cpu conflicts when multiple processes
2202 stay around for some time waiting for the end of their current connections.
2203
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02002204max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002205 By default, HAProxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02002206 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
2207 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
2208 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
2209 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
2210 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
2211 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
2212 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
2213
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01002214maxcompcpuusage <number>
2215 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
2216 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
2217 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
2218 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by HAProxy. A
2219 value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting a lower
2220 value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole process down
2221 and from introducing high latencies.
2222
2223maxcomprate <number>
2224 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
2225 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
2226 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
2227 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
2228 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
2229 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
2230 default value.
2231
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002232maxconn <number>
2233 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
2234 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
2235 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +02002236 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
2237 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
2238 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
2239 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaub28f3442019-03-04 08:13:43 +01002240 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will automatically be
2241 calculated based on the current file descriptors limit reported by the
2242 "ulimit -n" command, possibly reduced to a lower value if a memory limit
2243 is enforced, based on the buffer size, memory allocated to compression, SSL
2244 cache size, and use or not of SSL and the associated maxsslconn (which can
2245 also be automatic).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002246
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02002247maxconnrate <number>
2248 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
2249 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
2250 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
2251 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
2252 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
2253 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
2254 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
2255 fairness.
2256
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002257maxpipes <number>
2258 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
2259 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
2260 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
2261 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
2262 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
2263 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
2264
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02002265maxsessrate <number>
2266 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
2267 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
2268 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
2269 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
2270 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
2271 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
2272 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
2273 fairness.
2274
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02002275maxsslconn <number>
2276 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
2277 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
2278 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
2279 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
2280 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
2281 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
2282 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01002283 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
2284 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
2285 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
2286 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002287 when there is a memory limit, HAProxy will automatically adjust these values
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01002288 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
2289 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02002290
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02002291maxsslrate <number>
2292 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
2293 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
2294 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
2295 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
2296 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
2297 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
2298 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
2299 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
2300 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
2301 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
2302
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +01002303maxzlibmem <number>
2304 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
2305 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
2306 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +01002307 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
2308 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
2309 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
2310
Willy Tarreau85dd5212022-03-08 10:41:40 +01002311no-memory-trimming
2312 Disables memory trimming ("malloc_trim") at a few moments where attempts are
2313 made to reclaim lots of memory (on memory shortage or on reload). Trimming
2314 memory forces the system's allocator to scan all unused areas and to release
2315 them. This is generally seen as nice action to leave more available memory to
2316 a new process while the old one is unlikely to make significant use of it.
2317 But some systems dealing with tens to hundreds of thousands of concurrent
2318 connections may experience a lot of memory fragmentation, that may render
2319 this release operation extremely long. During this time, no more traffic
2320 passes through the process, new connections are not accepted anymore, some
2321 health checks may even fail, and the watchdog may even trigger and kill the
2322 unresponsive process, leaving a huge core dump. If this ever happens, then it
2323 is suggested to use this option to disable trimming and stop trying to be
2324 nice with the new process. Note that advanced memory allocators usually do
2325 not suffer from such a problem.
2326
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002327noepoll
2328 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
2329 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01002330 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002331
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00002332noevports
2333 Disables the use of the event ports event polling system on SunOS systems
2334 derived from Solaris 10 and later. It is equivalent to the command-line
2335 argument "-dv". The next polling system used will generally be "poll". See
2336 also "nopoll".
2337
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01002338nogetaddrinfo
2339 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
2340 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
2341
2342nokqueue
2343 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
2344 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
2345 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
2346
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002347nopoll
2348 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
2349 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002350 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00002351 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue", "noepoll" and
2352 "noevports".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002353
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01002354noreuseport
2355 Disables the use of SO_REUSEPORT - see socket(7). It is equivalent to the
2356 command line argument "-dR".
2357
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002358nosplice
2359 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002360 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002361 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002362 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002363 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
2364 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
2365 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
2366 "option splice-response".
2367
Willy Tarreauca3afc22021-05-05 18:33:19 +02002368profiling.memory { on | off }
2369 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') per-function memory profiling. This will
2370 keep usage statistics of malloc/calloc/realloc/free calls anywhere in the
2371 process (including libraries) which will be reported on the CLI using the
2372 "show profiling" command. This is essentially meant to be used when an
2373 abnormal memory usage is observed that cannot be explained by the pools and
2374 other info are required. The performance hit will typically be around 1%,
2375 maybe a bit more on highly threaded machines, so it is normally suitable for
2376 use in production. The same may be achieved at run time on the CLI using the
2377 "set profiling memory" command, please consult the management manual.
2378
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02002379profiling.tasks { auto | on | off }
2380 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') per-task CPU profiling. When set to 'auto'
2381 the profiling automatically turns on a thread when it starts to suffer from
2382 an average latency of 1000 microseconds or higher as reported in the
2383 "avg_loop_us" activity field, and automatically turns off when the latency
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002384 returns below 990 microseconds (this value is an average over the last 1024
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02002385 loops so it does not vary quickly and tends to significantly smooth short
2386 spikes). It may also spontaneously trigger from time to time on overloaded
2387 systems, containers, or virtual machines, or when the system swaps (which
2388 must absolutely never happen on a load balancer).
2389
2390 CPU profiling per task can be very convenient to report where the time is
2391 spent and which requests have what effect on which other request. Enabling
2392 it will typically affect the overall's performance by less than 1%, thus it
2393 is recommended to leave it to the default 'auto' value so that it only
2394 operates when a problem is identified. This feature requires a system
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +01002395 supporting the clock_gettime(2) syscall with clock identifiers
2396 CLOCK_MONOTONIC and CLOCK_THREAD_CPUTIME_ID, otherwise the reported time will
2397 be zero. This option may be changed at run time using "set profiling" on the
2398 CLI.
2399
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02002400spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09002401 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
2402 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
2403 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
2404 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
2405 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
2406 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02002407
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002408ssl-engine <name> [algo <comma-separated list of algorithms>]
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002409 Sets the OpenSSL engine to <name>. List of valid values for <name> may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002410 obtained using the command "openssl engine". This statement may be used
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002411 multiple times, it will simply enable multiple crypto engines. Referencing an
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002412 unsupported engine will prevent HAProxy from starting. Note that many engines
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002413 will lead to lower HTTPS performance than pure software with recent
2414 processors. The optional command "algo" sets the default algorithms an ENGINE
2415 will supply using the OPENSSL function ENGINE_set_default_string(). A value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002416 of "ALL" uses the engine for all cryptographic operations. If no list of
2417 algo is specified then the value of "ALL" is used. A comma-separated list
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002418 of different algorithms may be specified, including: RSA, DSA, DH, EC, RAND,
2419 CIPHERS, DIGESTS, PKEY, PKEY_CRYPTO, PKEY_ASN1. This is the same format that
2420 openssl configuration file uses:
2421 https://www.openssl.org/docs/man1.0.2/apps/config.html
2422
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00002423ssl-mode-async
2424 Adds SSL_MODE_ASYNC mode to the SSL context. This enables asynchronous TLS
Emeric Brun3854e012017-05-17 20:42:48 +02002425 I/O operations if asynchronous capable SSL engines are used. The current
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00002426 implementation supports a maximum of 32 engines. The Openssl ASYNC API
2427 doesn't support moving read/write buffers and is not compliant with
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002428 HAProxy's buffer management. So the asynchronous mode is disabled on
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002429 read/write operations (it is only enabled during initial and renegotiation
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00002430 handshakes).
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00002431
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01002432tune.buffers.limit <number>
2433 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
2434 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
2435 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
2436 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
2437 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002438 behavior. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01002439 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
2440 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
2441 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
2442 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
2443 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
2444 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
2445 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
2446 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002447 advised to do so by an HAProxy core developer.
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01002448
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01002449tune.buffers.reserve <number>
2450 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
2451 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
2452 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002453 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at HAProxy core developers.
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01002454
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002455tune.bufsize <number>
2456 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
2457 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
2458 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
2459 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
2460 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
2461 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
2462 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
Willy Tarreau45a66cc2017-11-24 11:28:00 +01002463 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased. In
2464 addition, use of HTTP/2 mandates that this value must be 16384 or more. If an
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002465 HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), HAProxy will
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04002466 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002467 than this size, HAProxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway). Note that the
Willy Tarreauc77d3642018-12-12 06:19:42 +01002468 value set using this parameter will automatically be rounded up to the next
2469 multiple of 8 on 32-bit machines and 16 on 64-bit machines.
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002470
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +01002471tune.chksize <number> (deprecated)
2472 This option is deprecated and ignored.
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +02002473
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01002474tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
2475 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
2476 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
2477 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
2478 this value. The default value is 1.
2479
Willy Tarreauc299e1e2019-02-27 11:35:12 +01002480tune.fail-alloc
2481 If compiled with DEBUG_FAIL_ALLOC, gives the percentage of chances an
2482 allocation attempt fails. Must be between 0 (no failure) and 100 (no
2483 success). This is useful to debug and make sure memory failures are handled
2484 gracefully.
2485
Willy Tarreaubc52bec2020-06-18 08:58:47 +02002486tune.fd.edge-triggered { on | off } [ EXPERIMENTAL ]
2487 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the edge-triggered polling mode for FDs
2488 that support it. This is currently only support with epoll. It may noticeably
2489 reduce the number of epoll_ctl() calls and slightly improve performance in
2490 certain scenarios. This is still experimental, it may result in frozen
2491 connections if bugs are still present, and is disabled by default.
2492
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02002493tune.h2.header-table-size <number>
2494 Sets the HTTP/2 dynamic header table size. It defaults to 4096 bytes and
2495 cannot be larger than 65536 bytes. A larger value may help certain clients
2496 send more compact requests, depending on their capabilities. This amount of
2497 memory is consumed for each HTTP/2 connection. It is recommended not to
2498 change it.
2499
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02002500tune.h2.initial-window-size <number>
2501 Sets the HTTP/2 initial window size, which is the number of bytes the client
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002502 can upload before waiting for an acknowledgment from HAProxy. This setting
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002503 only affects payload contents (i.e. the body of POST requests), not headers.
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02002504 The default value is 65535, which roughly allows up to 5 Mbps of upload
2505 bandwidth per client over a network showing a 100 ms ping time, or 500 Mbps
2506 over a 1-ms local network. It can make sense to increase this value to allow
2507 faster uploads, or to reduce it to increase fairness when dealing with many
2508 clients. It doesn't affect resource usage.
2509
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02002510tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams <number>
2511 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum number of concurrent streams per connection (ie the
2512 number of outstanding requests on a single connection). The default value is
2513 100. A larger one may slightly improve page load time for complex sites when
2514 visited over high latency networks, but increases the amount of resources a
2515 single client may allocate. A value of zero disables the limit so a single
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002516 client may create as many streams as allocatable by HAProxy. It is highly
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02002517 recommended not to change this value.
2518
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01002519tune.h2.max-frame-size <number>
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002520 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum frame size that HAProxy announces it is willing to
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01002521 receive to its peers. The default value is the largest between 16384 and the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002522 buffer size (tune.bufsize). In any case, HAProxy will not announce support
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01002523 for frame sizes larger than buffers. The main purpose of this setting is to
2524 allow to limit the maximum frame size setting when using large buffers. Too
2525 large frame sizes might have performance impact or cause some peers to
2526 misbehave. It is highly recommended not to change this value.
2527
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01002528tune.http.cookielen <number>
2529 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
2530 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
2531 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
2532 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
2533 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
2534 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
2535 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
2536 to change this value.
2537
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02002538tune.http.logurilen <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002539 Sets the maximum length of request URI in logs. This prevents truncating long
2540 request URIs with valuable query strings in log lines. This is not related
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02002541 to syslog limits. If you increase this limit, you may also increase the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002542 'log ... len yyy' parameter. Your syslog daemon may also need specific
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02002543 configuration directives too.
2544 The default value is 1024.
2545
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02002546tune.http.maxhdr <number>
2547 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
2548 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
2549 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
2550 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
2551 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
2552 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
Christopher Faulet50174f32017-06-21 16:31:35 +02002553 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. The accepted range is
2554 1..32767. Keep in mind that each new header consumes 32bits of memory for
2555 each session, so don't push this limit too high.
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02002556
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +02002557tune.idle-pool.shared { on | off }
2558 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') sharing of idle connection pools between
2559 threads for a same server. The default is to share them between threads in
2560 order to minimize the number of persistent connections to a server, and to
2561 optimize the connection reuse rate. But to help with debugging or when
2562 suspecting a bug in HAProxy around connection reuse, it can be convenient to
2563 forcefully disable this idle pool sharing between multiple threads, and force
Willy Tarreau0784db82021-02-19 11:45:22 +01002564 this option to "off". The default is on. It is strongly recommended against
2565 disabling this option without setting a conservative value on "pool-low-conn"
2566 for all servers relying on connection reuse to achieve a high performance
2567 level, otherwise connections might be closed very often as the thread count
2568 increases.
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +02002569
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002570tune.idletimer <timeout>
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002571 Sets the duration after which HAProxy will consider that an empty buffer is
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002572 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
2573 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
2574 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
2575 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002576 means that HAProxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002577 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (e.g. read a page before
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002578 clicking). There should be no reason for changing this value. Please check
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002579 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
2580
Willy Tarreau7ac908b2019-02-27 12:02:18 +01002581tune.listener.multi-queue { on | off }
2582 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the listener's multi-queue accept which
2583 spreads the incoming traffic to all threads a "bind" line is allowed to run
2584 on instead of taking them for itself. This provides a smoother traffic
2585 distribution and scales much better, especially in environments where threads
2586 may be unevenly loaded due to external activity (network interrupts colliding
2587 with one thread for example). This option is enabled by default, but it may
2588 be forcefully disabled for troubleshooting or for situations where it is
2589 estimated that the operating system already provides a good enough
2590 distribution and connections are extremely short-lived.
2591
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002592tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
2593 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01002594 instructions executed. This permits interrupting a long script and allows the
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002595 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
2596 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002597 executes some Lua code but more responsiveness is required, this value can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002598 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
2599 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
2600
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01002601tune.lua.maxmem
2602 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
2603 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
2604 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
2605 memory.
2606
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002607tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
2608 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002609 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
2610 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002611 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002612
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002613tune.lua.service-timeout <timeout>
2614 This is the execution timeout for the Lua services. This is useful for
2615 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
2616 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002617 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002618
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01002619tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
2620 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
2621 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
2622 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
2623 check servers.
2624
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01002625tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01002626 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
2627 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
Willy Tarreau66161322021-02-19 15:50:27 +01002628 used to give better performance at high connection rates, though this is not
2629 the case anymore with the multi-queue. This value applies individually to
2630 each listener, so that the number of processes a listener is bound to is
2631 taken into account. This value defaults to 4 which showed best results. If a
2632 significantly higher value was inherited from an ancient config, it might be
2633 worth removing it as it will both increase performance and lower response
2634 time. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice the number of processes
2635 the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1 completely disables the
2636 limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01002637
2638tune.maxpollevents <number>
2639 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
2640 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
2641 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
2642 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
2643 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
2644
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002645tune.maxrewrite <number>
2646 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
2647 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
2648 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
2649 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
2650 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
2651 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
2652 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
2653 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
2654 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
2655 bufsize.
2656
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02002657tune.pattern.cache-size <number>
2658 Sets the size of the pattern lookup cache to <number> entries. This is an LRU
2659 cache which reminds previous lookups and their results. It is used by ACLs
2660 and maps on slow pattern lookups, namely the ones using the "sub", "reg",
2661 "dir", "dom", "end", "bin" match methods as well as the case-insensitive
2662 strings. It applies to pattern expressions which means that it will be able
2663 to memorize the result of a lookup among all the patterns specified on a
2664 configuration line (including all those loaded from files). It automatically
2665 invalidates entries which are updated using HTTP actions or on the CLI. The
2666 default cache size is set to 10000 entries, which limits its footprint to
Willy Tarreau403bfbb2019-10-23 06:59:31 +02002667 about 5 MB per process/thread on 32-bit systems and 8 MB per process/thread
2668 on 64-bit systems, as caches are thread/process local. There is a very low
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02002669 risk of collision in this cache, which is in the order of the size of the
2670 cache divided by 2^64. Typically, at 10000 requests per second with the
2671 default cache size of 10000 entries, there's 1% chance that a brute force
2672 attack could cause a single collision after 60 years, or 0.1% after 6 years.
2673 This is considered much lower than the risk of a memory corruption caused by
2674 aging components. If this is not acceptable, the cache can be disabled by
2675 setting this parameter to 0.
2676
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02002677tune.pipesize <number>
2678 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
2679 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
2680 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
2681 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
2682 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
2683 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
2684
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002685tune.pool-high-fd-ratio <number>
2686 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002687 HAProxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors HAProxy can
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002688 use before we start killing idle connections when we can't reuse a connection
2689 and we have to create a new one. The default is 25 (one quarter of the file
2690 descriptor will mean that roughly half of the maximum front connections can
2691 keep an idle connection behind, anything beyond this probably doesn't make
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002692 much sense in the general case when targeting connection reuse).
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002693
Willy Tarreau83ca3052020-07-01 18:30:16 +02002694tune.pool-low-fd-ratio <number>
2695 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002696 HAProxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors HAProxy can
Willy Tarreau83ca3052020-07-01 18:30:16 +02002697 use before we stop putting connection into the idle pool for reuse. The
2698 default is 20.
2699
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002700tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
2701tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
2702 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
2703 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
2704 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002705 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002706 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002707 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
2708 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
2709
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01002710tune.recv_enough <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002711 HAProxy uses some hints to detect that a short read indicates the end of the
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01002712 socket buffers. One of them is that a read returns more than <recv_enough>
2713 bytes, which defaults to 10136 (7 segments of 1448 each). This default value
2714 may be changed by this setting to better deal with workloads involving lots
2715 of short messages such as telnet or SSH sessions.
2716
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002717tune.runqueue-depth <number>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002718 Sets the maximum amount of task that can be processed at once when running
Willy Tarreau060a7612021-03-10 11:06:26 +01002719 tasks. The default value depends on the number of threads but sits between 35
2720 and 280, which tend to show the highest request rates and lowest latencies.
2721 Increasing it may incur latency when dealing with I/Os, making it too small
2722 can incur extra overhead. Higher thread counts benefit from lower values.
2723 When experimenting with much larger values, it may be useful to also enable
2724 tune.sched.low-latency and possibly tune.fd.edge-triggered to limit the
2725 maximum latency to the lowest possible.
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +02002726
2727tune.sched.low-latency { on | off }
2728 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the low-latency task scheduler. By default
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002729 HAProxy processes tasks from several classes one class at a time as this is
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +02002730 the most efficient. But when running with large values of tune.runqueue-depth
2731 this can have a measurable effect on request or connection latency. When this
2732 low-latency setting is enabled, tasks of lower priority classes will always
2733 be executed before other ones if they exist. This will permit to lower the
2734 maximum latency experienced by new requests or connections in the middle of
2735 massive traffic, at the expense of a higher impact on this large traffic.
2736 For regular usage it is better to leave this off. The default value is off.
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002737
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002738tune.sndbuf.client <number>
2739tune.sndbuf.server <number>
2740 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
2741 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
2742 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002743 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002744 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002745 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
2746 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
2747 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
2748 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002749 notifying HAProxy again.
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002750
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01002751tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01002752 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
William Dauchy9a4bbfe2021-02-12 15:58:46 +01002753 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate. An
2754 encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks depending
2755 on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately 200 bytes of
2756 memory (based on `sizeof(struct sh_ssl_sess_hdr) + SHSESS_BLOCK_MIN_SIZE`
2757 calculation used for `shctx_init` function). The default value may be forced
2758 at build time, otherwise defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most
2759 idle entries are purged and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence
2760 of such a purge, hence the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring
2761 that all users keep their session as long as possible. All entries are
2762 pre-allocated upon startup and are shared between all processes if "nbproc"
2763 is greater than 1. Setting this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01002764
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01002765tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size <number>
2766 Sets the maximum size of the buffer used for capturing client hello cipher
2767 list, extensions list, elliptic curves list and elliptic curve point
2768 formats. If the value is 0 (default value) the capture is disabled,
2769 otherwise a buffer is allocated for each SSL/TLS connection.
2770
2771tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
2772 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
2773 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
2774 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
2775 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
2776 this maximum value. Only 1024 or higher values are allowed. Higher values
2777 will increase the CPU load, and values greater than 1024 bits are not
2778 supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not used if static
2779 Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied either directly in the certificate
2780 file or by using the ssl-dh-param-file parameter.
2781 If there is neither a default-dh-param nor a ssl-dh-param-file defined, and
2782 if the server's PEM file of a given frontend does not specify its own DH
2783 parameters, then DHE ciphers will be unavailable for this frontend.
2784
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02002785tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02002786 This option disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02002787 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
2788 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
2789 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
2790 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
2791 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
2792
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02002793tune.ssl.keylog { on | off }
2794 This option activates the logging of the TLS keys. It should be used with
2795 care as it will consume more memory per SSL session and could decrease
2796 performances. This is disabled by default.
2797
2798 These sample fetches should be used to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE that is
2799 required to decipher traffic with wireshark.
2800
2801 https://developer.mozilla.org/en-US/docs/Mozilla/Projects/NSS/Key_Log_Format
2802
2803 The SSLKEYLOG is a series of lines which are formatted this way:
2804
2805 <Label> <space> <ClientRandom> <space> <Secret>
2806
2807 The ClientRandom is provided by the %[ssl_fc_client_random,hex] sample
2808 fetch, the secret and the Label could be find in the array below. You need
2809 to generate a SSLKEYLOGFILE with all the labels in this array.
2810
2811 The following sample fetches are hexadecimal strings and does not need to be
2812 converted.
2813
2814 SSLKEYLOGFILE Label | Sample fetches for the Secrets
2815 --------------------------------|-----------------------------------------
2816 CLIENT_EARLY_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_client_early_traffic_secret]
2817 CLIENT_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_client_handshake_traffic_secret]
2818 SERVER_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_server_handshake_traffic_secret]
2819 CLIENT_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 | %[ssl_fc_client_traffic_secret_0]
2820 SERVER_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 | %[ssl_fc_server_traffic_secret_0]
William Lallemandd742b6c2020-07-07 10:14:56 +02002821 EXPORTER_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_exporter_secret]
2822 EARLY_EXPORTER_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_early_exporter_secret]
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02002823
2824 This is only available with OpenSSL 1.1.1, and useful with TLS1.3 session.
2825
2826 If you want to generate the content of a SSLKEYLOGFILE with TLS < 1.3, you
2827 only need this line:
2828
2829 "CLIENT_RANDOM %[ssl_fc_client_random,hex] %[ssl_fc_session_key,hex]"
2830
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01002831tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
2832 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002833 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01002834 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
2835 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
2836 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
2837 being used for too long.
2838
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01002839tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
2840 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
2841 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
2842 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
2843 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
2844 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
2845 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
2846 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
2847 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
2848 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
2849 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002850 best value. HAProxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002851 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01002852
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02002853tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size <number>
2854 Sets the size of the cache used to store generated certificates to <number>
2855 entries. This is a LRU cache. Because generating a SSL certificate
2856 dynamically is expensive, they are cached. The default cache size is set to
2857 1000 entries.
2858
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002859tune.vars.global-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01002860tune.vars.proc-max-size <size>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002861tune.vars.reqres-max-size <size>
2862tune.vars.sess-max-size <size>
2863tune.vars.txn-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01002864 These five tunes help to manage the maximum amount of memory used by the
2865 variables system. "global" limits the overall amount of memory available for
2866 all scopes. "proc" limits the memory for the process scope, "sess" limits the
2867 memory for the session scope, "txn" for the transaction scope, and "reqres"
2868 limits the memory for each request or response processing.
2869 Memory accounting is hierarchical, meaning more coarse grained limits include
2870 the finer grained ones: "proc" includes "sess", "sess" includes "txn", and
2871 "txn" includes "reqres".
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002872
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01002873 For example, when "tune.vars.sess-max-size" is limited to 100,
2874 "tune.vars.txn-max-size" and "tune.vars.reqres-max-size" cannot exceed
2875 100 either. If we create a variable "txn.var" that contains 100 bytes,
2876 all available space is consumed.
2877 Notice that exceeding the limits at runtime will not result in an error
2878 message, but values might be cut off or corrupted. So make sure to accurately
2879 plan for the amount of space needed to store all your variables.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002880
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002881tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
2882 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002883 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002884 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002885 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002886 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
2887
2888tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
2889 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
2890 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002891 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
2892 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002893
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020028943.3. Debugging
2895--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002896
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002897quiet
2898 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
2899 line argument "-q".
2900
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +02002901zero-warning
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002902 When this option is set, HAProxy will refuse to start if any warning was
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +02002903 emitted while processing the configuration. It is highly recommended to set
2904 this option on configurations that are not changed often, as it helps detect
2905 subtle mistakes and keep the configuration clean and forward-compatible. Note
2906 that "haproxy -c" will also report errors in such a case. This option is
2907 equivalent to command line argument "-dW".
2908
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002909
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010029103.4. Userlists
2911--------------
2912It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
2913http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
2914it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
2915
2916userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002917 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002918 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
2919
2920group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002921 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002922 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
2923 proceeded by "users" keyword.
2924
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002925user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
2926 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002927 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
2928 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002929 evaluated using the crypt(3) function, so depending on the system's
2930 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example, modern Glibc
2931 based Linux systems support MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512, and, of course, the
2932 classic DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002933
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002934 Attention: Be aware that using encrypted passwords might cause significantly
2935 increased CPU usage, depending on the number of requests, and the algorithm
2936 used. For any of the hashed variants, the password for each request must
2937 be processed through the chosen algorithm, before it can be compared to the
2938 value specified in the config file. Most current algorithms are deliberately
2939 designed to be expensive to compute to achieve resistance against brute
2940 force attacks. They do not simply salt/hash the clear text password once,
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002941 but thousands of times. This can quickly become a major factor in HAProxy's
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002942 overall CPU consumption!
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002943
2944 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002945 userlist L1
2946 group G1 users tiger,scott
2947 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002948
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002949 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
2950 user scott insecure-password elgato
2951 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002952
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002953 userlist L2
2954 group G1
2955 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002956
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002957 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
2958 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
2959 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002960
2961 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002962
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002963
29643.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002965----------
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02002966It is possible to propagate entries of any data-types in stick-tables between
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002967several HAProxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02002968instance pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. The pushed
2969values overwrite remote ones without aggregation. Interrupted exchanges are
2970automatically detected and recovered from the last known point.
2971In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to the new one
2972using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new process
2973tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication during a
2974reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large tables.
2975Note that Server IDs are used to identify servers remotely, so it is important
2976that configurations look similar or at least that the same IDs are forced on
2977each server on all participants.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002978
2979peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002980 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002981 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
2982
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002983bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2984 Defines the binding parameters of the local peer of this "peers" section.
2985 Such lines are not supported with "peer" line in the same "peers" section.
2986
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002987disabled
2988 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
2989 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
2990 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
2991
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002992default-bind [param*]
2993 Defines the binding parameters for the local peer, excepted its address.
2994
2995default-server [param*]
2996 Change default options for a server in a "peers" section.
2997
2998 Arguments:
2999 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
3000 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
Willy Tarreaufd5d0e82022-05-31 10:22:12 +02003001 section dedicated to it. In a peers section, the transport
3002 parameters of a "default-server" line are supported. Please refer
3003 to section 5 for more details, and the "server" keyword below in
3004 this section for some of the restrictions.
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003005
3006 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
3007
Emeric Brun7214dcf2021-09-29 10:29:52 +02003008enabled
3009 This re-enables a peers section which was previously disabled via the
3010 "disabled" keyword.
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02003011
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01003012log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Frédéric Lécailleb6f759b2019-11-05 09:57:45 +01003013 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
3014 "peers" sections support the same "log" keyword as for the proxies to
3015 log information about the "peers" listener. See "log" option for proxies for
3016 more details.
3017
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003018peer <peername> <ip>:<port> [param*]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003019 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
3020 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02003021 using "-L" command line option or "localpeer" global configuration setting),
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003022 HAProxy will listen for incoming remote peer connection on <ip>:<port>.
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02003023 Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to in order to join the
3024 remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to identify and
3025 validate the remote peer on the server side.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003026
3027 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
3028 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
3029
3030 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02003031 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument or the "localpeer"
3032 global configuration setting to change the local peer name. This makes it
3033 easier to maintain coherent configuration files across all peers.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003034
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02003035 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
3036 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003037
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003038 Note: "peer" keyword may transparently be replaced by "server" keyword (see
3039 "server" keyword explanation below).
3040
3041server <peername> [<ip>:<port>] [param*]
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02003042 As previously mentioned, "peer" keyword may be replaced by "server" keyword
Willy Tarreaufd5d0e82022-05-31 10:22:12 +02003043 with a support for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph that are
3044 related to transport settings. If the underlying peer is local, <ip>:<port>
3045 parameters must not be present; these parameters must be provided on a "bind"
3046 line (see "bind" keyword of this "peers" section).
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003047
Willy Tarreaufd5d0e82022-05-31 10:22:12 +02003048 A number of "server" parameters are irrelevant for "peers" sections. Peers by
3049 nature do not support dynamic host name resolution nor health checks, hence
3050 parameters like "init_addr", "resolvers", "check", "agent-check", or "track"
3051 are not supported. Similarly, there is no load balancing nor stickiness, thus
3052 parameters such as "weight" or "cookie" have no effect.
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003053
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003054 Example:
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003055 # The old way.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003056 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01003057 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
3058 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
3059 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003060
3061 backend mybackend
3062 mode tcp
3063 balance roundrobin
3064 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
3065 stick on src
3066
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01003067 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
3068 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003069
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003070 Example:
3071 peers mypeers
Emeric Brun6ca8ba42022-05-30 18:13:35 +02003072 bind 192.168.0.1:1024 ssl crt mycerts/pem
3073 default-server ssl verify none
3074 server haproxy1 #local peer
3075 server haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
3076 server haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003077
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01003078
3079table <tablename> type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
3080 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [store <data_type>]*
3081
3082 Configure a stickiness table for the current section. This line is parsed
3083 exactly the same way as the "stick-table" keyword in others section, except
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05003084 for the "peers" argument which is not required here and with an additional
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01003085 mandatory first parameter to designate the stick-table. Contrary to others
3086 sections, there may be several "table" lines in "peers" sections (see also
3087 "stick-table" keyword).
3088
3089 Also be aware of the fact that "peers" sections have their own stick-table
3090 namespaces to avoid collisions between stick-table names identical in
3091 different "peers" section. This is internally handled prepending the "peers"
3092 sections names to the name of the stick-tables followed by a '/' character.
3093 If somewhere else in the configuration file you have to refer to such
3094 stick-tables declared in "peers" sections you must use the prefixed version
3095 of the stick-table name as follows:
3096
3097 peers mypeers
3098 peer A ...
3099 peer B ...
3100 table t1 ...
3101
3102 frontend fe1
3103 tcp-request content track-sc0 src table mypeers/t1
3104
3105 This is also this prefixed version of the stick-table names which must be
3106 used to refer to stick-tables through the CLI.
3107
3108 About "peers" protocol, as only "peers" belonging to the same section may
3109 communicate with each others, there is no need to do such a distinction.
3110 Several "peers" sections may declare stick-tables with the same name.
3111 This is shorter version of the stick-table name which is sent over the network.
3112 There is only a '/' character as prefix to avoid stick-table name collisions between
3113 stick-tables declared as backends and stick-table declared in "peers" sections
3114 as follows in this weird but supported configuration:
3115
3116 peers mypeers
3117 peer A ...
3118 peer B ...
3119 table t1 type string size 10m store gpc0
3120
3121 backend t1
3122 stick-table type string size 10m store gpc0 peers mypeers
3123
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04003124 Here "t1" table declared in "mypeers" section has "mypeers/t1" as global name.
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01003125 "t1" table declared as a backend as "t1" as global name. But at peer protocol
3126 level the former table is named "/t1", the latter is again named "t1".
3127
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090031283.6. Mailers
3129------------
3130It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
3131If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
3132in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
3133
Pieter Baauw386a1272015-08-16 15:26:24 +02003134mailers <mailersect>
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003135 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
3136 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
3137
3138mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
3139 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
3140
3141 Example:
3142 mailers mymailers
3143 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
3144 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
3145
3146 backend mybackend
3147 mode tcp
3148 balance roundrobin
3149
3150 email-alert mailers mymailers
3151 email-alert from test1@horms.org
3152 email-alert to test2@horms.org
3153
3154 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
3155 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
3156
Pieter Baauw235fcfc2016-02-13 15:33:40 +01003157timeout mail <time>
3158 Defines the time available for a mail/connection to be made and send to
3159 the mail-server. If not defined the default value is 10 seconds. To allow
3160 for at least two SYN-ACK packets to be send during initial TCP handshake it
3161 is advised to keep this value above 4 seconds.
3162
3163 Example:
3164 mailers mymailers
3165 timeout mail 20s
3166 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003167
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +020031683.7. Programs
3169-------------
3170In master-worker mode, it is possible to launch external binaries with the
3171master, these processes are called programs. These programs are launched and
3172managed the same way as the workers.
3173
3174During a reload of HAProxy, those processes are dealing with the same
3175sequence as a worker:
3176
3177 - the master is re-executed
3178 - the master sends a SIGUSR1 signal to the program
3179 - if "option start-on-reload" is not disabled, the master launches a new
3180 instance of the program
3181
3182During a stop, or restart, a SIGTERM is sent to the programs.
3183
3184program <name>
3185 This is a new program section, this section will create an instance <name>
3186 which is visible in "show proc" on the master CLI. (See "9.4. Master CLI" in
3187 the management guide).
3188
3189command <command> [arguments*]
3190 Define the command to start with optional arguments. The command is looked
3191 up in the current PATH if it does not include an absolute path. This is a
3192 mandatory option of the program section. Arguments containing spaces must
3193 be enclosed in quotes or double quotes or be prefixed by a backslash.
3194
Andrew Heberle97236962019-07-12 11:50:26 +08003195user <user name>
3196 Changes the executed command user ID to the <user name> from /etc/passwd.
3197 See also "group".
3198
3199group <group name>
3200 Changes the executed command group ID to the <group name> from /etc/group.
3201 See also "user".
3202
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +02003203option start-on-reload
3204no option start-on-reload
3205 Start (or not) a new instance of the program upon a reload of the master.
3206 The default is to start a new instance. This option may only be used in a
3207 program section.
3208
3209
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +010032103.8. HTTP-errors
3211----------------
3212
3213It is possible to globally declare several groups of HTTP errors, to be
3214imported afterwards in any proxy section. Same group may be referenced at
3215several places and can be fully or partially imported.
3216
3217http-errors <name>
3218 Create a new http-errors group with the name <name>. It is an independent
3219 section that may be referenced by one or more proxies using its name.
3220
3221errorfile <code> <file>
3222 Associate a file contents to an HTTP error code
3223
3224 Arguments :
3225 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02003226 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01003227 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003228
3229 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
3230 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
3231 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
3232 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
3233 before any chroot is performed.
3234
3235 Please referrers to "errorfile" keyword in section 4 for details.
3236
3237 Example:
3238 http-errors website-1
3239 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/400.http
3240 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/404.http
3241 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
3242
3243 http-errors website-2
3244 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/400.http
3245 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/404.http
3246 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
3247
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +020032483.9. Rings
3249----------
3250
3251It is possible to globally declare ring-buffers, to be used as target for log
3252servers or traces.
3253
3254ring <ringname>
3255 Creates a new ring-buffer with name <ringname>.
3256
3257description <text>
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04003258 The description is an optional description string of the ring. It will
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003259 appear on CLI. By default, <name> is reused to fill this field.
3260
3261format <format>
3262 Format used to store events into the ring buffer.
3263
3264 Arguments:
3265 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
3266 one of the following :
3267
3268 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
3269 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
3270 designed to be used with a local log server.
3271
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01003272 local Analog to rfc3164 syslog message format except that hostname
3273 field is stripped. This is the default.
3274 Note: option "log-send-hostname" switches the default to
3275 rfc3164.
3276
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003277 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
3278 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
3279 used in containers or during development, where the severity
3280 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr). This
3281 is the default.
3282
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01003283 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format.
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003284 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
3285
3286 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
3287 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
3288
3289 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
3290 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
3291 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
3292 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
3293 logger consumes.
3294
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02003295 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between angle
3296 brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time,
3297 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used
3298 with a local log server.
3299
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003300 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
3301 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
3302 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
3303 used with a local log server.
3304
3305maxlen <length>
3306 The maximum length of an event message stored into the ring,
3307 including formatted header. If an event message is longer than
3308 <length>, it will be truncated to this length.
3309
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003310server <name> <address> [param*]
3311 Used to configure a syslog tcp server to forward messages from ring buffer.
3312 This supports for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph. Some of
3313 these parameters are irrelevant for "ring" sections. Important point: there
3314 is little reason to add more than one server to a ring, because all servers
3315 will receive the exact same copy of the ring contents, and as such the ring
3316 will progress at the speed of the slowest server. If one server does not
3317 respond, it will prevent old messages from being purged and may block new
3318 messages from being inserted into the ring. The proper way to send messages
3319 to multiple servers is to use one distinct ring per log server, not to
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +02003320 attach multiple servers to the same ring. Note that specific server directive
3321 "log-proto" is used to set the protocol used to send messages.
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003322
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003323size <size>
3324 This is the optional size in bytes for the ring-buffer. Default value is
3325 set to BUFSIZE.
3326
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003327timeout connect <timeout>
3328 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
3329
3330 Arguments :
3331 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
3332 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
3333 as explained at the top of this document.
3334
3335timeout server <timeout>
3336 Set the maximum time for pending data staying into output buffer.
3337
3338 Arguments :
3339 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
3340 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
3341 as explained at the top of this document.
3342
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003343 Example:
3344 global
3345 log ring@myring local7
3346
3347 ring myring
3348 description "My local buffer"
3349 format rfc3164
3350 maxlen 1200
3351 size 32764
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003352 timeout connect 5s
3353 timeout server 10s
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +02003354 server mysyslogsrv 127.0.0.1:6514 log-proto octet-count
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003355
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +020033563.10. Log forwarding
3357-------------------
3358
3359It is possible to declare one or multiple log forwarding section,
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003360HAProxy will forward all received log messages to a log servers list.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003361
3362log-forward <name>
3363 Creates a new log forwarder proxy identified as <name>.
3364
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003365backlog <conns>
3366 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
3367 on connections accept.
3368
3369bind <addr> [param*]
3370 Used to configure a stream log listener to receive messages to forward.
Emeric Brunda46c1c2020-10-08 08:39:02 +02003371 This supports the "bind" parameters found in 5.1 paragraph including
3372 those about ssl but some statements such as "alpn" may be irrelevant for
3373 syslog protocol over TCP.
3374 Those listeners support both "Octet Counting" and "Non-Transparent-Framing"
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003375 modes as defined in rfc-6587.
3376
Willy Tarreau76aaa7f2020-09-16 15:07:22 +02003377dgram-bind <addr> [param*]
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003378 Used to configure a datagram log listener to receive messages to forward.
3379 Addresses must be in IPv4 or IPv6 form,followed by a port. This supports
3380 for some of the "bind" parameters found in 5.1 paragraph among which
3381 "interface", "namespace" or "transparent", the other ones being
Willy Tarreau26ff5da2020-09-16 15:22:19 +02003382 silently ignored as irrelevant for UDP/syslog case.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003383
3384log global
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01003385log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003386 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
3387 Used to configure target log servers. See more details on proxies
3388 documentation.
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003389 If no format specified, HAProxy tries to keep the incoming log format.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003390 Configured facility is ignored, except if incoming message does not
3391 present a facility but one is mandatory on the outgoing format.
3392 If there is no timestamp available in the input format, but the field
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003393 exists in output format, HAProxy will use the local date.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003394
3395 Example:
3396 global
3397 log stderr format iso local7
3398
3399 ring myring
3400 description "My local buffer"
3401 format rfc5424
3402 maxlen 1200
3403 size 32764
3404 timeout connect 5s
3405 timeout server 10s
3406 # syslog tcp server
3407 server mysyslogsrv 127.0.0.1:514 log-proto octet-count
3408
3409 log-forward sylog-loadb
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003410 dgram-bind 127.0.0.1:1514
3411 bind 127.0.0.1:1514
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003412 # all messages on stderr
3413 log global
3414 # all messages on local tcp syslog server
3415 log ring@myring local0
3416 # load balance messages on 4 udp syslog servers
3417 log 127.0.0.1:10001 sample 1:4 local0
3418 log 127.0.0.1:10002 sample 2:4 local0
3419 log 127.0.0.1:10003 sample 3:4 local0
3420 log 127.0.0.1:10004 sample 4:4 local0
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003421
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003422maxconn <conns>
3423 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a log forwarder.
3424 10 is the default.
3425
3426timeout client <timeout>
3427 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
3428
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020034294. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003430----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003431
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003432Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
Willy Tarreau7c0b4d82021-02-12 14:58:08 +01003433 - defaults [<name>] [ from <defaults_name> ]
3434 - frontend <name> [ from <defaults_name> ]
3435 - backend <name> [ from <defaults_name> ]
3436 - listen <name> [ from <defaults_name> ]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003437
3438A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
3439connections.
3440
3441A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
3442to forward incoming connections.
3443
3444A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
3445parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
3446
Willy Tarreau7c0b4d82021-02-12 14:58:08 +01003447A "defaults" section resets all settings to the documented ones and presets new
3448ones for use by subsequent sections. All of "frontend", "backend" and "listen"
3449sections always take their initial settings from a defaults section, by default
3450the latest one that appears before the newly created section. It is possible to
3451explicitly designate a specific "defaults" section to load the initial settings
3452from by indicating its name on the section line after the optional keyword
3453"from". While "defaults" section do not impose a name, this use is encouraged
3454for better readability. It is also the only way to designate a specific section
3455to use instead of the default previous one. Since "defaults" section names are
3456optional, by default a very permissive check is applied on their name and these
3457are even permitted to overlap. However if a "defaults" section is referenced by
3458any other section, its name must comply with the syntax imposed on all proxy
3459names, and this name must be unique among the defaults sections. Please note
3460that regardless of what is currently permitted, it is recommended to avoid
3461duplicate section names in general and to respect the same syntax as for proxy
3462names. This rule might be enforced in a future version.
3463
3464Note that it is even possible for a defaults section to take its initial
3465settings from another one, and as such, inherit settings across multiple levels
3466of defaults sections. This can be convenient to establish certain configuration
3467profiles to carry groups of default settings (e.g. TCP vs HTTP or short vs long
3468timeouts) but can quickly become confusing to follow.
3469
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003470All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
3471'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
3472case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
3473
3474Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
3475logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
3476proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
3477However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
3478name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
3479
3480Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
3481and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003482bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003483protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
3484modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
3485arbitrary criteria.
3486
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003487In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
3488a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
Julien Pivotto21ad3152019-12-10 13:11:17 +01003489the backend's. HAProxy supports 3 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003490
3491 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
3492 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
3493 between responses and new requests.
3494
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003495 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
3496 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
3497 client-facing connection remains open.
3498
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003499 - CLO: close ("option httpclose"): the connection is closed after the end of
3500 the response and "Connection: close" appended in both directions.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003501
3502The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
3503frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
3504following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003505weakest option and close is the strongest.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003506
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003507 Backend mode
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003508
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003509 | KAL | SCL | CLO
3510 ----+-----+-----+----
3511 KAL | KAL | SCL | CLO
3512 ----+-----+-----+----
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003513 mode SCL | SCL | SCL | CLO
3514 ----+-----+-----+----
3515 CLO | CLO | CLO | CLO
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003516
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003517It is possible to chain a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. It is pointless if
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003518only HTTP traffic is handled. But it may be used to handle several protocols
3519within the same frontend. In this case, the client's connection is first handled
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003520as a raw tcp connection before being upgraded to HTTP. Before the upgrade, the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003521content processings are performend on raw data. Once upgraded, data is parsed
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003522and stored using an internal representation called HTX and it is no longer
3523possible to rely on raw representation. There is no way to go back.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003524
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003525There are two kind of upgrades, in-place upgrades and destructive upgrades. The
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003526first ones involves a TCP to HTTP/1 upgrade. In HTTP/1, the request
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003527processings are serialized, thus the applicative stream can be preserved. The
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003528second one involves a TCP to HTTP/2 upgrade. Because it is a multiplexed
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003529protocol, the applicative stream cannot be associated to any HTTP/2 stream and
3530is destroyed. New applicative streams are then created when HAProxy receives
3531new HTTP/2 streams at the lower level, in the H2 multiplexer. It is important
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003532to understand this difference because that drastically changes the way to
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003533process data. When an HTTP/1 upgrade is performed, the content processings
3534already performed on raw data are neither lost nor reexecuted while for an
3535HTTP/2 upgrade, applicative streams are distinct and all frontend rules are
3536evaluated systematically on each one. And as said, the first stream, the TCP
3537one, is destroyed, but only after the frontend rules were evaluated.
3538
3539There is another importnat point to understand when HTTP processings are
3540performed from a TCP proxy. While HAProxy is able to parse HTTP/1 in-fly from
3541tcp-request content rules, it is not possible for HTTP/2. Only the HTTP/2
3542preface can be parsed. This is a huge limitation regarding the HTTP content
3543analysis in TCP. Concretely it is only possible to know if received data are
3544HTTP. For instance, it is not possible to choose a backend based on the Host
3545header value while it is trivial in HTTP/1. Hopefully, there is a solution to
3546mitigate this drawback.
3547
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003548There are two ways to perform an HTTP upgrade. The first one, the historical
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003549method, is to select an HTTP backend. The upgrade happens when the backend is
3550set. Thus, for in-place upgrades, only the backend configuration is considered
3551in the HTTP data processing. For destructive upgrades, the applicative stream
3552is destroyed, thus its processing is stopped. With this method, possibilities
3553to choose a backend with an HTTP/2 connection are really limited, as mentioned
3554above, and a bit useless because the stream is destroyed. The second method is
3555to upgrade during the tcp-request content rules evaluation, thanks to the
3556"switch-mode http" action. In this case, the upgrade is performed in the
3557frontend context and it is possible to define HTTP directives in this
3558frontend. For in-place upgrades, it offers all the power of the HTTP analysis
3559as soon as possible. It is not that far from an HTTP frontend. For destructive
3560upgrades, it does not change anything except it is useless to choose a backend
3561on limited information. It is of course the recommended method. Thus, testing
3562the request protocol from the tcp-request content rules to perform an HTTP
3563upgrade is enough. All the remaining HTTP manipulation may be moved to the
3564frontend http-request ruleset. But keep in mind that tcp-request content rules
3565remains evaluated on each streams, that can't be changed.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003566
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020035674.1. Proxy keywords matrix
3568--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003569
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003570The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
3571limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
3572they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
3573limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003574marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, e.g. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003575option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02003576and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
3577with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
3578specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003579
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003580
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003581 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
3582------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
3583acl - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003584backlog X X X -
3585balance X - X X
3586bind - X X -
3587bind-process X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003588capture cookie - X X -
3589capture request header - X X -
3590capture response header - X X -
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09003591clitcpka-cnt X X X -
3592clitcpka-idle X X X -
3593clitcpka-intvl X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003594compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003595cookie X - X X
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003596declare capture - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003597default-server X - X X
3598default_backend X X X -
3599description - X X X
3600disabled X X X X
3601dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003602email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003603email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003604email-alert mailers X X X X
3605email-alert myhostname X X X X
3606email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003607enabled X X X X
3608errorfile X X X X
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003609errorfiles X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003610errorloc X X X X
3611errorloc302 X X X X
3612-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
3613errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01003614force-persist - - X X
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003615filter - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003616fullconn X - X X
3617grace X X X X
3618hash-type X - X X
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01003619http-after-response - X X X
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02003620http-check comment X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02003621http-check connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003622http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02003623http-check expect X - X X
Peter Gervai8912ae62020-06-11 18:26:36 +02003624http-check send X - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02003625http-check send-state X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02003626http-check set-var X - X X
3627http-check unset-var X - X X
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02003628http-error X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003629http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003630http-response - X X X
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02003631http-reuse X - X X
Aurelien DARRAGON17e3cd52023-01-12 15:59:27 +01003632http-send-name-header X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003633id - X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01003634ignore-persist - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02003635load-server-state-from-file X - X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02003636log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01003637log-format X X X -
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02003638log-format-sd X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01003639log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02003640max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003641maxconn X X X -
3642mode X X X X
3643monitor fail - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003644monitor-uri X X X -
3645option abortonclose (*) X - X X
3646option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
3647option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
3648option allbackups (*) X - X X
3649option checkcache (*) X - X X
3650option clitcpka (*) X X X -
3651option contstats (*) X X X -
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02003652option disable-h2-upgrade (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003653option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
3654option dontlognull (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003655-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
3656option forwardfor X X X X
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02003657option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client (*) X X X -
3658option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02003659option http-buffer-request (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau82649f92015-05-01 22:40:51 +02003660option http-ignore-probes (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01003661option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02003662option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02003663option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X - X X
Christopher Faulet79507152022-05-16 11:43:10 +02003664option http-restrict-req-hdr-names X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003665option http-server-close (*) X X X X
3666option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
3667option httpchk X - X X
3668option httpclose (*) X X X X
Freddy Spierenburge88b7732019-03-25 14:35:17 +01003669option httplog X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003670option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003671option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02003672option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09003673option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003674option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
3675option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
3676option logasap (*) X X X -
3677option mysql-check X - X X
3678option nolinger (*) X X X X
3679option originalto X X X X
3680option persist (*) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann809e22a2015-10-12 20:22:55 +02003681option pgsql-check X - X X
3682option prefer-last-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003683option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02003684option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003685option smtpchk X - X X
3686option socket-stats (*) X X X -
3687option splice-auto (*) X X X X
3688option splice-request (*) X X X X
3689option splice-response (*) X X X X
Aurelien DARRAGON54832622023-01-12 15:06:11 +01003690option spop-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003691option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
3692option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
3693-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01003694option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003695option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
3696option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
3697option tcpka X X X X
3698option tcplog X X X X
3699option transparent (*) X - X X
William Dauchy4711a892022-01-05 22:53:24 +01003700option idle-close-on-response (*) X X X -
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09003701external-check command X - X X
3702external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003703persist rdp-cookie X - X X
3704rate-limit sessions X X X -
3705redirect - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003706-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003707retries X - X X
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02003708retry-on X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003709server - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02003710server-state-file-name X - X X
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02003711server-template - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003712source X - X X
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09003713srvtcpka-cnt X - X X
3714srvtcpka-idle X - X X
3715srvtcpka-intvl X - X X
Baptiste Assmann5a549212015-10-12 20:30:24 +02003716stats admin - X X X
3717stats auth X X X X
3718stats enable X X X X
3719stats hide-version X X X X
3720stats http-request - X X X
3721stats realm X X X X
3722stats refresh X X X X
3723stats scope X X X X
3724stats show-desc X X X X
3725stats show-legends X X X X
3726stats show-node X X X X
3727stats uri X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003728-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
3729stick match - - X X
3730stick on - - X X
3731stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02003732stick store-response - - X X
Adam Spiers68af3c12017-04-06 16:31:39 +01003733stick-table - X X X
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02003734tcp-check comment X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02003735tcp-check connect X - X X
3736tcp-check expect X - X X
3737tcp-check send X - X X
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +02003738tcp-check send-lf X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02003739tcp-check send-binary X - X X
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +02003740tcp-check send-binary-lf X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02003741tcp-check set-var X - X X
3742tcp-check unset-var X - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02003743tcp-request connection - X X -
3744tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02003745tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02003746tcp-request session - X X -
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02003747tcp-response content - - X X
3748tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003749timeout check X - X X
3750timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02003751timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003752timeout connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003753timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
3754timeout http-request X X X X
3755timeout queue X - X X
3756timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02003757timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003758timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02003759timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003760transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01003761unique-id-format X X X -
3762unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003763use_backend - X X -
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02003764use-fcgi-app - - X X
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02003765use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003766------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
3767 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003768
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003769
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020037704.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
3771---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003772
3773This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
3774
3775
3776acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
3777 Declare or complete an access list.
3778 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3779 no | yes | yes | yes
3780 Example:
3781 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
3782 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
3783 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
3784
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003785 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003786
3787
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01003788backlog <conns>
3789 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
3790 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3791 yes | yes | yes | no
3792 Arguments :
3793 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
3794 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003795 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01003796
3797 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
3798 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
3799 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
3800 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
3801 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
3802 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
3803 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
3804 backlog parameter.
3805
3806 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
3807 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
3808 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
3809
3810 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
3811
3812
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003813balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003814balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003815 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
3816 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3817 yes | no | yes | yes
3818 Arguments :
3819 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
3820 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
3821 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
3822 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
3823
3824 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
3825 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
3826 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
3827 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02003828 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08003829 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02003830 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
3831 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
3832 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
3833 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
3834 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
3835 it, so that you don't worry.
3836
3837 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
3838 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
3839 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
3840 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
3841 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
3842 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
3843 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
3844 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003845
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01003846 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
3847 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
3848 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
3849 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
3850 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
3851 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
3852 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
Willy Tarreau8c855f62020-10-22 17:41:45 +02003853 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance. It will
3854 also consider the number of queued connections in addition to
3855 the established ones in order to minimize queuing.
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01003856
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003857 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003858 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003859 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
3860 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02003861 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003862 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
3863 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
3864 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
3865 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
3866 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02003867 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
3868 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
3869 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
3870 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
3871 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
3872 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003873
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003874 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
3875 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
3876 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
3877 address will always reach the same server as long as no
3878 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
3879 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
3880 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
3881 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003882 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003883 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003884 static by default, which means that changing a server's
3885 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
3886 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003887
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01003888 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
3889 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
3890 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
3891 the running servers. The result designates which server will
3892 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
3893 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
3894 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
3895 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
3896 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
3897 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
3898 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
3899 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003900
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01003901 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02003902 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
3903 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
3904 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
3905 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
3906 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
3907 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
3908 URIs start with a leading "/".
3909
3910 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
3911 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
3912 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
3913 evaluation stops when either is reached.
3914
Willy Tarreau57a37412020-09-23 08:56:29 +02003915 A "path-only" parameter indicates that the hashing key starts
3916 at the first '/' of the path. This can be used to ignore the
3917 authority part of absolute URIs, and to make sure that HTTP/1
3918 and HTTP/2 URIs will provide the same hash.
3919
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003920 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003921 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
3922
3923 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003924 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
3925 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003926 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
3927 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
3928 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
3929 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003930 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003931 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
3932 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003933
3934 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
3935 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
3936 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
3937 server will receive the request.
3938
3939 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
3940 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
3941 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
3942 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
3943 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003944 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
3945 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
3946 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003947
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003948 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
3949 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
3950 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
3951 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
3952 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01003953
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003954 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01003955 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
3956 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
3957 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
3958
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003959 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
3960 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
3961 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
3962
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01003963 random
3964 random(<draws>)
3965 A random number will be used as the key for the consistent
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02003966 hashing function. This means that the servers' weights are
3967 respected, dynamic weight changes immediately take effect, as
3968 well as new server additions. Random load balancing can be
3969 useful with large farms or when servers are frequently added
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01003970 or removed as it may avoid the hammering effect that could
3971 result from roundrobin or leastconn in this situation. The
3972 hash-balance-factor directive can be used to further improve
3973 fairness of the load balancing, especially in situations
3974 where servers show highly variable response times. When an
3975 argument <draws> is present, it must be an integer value one
3976 or greater, indicating the number of draws before selecting
3977 the least loaded of these servers. It was indeed demonstrated
3978 that picking the least loaded of two servers is enough to
3979 significantly improve the fairness of the algorithm, by
3980 always avoiding to pick the most loaded server within a farm
3981 and getting rid of any bias that could be induced by the
3982 unfair distribution of the consistent list. Higher values N
3983 will take away N-1 of the highest loaded servers at the
3984 expense of performance. With very high values, the algorithm
3985 will converge towards the leastconn's result but much slower.
3986 The default value is 2, which generally shows very good
3987 distribution and performance. This algorithm is also known as
3988 the Power of Two Random Choices and is described here :
3989 http://www.eecs.harvard.edu/~michaelm/postscripts/handbook2001.pdf
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02003990
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003991 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02003992 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003993 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
3994 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +01003995 with the equivalent ACL 'req.rdp_cookie()' function, the name
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003996 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
3997 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
3998 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003999 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02004000 used instead.
4001
4002 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
4003 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
4004 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +01004005 a 'req.rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02004006
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004007 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
4008 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
4009 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
4010
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004011 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02004012 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
4013 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004014
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01004015 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
4016 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
4017 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004018
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02004019 With authentication schemes that require the same connection like NTLM, URI
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05004020 based algorithms must not be used, as they would cause subsequent requests
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02004021 to be routed to different backend servers, breaking the invalid assumptions
4022 NTLM relies on.
4023
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004024 Examples :
4025 balance roundrobin
4026 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004027 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01004028 balance hdr(User-Agent)
4029 balance hdr(host)
4030 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004031
4032 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
4033 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
4034
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004035 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004036 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
4037 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
4038 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02004039 the body. (see acl http_end)
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004040
4041 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
4042 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
4043 defaults to 16 kB.
4044
4045 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
4046 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
4047
4048 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
4049 Round Robin.
4050
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00004051 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC7230 3.3.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004052 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
4053 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
4054 actually appeared in the first chunk).
4055
4056 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
4057
4058 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004059 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004060 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
4061 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
4062 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004063
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02004064 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "transparent", "hash-type" and "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004065
4066
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02004067bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
4068bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004069 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
4070 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4071 no | yes | yes | no
4072 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01004073 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
4074 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
4075 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
4076 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01004077 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01004078 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
4079 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
4080 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
4081 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
4082 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
4083 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02004084 - 'udp@' -> address is resolved as IPv4 or IPv6 and
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02004085 protocol UDP is used. Currently those listeners are
4086 supported only in log-forward sections.
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02004087 - 'udp4@' -> address is always IPv4 and protocol UDP
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02004088 is used. Currently those listeners are supported
4089 only in log-forward sections.
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02004090 - 'udp6@' -> address is always IPv6 and protocol UDP
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02004091 is used. Currently those listeners are supported
4092 only in log-forward sections.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01004093 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02004094 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
4095 Note: since abstract sockets are not "rebindable", they
4096 do not cope well with multi-process mode during
4097 soft-restart, so it is better to avoid them if
4098 nbproc is greater than 1. The effect is that if the
4099 new process fails to start, only one of the old ones
4100 will be able to rebind to the socket.
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01004101 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
4102 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
4103 be listening.
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02004104 - 'sockpair@<n>'-> like fd@ but you must use the fd of a
4105 connected unix socket or of a socketpair. The bind waits
4106 to receive a FD over the unix socket and uses it as if it
4107 was the FD of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004108 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
4109 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
4110 variables.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01004111
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01004112 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
4113 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004114 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
4115 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
4116 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01004117 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
4118 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
4119 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
4120 the range.
4121
4122 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
4123 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
4124 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
4125 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
4126 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
4127 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
4128 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004129 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01004130 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004131
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004132 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004133 alternative to the TCP listening port. HAProxy will then
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004134 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
4135 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
4136 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
4137 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
4138 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
4139 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
4140
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02004141 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
4142 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
4143 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
4144 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02004145
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004146 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
4147 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
4148 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
4149 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
4150 in a frontend.
4151
4152 Example :
4153 listen http_proxy
4154 bind :80,:443
4155 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004156 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004157
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02004158 listen http_https_proxy
4159 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02004160 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02004161
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01004162 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
4163 bind ipv6@:80
4164 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
4165 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
4166
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01004167 listen external_bind_app1
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004168 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01004169
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02004170 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
4171 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
4172 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
4173 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
4174 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
4175
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004176 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02004177 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004178
4179
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01004180bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[<process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004181 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
4182 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4183 yes | yes | yes | yes
4184 Arguments :
4185 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
4186 may be used to override a default value.
4187
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01004188 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004189 option may be combined with other numbers.
4190
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01004191 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004192 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
4193 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
4194 missing from all processes.
4195
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01004196 process_num The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01004197 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01004198 the machine's word size. Ranges can be partially defined. The
4199 higher bound can be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by
4200 the corresponding maximum value. If a proxy is bound to
4201 process numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it
4202 will either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02004203 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004204
4205 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
4206 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
4207 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
4208 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
4209 and 'even' instances.
4210
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01004211 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
4212 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
4213 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
4214 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004215
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02004216 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
4217 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
4218
Willy Tarreaub369a042014-09-16 13:21:03 +02004219 When a frontend has no explicit "bind-process" line, it tries to bind to all
4220 the processes referenced by its "bind" lines. That means that frontends can
4221 easily adapt to their listeners' processes.
4222
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004223 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
4224 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
4225
4226 Example :
4227 listen app_ip1
4228 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02004229 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004230
4231 listen app_ip2
4232 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02004233 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004234
4235 listen management
4236 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02004237 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004238
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01004239 listen management
4240 bind 10.0.0.4:80
4241 bind-process 1-4
4242
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02004243 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004244
4245
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004246capture cookie <name> len <length>
4247 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
4248 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4249 no | yes | yes | no
4250 Arguments :
4251 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
4252 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
4253 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
4254 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004255 and value (e.g. ASPSESSIONXXX).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004256
4257 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
4258 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
4259 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
4260 right if it exceeds <length>.
4261
4262 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
4263 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
4264 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
4265 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
4266
4267 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
4268 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
4269 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
4270
4271 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
4272 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
4273 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01004274 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
4275 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
4276 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004277
4278 Example:
4279 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
4280
4281 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004282 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004283
4284
4285capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004286 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004287 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4288 no | yes | yes | no
4289 Arguments :
4290 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004291 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004292 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
4293 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
4294 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
4295
4296 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
4297 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
4298 it exceeds <length>.
4299
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004300 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004301 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
4302 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004303 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
4304 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
4305 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
4306 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004307 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004308 environments to find where the request came from.
4309
4310 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
4311 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
4312 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
4313 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004314
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01004315 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
4316 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
4317 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
4318 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
4319 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004320
4321 Example:
4322 capture request header Host len 15
4323 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
Cyril Bontéd1b0f7c2015-10-26 22:37:39 +01004324 capture request header Referer len 15
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004325
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004326 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004327 about logging.
4328
4329
4330capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004331 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004332 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4333 no | yes | yes | no
4334 Arguments :
4335 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004336 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004337 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
4338 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
4339 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
4340
4341 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
4342 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
4343 it exceeds <length>.
4344
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004345 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004346 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
4347 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
4348 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004349 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
4350 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
4351 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
4352 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004353
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01004354 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
4355 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
4356 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
4357 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
4358 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004359
4360 Example:
4361 capture response header Content-length len 9
4362 capture response header Location len 15
4363
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004364 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004365 about logging.
4366
4367
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004368clitcpka-cnt <count>
4369 Sets the maximum number of keepalive probes TCP should send before dropping
4370 the connection on the client side.
4371 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4372 yes | yes | yes | no
4373 Arguments :
4374 <count> is the maximum number of keepalive probes.
4375
4376 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPCNT. If this keyword
4377 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_probes) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02004378 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
4379 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004380
4381 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-idle", "clitcpka-intvl".
4382
4383
4384clitcpka-idle <timeout>
4385 Sets the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts sending
4386 keepalive probes, if enabled the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the
4387 client side.
4388 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4389 yes | yes | yes | no
4390 Arguments :
4391 <timeout> is the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts
4392 sending keepalive probes. It is specified in seconds by default,
4393 but can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the
4394 unit, as explained at the top of this document.
4395
4396 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPIDLE. If this keyword
4397 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_time) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02004398 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
4399 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004400
4401 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-cnt", "clitcpka-intvl".
4402
4403
4404clitcpka-intvl <timeout>
4405 Sets the time between individual keepalive probes on the client side.
4406 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4407 yes | yes | yes | no
4408 Arguments :
4409 <timeout> is the time between individual keepalive probes. It is specified
4410 in seconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number
4411 is suffixed by the unit, as explained at the top of this
4412 document.
4413
4414 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPINTVL. If this keyword
4415 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_intvl) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02004416 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
4417 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004418
4419 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-cnt", "clitcpka-idle".
4420
4421
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004422compression algo <algorithm> ...
4423compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02004424compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02004425 Enable HTTP compression.
4426 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4427 yes | yes | yes | yes
4428 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004429 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
4430 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004431 offload makes HAProxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004432
4433 The currently supported algorithms are :
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004434 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
4435 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
4436 data.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004437
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004438 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01004439 support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004440
4441 deflate same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
4442 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
4443 browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
4444 strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
4445 experimentation. This setting is only available when support
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01004446 for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004447
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004448 raw-deflate same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
4449 alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
4450 browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
4451 it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
4452 and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
4453 with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
4454 to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01004455 available when support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004456
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04004457 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004458 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04004459 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004460 will be no-op: HAProxy will see the compressed response and will not
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04004461 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004462 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, HAProxy will compress the
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04004463 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02004464
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004465 The "offload" setting makes HAProxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02004466 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
4467 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004468 will be done on the single point where HAProxy is located. However in some
4469 deployment scenarios, HAProxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04004470 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004471 In that case HAProxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04004472 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
4473 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004474 so that prevents HAProxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
Willy Tarreauffea9fd2014-07-12 16:37:02 +02004475 then be used for such scenarios. Note: for now, the "offload" setting is
4476 ignored when set in a defaults section.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02004477
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01004478 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01004479 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
4480 "Accept-Encoding" header
Julien Pivottoff80c822021-03-29 12:41:40 +02004481 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1 or above
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01004482 * HTTP status code is not one of 200, 201, 202, or 203
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01004483 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
4484 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
4485 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
4486 "multipart"
4487 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
4488 header
4489 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
4490 and later
4491 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
4492 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01004493 * The response contains an invalid "ETag" header or multiple ETag headers
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01004494
Tim Duesterhusb229f012019-01-29 16:38:56 +01004495 Note: The compression does not emit the Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01004496
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02004497 Examples :
4498 compression algo gzip
4499 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004500
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004501
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004502cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02004503 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
4504 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01004505 [ dynamic ] [ attr <value> ]*
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004506 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
4507 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4508 yes | no | yes | yes
4509 Arguments :
4510 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
4511 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
4512 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
4513 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
4514 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
4515 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004516 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (e.g.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004517 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
4518 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
4519
4520 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004521 server and that HAProxy will have to modify its value to set the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004522 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
4523 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
4524 headers is left to the application. The application can then
4525 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01004526 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode
4527 doesn't work in HTTP tunnel mode. Unless the application
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004528 behavior is very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01004529 start with this mode for new deployments. This keyword is
4530 incompatible with "insert" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004531
4532 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004533 be inserted by HAProxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004534
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02004535 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004536 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02004537 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be removed before
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004538 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004539 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
4540 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
4541 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
4542 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
4543 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
4544 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
4545 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004546
4547 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
4548 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
4549 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
4550 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
4551 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
4552 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
4553 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
4554 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
4555 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01004556 this mode doesn't work with tunnel mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02004557 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
4558 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
4559 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004560
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02004561 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
4562 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
4563 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004564 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
4565 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
4566 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
4567 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02004568 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
4569 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
4570 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004571
4572 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
4573 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
4574 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
4575 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
4576 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
4577 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
4578 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
4579 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
4580 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
4581
4582 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
4583 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
4584 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
4585 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
4586 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
4587 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
4588 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
4589 persistence cookie in the cache.
4590 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
4591
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004592 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
4593 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004594 case, if a cookie is found in the response, HAProxy will leave it
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004595 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
4596 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004597 emit a cookie with an invalid value (e.g. empty) or with a date in
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004598 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
4599 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
4600 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
4601 they logout.
4602
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004603 httponly This option tells HAProxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02004604 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
4605 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
4606 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
4607
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004608 secure This option tells HAProxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02004609 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
4610 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
4611 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
4612 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
4613 this attribute.
4614
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02004615 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004616 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01004617 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
4618 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
4619 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
4620 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
4621 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
4622 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02004623
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004624 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
4625 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
4626 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
4627 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
4628 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
4629 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
4630 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
4631 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004632 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). When
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004633 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
4634 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
4635 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
4636 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
4637 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
4638 the site.
4639
4640 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
4641 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
4642 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
4643 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
4644 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
4645 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
4646 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
4647 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
4648 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
4649 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
4650 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
4651 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
4652 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004653 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). This
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004654 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
4655 redispatch after some absolute delay.
4656
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004657 dynamic Activate dynamic cookies. When used, a session cookie is
4658 dynamically created for each server, based on the IP and port
4659 of the server, and a secret key, specified in the
4660 "dynamic-cookie-key" backend directive.
4661 The cookie will be regenerated each time the IP address change,
4662 and is only generated for IPv4/IPv6.
4663
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004664 attr This option tells HAProxy to add an extra attribute when a
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01004665 cookie is inserted. The attribute value can contain any
4666 characters except control ones or ";". This option may be
4667 repeated.
4668
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004669 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
4670 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
4671 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
4672 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02004673
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004674 Examples :
4675 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
4676 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
4677 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004678 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004679
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02004680 See also : "balance source", "capture cookie", "server" and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004681
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004682
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02004683declare capture [ request | response ] len <length>
4684 Declares a capture slot.
4685 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4686 no | yes | yes | no
4687 Arguments:
4688 <length> is the length allowed for the capture.
4689
4690 This declaration is only available in the frontend or listen section, but the
4691 reserved slot can be used in the backends. The "request" keyword allocates a
4692 capture slot for use in the request, and "response" allocates a capture slot
4693 for use in the response.
4694
4695 See also: "capture-req", "capture-res" (sample converters),
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +02004696 "capture.req.hdr", "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches),
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02004697 "http-request capture" and "http-response capture".
4698
4699
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004700default-server [param*]
4701 Change default options for a server in a backend
4702 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4703 yes | no | yes | yes
4704 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004705 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
4706 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
4707 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
4708 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004709
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004710 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004711 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
4712
4713 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004714
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004715
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004716default_backend <backend>
4717 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
4718 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4719 yes | yes | yes | no
4720 Arguments :
4721 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
4722
4723 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
4724 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
4725 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
4726 will catch all undetermined requests.
4727
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004728 Example :
4729
4730 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
4731 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
4732 default_backend dynamic
4733
Willy Tarreau98d04852015-05-26 12:18:29 +02004734 See also : "use_backend"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004735
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004736
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02004737description <string>
4738 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
4739 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4740 no | yes | yes | yes
4741 Arguments : string
4742
4743 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
4744 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
4745 it describes.
4746 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
4747
4748
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004749disabled
4750 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
4751 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4752 yes | yes | yes | yes
4753 Arguments : none
4754
4755 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
4756 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
4757 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
4758 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
4759 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
4760 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
4761 keyword in a "defaults" section.
4762
4763 See also : "enabled"
4764
4765
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004766dispatch <address>:<port>
4767 Set a default server address
4768 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4769 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004770 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004771
4772 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
4773 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
4774 during start-up.
4775
4776 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
4777 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
4778 possible with normal servers.
4779
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02004780 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004781 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
4782 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
4783 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
4784 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
4785
4786 See also : "server"
4787
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004788
4789dynamic-cookie-key <string>
4790 Set the dynamic cookie secret key for a backend.
4791 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4792 yes | no | yes | yes
4793 Arguments : The secret key to be used.
4794
4795 When dynamic cookies are enabled (see the "dynamic" directive for cookie),
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004796 a dynamic cookie is created for each server (unless one is explicitly
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004797 specified on the "server" line), using a hash of the IP address of the
4798 server, the TCP port, and the secret key.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004799 That way, we can ensure session persistence across multiple load-balancers,
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004800 even if servers are dynamically added or removed.
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004801
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004802enabled
4803 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
4804 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4805 yes | yes | yes | yes
4806 Arguments : none
4807
4808 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
4809 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
4810
4811 See also : "disabled"
4812
4813
4814errorfile <code> <file>
4815 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
4816 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4817 yes | yes | yes | yes
4818 Arguments :
4819 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004820 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01004821 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004822
4823 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004824 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004825 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004826 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
4827 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004828
4829 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
4830 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
4831 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
4832
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004833 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
4834
Christopher Faulet70170672020-05-18 17:42:48 +02004835 The files are parsed when HAProxy starts and must be valid according to the
4836 HTTP specification. They should not exceed the configured buffer size
4837 (BUFSIZE), which generally is 16 kB, otherwise an internal error will be
4838 returned. It is also wise not to put any reference to local contents
4839 (e.g. images) in order to avoid loops between the client and HAProxy when all
4840 servers are down, causing an error to be returned instead of an
4841 image. Finally, The response cannot exceed (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite)
4842 so that "http-after-response" rules still have room to operate (see
4843 "tune.maxrewrite").
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004844
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004845 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
4846 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
4847 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004848 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004849 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
4850
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004851 See also : "http-error", "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004852
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004853 Example :
4854 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01004855 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004856 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
4857 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
4858
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004859
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004860errorfiles <name> [<code> ...]
4861 Import, fully or partially, the error files defined in the <name> http-errors
4862 section.
4863 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4864 yes | yes | yes | yes
4865 Arguments :
4866 <name> is the name of an existing http-errors section.
4867
4868 <code> is a HTTP status code. Several status code may be listed.
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004869 Currently, HAProxy is capable of generating codes 200, 400, 401,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01004870 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503,
4871 and 504.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004872
4873 Errors defined in the http-errors section with the name <name> are imported
4874 in the current proxy. If no status code is specified, all error files of the
4875 http-errors section are imported. Otherwise, only error files associated to
4876 the listed status code are imported. Those error files override the already
4877 defined custom errors for the proxy. And they may be overridden by following
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04004878 ones. Functionally, it is exactly the same as declaring all error files by
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004879 hand using "errorfile" directives.
4880
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004881 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302" ,
4882 "errorloc303" and section 3.8 about http-errors.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004883
4884 Example :
4885 errorfiles generic
4886 errorfiles site-1 403 404
4887
4888
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004889errorloc <code> <url>
4890errorloc302 <code> <url>
4891 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
4892 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4893 yes | yes | yes | yes
4894 Arguments :
4895 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004896 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01004897 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004898
4899 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
4900 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
4901 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
4902 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004903 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004904
4905 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
4906 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
4907 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
4908
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004909 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
4910
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004911 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
4912 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
4913 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
4914 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01004915 work around this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004916 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
4917 request.
4918
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004919 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc303"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004920
4921
4922errorloc303 <code> <url>
4923 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
4924 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4925 yes | yes | yes | yes
4926 Arguments :
4927 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004928 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01004929 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004930
4931 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
4932 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
4933 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
4934 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004935 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004936
4937 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
4938 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
4939 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
4940
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004941 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
4942
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004943 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
4944 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
4945 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
4946 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004947 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004948
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004949 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004950
4951
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004952email-alert from <emailaddr>
4953 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004954 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004955 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4956 yes | yes | yes | yes
4957
4958 Arguments :
4959
4960 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
4961
4962 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
4963 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
4964
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004965 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02004966 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about
4967 mailers.
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004968
4969
4970email-alert level <level>
4971 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
4972 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
4973 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4974 yes | yes | yes | yes
4975
4976 Arguments :
4977
4978 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
4979 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
4980 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
4981
4982 By default level is alert
4983
4984 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
4985 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
4986 for the proxy.
4987
Simon Horman1421e212015-04-30 13:10:35 +09004988 Alerts are sent when :
4989
4990 * An un-paused server is marked as down and <level> is alert or lower
4991 * A paused server is marked as down and <level> is notice or lower
4992 * A server is marked as up or enters the drain state and <level>
4993 is notice or lower
4994 * "option log-health-checks" is enabled, <level> is info or lower,
4995 and a health check status update occurs
4996
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004997 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
4998 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004999 section 3.6 about mailers.
5000
5001
5002email-alert mailers <mailersect>
5003 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
5004 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5005 yes | yes | yes | yes
5006
5007 Arguments :
5008
5009 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
5010
5011 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
5012 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
5013
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09005014 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
5015 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005016
5017
5018email-alert myhostname <hostname>
5019 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
5020 mailers.
5021 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5022 yes | yes | yes | yes
5023
5024 Arguments :
5025
Baptiste Assmann738bad92015-12-21 15:27:53 +01005026 <hostname> is the hostname to use when communicating with mailers
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005027
5028 By default the systems hostname is used.
5029
5030 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
5031 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
5032 for the proxy.
5033
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09005034 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
5035 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005036
5037
5038email-alert to <emailaddr>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005039 Declare both the recipient address in the envelope and to address in the
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005040 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
5041 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5042 yes | yes | yes | yes
5043
5044 Arguments :
5045
5046 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
5047
5048 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
5049 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
5050
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09005051 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005052 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
5053
5054
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01005055force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
5056 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
5057 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01005058 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01005059
5060 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
5061 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
5062 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
5063 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
5064 marked down for maintenance operations.
5065
5066 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
5067 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
5068 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
5069 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
5070 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
5071 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
5072 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
5073 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
5074 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
5075
5076 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
5077 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
5078 is used.
5079
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005080 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02005081 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01005082
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02005083
5084filter <name> [param*]
5085 Add the filter <name> in the filter list attached to the proxy.
5086 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5087 no | yes | yes | yes
5088 Arguments :
5089 <name> is the name of the filter. Officially supported filters are
5090 referenced in section 9.
5091
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01005092 <param*> is a list of parameters accepted by the filter <name>. The
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02005093 parsing of these parameters are the responsibility of the
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01005094 filter. Please refer to the documentation of the corresponding
5095 filter (section 9) for all details on the supported parameters.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02005096
5097 Multiple occurrences of the filter line can be used for the same proxy. The
5098 same filter can be referenced many times if needed.
5099
5100 Example:
5101 listen
5102 bind *:80
5103
5104 filter trace name BEFORE-HTTP-COMP
5105 filter compression
5106 filter trace name AFTER-HTTP-COMP
5107
5108 compression algo gzip
5109 compression offload
5110
5111 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5112
5113 See also : section 9.
5114
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01005115
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005116fullconn <conns>
5117 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
5118 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5119 yes | no | yes | yes
5120 Arguments :
5121 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
5122 servers use the maximal number of connections.
5123
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005124 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005125 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005126 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005127 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
5128 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
5129 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
5130 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
5131 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005132 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005133
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005134 Since it's hard to get this value right, HAProxy automatically sets it to
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02005135 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01005136 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
5137 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
5138 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02005139
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005140 Example :
5141 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
5142 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
5143 # connections.
5144 backend dynamic
5145 fullconn 10000
5146 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
5147 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
5148
5149 See also : "maxconn", "server"
5150
5151
Willy Tarreauab0a5192020-10-09 19:07:01 +02005152grace <time> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005153 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
5154 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01005155 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005156 Arguments :
5157 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
5158 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
5159 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
5160
5161 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
5162 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005163 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005164 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
5165
5166 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
5167 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
5168 simplify it.
5169
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005170
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04005171hash-balance-factor <factor>
5172 Specify the balancing factor for bounded-load consistent hashing
5173 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5174 yes | no | no | yes
5175 Arguments :
5176 <factor> is the control for the maximum number of concurrent requests to
5177 send to a server, expressed as a percentage of the average number
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01005178 of concurrent requests across all of the active servers.
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04005179
5180 Specifying a "hash-balance-factor" for a server with "hash-type consistent"
5181 enables an algorithm that prevents any one server from getting too many
5182 requests at once, even if some hash buckets receive many more requests than
5183 others. Setting <factor> to 0 (the default) disables the feature. Otherwise,
5184 <factor> is a percentage greater than 100. For example, if <factor> is 150,
5185 then no server will be allowed to have a load more than 1.5 times the average.
5186 If server weights are used, they will be respected.
5187
5188 If the first-choice server is disqualified, the algorithm will choose another
5189 server based on the request hash, until a server with additional capacity is
5190 found. A higher <factor> allows more imbalance between the servers, while a
5191 lower <factor> means that more servers will be checked on average, affecting
5192 performance. Reasonable values are from 125 to 200.
5193
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02005194 This setting is also used by "balance random" which internally relies on the
5195 consistent hashing mechanism.
5196
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04005197 See also : "balance" and "hash-type".
5198
5199
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005200hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005201 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
5202 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5203 yes | no | yes | yes
5204 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005205 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
5206 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005207
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005208 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
5209 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
5210 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
5211 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
5212 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
5213 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
5214 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
5215 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
5216 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
5217 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01005218
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005219 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
5220 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
5221 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
5222 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
5223 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
5224 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
5225 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
5226 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
5227 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
5228 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
5229 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
5230 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
5231 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005232 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
5233 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005234
5235 <function> is the hash function to be used :
5236
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005237 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005238 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
5239 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
5240 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005241 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
5242 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
5243 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005244
5245 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
5246 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005247 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
5248 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
5249 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
5250 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
5251
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005252 wt6 this function was designed for HAProxy while testing other
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01005253 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
5254 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
5255 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
5256 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
5257 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
5258 parameter.
5259
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01005260 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
5261 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
5262 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
5263 used on strings.
5264
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005265 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
5266
5267 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
5268 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
5269 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
5270 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
5271 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
5272 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
5273 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
5274 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
5275 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
5276 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
5277 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
5278 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005279
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005280 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
5281 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
5282 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005283
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04005284 See also : "balance", "hash-balance-factor", "server"
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005285
5286
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005287http-after-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5288 Access control for all Layer 7 responses (server, applet/service and internal
5289 ones).
5290
5291 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5292 no | yes | yes | yes
5293
5294 The http-after-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer
5295 7 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they
5296 are met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
5297 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
5298 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
5299 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
5300
5301 Unlike http-response rules, these ones are applied on all responses, the
5302 server ones but also to all responses generated by HAProxy. These rules are
5303 evaluated at the end of the responses analysis, before the data forwarding.
5304
5305 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
5306 below.
5307
5308 There is no limit to the number of http-after-response statements per
5309 instance.
5310
Christopher Fauletd5ac6de2020-12-02 08:40:14 +01005311 Note: Errors emitted in early stage of the request parsing are handled by the
5312 multiplexer at a lower level, before any http analysis. Thus no
5313 http-after-response ruleset is evaluated on these errors.
5314
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005315 Example:
5316 http-after-response set-header Strict-Transport-Security "max-age=31536000"
5317 http-after-response set-header Cache-Control "no-store,no-cache,private"
5318 http-after-response set-header Pragma "no-cache"
5319
5320http-after-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5321
5322 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
5323 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
5324 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
5325 example, or to pass some internal information.
5326 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
5327 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
5328 the resulting header from a previous rule.
5329
5330http-after-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5331
5332 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
5333 No further "http-after-response" rules are evaluated.
5334
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00005335http-after-response del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005336
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00005337 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. <meth>
5338 is the matching method, applied on the header name. Supported matching methods
5339 are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix match), "end" (suffix match), "sub"
5340 (substring match) and "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
5341 method is used.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005342
5343http-after-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
5344 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5345
5346 This works like "http-response replace-header".
5347
5348 Example:
5349 http-after-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
5350
5351 # applied to:
5352 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
5353
5354 # outputs:
5355 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
5356
5357 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
5358
5359http-after-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
5360 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5361
5362 This works like "http-response replace-value".
5363
5364 Example:
5365 http-after-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
5366
5367 # applied to:
5368 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
5369
5370 # outputs:
5371 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
5372
5373http-after-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5374
5375 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
5376 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
5377 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
5378
5379http-after-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
5380 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5381
5382 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
5383 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
5384 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
5385 fallback.
5386
5387 Example:
5388 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
5389 http-response set-status 431
5390 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
5391 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down"
5392
5393http-after-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5394
5395 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
5396 inline.
5397
5398 Arguments:
5399 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5400 scope. The scopes allowed are:
5401 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
5402 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
5403 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
5404 (request and response)
5405 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
5406 processing
5407 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
5408 processing
5409 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5410 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
5411 and '_'.
5412
5413 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
5414 followed by some converters.
5415
5416 Example:
5417 http-after-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
5418
5419http-after-response strict-mode { on | off }
5420
5421 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
5422 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
5423 performing a rewrite on the responses. When the strict mode is enabled, any
5424 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
5425 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005426 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the response
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005427 processing.
5428
5429 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
5430 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005431 the backend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the frontend
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005432 rules evaluation.
5433
5434http-after-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5435
5436 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-after-response set-var" for
5437 details about <var-name>.
5438
5439 Example:
5440 http-after-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
5441
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005442
5443http-check comment <string>
5444 Defines a comment for the following the http-check rule, reported in logs if
5445 it fails.
5446 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5447 yes | no | yes | yes
5448
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005449 Arguments :
5450 <string> is the comment message to add in logs if the following http-check
5451 rule fails.
5452
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005453 It only works for connect, send and expect rules. It is useful to make
5454 user-friendly error reporting.
5455
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005456 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check connect", "http-check send" and
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005457 "http-check expect".
5458
5459
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005460http-check connect [default] [port <expr>] [addr <ip>] [send-proxy]
5461 [via-socks4] [ssl] [sni <sni>] [alpn <alpn>] [linger]
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +02005462 [proto <name>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005463 Opens a new connection to perform an HTTP health check
5464 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5465 yes | no | yes | yes
5466
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005467 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005468 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
5469
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005470 default Use default options of the server line to do the health
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005471 checks. The server options are used only if not redefined.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005472
5473 port <expr> if not set, check port or server port is used.
5474 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
5475 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to
5476 65535 or an sample-fetch expression.
5477
5478 addr <ip> defines the IP address to do the health check.
5479
5480 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
5481
5482 via-socks4 enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy.
5483
5484 ssl opens a ciphered connection
5485
5486 sni <sni> specifies the SNI to use to do health checks over SSL.
5487
5488 alpn <alpn> defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol
5489 list consists in a comma-delimited list of protocol names,
5490 for instance: "h2,http/1.1". If it is not set, the server ALPN
5491 is used.
5492
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +02005493 proto <name> forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for this connection.
5494 It must be an HTTP mux protocol and it must be usable on the
5495 backend side. The list of available protocols is reported in
5496 haproxy -vv.
5497
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005498 linger cleanly close the connection instead of using a single RST.
5499
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005500 Just like tcp-check health checks, it is possible to configure the connection
5501 to use to perform HTTP health check. This directive should also be used to
5502 describe a scenario involving several request/response exchanges, possibly on
5503 different ports or with different servers.
5504
5505 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
5506 directive, then the first step of the http-check sequence must be to specify
5507 the port with a "http-check connect".
5508
5509 In an http-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
5510 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
5511 do.
5512
5513 When a connect must start the ruleset, if may still be preceded by set-var,
5514 unset-var or comment rules.
5515
5516 Examples :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005517 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
5518 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
5519 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
5520 option httpchk
5521
5522 http-check connect
Christopher Fauleta5c14ef2020-04-29 14:19:13 +02005523 http-check send meth GET uri / ver HTTP/1.1 hdr host haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005524 http-check expect status 200-399
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005525 http-check connect port 443 ssl sni haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Fauleta5c14ef2020-04-29 14:19:13 +02005526 http-check send meth GET uri / ver HTTP/1.1 hdr host haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005527 http-check expect status 200-399
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005528
5529 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
5530
5531 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check send", "http-check expect"
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005532
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005533
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005534http-check disable-on-404
5535 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
5536 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005537 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005538 Arguments : none
5539
5540 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
5541 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
5542 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
5543 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
5544 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
5545 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
5546 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
5547 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005548 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
5549 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
Christopher Fauletfa8b89a2020-11-20 18:54:13 +01005550 responses will still be considered as soft-stop. Note also that a stopped
5551 server will stay stopped even if it replies 404s. This option is only
5552 evaluated for running servers.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005553
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005554 See also : "option httpchk" and "http-check expect".
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005555
5556
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005557http-check expect [min-recv <int>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005558 [ok-status <st>] [error-status <st>] [tout-status <st>]
5559 [on-success <fmt>] [on-error <fmt>] [status-code <expr>]
5560 [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005561 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005562 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02005563 yes | no | yes | yes
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005564
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005565 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005566 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
5567
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005568 min-recv is optional and can define the minimum amount of data required to
5569 evaluate the current expect rule. If the number of received bytes
5570 is under this limit, the check will wait for more data. This
5571 option can be used to resolve some ambiguous matching rules or to
5572 avoid executing costly regex matches on content known to be still
5573 incomplete. If an exact string is used, the minimum between the
5574 string length and this parameter is used. This parameter is
5575 ignored if it is set to -1. If the expect rule does not match,
5576 the check will wait for more data. If set to 0, the evaluation
5577 result is always conclusive.
5578
5579 ok-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
5580 the expect rule is successfully evaluated and if it is
5581 the last rule in the tcp-check ruleset. "L7OK", "L7OKC",
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005582 "L6OK" and "L4OK" are supported :
5583 - L7OK : check passed on layer 7
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +01005584 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
5585 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005586 - L6OK : check passed on layer 6
5587 - L4OK : check passed on layer 4
5588 By default "L7OK" is used.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005589
5590 error-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
5591 an error occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +01005592 "L7OKC", "L7RSP", "L7STS", "L6RSP" and "L4CON" are
5593 supported :
5594 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
5595 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005596 - L7RSP : layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
5597 - L7STS : layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
5598 - L6RSP : layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
5599 - L4CON : layer 1-4 connection problem
5600 By default "L7RSP" is used.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005601
5602 tout-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
5603 a timeout occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005604 "L7TOUT", "L6TOUT", and "L4TOUT" are supported :
5605 - L7TOUT : layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
5606 - L6TOUT : layer 6 (SSL) timeout
5607 - L4TOUT : layer 1-4 timeout
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005608 By default "L7TOUT" is used.
5609
5610 on-success <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
5611 informational message reported in logs if the expect
5612 rule is successfully evaluated and if it is the last rule
5613 in the tcp-check ruleset. <fmt> is a log-format string.
5614
5615 on-error <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
5616 informational message reported in logs if an error
5617 occurred during the expect rule evaluation. <fmt> is a
5618 log-format string.
5619
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005620 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02005621 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus", "hdr",
5622 "fhdr", "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005623 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
5624 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
5625 details on the supported keywords.
5626
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005627 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string, a regular
5628 expression or a more complex pattern with several arguments. If
5629 the string pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped with the
5630 usual backslash ('\').
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005631
5632 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
5633 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
5634 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
5635 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
5636 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
5637
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005638 status <codes> : test the status codes found parsing <codes> string. it
5639 must be a comma-separated list of status codes or range
5640 codes. A health check response will be considered as
5641 valid if the response's status code matches any status
5642 code or is inside any range of the list. If the "status"
5643 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
5644 considered invalid if the status code matches.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005645
5646 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005647 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005648 response's status code matches the expression. If the
5649 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
5650 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
5651 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
5652
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02005653 hdr { name | name-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <name>
5654 [ { value | value-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <value> :
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005655 test the specified header pattern on the HTTP response
5656 headers. The name pattern is mandatory but the value
5657 pattern is optional. If not specified, only the header
5658 presence is verified. <meth> is the matching method,
5659 applied on the header name or the header value. Supported
5660 matching methods are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix
5661 match), "end" (suffix match), "sub" (substring match) or
5662 "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02005663 method is used. If the "name-lf" parameter is used,
5664 <name> is evaluated as a log-format string. If "value-lf"
5665 parameter is used, <value> is evaluated as a log-format
5666 string. These parameters cannot be used with the regex
5667 matching method. Finally, the header value is considered
5668 as comma-separated list. Note that matchings are case
5669 insensitive on the header names.
5670
5671 fhdr { name | name-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <name>
5672 [ { value | value-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <value> :
5673 test the specified full header pattern on the HTTP
5674 response headers. It does exactly the same than "hdr"
5675 keyword, except the full header value is tested, commas
5676 are not considered as delimiters.
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005677
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005678 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005679 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005680 response's body contains this exact string. If the
5681 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
5682 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
5683 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
5684 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005685 specific error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005686 trace).
5687
5688 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005689 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005690 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
5691 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
5692 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
5693 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
5694 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005695 error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack trace).
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005696
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +02005697 string-lf <fmt> : test a log-format string match in the HTTP response body.
5698 A health check response will be considered valid if the
5699 response's body contains the string resulting of the
5700 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format rules.
5701 If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
5702 considered invalid if the body contains the string.
5703
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005704 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +01005705 defined by the global "tune.bufsize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005706 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
5707 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
5708 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
5709 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
5710 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
5711 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
5712
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005713 In an http-check ruleset, the last expect rule may be implicit. If no expect
5714 rule is specified after the last "http-check send", an implicit expect rule
5715 is defined to match on 2xx or 3xx status codes. It means this rule is also
5716 defined if there is no "http-check" rule at all, when only "option httpchk"
5717 is set.
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01005718
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005719 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
5720 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
5721
5722 Examples :
5723 # only accept status 200 as valid
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005724 http-check expect status 200,201,300-310
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005725
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005726 # be sure a sessid coookie is set
5727 http-check expect header name "set-cookie" value -m beg "sessid="
5728
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005729 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01005730 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005731
5732 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01005733 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005734
5735 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03005736 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*--></html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005737
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005738 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check connect", "http-check disable-on-404"
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005739 and "http-check send".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005740
5741
Christopher Faulet7c95f5f2020-05-06 15:06:34 +02005742http-check send [meth <method>] [{ uri <uri> | uri-lf <fmt> }>] [ver <version>]
Christopher Faulet574e7bd2020-05-06 15:38:58 +02005743 [hdr <name> <fmt>]* [{ body <string> | body-lf <fmt> }]
5744 [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005745 Add a possible list of headers and/or a body to the request sent during HTTP
5746 health checks.
5747 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5748 yes | no | yes | yes
5749 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005750 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
5751
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005752 meth <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not
5753 set, the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires
5754 low server processing and is easy to filter out from the
5755 logs. Any method may be used, though it is not recommended
5756 to invent non-standard ones.
5757
Christopher Faulet7c95f5f2020-05-06 15:06:34 +02005758 uri <uri> is optional and set the URI referenced in the HTTP requests
5759 to the string <uri>. It defaults to "/" which is accessible
5760 by default on almost any server, but may be changed to any
5761 other URI. Query strings are permitted.
5762
5763 uri-lf <fmt> is optional and set the URI referenced in the HTTP requests
5764 using the log-format string <fmt>. It defaults to "/" which
5765 is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
5766 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005767
Christopher Faulet907701b2020-04-28 09:37:00 +02005768 ver <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005769 "HTTP/1.0" but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005770 1.0, so turning it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005771 the Host field is mandatory in HTTP/1.1, use "hdr" argument
5772 to add it.
5773
5774 hdr <name> <fmt> adds the HTTP header field whose name is specified in
5775 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt>, which follows
5776 to the log-format rules.
5777
5778 body <string> add the body defined by <string> to the request sent during
5779 HTTP health checks. If defined, the "Content-Length" header
5780 is thus automatically added to the request.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005781
Christopher Faulet574e7bd2020-05-06 15:38:58 +02005782 body-lf <fmt> add the body defined by the log-format string <fmt> to the
5783 request sent during HTTP health checks. If defined, the
5784 "Content-Length" header is thus automatically added to the
5785 request.
5786
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005787 In addition to the request line defined by the "option httpchk" directive,
5788 this one is the valid way to add some headers and optionally a body to the
5789 request sent during HTTP health checks. If a body is defined, the associate
Christopher Faulet9df910c2020-04-29 14:20:47 +02005790 "Content-Length" header is automatically added. Thus, this header or
5791 "Transfer-encoding" header should not be present in the request provided by
5792 "http-check send". If so, it will be ignored. The old trick consisting to add
5793 headers after the version string on the "option httpchk" line is now
Amaury Denoyelle6d975f02020-12-22 14:08:52 +01005794 deprecated.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005795
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005796 Also "http-check send" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
Amaury Denoyelle6d975f02020-12-22 14:08:52 +01005797 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, unless a Connection
5798 header has already already been configured via a hdr entry.
Christopher Faulet9df910c2020-04-29 14:20:47 +02005799
5800 Note that the Host header and the request authority, when both defined, are
5801 automatically synchronized. It means when the HTTP request is sent, when a
5802 Host is inserted in the request, the request authority is accordingly
5803 updated. Thus, don't be surprised if the Host header value overwrites the
5804 configured request authority.
5805
5806 Note also for now, no Host header is automatically added in HTTP/1.1 or above
5807 requests. You should add it explicitly.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005808
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005809 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check send-state" and "http-check expect".
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005810
5811
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005812http-check send-state
5813 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
5814 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5815 yes | no | yes | yes
5816 Arguments : none
5817
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005818 When this option is set, HAProxy will systematically send a special header
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005819 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005820 how they are seen by HAProxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
5821 manipulated without access to HAProxy and the operator needs to know whether
5822 HAProxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005823
5824 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
5825 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
5826 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
5827 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
5828 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08005829 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
5830 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
5831 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
5832
5833 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
5834 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
5835 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
5836
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005837 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
5838 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
5839 checked in multiple backends.
5840
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005841 - a variable "node" containing the name of the HAProxy node, as set in the
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005842 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
5843
5844 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
5845 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
5846 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
5847 one fails.
5848
5849 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
5850 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
5851 connections on all servers of the same backend.
5852
5853 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
5854 server's queue.
5855
5856 Example of a header received by the application server :
5857 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
5858 scur=13/22; qcur=0
5859
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005860 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404" and
5861 "http-check send".
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005862
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005863
5864http-check set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005865 This operation sets the content of a variable. The variable is declared inline.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005866 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5867 yes | no | yes | yes
5868
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005869 Arguments :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005870 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5871 scope. The scopes allowed for http-check are:
5872 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
5873 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
5874 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
5875 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5876 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
5877 and '-'.
5878
5879 <expr> Is a sample-fetch expression potentially followed by converters.
5880
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005881 Examples :
5882 http-check set-var(check.port) int(1234)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005883
5884
5885http-check unset-var(<var-name>)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005886 Free a reference to a variable within its scope.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005887 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5888 yes | no | yes | yes
5889
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005890 Arguments :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005891 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5892 scope. The scopes allowed for http-check are:
5893 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
5894 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
5895 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
5896 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5897 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
5898 and '-'.
5899
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005900 Examples :
5901 http-check unset-var(check.port)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005902
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005903
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005904http-error status <code> [content-type <type>]
5905 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
5906 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
5907 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
5908 Defines a custom error message to use instead of errors generated by HAProxy.
5909 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5910 yes | yes | yes | yes
5911 Arguments :
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05005912 status <code> is the HTTP status code. It must be specified.
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005913 Currently, HAProxy is capable of generating codes
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02005914 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410, 413, 425,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01005915 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005916
5917 content-type <type> is the response content type, for instance
5918 "text/plain". This parameter is ignored and should be
5919 omitted when an errorfile is configured or when the
5920 payload is empty. Otherwise, it must be defined.
5921
5922 default-errorfiles Reset the previously defined error message for current
5923 proxy for the status <code>. If used on a backend, the
5924 frontend error message is used, if defined. If used on
5925 a frontend, the default error message is used.
5926
5927 errorfile <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response.
5928 It is recommended to follow the common practice of
5929 appending ".http" to the filename so that people do
5930 not confuse the response with HTML error pages, and to
5931 use absolute paths, since files are read before any
5932 chroot is performed.
5933
5934 errorfiles <name> designates the http-errors section to use to import
5935 the error message with the status code <code>. If no
5936 such message is found, the proxy's error messages are
5937 considered.
5938
5939 file <file> specifies the file to use as response payload. If the
5940 file is not empty, its content-type must be set as
5941 argument to "content-type", otherwise, any
5942 "content-type" argument is ignored. <file> is
5943 considered as a raw string.
5944
5945 string <str> specifies the raw string to use as response payload.
5946 The content-type must always be set as argument to
5947 "content-type".
5948
5949 lf-file <file> specifies the file to use as response payload. If the
5950 file is not empty, its content-type must be set as
5951 argument to "content-type", otherwise, any
5952 "content-type" argument is ignored. <file> is
5953 evaluated as a log-format string.
5954
5955 lf-string <str> specifies the log-format string to use as response
5956 payload. The content-type must always be set as
5957 argument to "content-type".
5958
5959 hdr <name> <fmt> adds to the response the HTTP header field whose name
5960 is specified in <name> and whose value is defined by
5961 <fmt>, which follows to the log-format rules.
5962 This parameter is ignored if an errorfile is used.
5963
5964 This directive may be used instead of "errorfile", to define a custom error
5965 message. As "errorfile" directive, it is used for errors detected and
5966 returned by HAProxy. If an errorfile is defined, it is parsed when HAProxy
5967 starts and must be valid according to the HTTP standards. The generated
5968 response must not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFFSIZE), otherwise an
5969 internal error will be returned. Finally, if you consider to use some
5970 http-after-response rules to rewrite these errors, the reserved buffer space
5971 should be available (see "tune.maxrewrite").
5972
5973 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
5974 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
5975 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running.
5976
Christopher Fauletd5ac6de2020-12-02 08:40:14 +01005977 Note: 400/408/500 errors emitted in early stage of the request parsing are
5978 handled by the multiplexer at a lower level. No custom formatting is
5979 supported at this level. Thus only static error messages, defined with
5980 "errorfile" directive, are supported. However, this limitation only
5981 exists during the request headers parsing or between two transactions.
5982
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005983 See also : "errorfile", "errorfiles", "errorloc", "errorloc302",
5984 "errorloc303" and section 3.8 about http-errors.
5985
5986
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005987http-request <action> [options...] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005988 Access control for Layer 7 requests
5989
5990 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5991 no | yes | yes | yes
5992
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005993 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
5994 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
5995 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
5996 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
5997 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005998
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005999 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
6000 below.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006001
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006002 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006003
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006004 Example:
6005 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
6006 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
6007 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006008
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006009 http-request allow if nagios
6010 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
6011 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
6012 http-request deny
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01006013
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006014 Example:
6015 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
6016 acl add path /addacl
6017 acl del path /delacl
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006018
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006019 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006020
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006021 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
6022 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02006023
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006024 Example:
6025 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
6026 acl setmap path /setmap
6027 acl delmap path /delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006028
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006029 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006030
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006031 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
6032 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006033
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006034 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
6035 about ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006036
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006037http-request add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006038
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006039 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
6040 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
6041 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6042 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
6043 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values. This
6044 lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
6045 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
6046 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006047
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006048http-request add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006049
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006050 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and
6051 whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see
6052 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
6053 connection-specific information to the server (e.g. the client's SSL
6054 certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This rule is not
6055 final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note that header
6056 addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse the resulting
6057 header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006058
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006059http-request allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006060
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006061 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request pass the check.
6062 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006063
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006064
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006065http-request auth [realm <realm>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006066
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006067 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds with an
6068 HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid user name
6069 and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An optional
6070 "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm that is
6071 returned with the response (typically the application's name).
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006072
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02006073 The corresponding proxy's error message is used. It may be customized using
6074 an "errorfile" or an "http-error" directive. For 401 responses, all
6075 occurrences of the WWW-Authenticate header are removed and replaced by a new
6076 one with a basic authentication challenge for realm "<realm>". For 407
6077 responses, the same is done on the Proxy-Authenticate header. If the error
6078 message must not be altered, consider to use "http-request return" rule
6079 instead.
6080
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006081 Example:
6082 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
6083 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006084
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02006085http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006086
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02006087 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006088
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006089http-request capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ]
6090 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006091
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006092 This captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and
6093 converts it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
6094 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next
6095 to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs,
6096 and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it
6097 into headers or anything. The length should be limited given that this size
6098 will be allocated for each capture during the whole session life.
6099 Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture request header" for
6100 more information.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006101
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006102 If the keyword "id" is used instead of "len", the action tries to store the
6103 captured string in a previously declared capture slot. This is useful to run
6104 captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a previous directive
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01006105 "http-request capture" or with the "declare capture" keyword.
6106
6107 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
6108 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
6109 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
6110 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006111
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006112http-request del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006113
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006114 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
6115 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
6116 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6117 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
6118 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
6119 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006120
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00006121http-request del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02006122
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00006123 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. <meth>
6124 is the matching method, applied on the header name. Supported matching methods
6125 are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix match), "end" (suffix match), "sub"
6126 (substring match) and "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
6127 method is used.
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02006128
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006129http-request del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02006130
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006131 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
6132 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
6133 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6134 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
6135 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
6136 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02006137
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006138http-request deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6139http-request deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
6140 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6141 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
6142 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
6143 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04006144
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006145 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the request.
6146 By default an HTTP 403 error is returned. But the response may be customized
6147 using same syntax than "http-request return" rules. Thus, see "http-request
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05006148 return" for details. For compatibility purpose, when no argument is defined,
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006149 or only "deny_status", the argument "default-errorfiles" is implied. It means
6150 "http-request deny [deny_status <status>]" is an alias of
6151 "http-request deny [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006152 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006153 See also "http-request return".
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04006154
Olivier Houchard602bf7d2019-05-10 13:59:15 +02006155http-request disable-l7-retry [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6156 This disables any attempt to retry the request if it fails for any other
6157 reason than a connection failure. This can be useful for example to make
6158 sure POST requests aren't retried on failure.
6159
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01006160http-request do-resolve(<var>,<resolvers>,[ipv4,ipv6]) <expr> :
6161
6162 This action performs a DNS resolution of the output of <expr> and stores
6163 the result in the variable <var>. It uses the DNS resolvers section
6164 pointed by <resolvers>.
6165 It is possible to choose a resolution preference using the optional
6166 arguments 'ipv4' or 'ipv6'.
6167 When performing the DNS resolution, the client side connection is on
6168 pause waiting till the end of the resolution.
6169 If an IP address can be found, it is stored into <var>. If any kind of
6170 error occurs, then <var> is not set.
6171 One can use this action to discover a server IP address at run time and
6172 based on information found in the request (IE a Host header).
6173 If this action is used to find the server's IP address (using the
6174 "set-dst" action), then the server IP address in the backend must be set
William Lallemandac83dba2022-08-26 16:38:43 +02006175 to 0.0.0.0. The do-resolve action takes an host-only parameter, any port must
6176 be removed from the string.
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01006177
6178 Example:
6179 resolvers mydns
6180 nameserver local 127.0.0.53:53
6181 nameserver google 8.8.8.8:53
6182 timeout retry 1s
6183 hold valid 10s
6184 hold nx 3s
6185 hold other 3s
6186 hold obsolete 0s
6187 accepted_payload_size 8192
6188
6189 frontend fe
6190 bind 10.42.0.1:80
William Lallemandac83dba2022-08-26 16:38:43 +02006191 http-request do-resolve(txn.myip,mydns,ipv4) hdr(Host),lower,regsub(:[0-9]*$,)
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01006192 http-request capture var(txn.myip) len 40
6193
6194 # return 503 when the variable is not set,
6195 # which mean DNS resolution error
6196 use_backend b_503 unless { var(txn.myip) -m found }
6197
6198 default_backend be
6199
6200 backend b_503
6201 # dummy backend used to return 503.
6202 # one can use the errorfile directive to send a nice
6203 # 503 error page to end users
6204
6205 backend be
6206 # rule to prevent HAProxy from reconnecting to services
6207 # on the local network (forged DNS name used to scan the network)
6208 http-request deny if { var(txn.myip) -m ip 127.0.0.0/8 10.0.0.0/8 }
6209 http-request set-dst var(txn.myip)
6210 server clear 0.0.0.0:0
6211
6212 NOTE: Don't forget to set the "protection" rules to ensure HAProxy won't
6213 be used to scan the network or worst won't loop over itself...
6214
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01006215http-request early-hint <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6216
6217 This is used to build an HTTP 103 Early Hints response prior to any other one.
6218 This appends an HTTP header field to this response whose name is specified in
6219 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules
6220 (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
Frédéric Lécaille3aac1062018-11-13 09:42:13 +01006221 to the client some Link headers to preload resources required to render the
6222 HTML documents.
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01006223
6224 See RFC 8297 for more information.
6225
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02006226http-request normalize-uri <normalizer> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhusdec1c362021-05-10 17:28:26 +02006227http-request normalize-uri fragment-encode [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhusc9e05ab2021-05-10 17:28:25 +02006228http-request normalize-uri fragment-strip [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006229http-request normalize-uri path-merge-slashes [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Maximilian Maderff3bb8b2021-04-21 00:22:50 +02006230http-request normalize-uri path-strip-dot [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006231http-request normalize-uri path-strip-dotdot [ full ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006232http-request normalize-uri percent-decode-unreserved [ strict ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006233http-request normalize-uri percent-to-uppercase [ strict ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6234http-request normalize-uri query-sort-by-name [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02006235
Tim Duesterhusb918a4a2021-04-16 23:52:29 +02006236 Performs normalization of the request's URI.
6237
Tim Duesterhus2963fd32021-04-17 00:24:56 +02006238 URI normalization in HAProxy 2.4 is currently available as an experimental
Amaury Denoyellea9e639a2021-05-06 15:50:12 +02006239 technical preview. As such, it requires the global directive
6240 'expose-experimental-directives' first to be able to invoke it. You should be
6241 prepared that the behavior of normalizers might change to fix possible
6242 issues, possibly breaking proper request processing in your infrastructure.
Tim Duesterhus2963fd32021-04-17 00:24:56 +02006243
Tim Duesterhusb918a4a2021-04-16 23:52:29 +02006244 Each normalizer handles a single type of normalization to allow for a
6245 fine-grained selection of the level of normalization that is appropriate for
6246 the supported backend.
6247
6248 As an example the "path-strip-dotdot" normalizer might be useful for a static
6249 fileserver that directly maps the requested URI to the path within the local
6250 filesystem. However it might break routing of an API that expects a specific
6251 number of segments in the path.
6252
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006253 It is important to note that some normalizers might result in unsafe
6254 transformations for broken URIs. It might also be possible that a combination
6255 of normalizers that are safe by themselves results in unsafe transformations
6256 when improperly combined.
6257
6258 As an example the "percent-decode-unreserved" normalizer might result in
6259 unexpected results when a broken URI includes bare percent characters. One
6260 such a broken URI is "/%%36%36" which would be decoded to "/%66" which in
6261 turn is equivalent to "/f". By specifying the "strict" option requests to
6262 such a broken URI would safely be rejected.
6263
Tim Duesterhusb918a4a2021-04-16 23:52:29 +02006264 The following normalizers are available:
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02006265
Tim Duesterhusdec1c362021-05-10 17:28:26 +02006266 - fragment-encode: Encodes "#" as "%23".
6267
6268 The "fragment-strip" normalizer should be preferred, unless it is known
6269 that broken clients do not correctly encode '#' within the path component.
6270
6271 Example:
6272 - /#foo -> /%23foo
6273
Tim Duesterhusc9e05ab2021-05-10 17:28:25 +02006274 - fragment-strip: Removes the URI's "fragment" component.
6275
6276 According to RFC 3986#3.5 the "fragment" component of an URI should not
6277 be sent, but handled by the User Agent after retrieving a resource.
6278
6279 This normalizer should be applied first to ensure that the fragment is
6280 not interpreted as part of the request's path component.
6281
6282 Example:
6283 - /#foo -> /
6284
Tim Duesterhusd6d33de2021-04-21 21:20:35 +02006285 - path-strip-dot: Removes "/./" segments within the "path" component
6286 (RFC 3986#6.2.2.3).
Maximilian Maderff3bb8b2021-04-21 00:22:50 +02006287
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006288 Segments including percent encoded dots ("%2E") will not be detected. Use
6289 the "percent-decode-unreserved" normalizer first if this is undesired.
6290
Tim Duesterhus7a95f412021-04-21 21:20:33 +02006291 Example:
6292 - /. -> /
6293 - /./bar/ -> /bar/
6294 - /a/./a -> /a/a
6295 - /.well-known/ -> /.well-known/ (no change)
Maximilian Maderff3bb8b2021-04-21 00:22:50 +02006296
Tim Duesterhusd6d33de2021-04-21 21:20:35 +02006297 - path-strip-dotdot: Normalizes "/../" segments within the "path" component
6298 (RFC 3986#6.2.2.3).
6299
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006300 This merges segments that attempt to access the parent directory with
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006301 their preceding segment.
6302
6303 Empty segments do not receive special treatment. Use the "merge-slashes"
6304 normalizer first if this is undesired.
6305
6306 Segments including percent encoded dots ("%2E") will not be detected. Use
6307 the "percent-decode-unreserved" normalizer first if this is undesired.
Tim Duesterhus9982fc22021-04-15 21:45:59 +02006308
6309 Example:
6310 - /foo/../ -> /
6311 - /foo/../bar/ -> /bar/
6312 - /foo/bar/../ -> /foo/
6313 - /../bar/ -> /../bar/
Tim Duesterhus560e1a62021-04-15 21:46:00 +02006314 - /bar/../../ -> /../
Tim Duesterhus9982fc22021-04-15 21:45:59 +02006315 - /foo//../ -> /foo/
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006316 - /foo/%2E%2E/ -> /foo/%2E%2E/
Tim Duesterhus9982fc22021-04-15 21:45:59 +02006317
Tim Duesterhus560e1a62021-04-15 21:46:00 +02006318 If the "full" option is specified then "../" at the beginning will be
6319 removed as well:
6320
6321 Example:
6322 - /../bar/ -> /bar/
6323 - /bar/../../ -> /
6324
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006325 - path-merge-slashes: Merges adjacent slashes within the "path" component
6326 into a single slash.
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02006327
6328 Example:
6329 - // -> /
6330 - /foo//bar -> /foo/bar
6331
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006332 - percent-decode-unreserved: Decodes unreserved percent encoded characters to
6333 their representation as a regular character (RFC 3986#6.2.2.2).
6334
6335 The set of unreserved characters includes all letters, all digits, "-",
6336 ".", "_", and "~".
6337
6338 Example:
6339 - /%61dmin -> /admin
6340 - /foo%3Fbar=baz -> /foo%3Fbar=baz (no change)
6341 - /%%36%36 -> /%66 (unsafe)
6342 - /%ZZ -> /%ZZ
6343
6344 If the "strict" option is specified then invalid sequences will result
6345 in a HTTP 400 Bad Request being returned.
6346
6347 Example:
6348 - /%%36%36 -> HTTP 400
6349 - /%ZZ -> HTTP 400
6350
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006351 - percent-to-uppercase: Uppercases letters within percent-encoded sequences
Tim Duesterhusc315efd2021-04-21 21:20:34 +02006352 (RFC 3986#6.2.2.1).
Tim Duesterhusa4071932021-04-15 21:46:02 +02006353
6354 Example:
6355 - /%6f -> /%6F
6356 - /%zz -> /%zz
6357
6358 If the "strict" option is specified then invalid sequences will result
6359 in a HTTP 400 Bad Request being returned.
6360
6361 Example:
6362 - /%zz -> HTTP 400
6363
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006364 - query-sort-by-name: Sorts the query string parameters by parameter name.
Tim Duesterhusd7b89be2021-04-15 21:46:01 +02006365 Parameters are assumed to be delimited by '&'. Shorter names sort before
6366 longer names and identical parameter names maintain their relative order.
6367
6368 Example:
6369 - /?c=3&a=1&b=2 -> /?a=1&b=2&c=3
6370 - /?aaa=3&a=1&aa=2 -> /?a=1&aa=2&aaa=3
6371 - /?a=3&b=4&a=1&b=5&a=2 -> /?a=3&a=1&a=2&b=4&b=5
6372
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006373http-request redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006374
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006375 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule. This is exactly
6376 the same as the "redirect" statement except that it inserts a redirect rule
6377 which can be processed in the middle of other "http-request" rules and that
6378 these rules use the "log-format" strings. See the "redirect" keyword for the
6379 rule's syntax.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006380
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006381http-request reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006382
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006383 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately closes the connection
6384 without sending any response. It acts similarly to the
6385 "tcp-request content reject" rules. It can be useful to force an immediate
6386 connection closure on HTTP/2 connections.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006387
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006388http-request replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6389 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02006390
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006391 This matches the value of all occurrences of header field <name> against
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006392 <match-regex>. Matching is performed case-sensitively. Matching values are
6393 completely replaced by <replace-fmt>. Format characters are allowed in
6394 <replace-fmt> and work like <fmt> arguments in "http-request add-header".
6395 Standard back-references using the backslash ('\') followed by a number are
6396 supported.
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02006397
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006398 This action acts on whole header lines, regardless of the number of values
6399 they may contain. Thus it is well-suited to process headers naturally
6400 containing commas in their value, such as If-Modified-Since. Headers that
6401 contain a comma-separated list of values, such as Accept, should be processed
6402 using "http-request replace-value".
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01006403
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006404 Example:
6405 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
6406
6407 # applied to:
6408 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
6409
6410 # outputs:
6411 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
6412
6413 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006414
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006415 http-request replace-header User-Agent curl foo
6416
6417 # applied to:
6418 User-Agent: curl/7.47.0
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006419
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006420 # outputs:
6421 User-Agent: foo
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006422
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01006423http-request replace-path <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6424 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6425
6426 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's path
6427 component instead of a header. The path component starts at the first '/'
Christopher Faulet82c83322020-09-02 14:16:59 +02006428 after an optional scheme+authority and ends before the question mark. Thus,
6429 the replacement does not modify the scheme, the authority and the
6430 query-string.
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01006431
6432 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
6433 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
6434 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
6435
6436 Example:
6437 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
6438 http-request replace-path (.*) /foo\1
6439
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01006440 # strip /foo : turn /foo/bar?q=1 into /bar?q=1
6441 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1
6442 # or more efficient if only some requests match :
6443 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1 if { url_beg /foo/ }
6444
Christopher Faulet312294f2020-09-02 17:17:44 +02006445http-request replace-pathq <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6446 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6447
6448 This does the same as "http-request replace-path" except that the path
6449 contains the query-string if any is present. Thus, the path and the
6450 query-string are replaced.
6451
6452 Example:
6453 # suffix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /bar/foo?q=1 :
6454 http-request replace-pathq ([^?]*)(\?(.*))? \1/foo\2
6455
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006456http-request replace-uri <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6457 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6458
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006459 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's URI part
6460 instead of a header. The URI part may contain an optional scheme, authority or
6461 query string. These are considered to be part of the value that is matched
6462 against.
6463
6464 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
6465 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
6466 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006467
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01006468 IMPORTANT NOTE: historically in HTTP/1.x, the vast majority of requests sent
6469 by browsers use the "origin form", which differs from the "absolute form" in
6470 that they do not contain a scheme nor authority in the URI portion. Mostly
6471 only requests sent to proxies, those forged by hand and some emitted by
6472 certain applications use the absolute form. As such, "replace-uri" usually
6473 works fine most of the time in HTTP/1.x with rules starting with a "/". But
6474 with HTTP/2, clients are encouraged to send absolute URIs only, which look
6475 like the ones HTTP/1 clients use to talk to proxies. Such partial replace-uri
6476 rules may then fail in HTTP/2 when they work in HTTP/1. Either the rules need
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01006477 to be adapted to optionally match a scheme and authority, or replace-path
6478 should be used.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006479
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01006480 Example:
6481 # rewrite all "http" absolute requests to "https":
6482 http-request replace-uri ^http://(.*) https://\1
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006483
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01006484 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
6485 http-request replace-uri ([^/:]*://[^/]*)?(.*) \1/foo\2
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006486
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006487http-request replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6488 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006489
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006490 This works like "replace-header" except that it matches the regex against
6491 every comma-delimited value of the header field <name> instead of the
6492 entire header. This is suited for all headers which are allowed to carry
6493 more than one value. An example could be the Accept header.
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006494
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006495 Example:
6496 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02006497
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006498 # applied to:
6499 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02006500
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006501 # outputs:
6502 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01006503
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006504http-request return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
6505 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6506 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01006507 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006508 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6509
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006510 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately returns a response. The
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006511 default status code used for the response is 200. It can be optionally
6512 specified as an arguments to "status". The response content-type may also be
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006513 specified as an argument to "content-type". Finally the response itself may
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02006514 be defined. It can be a full HTTP response specifying the errorfile to use,
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006515 or the response payload specifying the file or the string to use. These rules
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006516 are followed to create the response :
6517
6518 * If neither the errorfile nor the payload to use is defined, a dummy
6519 response is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It can be
6520 any code in the range [200, 599]. The "content-type" argument, if any, is
6521 ignored.
6522
6523 * If "default-errorfiles" argument is set, the proxy's errorfiles are
6524 considered. If the "status" argument is defined, it must be one of the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04006525 status code handled by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01006526 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if
6527 any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006528
6529 * If a specific errorfile is defined, with an "errorfile" argument, the
6530 corresponding file, containing a full HTTP response, is returned. Only the
6531 "status" argument is considered. It must be one of the status code handled
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04006532 by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01006533 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006534
6535 * If an http-errors section is defined, with an "errorfiles" argument, the
6536 corresponding file in the specified http-errors section, containing a full
6537 HTTP response, is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04006538 must be one of the status code handled by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01006539 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type"
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02006540 argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006541
6542 * If a "file" or a "lf-file" argument is specified, the file's content is
6543 used as the response payload. If the file is not empty, its content-type
6544 must be set as argument to "content-type". Otherwise, any "content-type"
6545 argument is ignored. With a "lf-file" argument, the file's content is
6546 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "file" argument, it is considered
6547 as a raw content.
6548
6549 * If a "string" or "lf-string" argument is specified, the defined string is
6550 used as the response payload. The content-type must always be set as
6551 argument to "content-type". With a "lf-string" argument, the string is
6552 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "string" argument, it is
6553 considered as a raw string.
6554
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02006555 When the response is not based on an errorfile, it is possible to append HTTP
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01006556 header fields to the response using "hdr" arguments. Otherwise, all "hdr"
6557 arguments are ignored. For each one, the header name is specified in <name>
6558 and its value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules.
6559
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006560 Note that the generated response must be smaller than a buffer. And to avoid
6561 any warning, when an errorfile or a raw file is loaded, the buffer space
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02006562 reserved for the headers rewriting should also be free.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006563
6564 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
6565
6566 Example:
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006567 http-request return errorfile /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/200.http \
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006568 if { path /ping }
6569
6570 http-request return content-type image/x-icon file /var/www/favicon.ico \
6571 if { path /favicon.ico }
6572
6573 http-request return status 403 content-type text/plain \
6574 lf-string "Access denied. IP %[src] is blacklisted." \
6575 if { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
6576
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006577http-request sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6578http-request sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006579
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006580 This actions increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
6581 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
6582 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006583
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01006584http-request sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
6585 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006586
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01006587 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
6588 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
6589 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
6590 evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006591
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006592http-request set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006593
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006594 This is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
6595 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites destination IP,
6596 but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask the IP for
6597 privacy. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0' as a
6598 server address in the backend.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006599
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006600 Arguments:
6601 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
6602 by some converters.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006603
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006604 Example:
6605 http-request set-dst hdr(x-dst)
6606 http-request set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006607
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006608 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as the
6609 address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006610
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006611http-request set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006612
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006613 This is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
6614 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0'
6615 as a server address in the backend.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006616
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006617 Arguments:
6618 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
6619 followed by some converters.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006620
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006621 Example:
6622 http-request set-dst-port hdr(x-port)
6623 http-request set-dst-port int(4000)
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006624
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006625 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
6626 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
6627 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006628
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006629http-request set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006630
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006631 This does the same as "http-request add-header" except that the header name
6632 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
6633 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
6634 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so it
6635 is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006636
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006637 Example:
6638 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
6639 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
6640 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id,hex]
6641 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
6642 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
6643 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
6644 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
6645 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
6646 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006647
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006648http-request set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006649
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006650 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
6651 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
6652 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
6653 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule
6654 can be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006655
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006656http-request set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
6657 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006658
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006659 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
6660 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
6661 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
6662 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
6663 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
6664 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
6665 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
6666 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
6667 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006668
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006669http-request set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006670
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006671 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
6672 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
6673 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
6674 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by
6675 "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different route
6676 (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on Linux
6677 kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02006678
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006679http-request set-method <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006680
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006681 This rewrites the request method with the result of the evaluation of format
6682 string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons for having to do so as
6683 this is more likely to break something than to fix it.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006684
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006685http-request set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006686
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006687 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. It only
6688 has effect against the other requests being processed at the same time.
6689 The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the "bind"
6690 line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the nicest
6691 the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important than
6692 other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
6693 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
6694 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006695
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006696http-request set-path <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02006697
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006698 This rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of format
6699 string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a scheme and
6700 authority is found before the path, they are left intact as well. If the
6701 request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with the format.
6702 This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of a path for
6703 example. See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02006704
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006705 Example :
6706 # prepend the host name before the path
6707 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006708
Christopher Faulet312294f2020-09-02 17:17:44 +02006709http-request set-pathq <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6710
6711 This does the same as "http-request set-path" except that the query-string is
6712 also rewritten. It may be used to remove the query-string, including the
6713 question mark (it is not possible using "http-request set-query").
6714
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006715http-request set-priority-class <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +02006716
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006717 This is used to set the queue priority class of the current request.
6718 The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer in the
6719 range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be truncated.
6720 The priority class determines the order in which queued requests are
6721 processed. Lower values have higher priority.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006722
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006723http-request set-priority-offset <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006724
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006725 This is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset of the current
6726 request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer
6727 in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be truncated.
6728 When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority class, then by
6729 the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in milliseconds. Lower
6730 values have higher priority.
6731 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision
6732 for 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
6733 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
6734 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
6735 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006736
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006737http-request set-query <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006738
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006739 This rewrites the request's query string which appears after the first
6740 question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format string <fmt>.
6741 The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the request doesn't
6742 contain a question mark and the new value is not empty, then one is added at
6743 the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If a question mark was
6744 present, it will never be removed even if the value is empty. This can be
6745 used to add or remove parameters from the query string.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08006746
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006747 See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006748
6749 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006750 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
6751 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006752
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006753http-request set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6754 This is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
6755 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites source IP, but
6756 provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask source IP for
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02006757 privacy. All subsequent calls to "src" fetch will return this value
6758 (see example).
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006759
6760 Arguments :
6761 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
6762 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006763
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02006764 See also "option forwardfor".
6765
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01006766 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006767 http-request set-src hdr(x-forwarded-for)
6768 http-request set-src src,ipmask(24)
6769
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02006770 # After the masking this will track connections
6771 # based on the IP address with the last byte zeroed out.
6772 http-request track-sc0 src
6773
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006774 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
6775 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
6776
6777http-request set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6778
6779 This is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
6780 expression.
6781
6782 Arguments:
6783 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
6784 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006785
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006786 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006787 http-request set-src-port hdr(x-port)
6788 http-request set-src-port int(4000)
6789
6790 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long as
6791 the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source address to
6792 IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
6793
Alex59c53352021-04-27 12:57:07 +02006794http-request set-timeout { server | tunnel } { <timeout> | <expr> }
Amaury Denoyelle8d228232020-12-10 13:43:54 +01006795 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6796
6797 This action overrides the specified "server" or "tunnel" timeout for the
6798 current stream only. The timeout can be specified in millisecond or with any
6799 other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit as explained at the top of
6800 this document. It is also possible to write an expression which must returns
6801 a number interpreted as a timeout in millisecond.
6802
6803 Note that the server/tunnel timeouts are only relevant on the backend side
6804 and thus this rule is only available for the proxies with backend
6805 capabilities. Also the timeout value must be non-null to obtain the expected
6806 results.
6807
6808 Example:
Alex59c53352021-04-27 12:57:07 +02006809 http-request set-timeout tunnel 5s
6810 http-request set-timeout server req.hdr(host),map_int(host.lst)
Amaury Denoyelle8d228232020-12-10 13:43:54 +01006811
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006812http-request set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6813
6814 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
6815 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. This value
6816 represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be expressed both in
6817 decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that only the 6 higher
6818 bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are always 0. This can
6819 be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers based on some
6820 information from the request.
6821
6822 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
6823
6824http-request set-uri <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6825
6826 This rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of format
6827 string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all replaced
Christopher Faulete6794272022-11-22 15:41:48 +01006828 at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies, or to perform
6829 complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts between the path and
6830 the query string. If an absolute URI is set, it will be sent as is to
6831 HTTP/1.1 servers. If it is not the desired behavior, the host, the path
6832 and/or the query string should be set separately.
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006833 See also "http-request set-path" and "http-request set-query".
6834
6835http-request set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6836
6837 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
6838 inline.
6839
6840 Arguments:
6841 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
6842 scope. The scopes allowed are:
6843 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
6844 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
6845 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
6846 (request and response)
6847 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
6848 processing
6849 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
6850 processing
6851 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
6852 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
6853 and '_'.
6854
6855 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
6856 followed by some converters.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006857
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006858 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006859 http-request set-var(req.my_var) req.fhdr(user-agent),lower
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006860
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006861http-request send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
6862 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006863
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006864 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
6865 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
6866 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
6867 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
6868 agent name must be used.
6869
6870 Arguments:
6871 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
6872
6873 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
6874 configuration.
6875
6876http-request silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6877
6878 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
6879 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
6880 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
6881 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
6882 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
6883 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
6884 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
6885 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
6886 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
6887 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
6888 action.
6889 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
6890 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
6891 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
6892 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
6893 you fully understand how it works.
6894
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006895http-request strict-mode { on | off }
6896
6897 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
6898 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
6899 performing a rewrite on the requests. When the strict mode is enabled, any
6900 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
6901 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006902 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the request
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006903 processing.
6904
Christopher Faulet1aea50e2020-01-17 16:03:53 +01006905 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006906 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
6907 the frontend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the backend
6908 rules evaluation.
6909
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006910http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6911http-request tarpit [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
6912 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6913 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
6914 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
6915 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006916
6917 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks the request
6918 without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit" or
6919 "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the client
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006920 is still connected, a response is returned so that the client does not
6921 suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags "PT". The goal of
6922 the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack when they're limited
6923 on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very efficient against very
6924 dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the load on firewalls compared to
6925 a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly" developed robots, it can make
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04006926 things worse by forcing HAProxy and the front firewall to support insane
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006927 number of concurrent connections. By default an HTTP error 500 is returned.
6928 But the response may be customized using same syntax than
6929 "http-request return" rules. Thus, see "http-request return" for details.
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05006930 For compatibility purpose, when no argument is defined, or only "deny_status",
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006931 the argument "default-errorfiles" is implied. It means
6932 "http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>]" is an alias of
6933 "http-request tarpit [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
6934 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
6935 See also "http-request return" and "http-request silent-drop".
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006936
6937http-request track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6938http-request track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6939http-request track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6940
6941 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules do
6942 not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The number of counters
6943 that may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection is set in
6944 MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3,
Matteo Contrini1857b8c2020-10-16 17:35:54 +02006945 so the track-sc number is between 0 and (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). The first
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006946 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
6947 table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking
6948 of the counters of the specified table as the second set. The first
6949 "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
6950 table as the third set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of
6951 counters for the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend
6952 ones. But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
6953
6954 Arguments :
6955 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described in
6956 section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming request or
6957 connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined, and used to
6958 select which table entry to update the counters.
6959
6960 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one, which
6961 is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All the counters
6962 for the matches and updates for the key will then be performed in
6963 that table until the session ends.
6964
6965 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table and if
6966 it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to that entry
6967 is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's counters are updated
6968 as often as possible, every time the session's counters are updated, and also
6969 systematically when the session ends. Counters are only updated for events
6970 that happen after the tracking has been started. As an exception, connection
6971 counters and request counters are systematically updated so that they reflect
6972 useful information.
6973
6974 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is counted
6975 for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not expire during
6976 that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance advantage over just
6977 checking the keys, because only one table lookup is performed for all ACL
6978 checks that make use of it.
6979
6980http-request unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6981
6982 This is used to unset a variable. See above for details about <var-name>.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006983
6984 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006985 http-request unset-var(req.my_var)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006986
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +01006987http-request use-service <service-name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6988
6989 This directive executes the configured HTTP service to reply to the request
6990 and stops the evaluation of the rules. An HTTP service may choose to reply by
6991 sending any valid HTTP response or it may immediately close the connection
6992 without sending any response. Outside natives services, for instance the
6993 Prometheus exporter, it is possible to write your own services in Lua. No
6994 further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
6995
6996 Arguments :
6997 <service-name> is mandatory. It is the service to call
6998
6999 Example:
7000 http-request use-service prometheus-exporter if { path /metrics }
7001
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02007002http-request wait-for-body time <time> [ at-least <bytes> ]
7003 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7004
7005 This will delay the processing of the request waiting for the payload for at
7006 most <time> milliseconds. if "at-least" argument is specified, HAProxy stops
7007 to wait the payload when the first <bytes> bytes are received. 0 means no
7008 limit, it is the default value. Regardless the "at-least" argument value,
7009 HAProxy stops to wait if the whole payload is received or if the request
7010 buffer is full. This action may be used as a replacement to "option
7011 http-buffer-request".
7012
7013 Arguments :
7014
7015 <time> is mandatory. It is the maximum time to wait for the body. It
7016 follows the HAProxy time format and is expressed in milliseconds.
7017
7018 <bytes> is optional. It is the minimum payload size to receive to stop to
Ilya Shipitsinb2be9a12021-04-24 13:25:42 +05007019 wait. It follows the HAProxy size format and is expressed in
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02007020 bytes.
7021
7022 Example:
7023 http-request wait-for-body time 1s at-least 1k if METH_POST
7024
7025 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
7026
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007027http-request wait-for-handshake [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007028
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007029 This will delay the processing of the request until the SSL handshake
7030 happened. This is mostly useful to delay processing early data until we're
7031 sure they are valid.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007032
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01007033
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007034http-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007035 Access control for Layer 7 responses
7036
7037 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7038 no | yes | yes | yes
7039
7040 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
7041 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
7042 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
7043 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
7044 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
7045 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
7046
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007047 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
7048 below.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007049
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007050 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007051
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007052 Example:
7053 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02007054
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007055 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007056
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007057 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
7058 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007059
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007060 Example:
7061 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007062
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007063 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007064
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007065 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
7066 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007067
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007068 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
7069 ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007070
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007071http-response add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007072
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007073 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
7074 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
7075 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
7076 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
7077 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
7078 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
7079 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
7080 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007081
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007082http-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007083
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007084 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
7085 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
7086 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
7087 example, or to pass some internal information.
7088 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
7089 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
7090 the resulting header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007091
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007092http-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007093
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007094 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
7095 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the current section.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007096
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02007097http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007098
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02007099 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007100
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007101http-response capture <sample> id <id> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007102
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007103 This captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and
7104 converts it to a string. The resulting string is stored into the next request
7105 "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to some captured HTTP
7106 headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs, and it will be
7107 possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it into headers or
7108 anything. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and
7109 "capture response header" for more information.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02007110
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007111 The keyword "id" is the id of the capture slot which is used for storing the
7112 string. The capture slot must be defined in an associated frontend.
7113 This is useful to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a
7114 previous directive "http-response capture" or with the "declare capture"
7115 keyword.
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01007116
7117 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
7118 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
7119 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
7120 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02007121
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007122http-response del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02007123
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007124 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
7125 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
7126 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
7127 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
7128 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
7129 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02007130
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00007131http-response del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02007132
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00007133 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. <meth>
7134 is the matching method, applied on the header name. Supported matching methods
7135 are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix match), "end" (suffix match), "sub"
7136 (substring match) and "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
7137 method is used.
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02007138
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007139http-response del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02007140
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007141 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
7142 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
7143 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
7144 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
7145 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
7146 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007147
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007148http-response deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7149http-response deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
7150 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
7151 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
7152 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
7153 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007154
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007155 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the response.
7156 By default an HTTP 502 error is returned. But the response may be customized
7157 using same syntax than "http-response return" rules. Thus, see
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05007158 "http-response return" for details. For compatibility purpose, when no
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007159 argument is defined, or only "deny_status", the argument "default-errorfiles"
7160 is implied. It means "http-response deny [deny_status <status>]" is an alias
7161 of "http-response deny [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
Christopher Faulet040c8cd2020-01-13 16:43:45 +01007162 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007163 See also "http-response return".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007164
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007165http-response redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007166
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007167 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
7168 This supports a format string similarly to "http-request redirect" rules,
7169 with the exception that only the "location" type of redirect is possible on
7170 the response. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax. When a
7171 redirect rule is applied during a response, connections to the server are
7172 closed so that no data can be forwarded from the server to the client.
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02007173
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007174http-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
7175 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02007176
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01007177 This works like "http-request replace-header" except that it works on the
7178 server's response instead of the client's request.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01007179
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007180 Example:
7181 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02007182
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007183 # applied to:
7184 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007185
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007186 # outputs:
7187 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007188
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007189 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007190
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007191http-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
7192 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007193
Tim Duesterhus6bd909b2020-01-17 15:53:18 +01007194 This works like "http-request replace-value" except that it works on the
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01007195 server's response instead of the client's request.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007196
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007197 Example:
7198 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01007199
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007200 # applied to:
7201 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01007202
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007203 # outputs:
7204 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01007205
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007206http-response return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
7207 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
7208 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01007209 [ hdr <name> <value> ]*
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007210 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7211
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05007212 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately returns a response. The
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007213 default status code used for the response is 200. It can be optionally
7214 specified as an arguments to "status". The response content-type may also be
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04007215 specified as an argument to "content-type". Finally the response itself may
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007216 be defined. If can be a full HTTP response specifying the errorfile to use,
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05007217 or the response payload specifying the file or the string to use. These rules
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007218 are followed to create the response :
7219
7220 * If neither the errorfile nor the payload to use is defined, a dummy
7221 response is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It can be
7222 any code in the range [200, 599]. The "content-type" argument, if any, is
7223 ignored.
7224
7225 * If "default-errorfiles" argument is set, the proxy's errorfiles are
7226 considered. If the "status" argument is defined, it must be one of the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007227 status code handled by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01007228 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if
7229 any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007230
7231 * If a specific errorfile is defined, with an "errorfile" argument, the
7232 corresponding file, containing a full HTTP response, is returned. Only the
7233 "status" argument is considered. It must be one of the status code handled
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007234 by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01007235 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007236
7237 * If an http-errors section is defined, with an "errorfiles" argument, the
7238 corresponding file in the specified http-errors section, containing a full
7239 HTTP response, is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007240 must be one of the status code handled by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01007241 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type"
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02007242 argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007243
7244 * If a "file" or a "lf-file" argument is specified, the file's content is
7245 used as the response payload. If the file is not empty, its content-type
7246 must be set as argument to "content-type". Otherwise, any "content-type"
7247 argument is ignored. With a "lf-file" argument, the file's content is
7248 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "file" argument, it is considered
7249 as a raw content.
7250
7251 * If a "string" or "lf-string" argument is specified, the defined string is
7252 used as the response payload. The content-type must always be set as
7253 argument to "content-type". With a "lf-string" argument, the string is
7254 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "string" argument, it is
7255 considered as a raw string.
7256
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01007257 When the response is not based an errorfile, it is possible to appends HTTP
7258 header fields to the response using "hdr" arguments. Otherwise, all "hdr"
7259 arguments are ignored. For each one, the header name is specified in <name>
7260 and its value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules.
7261
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007262 Note that the generated response must be smaller than a buffer. And to avoid
7263 any warning, when an errorfile or a raw file is loaded, the buffer space
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05007264 reserved to the headers rewriting should also be free.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007265
7266 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
7267
7268 Example:
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04007269 http-response return errorfile /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/200.http \
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007270 if { status eq 404 }
7271
7272 http-response return content-type text/plain \
7273 string "This is the end !" \
7274 if { status eq 500 }
7275
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007276http-response sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7277http-response sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08007278
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007279 This action increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
7280 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
7281 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02007282
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01007283http-response sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
7284 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02007285
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01007286 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
7287 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
7288 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
7289 evaluation continues.
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01007290
Christopher Faulet68fc3a12021-08-12 09:32:07 +02007291http-response send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
7292 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02007293
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007294 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
7295 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
7296 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
7297 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
7298 agent name must be used.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02007299
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007300 Arguments:
7301 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02007302
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007303 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
7304 configuration.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02007305
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007306http-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007307
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007308 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
7309 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
7310 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007311
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007312http-response set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7313
7314 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
7315 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
7316 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
7317 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule can
7318 be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
7319
7320http-response set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
7321
7322 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
7323 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
7324 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
7325 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
7326 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry. It performs a
7327 lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
7328 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
7329 It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the stats socket, but can
7330 be triggered by an HTTP response.
7331
7332http-response set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7333
7334 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
7335 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
7336 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
7337 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed
7338 by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different
7339 route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on
7340 Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
7341
7342http-response set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7343
7344 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
7345 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
7346 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
7347 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
7348 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important
7349 than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
7350 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
7351 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
7352
7353http-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
7354 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7355
7356 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
7357 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
7358 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
7359 fallback.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007360
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007361 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007362 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
7363 http-response set-status 431
7364 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
7365 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007366
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007367http-response set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007368
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007369 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
7370 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
7371 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
7372 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that
7373 only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are
7374 always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers
7375 based on some information from the request.
7376
7377 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
7378
7379http-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7380
7381 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
7382 inline.
7383
7384 Arguments:
7385 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
7386 scope. The scopes allowed are:
7387 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
7388 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
7389 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
7390 (request and response)
7391 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
7392 processing
7393 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
7394 processing
7395 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
7396 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
7397 and '_'.
7398
7399 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
7400 followed by some converters.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007401
7402 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007403 http-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007404
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007405http-response silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007406
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007407 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
7408 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
7409 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
7410 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
7411 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
7412 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
7413 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
7414 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
7415 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
7416 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
7417 action.
7418 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
7419 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
7420 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
7421 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
7422 you fully understand how it works.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007423
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01007424http-response strict-mode { on | off }
7425
7426 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
7427 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
7428 performing a rewrite on the responses. When the strict mode is enabled, any
7429 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
7430 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05007431 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the response
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01007432 processing.
7433
Christopher Faulet1aea50e2020-01-17 16:03:53 +01007434 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01007435 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04007436 the backend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the frontend
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01007437 rules evaluation.
7438
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007439http-response track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7440http-response track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7441http-response track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007442
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007443 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current response. Please refer
7444 to "http-request track-sc" for a complete description. The only difference
7445 from "http-request track-sc" is the <key> sample expression can only make use
7446 of samples in response (e.g. res.*, status etc.) and samples below Layer 6
7447 (e.g. SSL-related samples, see section 7.3.4). If the sample is not
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007448 supported, HAProxy will fail and warn while parsing the config.
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007449
7450http-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7451
7452 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-response set-var" for details
7453 about <var-name>.
7454
7455 Example:
7456 http-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
7457
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02007458http-response wait-for-body time <time> [ at-least <bytes> ]
7459 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7460
7461 This will delay the processing of the response waiting for the payload for at
7462 most <time> milliseconds. if "at-least" argument is specified, HAProxy stops
7463 to wait the payload when the first <bytes> bytes are received. 0 means no
7464 limit, it is the default value. Regardless the "at-least" argument value,
7465 HAProxy stops to wait if the whole payload is received or if the response
7466 buffer is full.
7467
7468 Arguments :
7469
7470 <time> is mandatory. It is the maximum time to wait for the body. It
7471 follows the HAProxy time format and is expressed in milliseconds.
7472
7473 <bytes> is optional. It is the minimum payload size to receive to stop to
Ilya Shipitsinb2be9a12021-04-24 13:25:42 +05007474 wait. It follows the HAProxy size format and is expressed in
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02007475 bytes.
7476
7477 Example:
7478 http-response wait-for-body time 1s at-least 10k
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02007479
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007480http-reuse { never | safe | aggressive | always }
7481 Declare how idle HTTP connections may be shared between requests
7482
7483 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7484 yes | no | yes | yes
7485
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007486 By default, a connection established between HAProxy and the backend server
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01007487 which is considered safe for reuse is moved back to the server's idle
7488 connections pool so that any other request can make use of it. This is the
7489 "safe" strategy below.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007490
7491 The argument indicates the desired connection reuse strategy :
7492
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01007493 - "never" : idle connections are never shared between sessions. This mode
7494 may be enforced to cancel a different strategy inherited from
7495 a defaults section or for troubleshooting. For example, if an
7496 old bogus application considers that multiple requests over
7497 the same connection come from the same client and it is not
7498 possible to fix the application, it may be desirable to
7499 disable connection sharing in a single backend. An example of
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007500 such an application could be an old HAProxy using cookie
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01007501 insertion in tunnel mode and not checking any request past the
7502 first one.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007503
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01007504 - "safe" : this is the default and the recommended strategy. The first
7505 request of a session is always sent over its own connection,
7506 and only subsequent requests may be dispatched over other
7507 existing connections. This ensures that in case the server
7508 closes the connection when the request is being sent, the
7509 browser can decide to silently retry it. Since it is exactly
7510 equivalent to regular keep-alive, there should be no side
Amaury Denoyelle27179652020-10-14 18:17:12 +02007511 effects. There is also a special handling for the connections
7512 using protocols subject to Head-of-line blocking (backend with
7513 h2 or fcgi). In this case, when at least one stream is
7514 processed, the used connection is reserved to handle streams
7515 of the same session. When no more streams are processed, the
7516 connection is released and can be reused.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007517
7518 - "aggressive" : this mode may be useful in webservices environments where
7519 all servers are not necessarily known and where it would be
7520 appreciable to deliver most first requests over existing
7521 connections. In this case, first requests are only delivered
7522 over existing connections that have been reused at least once,
7523 proving that the server correctly supports connection reuse.
7524 It should only be used when it's sure that the client can
7525 retry a failed request once in a while and where the benefit
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02007526 of aggressive connection reuse significantly outweighs the
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007527 downsides of rare connection failures.
7528
7529 - "always" : this mode is only recommended when the path to the server is
7530 known for never breaking existing connections quickly after
7531 releasing them. It allows the first request of a session to be
7532 sent to an existing connection. This can provide a significant
7533 performance increase over the "safe" strategy when the backend
7534 is a cache farm, since such components tend to show a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007535 consistent behavior and will benefit from the connection
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007536 sharing. It is recommended that the "http-keep-alive" timeout
7537 remains low in this mode so that no dead connections remain
7538 usable. In most cases, this will lead to the same performance
7539 gains as "aggressive" but with more risks. It should only be
7540 used when it improves the situation over "aggressive".
7541
7542 When http connection sharing is enabled, a great care is taken to respect the
Amaury Denoyelled773a4e2021-01-29 15:18:49 +01007543 connection properties and compatibility. Indeed, some properties are specific
7544 and it is not possibly to reuse it blindly. Those are the SSL SNI, source
7545 and destination address and proxy protocol block. A connection is reused only
7546 if it shares the same set of properties with the request.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007547
Amaury Denoyelled773a4e2021-01-29 15:18:49 +01007548 Also note that connections with certain bogus authentication schemes (relying
7549 on the connection) like NTLM are marked private and never shared.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007550
Lukas Tribuse8adfeb2019-11-06 11:50:25 +01007551 A connection pool is involved and configurable with "pool-max-conn".
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007552
7553 Note: connection reuse improves the accuracy of the "server maxconn" setting,
7554 because almost no new connection will be established while idle connections
7555 remain available. This is particularly true with the "always" strategy.
7556
Willy Tarreauee9afa22022-11-25 09:17:18 +01007557 The rules to decide to keep an idle connection opened or to close it after
7558 processing are also governed by the "tune.pool-low-fd-ratio" (default: 20%)
7559 and "tune.pool-high-fd-ratio" (default: 25%). These correspond to the
7560 percentage of total file descriptors spent in idle connections above which
7561 haproxy will respectively refrain from keeping a connection opened after a
7562 response, and actively kill idle connections. Some setups using a very high
7563 ratio of idle connections, either because of too low a global "maxconn", or
7564 due to a lot of HTTP/2 or HTTP/3 traffic on the frontend (few connections)
7565 but HTTP/1 connections on the backend, may observe a lower reuse rate because
7566 too few connections are kept open. It may be desirable in this case to adjust
7567 such thresholds or simply to increase the global "maxconn" value.
7568
7569 Similarly, when thread groups are explicitly enabled, it is important to
7570 understand that idle connections are only usable between threads from a same
7571 group. As such it may happen that unfair load between groups leads to more
7572 idle connections being needed, causing a lower reuse rate. The same solution
7573 may then be applied (increase global "maxconn" or increase pool ratios).
7574
7575 See also : "option http-keep-alive", "server maxconn", "thread-groups",
7576 "tune.pool-high-fd-ratio", "tune.pool-low-fd-ratio"
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007577
7578
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007579http-send-name-header [<header>]
7580 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007581 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7582 yes | no | yes | yes
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007583 Arguments :
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007584 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
7585
Willy Tarreau81bef7e2019-10-07 14:58:02 +02007586 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the header field named <header>
7587 to be set to the name of the target server at the moment the request is about
7588 to be sent on the wire. Any existing occurrences of this header are removed.
7589 Upon retries and redispatches, the header field is updated to always reflect
7590 the server being attempted to connect to. Given that this header is modified
7591 very late in the connection setup, it may have unexpected effects on already
7592 modified headers. For example using it with transport-level header such as
7593 connection, content-length, transfer-encoding and so on will likely result in
7594 invalid requests being sent to the server. Additionally it has been reported
7595 that this directive is currently being used as a way to overwrite the Host
7596 header field in outgoing requests; while this trick has been known to work
7597 as a side effect of the feature for some time, it is not officially supported
7598 and might possibly not work anymore in a future version depending on the
7599 technical difficulties this feature induces. A long-term solution instead
7600 consists in fixing the application which required this trick so that it binds
7601 to the correct host name.
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007602
7603 See also : "server"
7604
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01007605id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02007606 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
7607 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7608 no | yes | yes | yes
7609 Arguments : none
7610
7611 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
7612 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
7613 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01007614
7615
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007616ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
7617 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
7618 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01007619 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007620
7621 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
7622 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
7623 and running).
7624
7625 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
7626 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
7627 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007628 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007629 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
7630
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007631 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
7632 "unless" condition is met.
7633
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03007634 Example:
7635 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
7636 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
7637 ignore-persist if url_static
7638
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007639 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
7640
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007641load-server-state-from-file { global | local | none }
7642 Allow seamless reload of HAProxy
7643 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7644 yes | no | yes | yes
7645
7646 This directive points HAProxy to a file where server state from previous
7647 running process has been saved. That way, when starting up, before handling
7648 traffic, the new process can apply old states to servers exactly has if no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007649 reload occurred. The purpose of the "load-server-state-from-file" directive is
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007650 to tell HAProxy which file to use. For now, only 2 arguments to either prevent
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007651 loading state or load states from a file containing all backends and servers.
7652 The state file can be generated by running the command "show servers state"
7653 over the stats socket and redirect output.
7654
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007655 The format of the file is versioned and is very specific. To understand it,
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007656 please read the documentation of the "show servers state" command (chapter
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02007657 9.3 of Management Guide).
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007658
7659 Arguments:
7660 global load the content of the file pointed by the global directive
7661 named "server-state-file".
7662
7663 local load the content of the file pointed by the directive
7664 "server-state-file-name" if set. If not set, then the backend
7665 name is used as a file name.
7666
7667 none don't load any stat for this backend
7668
7669 Notes:
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01007670 - server's IP address is preserved across reloads by default, but the
7671 order can be changed thanks to the server's "init-addr" setting. This
7672 means that an IP address change performed on the CLI at run time will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007673 be preserved, and that any change to the local resolver (e.g. /etc/hosts)
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01007674 will possibly not have any effect if the state file is in use.
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007675
7676 - server's weight is applied from previous running process unless it has
7677 has changed between previous and new configuration files.
7678
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007679 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007680
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007681 global
7682 stats socket /tmp/socket
7683 server-state-file /tmp/server_state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007684
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007685 defaults
7686 load-server-state-from-file global
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007687
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007688 backend bk
7689 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
7690 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007691
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007692
7693 Then one can run :
7694
7695 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state" > /tmp/server_state
7696
7697 Content of the file /tmp/server_state would be like this:
7698
7699 1
7700 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
7701 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7702 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7703
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007704 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007705
7706 global
7707 stats socket /tmp/socket
7708 server-state-base /etc/haproxy/states
7709
7710 defaults
7711 load-server-state-from-file local
7712
7713 backend bk
7714 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
7715 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
7716
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007717
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007718 Then one can run :
7719
7720 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state bk" > /etc/haproxy/states/bk
7721
7722 Content of the file /etc/haproxy/states/bk would be like this:
7723
7724 1
7725 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
7726 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7727 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7728
7729 See also: "server-state-file", "server-state-file-name", and
7730 "show servers state"
7731
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007732
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007733log global
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01007734log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02007735 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02007736no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007737 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
7738 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7739 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02007740
7741 Prefix :
7742 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
7743 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
7744 prefix does not allow arguments.
7745
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007746 Arguments :
7747 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
7748 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
7749 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
7750 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
7751 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
7752 parameter.
7753
7754 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
7755 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
7756
7757 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
7758 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
7759 standard syslog port).
7760
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01007761 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
7762 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
7763 standard syslog port).
7764
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007765 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
7766 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
7767 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007768 appropriately writable).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007769
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01007770 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may
7771 point to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered
7772 logs are used and one writev() call per log is performed. This
7773 is a bit expensive but acceptable for most workloads. Messages
7774 sent this way will not be truncated but may be dropped, in
7775 which case the DroppedLogs counter will be incremented. The
7776 writev() call is atomic even on pipes for messages up to
7777 PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least 512 and
7778 which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
7779 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other
7780 processes. Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file
7781 descriptor may also be directed to a file, but doing so will
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007782 significantly slow HAProxy down as non-blocking calls will be
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01007783 ignored. Also there will be no way to purge nor rotate this
7784 file without restarting the process. Note that the configured
7785 syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable for use
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007786 with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
7787 formats below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01007788
7789 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1"
7790 and "fd@2", see above.
7791
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02007792 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond
7793 to an in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the
7794 "show events" command, which will also list existing rings and
7795 their sizes. Such buffers are lost on reload or restart but
7796 when used as a complement this can help troubleshooting by
7797 having the logs instantly available.
7798
Emeric Brun94aab062021-04-02 10:41:36 +02007799 - An explicit stream address prefix such as "tcp@","tcp6@",
7800 "tcp4@" or "uxst@" will allocate an implicit ring buffer with
7801 a stream forward server targeting the given address.
7802
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01007803 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
7804 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01007805
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02007806 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
7807 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
7808 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
7809 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
7810 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
7811 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
7812 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
7813 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
7814 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
7815 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007816 long captures or JSON-formatted logs may require larger values.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02007817
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02007818 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
7819 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
7820 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
7821 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must
7822 be set with <sample_size> parameter.
7823
7824 <sample_size>
7825 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
7826 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
7827 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
7828 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
7829 (see also <ranges> parameter).
7830
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01007831 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
7832 one of the following :
7833
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01007834 local Analog to rfc3164 syslog message format except that hostname
7835 field is stripped. This is the default.
7836 Note: option "log-send-hostname" switches the default to
7837 rfc3164.
7838
7839 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format.
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01007840 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
7841
7842 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
7843 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
7844
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02007845 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between
7846 angle brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID,
7847 date, time, process name and system name are omitted. This is
7848 designed to be used with a local log server.
7849
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01007850 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
7851 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
7852 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
7853 local log server. This format is compatible with what the
7854 systemd logger consumes.
7855
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02007856 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
7857 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
7858 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
7859 used with a local log server.
7860
7861 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
7862 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
7863 designed to be used with a local log server.
7864
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007865 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
7866 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to
7867 be used in containers or during development, where the severity
7868 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
7869
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007870 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
7871
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01007872 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
7873 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
7874 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
7875
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007876 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
7877 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
7878 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
7879 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007880
7881 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
7882 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
7883 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02007884 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
7885 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
7886 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
7887 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
7888 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007889
7890 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
7891
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02007892 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
7893 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
7894 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007895
7896 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
7897 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
7898 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
7899 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
7900
7901 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
7902 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007903
7904 Example :
7905 log global
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007906 log stdout format short daemon # send log to systemd
7907 log stdout format raw daemon # send everything to stdout
7908 log stderr format raw daemon notice # send important events to stderr
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02007909 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
Emeric Brun94aab062021-04-02 10:41:36 +02007910 log tcp@127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output
7911 # level and send in tcp
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007912 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01007913
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007914
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01007915log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01007916 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
7917 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7918 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01007919
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01007920 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
7921 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
7922 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
7923 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
7924 string in depth.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01007925
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02007926 "log-format" directive overrides previous "option tcplog", "log-format" and
7927 "option httplog" directives.
7928
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02007929log-format-sd <string>
7930 Specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string
7931 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7932 yes | yes | yes | no
7933
7934 This directive specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string that
7935 will be used for all logs resulting from traffic passing through the frontend
7936 using this line. If the directive is used in a defaults section, all
7937 subsequent frontends will use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4
7938 which covers the log format string in depth.
7939
7940 See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3 for more information
7941 about the RFC5424 structured-data part.
7942
7943 Note : This log format string will be used only for loggers that have set
7944 log format to "rfc5424".
7945
7946 Example :
7947 log-format-sd [exampleSDID@1234\ bytes=\"%B\"\ status=\"%ST\"]
7948
7949
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01007950log-tag <string>
7951 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
7952 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7953 yes | yes | yes | yes
7954
7955 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
7956 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007957 from the command line, which usually is "HAProxy". Sometimes it can be useful
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01007958 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
7959 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
7960 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
7961 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
7962 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
7963 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007964
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02007965max-keep-alive-queue <value>
7966 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
7967 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7968 yes | no | yes | yes
7969
7970 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
7971 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
7972 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
7973 servers.
7974
7975 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007976 connections at which HAProxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02007977 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
7978 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
7979 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007980 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (e.g. local static server can
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02007981 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
7982 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
7983 picking a different server.
7984
7985 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
7986 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
7987 even if they have to be queued.
7988
7989 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
7990 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
7991
Olivier Houcharda4d4fdf2018-12-14 19:27:06 +01007992max-session-srv-conns <nb>
7993 Set the maximum number of outgoing connections we can keep idling for a given
7994 client session. The default is 5 (it precisely equals MAX_SRV_LIST which is
7995 defined at build time).
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02007996
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007997maxconn <conns>
7998 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
7999 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8000 yes | yes | yes | no
8001 Arguments :
8002 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
8003 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
8004 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
8005 closes.
8006
8007 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008008 very high so that HAProxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008009 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
8010 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
Baptiste Assmann79fb45d2016-03-06 23:34:31 +01008011 of tune.bufsize (16kB by default) each, as well as some other data resulting
8012 in about 33 kB of RAM being consumed per established connection. That means
8013 that a medium system equipped with 1GB of RAM can withstand around
8014 20000-25000 concurrent connections if properly tuned.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008015
8016 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
8017 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
8018 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
8019
Willy Tarreauc8d5b952019-02-27 17:25:52 +01008020 When this value is set to zero, which is the default, the global "maxconn"
8021 value is used.
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02008022
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008023 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
8024
8025
Willy Tarreau77e0dae2020-10-14 15:44:27 +02008026mode { tcp|http }
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008027 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
8028 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8029 yes | yes | yes | yes
8030 Arguments :
8031 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
8032 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
8033 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
8034 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
8035
8036 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
8037 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
8038 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
8039 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
8040 brings HAProxy most of its value.
8041
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008042 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
8043 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
8044 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008045
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008046 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008047 defaults http_instances
8048 mode http
8049
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008050
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01008051monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008052 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008053 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8054 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008055 Arguments :
8056 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
8057 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008058 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008059 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
8060 backend and its backup.
8061
8062 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
8063 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
8064 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
8065 servers in a list of backends.
8066
8067 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
8068 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
8069 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008070 conditions above is met, HAProxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008071 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
8072 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008073 HAProxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02008074 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
8075 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008076
8077 Example:
8078 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008079 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008080 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
8081 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
8082 monitor-uri /site_alive
8083 monitor fail if site_dead
8084
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02008085 See also : "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008086
8087
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008088monitor-uri <uri>
8089 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
8090 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8091 yes | yes | yes | no
8092 Arguments :
8093 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
8094 health status instead of forwarding the request.
8095
8096 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
8097 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
8098 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
8099 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
8100 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
8101 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
8102 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
8103 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
8104
Willy Tarreau721d8e02017-12-01 18:25:08 +01008105 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after the request is parsed
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02008106 and even before any "http-request". The only rulesets applied before are the
8107 tcp-request ones. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
Willy Tarreau28848542022-11-25 10:24:44 +01008108 purpose. Only one URI may be configured for monitoring; when multiple
8109 "monitor-uri" statements are present, the last one will define the URI to
8110 be used. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02008111 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
8112 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
8113 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008114
Christopher Faulet6072beb2020-02-18 15:34:58 +01008115 Note: if <uri> starts by a slash ('/'), the matching is performed against the
8116 request's path instead of the request's uri. It is a workaround to let
8117 the HTTP/2 requests match the monitor-uri. Indeed, in HTTP/2, clients
8118 are encouraged to send absolute URIs only.
8119
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008120 Example :
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008121 # Use /haproxy_test to report HAProxy's status
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008122 frontend www
8123 mode http
8124 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
8125
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02008126 See also : "monitor fail"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008127
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008128
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008129option abortonclose
8130no option abortonclose
8131 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
8132 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8133 yes | no | yes | yes
8134 Arguments : none
8135
8136 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
8137 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
8138 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
8139 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008140 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008141 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
8142 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
8143 encountered while delivering the response.
8144
8145 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
8146 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
8147 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
8148 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
8149 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
8150 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008151 support this behavior (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008152 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008153 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008154 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
8155 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
8156 still not served and not pollute the servers.
8157
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008158 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behavior using the option
8159 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behavior is HTTP
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008160 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
8161 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
8162 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
8163 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
8164 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
8165 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008166 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008167
8168 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8169 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8170
8171 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
8172
8173
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008174option accept-invalid-http-request
8175no option accept-invalid-http-request
8176 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
8177 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8178 yes | yes | yes | no
8179 Arguments : none
8180
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02008181 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008182 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008183 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008184 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
8185 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
8186 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
8187 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
8188 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01008189 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
8190 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
8191 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
8192 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008193 not allowed at all. HAProxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02008194 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
Willy Tarreau13317662015-05-01 13:47:08 +02008195 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version, it allows HTTP/0.9 requests
8196 to pass through (no version specified) and multiple digits for both the major
8197 and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008198
8199 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
8200 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
8201 been confirmed.
8202
8203 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
8204 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01008205 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
8206 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008207 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
8208
8209 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8210 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8211
8212 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
8213 stats socket.
8214
8215
8216option accept-invalid-http-response
8217no option accept-invalid-http-response
8218 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
8219 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8220 yes | no | yes | yes
8221 Arguments : none
8222
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02008223 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008224 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008225 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008226 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
8227 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
8228 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
8229 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
8230 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02008231 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
8232 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
8233 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008234
8235 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
8236 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
8237 been confirmed.
8238
8239 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
8240 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
8241 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
8242 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
8243
8244 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8245 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8246
8247 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
8248 stats socket.
8249
8250
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008251option allbackups
8252no option allbackups
8253 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
8254 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8255 yes | no | yes | yes
8256 Arguments : none
8257
8258 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
8259 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
8260 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
8261 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
8262 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
8263 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
8264 order between the backup servers anymore.
8265
8266 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
8267 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
8268
8269 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8270 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8271
8272
8273option checkcache
8274no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08008275 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008276 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8277 yes | no | yes | yes
8278 Arguments : none
8279
8280 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
8281 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008282 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008283 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
8284 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02008285 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008286
8287 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008288 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008289 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008290 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
8291 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008292 to the client are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008293 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header;
Willy Tarreauc55ddce2017-12-21 11:41:38 +01008294 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 204, 206, 300, 301,
8295 404, 405, 410, 414, 501, provided that the server has not set a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008296 "Cache-control: public" header field;
Willy Tarreau24ea0bc2017-12-21 11:32:55 +01008297 - all those that result from a request using a method other than GET, HEAD,
8298 OPTIONS, TRACE, provided that the server has not set a 'Cache-Control:
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008299 public' header field;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008300 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
8301 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
8302 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
8303 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
8304 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
8305 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
8306 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
8307 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
8308 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
8309
8310 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02008311 just as if it was from an "http-response deny" rule, with an "HTTP 502 bad
8312 gateway". The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the
8313 response during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in
8314 the logs so that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008315
8316 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
8317 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01008318 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008319 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviors.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008320
8321 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8322 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8323
8324
8325option clitcpka
8326no option clitcpka
8327 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
8328 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8329 yes | yes | yes | no
8330 Arguments : none
8331
8332 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
8333 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008334 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008335 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
8336
8337 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
8338 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
8339 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
8340 operating system and its tuning parameters.
8341
8342 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
8343 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
8344 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
8345 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
8346 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
8347
8348 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
8349
8350 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
8351 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
8352 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
8353
8354 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8355 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8356
8357 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
8358
8359
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008360option contstats
8361 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
8362 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8363 yes | yes | yes | no
8364 Arguments : none
8365
8366 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
8367 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
8368 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008369 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from HAProxy counters looks like
Willy Tarreaudef0d222016-11-08 22:03:00 +01008370 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented frequently
8371 along the session, typically every 5 seconds, which is often enough to
8372 produce clean graphs. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so it is not
8373 not enabled by default, as it can cause a lot of wakeups for very large
8374 session counts and cause a small performance drop.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008375
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02008376option disable-h2-upgrade
8377no option disable-h2-upgrade
8378 Enable or disable the implicit HTTP/2 upgrade from an HTTP/1.x client
8379 connection.
8380 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8381 yes | yes | yes | no
8382 Arguments : none
8383
8384 By default, HAProxy is able to implicitly upgrade an HTTP/1.x client
8385 connection to an HTTP/2 connection if the first request it receives from a
8386 given HTTP connection matches the HTTP/2 connection preface (i.e. the string
8387 "PRI * HTTP/2.0\r\n\r\nSM\r\n\r\n"). This way, it is possible to support
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +01008388 HTTP/1.x and HTTP/2 clients on a non-SSL connections. This option must be
8389 used to disable the implicit upgrade. Note this implicit upgrade is only
8390 supported for HTTP proxies, thus this option too. Note also it is possible to
8391 force the HTTP/2 on clear connections by specifying "proto h2" on the bind
8392 line. Finally, this option is applied on all bind lines. To disable implicit
8393 HTTP/2 upgrades for a specific bind line, it is possible to use "proto h1".
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02008394
8395 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8396 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008397
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008398option dontlog-normal
8399no option dontlog-normal
8400 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
8401 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8402 yes | yes | yes | no
8403 Arguments : none
8404
8405 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
8406 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
8407 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
8408 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
8409 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
8410 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
8411 logged.
8412
8413 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
8414 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
8415 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
8416
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008417 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008418 logging.
8419
8420
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008421option dontlognull
8422no option dontlognull
8423 Enable or disable logging of null connections
8424 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8425 yes | yes | yes | no
8426 Arguments : none
8427
8428 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
8429 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
8430 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
8431 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
8432 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
8433 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008434 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
8435 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
8436 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008437
8438 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008439 environments (e.g. internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008440 would not be logged.
8441
8442 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8443 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8444
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02008445 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-uri", and
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008446 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008447
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008448
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008449option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008450 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
8451 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8452 yes | yes | yes | yes
8453 Arguments :
8454 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
8455 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008456 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008457 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008458
8459 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
8460 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
8461 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
8462 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
8463 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
8464 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
8465 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008466 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
8467 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
8468 possible that the client has already brought one.
8469
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008470 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008471 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008472 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (e.g. stunnel),
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008473 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008474 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (e.g. Zeus Web Servers
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008475 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008476
8477 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
8478 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
8479 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
8480 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
8481 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
8482 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
Christopher Faulet5d1def62021-02-26 09:19:15 +01008483 private networks or 127.0.0.1. IPv4 and IPv6 are both supported.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008484
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008485 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
8486 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008487 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching HAProxy
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008488 are under the control of the end-user.
8489
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008490 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008491 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
8492 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008493 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
8494 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
8495 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008496
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02008497 Example :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008498 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
8499 frontend www
8500 mode http
8501 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
8502
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008503 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
8504 backend www
8505 mode http
8506 option forwardfor header X-Client
8507
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008508 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008509 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008510
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008511
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02008512option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
8513no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
8514 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus clients
8515 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8516 yes | yes | yes | no
8517 Arguments : none
8518
8519 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
8520 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
8521 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
8522 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
8523 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
8524 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
8525 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
8526
8527 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 response, its header names are converted to
8528 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the clients. If a client is
8529 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a response coming
8530 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
8531 different format when the response is formatted and sent to the client, by
8532 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
8533 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
8534 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the client to be
8535 fixed, because clients which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
8536 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
8537
8538 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant clients.
8539
8540 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8541 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8542
8543 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server", "h1-case-adjust",
8544 "h1-case-adjust-file".
8545
8546
8547option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
8548no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
8549 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus servers
8550 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8551 yes | no | yes | yes
8552 Arguments : none
8553
8554 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
8555 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
8556 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
8557 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
8558 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
8559 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
8560 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
8561
8562 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 request, its header names are converted to
8563 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the servers. If a server is
8564 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a request coming
8565 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
8566 different format when the request is formatted and sent to the server, by
8567 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
8568 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
8569 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the server to be
8570 fixed, because servers which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
8571 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
8572
8573 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant servers.
8574
8575 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8576 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8577
8578 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client", "h1-case-adjust",
8579 "h1-case-adjust-file".
8580
8581
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02008582option http-buffer-request
8583no option http-buffer-request
8584 Enable or disable waiting for whole HTTP request body before proceeding
8585 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8586 yes | yes | yes | yes
8587 Arguments : none
8588
8589 It is sometimes desirable to wait for the body of an HTTP request before
8590 taking a decision. This is what is being done by "balance url_param" for
8591 example. The first use case is to buffer requests from slow clients before
8592 connecting to the server. Another use case consists in taking the routing
8593 decision based on the request body's contents. This option placed in a
8594 frontend or backend forces the HTTP processing to wait until either the whole
Christopher Faulet6db8a2e2019-11-19 16:27:25 +01008595 body is received or the request buffer is full. It can have undesired side
8596 effects with some applications abusing HTTP by expecting unbuffered
8597 transmissions between the frontend and the backend, so this should definitely
8598 not be used by default.
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02008599
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02008600 See also : "option http-no-delay", "timeout http-request",
8601 "http-request wait-for-body"
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02008602
8603
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008604option http-ignore-probes
8605no option http-ignore-probes
8606 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
8607 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8608 yes | yes | yes | no
8609 Arguments : none
8610
8611 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
8612 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
8613 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
8614 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
8615 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
8616 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
8617 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
8618 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
8619 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008620 was received over a connection before it was closed;
8621 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation;
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008622 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
8623
8624 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
8625 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
8626 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
8627 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
8628 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
8629 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
8630 are often the only way to detect them.
8631
8632 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8633 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8634
8635 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
8636
8637
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008638option http-keep-alive
8639no option http-keep-alive
Christopher Faulet84145a72023-02-20 17:09:34 +01008640 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server for HTTP/1.x
8641 connections
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008642 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8643 yes | yes | yes | yes
8644 Arguments : none
8645
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008646 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
Christopher Faulet84145a72023-02-20 17:09:34 +01008647 HTTP/1.x connections: for each connection it processes each request and
8648 response, and leaves the connection idle on both sides. This mode may be
8649 changed by several options such as "option http-server-close" or "option
8650 httpclose". This option allows to set back the keep-alive mode, which can be
8651 useful when another mode was used in a defaults section.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008652
8653 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
8654 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008655 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
8656 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
8657 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
8658 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
8659 situations where this option may be useful :
8660
8661 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008662 instead of requests (e.g. NTLM authentication)
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008663
8664 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
8665 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
8666
8667 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008668
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008669 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
8670 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
8671 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
8672 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
8673 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
8674 not set.
8675
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008676 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
Christopher Faulet84145a72023-02-20 17:09:34 +01008677 http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008678
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008679 See also : "option httpclose",, "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet84145a72023-02-20 17:09:34 +01008680 "option prefer-last-server" and "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008681
8682
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02008683option http-no-delay
8684no option http-no-delay
8685 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
8686 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8687 yes | yes | yes | yes
8688 Arguments : none
8689
8690 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
8691 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
8692 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
8693 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
8694 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
8695 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
8696 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008697 HAProxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02008698 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
8699 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
8700 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
8701 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
8702 affected.
8703
8704 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
8705 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
8706 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
8707 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
8708 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
8709 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
8710 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
8711 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
8712 latency environments.
8713
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02008714 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
8715
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02008716
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008717option http-pretend-keepalive
8718no option http-pretend-keepalive
Christopher Faulet84145a72023-02-20 17:09:34 +01008719 Define whether HAProxy will announce keepalive for HTTP/1.x connection to the
8720 server or not
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008721 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02008722 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008723 Arguments : none
8724
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008725 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose", HAProxy
Christopher Faulet84145a72023-02-20 17:09:34 +01008726 adds a "Connection: close" header to the HTTP/1.x request forwarded to the
8727 server. Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically
8728 refrain from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length,
8729 while this is totally unrelated. The effect is that a client or a cache could
8730 receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and consider the
8731 response complete.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008732
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008733 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", HAProxy will make the server
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008734 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008735 to the abnormal undesired above. When HAProxy gets the whole response, it
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008736 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008737 "option httpclose". That way the client gets a normal response and the
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008738 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
8739
8740 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
8741 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
8742 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
8743 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008744 worth noting that when this option is enabled, HAProxy will have slightly
8745 less work to do. So if HAProxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008746 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
8747
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02008748 This option may be set in backend and listen sections. Using it in a frontend
8749 section will be ignored and a warning will be reported during startup. It is
8750 a backend related option, so there is no real reason to set it on a
Christopher Faulet84145a72023-02-20 17:09:34 +01008751 frontend.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008752
8753 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8754 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8755
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008756 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close", and
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008757 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008758
Christopher Faulet79507152022-05-16 11:43:10 +02008759option http-restrict-req-hdr-names { preserve | delete | reject }
8760 Set HAProxy policy about HTTP request header names containing characters
8761 outside the "[a-zA-Z0-9-]" charset
8762 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8763 yes | yes | yes | yes
8764 Arguments :
8765 preserve disable the filtering. It is the default mode for HTTP proxies
8766 with no FastCGI application configured.
8767
8768 delete remove request headers with a name containing a character
8769 outside the "[a-zA-Z0-9-]" charset. It is the default mode for
8770 HTTP backends with a configured FastCGI application.
8771
8772 reject reject the request with a 403-Forbidden response if it contains a
8773 header name with a character outside the "[a-zA-Z0-9-]" charset.
8774
8775 This option may be used to restrict the request header names to alphanumeric
8776 and hyphen characters ([A-Za-z0-9-]). This may be mandatory to interoperate
8777 with non-HTTP compliant servers that fail to handle some characters in header
8778 names. It may also be mandatory for FastCGI applications because all
8779 non-alphanumeric characters in header names are replaced by an underscore
8780 ('_'). Thus, it is easily possible to mix up header names and bypass some
8781 rules. For instance, "X-Forwarded-For" and "X_Forwarded-For" headers are both
8782 converted to "HTTP_X_FORWARDED_FOR" in FastCGI.
8783
8784 Note this option is evaluated per proxy and after the http-request rules
8785 evaluation.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008786
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008787option http-server-close
8788no option http-server-close
Christopher Faulet84145a72023-02-20 17:09:34 +01008789 Enable or disable HTTP/1.x connection closing on the server side
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008790 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8791 yes | yes | yes | yes
8792 Arguments : none
8793
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008794 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
Christopher Faulet84145a72023-02-20 17:09:34 +01008795 HTTP/1.x connections: for each connection it processes each request and
8796 response, and leaves the connection idle on both sides. This mode may be
8797 changed by several options such as "option http-server-close" or "option
8798 httpclose". Setting "option http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close
8799 mode on the server side while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive
8800 and pipelining on the client side. This provides the lowest latency on the
8801 client side (slow network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side
8802 to save server resources, similarly to "option httpclose". It also permits
8803 non-keepalive capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients
8804 if they conform to the requirements of RFC7230. Please note that some servers
8805 do not always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close"
8806 in the request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A
8807 workaround consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008808
8809 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
8810 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
8811 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
8812 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01008813 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
8814 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008815
8816 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
8817 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008818 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
8819 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
8820 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008821
8822 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8823 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8824
Christopher Faulet84145a72023-02-20 17:09:34 +01008825 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive" and
8826 "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008827
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008828option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01008829no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008830 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
8831 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8832 yes | yes | yes | no
8833 Arguments : none
8834
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00008835 While RFC7230 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008836 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
8837 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
8838 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
8839 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
8840 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008841 HAProxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008842
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008843 By setting this option in a frontend, HAProxy can automatically switch to use
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008844 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01008845 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. This
8846 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode. Note that this option can only be
8847 specified in a frontend and will affect the request along its whole life.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008848
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01008849 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
8850 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
8851 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
8852 front of an existing proxy.
8853
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008854 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
8855
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008856 See also : "option httpclose", and "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008857
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008858option httpchk
8859option httpchk <uri>
8860option httpchk <method> <uri>
8861option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02008862 Enables HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008863 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8864 yes | no | yes | yes
8865 Arguments :
8866 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
8867 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
8868 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
8869 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
8870 ones.
8871
8872 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
8873 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
8874 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
8875
8876 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
8877 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
8878 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02008879 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, use "http-check send" directive to add it.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008880
8881 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
8882 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
8883 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
8884 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
8885 the lack of any response.
8886
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02008887 Combined with "http-check" directives, it is possible to customize the
8888 request sent during the HTTP health checks or the matching rules on the
8889 response. It is also possible to configure a send/expect sequence, just like
8890 with the directive "tcp-check" for TCP health checks.
8891
8892 The server configuration is used by default to open connections to perform
8893 HTTP health checks. By it is also possible to overwrite server parameters
8894 using "http-check connect" rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008895
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02008896 "httpchk" option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works
8897 with plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts
Christopher Faulet14cd3162020-04-16 14:50:06 +02008898 bound to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon. However, it will always
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04008899 internally relies on an HTX multiplexer. Thus, it means the request
Christopher Faulet14cd3162020-04-16 14:50:06 +02008900 formatting and the response parsing will be strict.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008901
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02008902 Note : For a while, there was no way to add headers or body in the request
8903 used for HTTP health checks. So a workaround was to hide it at the end
8904 of the version string with a "\r\n" after the version. It is now
8905 deprecated. The directive "http-check send" must be used instead.
8906
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008907 Examples :
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02008908 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
8909 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
8910 backend https_relay
8911 mode tcp
8912 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1
8913 http-check send hdr Host www
8914 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008915
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09008916 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
8917 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
8918 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008919
8920
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008921option httpclose
8922no option httpclose
Christopher Faulet84145a72023-02-20 17:09:34 +01008923 Enable or disable HTTP/1.x connection closing
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008924 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8925 yes | yes | yes | yes
8926 Arguments : none
8927
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008928 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
Christopher Faulet84145a72023-02-20 17:09:34 +01008929 HTTP/1.x connections: for each connection it processes each request and
8930 response, and leaves the connection idle on both sides. This mode may be
8931 changed by several options such as "option http-server-close" or "option
8932 httpclose".
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008933
Christopher Faulet84145a72023-02-20 17:09:34 +01008934 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will close the client or the server
8935 connection, depending where the option is set. Only the frontend is
8936 considered for client connections while the frontend and the backend are
8937 considered for server ones. In this case the option is enabled if at least
8938 one of the frontend or backend holding the connection has it enabled. If the
8939 option is set on a listener, it is applied both on client and server
8940 connections. It will check if a "Connection: close" header is already set in
8941 each direction, and will add one if missing.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008942
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008943 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
Christopher Faulet84145a72023-02-20 17:09:34 +01008944 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" request header, but will
8945 still cause the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008946
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008947 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close" or "option
Christopher Faulet84145a72023-02-20 17:09:34 +01008948 http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008949
8950 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8951 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8952
Christopher Faulet84145a72023-02-20 17:09:34 +01008953 See also : "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008954
8955
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008956option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008957 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
8958 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01008959 yes | yes | yes | no
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008960 Arguments :
8961 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
8962 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
8963 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008964 log analyzer which only support the CLF format and which is not
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008965 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008966
8967 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
8968 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
8969 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
8970 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
8971 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
8972 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
8973 ports.
8974
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01008975 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
8976 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008977
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02008978 "option httplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
8979
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008980 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008981
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008982
8983option http_proxy
8984no option http_proxy
8985 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
8986 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8987 yes | yes | yes | yes
8988 Arguments : none
8989
8990 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
8991 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
8992 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
8993 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
8994 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
8995
8996 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
8997 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01008998 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. This
8999 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009000
9001 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9002 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9003
9004 Example :
9005 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
9006 backend direct_forward
9007 option httpclose
9008 option http_proxy
9009
9010 See also : "option httpclose"
9011
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02009012
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009013option independent-streams
9014no option independent-streams
9015 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02009016 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9017 yes | yes | yes | yes
9018 Arguments : none
9019
9020 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
9021 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
9022 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
9023 receive data or not.
9024
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009025 While this default behavior is desirable for almost all applications, there
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02009026 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
9027 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
9028 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
9029 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
9030 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
9031 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
9032 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
9033 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
9034 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
9035 socket buffers.
9036
9037 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
9038 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
9039 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
9040 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
9041 slow lines, so use it with caution.
9042
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009043 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02009044
9045
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02009046option ldap-check
9047 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
9048 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9049 yes | no | yes | yes
9050 Arguments : none
9051
9052 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
9053 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
9054 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
9055 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
9056
9057 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
9058 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
9059
9060 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
9061 configure it.
9062
9063 Example :
9064 option ldap-check
9065
9066 See also : "option httpchk"
9067
9068
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009069option external-check
9070 Use external processes for server health checks
9071 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9072 yes | no | yes | yes
9073
9074 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
9075 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
9076 command".
9077
9078 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
9079
9080 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
9081
9082
William Dauchy4711a892022-01-05 22:53:24 +01009083option idle-close-on-response
9084no option idle-close-on-response
9085 Avoid closing idle frontend connections if a soft stop is in progress
9086 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9087 yes | yes | yes | no
9088 Arguments : none
9089
9090 By default, idle connections will be closed during a soft stop. In some
9091 environments, a client talking to the proxy may have prepared some idle
9092 connections in order to send requests later. If there is no proper retry on
9093 write errors, this can result in errors while haproxy is reloading. Even
9094 though a proper implementation should retry on connection/write errors, this
9095 option was introduced to support backwards compatibility with haproxy prior
9096 to version 2.4. Indeed before v2.4, haproxy used to wait for a last request
9097 and response to add a "connection: close" header before closing, thus
9098 notifying the client that the connection would not be reusable.
9099
9100 In a real life example, this behavior was seen in AWS using the ALB in front
9101 of a haproxy. The end result was ALB sending 502 during haproxy reloads.
9102
9103 Users are warned that using this option may increase the number of old
9104 processes if connections remain idle for too long. Adjusting the client
9105 timeouts and/or the "hard-stop-after" parameter accordingly might be
9106 needed in case of frequent reloads.
9107
9108 See also: "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout http-request",
9109 "hard-stop-after"
9110
9111
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02009112option log-health-checks
9113no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02009114 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02009115 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9116 yes | no | yes | yes
9117 Arguments : none
9118
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02009119 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
9120 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
9121 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02009122
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02009123 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
9124 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
9125 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
9126 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
9127 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
9128
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009129 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (e.g. enable/disable on
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02009130 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02009131
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02009132 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
9133 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
9134 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02009135
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02009136
9137option log-separate-errors
9138no option log-separate-errors
9139 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
9140 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9141 yes | yes | yes | no
9142 Arguments : none
9143
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009144 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes HAProxy
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02009145 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
9146 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
9147 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
9148 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
9149 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
9150 provides very important information.
9151
9152 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
9153 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
9154 error logs.
9155
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009156 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02009157 logging.
9158
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009159
9160option logasap
9161no option logasap
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02009162 Enable or disable early logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009163 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9164 yes | yes | yes | no
9165 Arguments : none
9166
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02009167 By default, logs are emitted when all the log format variables and sample
9168 fetches used in the definition of the log-format string return a value, or
9169 when the session is terminated. This allows the built in log-format strings
9170 to account for the transfer time, or the number of bytes in log messages.
9171
9172 When handling long lived connections such as large file transfers or RDP,
9173 it may take a while for the request or connection to appear in the logs.
9174 Using "option logasap", the log message is created as soon as the server
9175 connection is established in mode tcp, or as soon as the server sends the
9176 complete headers in mode http. Missing information in the logs will be the
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +05009177 total number of bytes which will only indicate the amount of data transferred
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02009178 before the message was created and the total time which will not take the
9179 remainder of the connection life or transfer time into account. For the case
9180 of HTTP, it is good practice to capture the Content-Length response header
9181 so that the logs at least indicate how many bytes are expected to be
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +05009182 transferred.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009183
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009184 Examples :
9185 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
9186 mode http
9187 option httplog
9188 option logasap
9189 log 192.168.2.200 local3
9190
9191 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
9192 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
9193 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
9194 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
9195
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009196 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009197 logging.
9198
9199
Christopher Faulet62f79fe2020-05-18 18:13:03 +02009200option mysql-check [ user <username> [ { post-41 | pre-41 } ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009201 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01009202 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9203 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009204 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009205 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
9206 server.
Christopher Faulet62f79fe2020-05-18 18:13:03 +02009207 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks (the default)
9208 pre-41 Send pre v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009209
9210 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
9211 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009212 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialization packet and/or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009213 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
Daniel Black9dc310d2021-07-01 12:09:32 +10009214 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires an unlocked authorised
9215 user without a password. To create a basic limited user in MySQL with
9216 optional resource limits:
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009217
Daniel Black9dc310d2021-07-01 12:09:32 +10009218 CREATE USER '<username>'@'<ip_of_haproxy|network_of_haproxy/netmask>'
9219 /*!50701 WITH MAX_QUERIES_PER_HOUR 1 MAX_UPDATES_PER_HOUR 0 */
9220 /*M!100201 MAX_STATEMENT_TIME 0.0001 */;
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009221
9222 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009223 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialization packet or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009224 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
9225 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
9226 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
9227 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
9228 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
9229 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
9230 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
9231
9232 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
9233 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01009234
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02009235 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01009236
9237 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
9238 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
9239 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
9240 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02009241 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009242 server to route the client via the machine hosting HAProxy.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01009243
9244 See also: "option httpchk"
9245
9246
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009247option nolinger
9248no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009249 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009250 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9251 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009252 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009253
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009254 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (e.g. they are
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009255 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
9256 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
9257 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
9258 connections.
9259
9260 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
9261 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009262 a TCP RST is emitted, any pending data are truncated, and the session is
9263 instantly purged from the system's tables. The generally visible effect for
9264 a client is that responses are truncated if the close happens with a last
9265 block of data (e.g. on a redirect or error response). On the server side,
9266 it may help release the source ports immediately when forwarding a client
9267 aborts in tunnels. In both cases, TCP resets are emitted and given that
9268 the session is instantly destroyed, there will be no retransmit. On a lossy
9269 network this can increase problems, especially when there is a firewall on
9270 the lossy side, because the firewall might see and process the reset (hence
9271 purge its session) and block any further traffic for this session,, including
9272 retransmits from the other side. So if the other side doesn't receive it,
9273 it will never receive any RST again, and the firewall might log many blocked
9274 packets.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009275
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009276 For all these reasons, it is strongly recommended NOT to use this option,
9277 unless absolutely needed as a last resort. In most situations, using the
9278 "client-fin" or "server-fin" timeouts achieves similar results with a more
9279 reliable behavior. On Linux it's also possible to use the "tcp-ut" bind or
9280 server setting.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009281
9282 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
9283 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009284 for servers. While this option is technically supported in "defaults"
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +05009285 sections, it must really not be used there as it risks to accidentally
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009286 propagate to sections that must no use it and to cause problems there.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009287
9288 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9289 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9290
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009291 See also: "timeout client-fin", "timeout server-fin", "tcp-ut" bind or server
9292 keywords.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009293
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009294option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
9295 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
9296 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9297 yes | yes | yes | yes
9298 Arguments :
9299 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
9300 matching <network>
9301 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
9302 header name.
9303
9304 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
9305 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
9306 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
9307 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
9308 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
9309 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
9310 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
9311 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
9312 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
9313 possible that the client has already brought one.
9314
9315 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
9316 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
9317 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
9318 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
9319 header and requires different one.
9320
9321 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
9322 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
9323 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
Amaury Denoyellef8b42922021-03-04 18:41:14 +01009324 header for a known destination address or network by adding the "except"
9325 keyword followed by the network address. In this case, any destination IP
9326 matching the network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common
9327 uses are with private networks or 127.0.0.1. IPv4 and IPv6 are both
9328 supported.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009329
9330 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
9331 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
9332 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
9333 both are defined.
9334
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009335 Examples :
9336 # Original Destination address
9337 frontend www
9338 mode http
9339 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
9340
9341 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
9342 backend www
9343 mode http
9344 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
9345
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02009346 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009347
9348
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009349option persist
9350no option persist
9351 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
9352 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9353 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009354 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009355
9356 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
9357 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
9358 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
9359 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
9360 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
9361 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
9362 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
9363 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
9364 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
9365 redirected to another valid server.
9366
9367 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9368 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9369
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01009370 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009371
9372
Christopher Faulet36136e52022-10-03 15:00:59 +02009373option pgsql-check user <username>
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01009374 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
9375 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9376 yes | no | yes | yes
9377 Arguments :
9378 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
9379 PostgreSQL server.
9380
9381 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
9382 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
9383 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
9384 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
9385
9386 See also: "option httpchk"
9387
9388
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01009389option prefer-last-server
9390no option prefer-last-server
9391 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
9392 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9393 yes | no | yes | yes
9394 Arguments : none
9395
9396 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009397 request was sent to a server to which HAProxy still holds a connection, it is
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01009398 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
9399 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009400 we only indicate a preference which HAProxy tries to apply without any form
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01009401 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009402 this option is used, HAProxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01009403 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
9404 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01009405 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009406 HAProxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02009407 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required), when the load
9408 balancing algorithm is not deterministic. This is mandatory for use with the
9409 broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01009410 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
9411 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
9412 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01009413
9414 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9415 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9416
9417 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
9418
9419
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009420option redispatch
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009421option redispatch <interval>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009422no option redispatch
9423 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
9424 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9425 yes | no | yes | yes
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009426 Arguments :
9427 <interval> The optional integer value that controls how often redispatches
9428 occur when retrying connections. Positive value P indicates a
9429 redispatch is desired on every Pth retry, and negative value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009430 N indicate a redispatch is desired on the Nth retry prior to the
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009431 last retry. For example, the default of -1 preserves the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009432 historical behavior of redispatching on the last retry, a
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009433 positive value of 1 would indicate a redispatch on every retry,
9434 and a positive value of 3 would indicate a redispatch on every
9435 third retry. You can disable redispatches with a value of 0.
9436
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009437
9438 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
9439 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
9440 be able to access the service anymore.
9441
Willy Tarreau59884a62019-01-02 14:48:31 +01009442 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break cookie or
9443 consistent hash based persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009444
Olivier Carrère6e6f59b2020-04-15 11:30:18 +02009445 Active servers are selected from a subset of the list of available
9446 servers. Active servers that are not down or in maintenance (i.e., whose
9447 health is not checked or that have been checked as "up"), are selected in the
9448 following order:
9449
9450 1. Any active, non-backup server, if any, or,
9451
9452 2. If the "allbackups" option is not set, the first backup server in the
9453 list, or
9454
9455 3. If the "allbackups" option is set, any backup server.
9456
9457 When a retry occurs, HAProxy tries to select another server than the last
9458 one. The new server is selected from the current list of servers.
9459
9460 Sometimes, if the list is updated between retries (e.g., if numerous retries
9461 occur and last longer than the time needed to check that a server is down,
9462 remove it from the list and fall back on the list of backup servers),
9463 connections may be redirected to a backup server, though.
9464
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009465 It also allows to retry connections to another server in case of multiple
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009466 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
9467 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009468
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009469 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9470 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9471
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02009472 See also : "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009473
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009474
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02009475option redis-check
9476 Use redis health checks for server testing
9477 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9478 yes | no | yes | yes
9479 Arguments : none
9480
9481 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
9482 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
9483 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
9484 find the "+PONG" response message.
9485
9486 Example :
9487 option redis-check
9488
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009489 See also : "option httpchk", "option tcp-check", "tcp-check expect"
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02009490
9491
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009492option smtpchk
9493option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
9494 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
9495 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9496 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009497 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009498 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02009499 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESMTP). All other
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009500 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
9501
9502 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
9503 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
9504 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
9505
9506 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
9507 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
9508 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
9509 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
9510 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
9511 dead server.
9512
9513 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
9514 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009515 so you may want to experiment to improve the behavior. Using telnet on port
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009516 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
9517
9518 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
9519 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
9520 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
9521 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02009522 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009523
9524 Example :
9525 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
9526
9527 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
9528
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009529
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02009530option socket-stats
9531no option socket-stats
9532
9533 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
9534 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9535 yes | yes | yes | no
9536
9537 Arguments : none
9538
9539
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009540option splice-auto
9541no option splice-auto
9542 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
9543 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9544 yes | yes | yes | yes
9545 Arguments : none
9546
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009547 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, HAProxy
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009548 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009549 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. HAProxy
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009550 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009551 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009552 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
9553 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
9554 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
9555 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
9556
9557 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
9558 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
9559 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
9560 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
9561 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
9562 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
9563 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
9564 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
9565 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
9566 keyword.
9567
9568 Example :
9569 option splice-auto
9570
9571 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9572 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9573
9574 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
9575 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
9576
9577
9578option splice-request
9579no option splice-request
9580 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
9581 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9582 yes | yes | yes | yes
9583 Arguments : none
9584
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009585 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, HAProxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009586 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009587 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
9588 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
9589 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
9590 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
9591
9592 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
9593
9594 Example :
9595 option splice-request
9596
9597 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9598 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9599
9600 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
9601 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
9602
9603
9604option splice-response
9605no option splice-response
9606 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
9607 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9608 yes | yes | yes | yes
9609 Arguments : none
9610
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009611 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, HAProxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009612 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009613 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
9614 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
9615 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
9616 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
9617
9618 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
9619
9620 Example :
9621 option splice-response
9622
9623 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9624 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9625
9626 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
9627 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
9628
9629
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01009630option spop-check
9631 Use SPOP health checks for server testing
9632 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Aurelien DARRAGON54832622023-01-12 15:06:11 +01009633 yes | no | yes | yes
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01009634 Arguments : none
9635
9636 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks SPOP protocol instead
9637 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
9638 a HELLO handshake is performed between HAProxy and the server, and the
9639 response is analyzed to check no error is reported.
9640
9641 Example :
9642 option spop-check
9643
9644 See also : "option httpchk"
9645
9646
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009647option srvtcpka
9648no option srvtcpka
9649 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
9650 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9651 yes | no | yes | yes
9652 Arguments : none
9653
9654 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
9655 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009656 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009657 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
9658
9659 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
9660 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
9661 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
9662 operating system and its tuning parameters.
9663
9664 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
9665 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
9666 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
9667 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
9668 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
9669
9670 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
9671
9672 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
9673 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
9674 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
9675
9676 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9677 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9678
9679 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
9680
9681
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009682option ssl-hello-chk
9683 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
9684 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9685 yes | no | yes | yes
9686 Arguments : none
9687
9688 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
9689 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
9690 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
9691 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
9692 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
9693 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
9694 hello message.
9695
9696 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
9697 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
9698 messages, which is appreciable.
9699
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009700 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into HAProxy
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009701 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
9702 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009703
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009704 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
9705
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009706
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009707option tcp-check
9708 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
9709 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9710 yes | no | yes | yes
9711
9712 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
9713 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
9714
9715 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
9716 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
9717 attempt, which remains the default mode.
9718
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009719 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009720 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
9721 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
9722 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
9723 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
9724 only.
9725
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009726 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009727 The connection is opened and HAProxy waits for the server to present some
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009728 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
9729 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
9730 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
9731
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009732 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009733 used to test a hello-type protocol. HAProxy sends a message, the server
9734 responds and its response is analyzed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009735 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009736 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
9737 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
9738 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
9739 the respective protocols.
9740 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009741 analyzed.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009742
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009743 A fifth mode can be used to insert comments in different steps of the script.
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009744
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009745 For each tcp-check rule you create, you can add a "comment" directive,
9746 followed by a string. This string will be reported in the log and stderr in
9747 debug mode. It is useful to make user-friendly error reporting. The
9748 "comment" is of course optional.
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009749
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009750 During the execution of a health check, a variable scope is made available to
9751 store data samples, using the "tcp-check set-var" operation. Freeing those
9752 variable is possible using "tcp-check unset-var".
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +01009753
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009754
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009755 Examples :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009756 # perform a POP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009757 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009758 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready comment POP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009759
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009760 # perform an IMAP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009761 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009762 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready comment IMAP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009763
9764 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
9765 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009766 # (send a command then analyze the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009767 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009768 tcp-check comment PING\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009769 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02009770 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009771 tcp-check comment role\ check
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009772 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
9773 tcp-check expect string role:master
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009774 tcp-check comment QUIT\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009775 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
9776 tcp-check expect string +OK
9777
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009778 forge a HTTP request, then analyze the response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009779 (send many headers before analyzing)
9780 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009781 tcp-check comment forge\ and\ send\ HTTP\ request
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009782 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
9783 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
9784 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
9785 tcp-check send \r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009786 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..) comment check\ HTTP\ response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009787
9788
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009789 See also : "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect" and "tcp-check send".
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009790
9791
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02009792option tcp-smart-accept
9793no option tcp-smart-accept
9794 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
9795 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9796 yes | yes | yes | no
9797 Arguments : none
9798
9799 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
9800 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
9801 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
9802 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
9803 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
9804 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
9805
9806 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
9807 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
9808 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
9809 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
9810
9811 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
9812 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
9813 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009814 fall back to normal behavior by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02009815
9816 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
9817 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
9818 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
9819
9820 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
9821 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
9822 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
9823
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02009824 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
9825
9826
9827option tcp-smart-connect
9828no option tcp-smart-connect
9829 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
9830 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9831 yes | no | yes | yes
9832 Arguments : none
9833
9834 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
9835 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
9836 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
9837 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
9838 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
9839
9840 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
9841 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
9842 complex.
9843
9844 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
9845 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
9846 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
9847
9848 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9849 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9850
9851 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
9852
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02009853
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009854option tcpka
9855 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
9856 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9857 yes | yes | yes | yes
9858 Arguments : none
9859
9860 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
9861 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009862 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009863 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
9864
9865 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
9866 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
9867 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
9868 operating system and its tuning parameters.
9869
9870 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
9871 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
9872 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
9873 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
9874 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
9875
9876 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
9877
9878 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
9879 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
9880 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
9881 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
9882 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
9883 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
9884 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
9885 backends.
9886
9887 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
9888
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009889
9890option tcplog
9891 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
9892 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01009893 yes | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009894 Arguments : none
9895
9896 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
9897 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
9898 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
9899 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
9900 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
9901 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
9902 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
9903 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
9904
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02009905 "option tcplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
9906
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009907 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009908
9909
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009910option transparent
9911no option transparent
9912 Enable client-side transparent proxying
9913 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01009914 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009915 Arguments : none
9916
9917 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
9918 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
9919 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
9920 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
9921 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
9922 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
9923 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
9924 appropriate server.
9925
9926 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
9927 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
9928
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01009929 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009930 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009931
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009932
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009933external-check command <command>
9934 Executable to run when performing an external-check
9935 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9936 yes | no | yes | yes
9937
9938 Arguments :
9939 <command> is the external command to run
9940
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009941 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
9942
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01009943 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009944
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01009945 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
9946 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
9947 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
9948 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
9949 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
9950 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009951
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +01009952 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
9953
9954 Environment variables :
9955 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
9956 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
9957
9958 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
9959
9960 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
9961
9962 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
9963 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
9964 for a UNIX socket).
9965
9966 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
9967
9968 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
9969
9970 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
9971
9972 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
9973
9974 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
9975
9976 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
9977 socket).
9978
9979 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
9980 the command may be set using "external-check path".
9981
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +02009982 See also "2.3. Environment variables" for other variables.
9983
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009984 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
9985 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
9986 failed.
9987
9988 Example :
9989 external-check command /bin/true
9990
9991 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
9992
9993
9994external-check path <path>
9995 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
9996 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9997 yes | no | yes | yes
9998
9999 Arguments :
10000 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
10001
10002 The default path is "".
10003
10004 Example :
10005 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
10006
10007 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
10008 "external-check command"
10009
10010
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020010011persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +020010012persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020010013 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
10014 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10015 yes | no | yes | yes
10016 Arguments :
10017 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +020010018 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
10019 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020010020
10021 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
10022 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010023 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analyzed
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020010024 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
10025 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
10026 forwarded to this server.
10027
10028 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
10029 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
10030 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010031 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020010032 a single "listen" section.
10033
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +020010034 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
10035 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
10036 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
10037
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020010038 Example :
10039 listen tse-farm
10040 bind :3389
10041 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
10042 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
10043 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
10044 # apply RDP cookie persistence
10045 persist rdp-cookie
10046 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020010047 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020010048 balance rdp-cookie
10049 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
10050 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
10051
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010010052 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the "req.rdp_cookie" ACL.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020010053
10054
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +010010055rate-limit sessions <rate>
10056 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
10057 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10058 yes | yes | yes | no
10059 Arguments :
10060 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
10061 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
10062
10063 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
10064 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
10065 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010066 (in system buffers) and HAProxy will not even be aware that sessions are
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +010010067 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
10068 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
10069
10070 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
10071 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
10072 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
10073 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
10074
10075 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
10076 listen smtp
10077 mode tcp
10078 bind :25
10079 rate-limit sessions 10
Panagiotis Panagiotopoulos7282d8e2016-02-11 16:37:15 +020010080 server smtp1 127.0.0.1:1025
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +010010081
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +020010082 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
10083 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
10084 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +010010085
10086 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
10087
10088
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020010089redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10090redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10091redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020010092 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
10093 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10094 no | yes | yes | yes
10095
10096 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +010010097 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020010098
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010099 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020010100 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010010101 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
10102 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
10103 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020010104
10105 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
10106 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
10107 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
10108 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
10109 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010010110 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
10111 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
10112 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
10113 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020010114
10115 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
10116 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
10117 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
10118 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
10119 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
10120 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010121 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020010122 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010010123 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
10124 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
10125 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010126
10127 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +010010128 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
10129 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
10130 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
Baptiste Assmannea849c02015-08-03 11:42:50 +020010131 means "Moved temporarily" and means that the browser should not
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +010010132 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
10133 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
10134 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
10135 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010136
10137 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010138 expected behavior of a redirection :
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010139
10140 - "drop-query"
10141 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
10142 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
10143 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
10144 with a location-type redirect.
10145
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +010010146 - "append-slash"
10147 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
10148 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
10149 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
10150 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
10151
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010152 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
10153 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
10154 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
10155 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
10156 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
10157 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
10158 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
10159
10160 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
10161 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
10162 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
10163 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
10164 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
10165 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
10166 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020010167
10168 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
10169 acl clear dst_port 80
10170 acl secure dst_port 8080
10171 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010172 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +010010173 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010174 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
10175
10176 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +010010177 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
10178 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
10179 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010180 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020010181
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +010010182 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
10183 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
10184 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
10185
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010186 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by HAProxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +010010187 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020010188
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010010189 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
Coen Rosdorff596659b2016-04-11 11:33:49 +020010190 http-request redirect code 301 location \
10191 http://www.%[hdr(host)]%[capture.req.uri] \
10192 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010010193
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010194 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020010195
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +010010196
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +020010197retries <value>
Willy Tarreaucc834882022-11-25 11:06:20 +010010198 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a failure
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +020010199 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10200 yes | no | yes | yes
10201 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaucc834882022-11-25 11:06:20 +010010202 <value> is the number of times a request or connection attempt should be
10203 retried on a server after a failure.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +020010204
Willy Tarreaucc834882022-11-25 11:06:20 +010010205 By default, retries apply only to new connection attempts. However, when
10206 the "retry-on" directive is used, other conditions might trigger a retry
10207 (e.g. empty response, undesired status code), and each of them will count
10208 one attempt, and when the total number attempts reaches the value here, an
10209 error will be returned.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +020010210
10211 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -070010212 a turn-around timer of min("timeout connect", one second) is applied before
Willy Tarreaucc834882022-11-25 11:06:20 +010010213 a retry occurs on the same server.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +020010214
Willy Tarreaucc834882022-11-25 11:06:20 +010010215 When "option redispatch" is set, some retries may be performed on another
10216 server even if a cookie references a different server. By default this will
10217 only be the last retry unless an argument is passed to "option redispatch".
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +020010218
10219 See also : "option redispatch"
10220
10221
Lukas Tribusbb474ff2021-12-08 11:33:01 +010010222retry-on [space-delimited list of keywords]
Jerome Magnin5ce3c142020-05-13 20:09:57 +020010223 Specify when to attempt to automatically retry a failed request.
10224 This setting is only valid when "mode" is set to http and is silently ignored
10225 otherwise.
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010226 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10227 yes | no | yes | yes
10228 Arguments :
Lukas Tribusbb474ff2021-12-08 11:33:01 +010010229 <keywords> is a space-delimited list of keywords or HTTP status codes, each
10230 representing a type of failure event on which an attempt to
10231 retry the request is desired. Please read the notes at the
10232 bottom before changing this setting. The following keywords are
10233 supported :
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010234
10235 none never retry
10236
10237 conn-failure retry when the connection or the SSL handshake failed
10238 and the request could not be sent. This is the default.
10239
10240 empty-response retry when the server connection was closed after part
10241 of the request was sent, and nothing was received from
10242 the server. This type of failure may be caused by the
10243 request timeout on the server side, poor network
10244 condition, or a server crash or restart while
10245 processing the request.
10246
Olivier Houcharde3249a92019-05-03 23:01:47 +020010247 junk-response retry when the server returned something not looking
10248 like a complete HTTP response. This includes partial
10249 responses headers as well as non-HTTP contents. It
10250 usually is a bad idea to retry on such events, which
10251 may be caused a configuration issue (wrong server port)
10252 or by the request being harmful to the server (buffer
10253 overflow attack for example).
10254
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010255 response-timeout the server timeout stroke while waiting for the server
10256 to respond to the request. This may be caused by poor
10257 network condition, the reuse of an idle connection
10258 which has expired on the path, or by the request being
10259 extremely expensive to process. It generally is a bad
10260 idea to retry on such events on servers dealing with
10261 heavy database processing (full scans, etc) as it may
10262 amplify denial of service attacks.
10263
Olivier Houchard865d8392019-05-03 22:46:27 +020010264 0rtt-rejected retry requests which were sent over early data and were
10265 rejected by the server. These requests are generally
10266 considered to be safe to retry.
10267
Julien Pivotto2de240a2020-11-12 11:14:05 +010010268 <status> any HTTP status code among "401" (Unauthorized), "403"
10269 (Forbidden), "404" (Not Found), "408" (Request Timeout),
10270 "425" (Too Early), "500" (Server Error), "501" (Not
10271 Implemented), "502" (Bad Gateway), "503" (Service
10272 Unavailable), "504" (Gateway Timeout).
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010273
Olivier Houchardddf0e032019-05-10 18:05:40 +020010274 all-retryable-errors
10275 retry request for any error that are considered
10276 retryable. This currently activates "conn-failure",
10277 "empty-response", "junk-response", "response-timeout",
10278 "0rtt-rejected", "500", "502", "503", and "504".
10279
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010280 Using this directive replaces any previous settings with the new ones; it is
10281 not cumulative.
10282
10283 Please note that using anything other than "none" and "conn-failure" requires
10284 to allocate a buffer and copy the whole request into it, so it has memory and
10285 performance impacts. Requests not fitting in a single buffer will never be
10286 retried (see the global tune.bufsize setting).
10287
10288 You have to make sure the application has a replay protection mechanism built
10289 in such as a unique transaction IDs passed in requests, or that replaying the
10290 same request has no consequence, or it is very dangerous to use any retry-on
10291 value beside "conn-failure" and "none". Static file servers and caches are
10292 generally considered safe against any type of retry. Using a status code can
10293 be useful to quickly leave a server showing an abnormal behavior (out of
10294 memory, file system issues, etc), but in this case it may be a good idea to
10295 immediately redispatch the connection to another server (please see "option
10296 redispatch" for this). Last, it is important to understand that most causes
10297 of failures are the requests themselves and that retrying a request causing a
10298 server to misbehave will often make the situation even worse for this server,
10299 or for the whole service in case of redispatch.
10300
10301 Unless you know exactly how the application deals with replayed requests, you
10302 should not use this directive.
10303
10304 The default is "conn-failure".
10305
Lukas Tribusbb474ff2021-12-08 11:33:01 +010010306 Example:
10307 retry-on 503 504
10308
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010309 See also: "retries", "option redispatch", "tune.bufsize"
10310
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +010010311server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010312 Declare a server in a backend
10313 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10314 no | no | yes | yes
10315 Arguments :
10316 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010317 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -050010318 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010319
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +010010320 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
10321 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
10322 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
10323 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +020010324 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
10325 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010326 intercepted and HAProxy must forward to the original destination
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +020010327 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
10328 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010010329 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
10330 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
10331 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
10332 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
10333 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
10334 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
10335 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +020010336 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +020010337 - 'sockpair@' -> address is the FD of a connected unix
10338 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the
10339 backend creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes
10340 one of them over the FD. The bind part will use the
10341 received socket as the client FD. Should be used
10342 carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +020010343 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
10344 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010010345 variables. The "init-addr" setting can be used to modify the way
10346 IP addresses should be resolved upon startup.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010347
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010348 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010349 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
10350 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
10351 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
10352 adding this value to the client's port.
10353
10354 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
10355 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010356 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010357
10358 Examples :
10359 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
10360 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010010361 server transp ipv4@
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +020010362 server backup "${SRV_BACKUP}:1080" backup
10363 server www1_dc1 "${LAN_DC1}.101:80"
10364 server www1_dc2 "${LAN_DC2}.101:80"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010365
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +020010366 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
10367 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
10368 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
10369 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
10370 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
10371
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -050010372 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
10373 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010374
Christopher Faulet583b6de2021-02-12 09:27:10 +010010375server-state-file-name [ { use-backend-name | <file> } ]
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020010376 Set the server state file to read, load and apply to servers available in
Christopher Faulet583b6de2021-02-12 09:27:10 +010010377 this backend.
10378 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10379 no | no | yes | yes
10380
10381 It only applies when the directive "load-server-state-from-file" is set to
10382 "local". When <file> is not provided, if "use-backend-name" is used or if
10383 this directive is not set, then backend name is used. If <file> starts with a
10384 slash '/', then it is considered as an absolute path. Otherwise, <file> is
10385 concatenated to the global directive "server-state-base".
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020010386
10387 Example: the minimal configuration below would make HAProxy look for the
10388 state server file '/etc/haproxy/states/bk':
10389
10390 global
10391 server-state-file-base /etc/haproxy/states
10392
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010010393 backend bk
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020010394 load-server-state-from-file
10395
Christopher Faulet583b6de2021-02-12 09:27:10 +010010396 See also: "server-state-base", "load-server-state-from-file", and
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020010397 "show servers state"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010398
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +020010399server-template <prefix> <num | range> <fqdn>[:<port>] [params*]
10400 Set a template to initialize servers with shared parameters.
10401 The names of these servers are built from <prefix> and <num | range> parameters.
10402 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10403 no | no | yes | yes
10404
10405 Arguments:
10406 <prefix> A prefix for the server names to be built.
10407
10408 <num | range>
10409 If <num> is provided, this template initializes <num> servers
10410 with 1 up to <num> as server name suffixes. A range of numbers
10411 <num_low>-<num_high> may also be used to use <num_low> up to
10412 <num_high> as server name suffixes.
10413
10414 <fqdn> A FQDN for all the servers this template initializes.
10415
10416 <port> Same meaning as "server" <port> argument (see "server" keyword).
10417
10418 <params*>
10419 Remaining server parameters among all those supported by "server"
10420 keyword.
10421
10422 Examples:
10423 # Initializes 3 servers with srv1, srv2 and srv3 as names,
10424 # google.com as FQDN, and health-check enabled.
10425 server-template srv 1-3 google.com:80 check
10426
10427 # or
10428 server-template srv 3 google.com:80 check
10429
10430 # would be equivalent to:
10431 server srv1 google.com:80 check
10432 server srv2 google.com:80 check
10433 server srv3 google.com:80 check
10434
10435
10436
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010437source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010438source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +010010439source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010440 Set the source address for outgoing connections
10441 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10442 yes | no | yes | yes
10443 Arguments :
10444 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
10445 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010010446
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010447 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010010448 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
10449 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
10450 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
10451 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
10452 supported prefixes are :
10453 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
10454 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
10455 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +020010456 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020010457 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
10458 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010459
10460 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
10461 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020010462 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
10463 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
10464 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010465
10466 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
10467 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
10468 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
10469 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
10470 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
10471 <addr>.
10472
10473 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
10474 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
10475 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
10476 port.
10477
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010478 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
10479 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
10480 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
10481 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +010010482 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010483 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
10484 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
10485 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
10486 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
10487 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
10488 HTTP header.
10489
10490 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
10491 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010492 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010493 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
10494 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
10495 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
10496 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
10497 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
10498 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
10499 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
10500
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +010010501 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
10502 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
10503 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
10504 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
10505 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
10506 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
10507
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010508 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
10509 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
10510 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
10511 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
10512
10513 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
10514 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
10515 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
10516 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
10517 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
10518 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
10519
10520 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
10521 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
10522 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
10523 there are two methods :
10524
10525 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
10526 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
10527 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
10528 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
10529 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
10530 of the client ranges may be used.
10531
10532 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
10533 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
10534 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
10535 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
10536 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
10537 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
10538 same session.
10539
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010540 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
10541 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
10542 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010543 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010544
Baptiste Assmann91bd3372015-07-17 21:59:42 +020010545 In order to work, "usesrc" requires root privileges.
10546
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010547 Examples :
10548 backend private
10549 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
10550 source 192.168.1.200
10551
10552 backend transparent_ssl1
10553 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
10554 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
10555
10556 backend transparent_ssl2
10557 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
10558 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
10559 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
10560
10561 backend transparent_ssl3
10562 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
10563 # is more conntrack-friendly.
10564 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
10565
10566 backend transparent_smtp
10567 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
10568 # with Tproxy version 4.
10569 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
10570
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010571 backend transparent_http
10572 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
10573 # proxy.
10574 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
10575
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010576 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010577 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
10578
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010579
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090010580srvtcpka-cnt <count>
10581 Sets the maximum number of keepalive probes TCP should send before dropping
10582 the connection on the server side.
10583 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10584 yes | no | yes | yes
10585 Arguments :
10586 <count> is the maximum number of keepalive probes.
10587
10588 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPCNT. If this keyword
10589 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_probes) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +020010590 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
10591 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090010592
10593 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-idle", "srvtcpka-intvl".
10594
10595
10596srvtcpka-idle <timeout>
10597 Sets the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts sending
10598 keepalive probes, if enabled the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the
10599 server side.
10600 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10601 yes | no | yes | yes
10602 Arguments :
10603 <timeout> is the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts
10604 sending keepalive probes. It is specified in seconds by default,
10605 but can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the
10606 unit, as explained at the top of this document.
10607
10608 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPIDLE. If this keyword
10609 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_time) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +020010610 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
10611 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090010612
10613 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-cnt", "srvtcpka-intvl".
10614
10615
10616srvtcpka-intvl <timeout>
10617 Sets the time between individual keepalive probes on the server side.
10618 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10619 yes | no | yes | yes
10620 Arguments :
10621 <timeout> is the time between individual keepalive probes. It is specified
10622 in seconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number
10623 is suffixed by the unit, as explained at the top of this
10624 document.
10625
10626 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPINTVL. If this keyword
10627 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_intvl) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +020010628 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
10629 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090010630
10631 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-cnt", "srvtcpka-idle".
10632
10633
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020010634stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
10635 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
10636 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010637 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020010638
10639 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
10640 matched.
10641
10642 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
10643 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
10644
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010645 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
10646 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010647 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010648
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +010010649 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
10650 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
10651 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
10652 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020010653
10654 Example :
10655 # statistics admin level only for localhost
10656 backend stats_localhost
10657 stats enable
10658 stats admin if LOCALHOST
10659
10660 Example :
10661 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
10662 backend stats_auth
10663 stats enable
10664 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
10665 stats admin if TRUE
10666
10667 Example :
10668 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
10669 userlist stats-auth
10670 group admin users admin
10671 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
10672 group readonly users haproxy
10673 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
10674
10675 backend stats_auth
10676 stats enable
10677 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
10678 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
10679 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
10680 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
10681
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010682 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
10683 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
10684 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020010685
10686
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010687stats auth <user>:<passwd>
10688 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
10689 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010690 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010691 Arguments :
10692 <user> is a user name to grant access to
10693
10694 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
10695
10696 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
10697 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
10698 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
10699 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
10700 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
10701 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
10702
10703 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
10704 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
10705 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020010706 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010707
10708 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
10709 report using "stats scope".
10710
10711 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10712 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10713 unobvious parameters.
10714
10715 Example :
10716 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10717 backend public_www
10718 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10719 stats enable
10720 stats hide-version
10721 stats scope .
10722 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010723 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010724 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10725 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10726
10727 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10728 backend private_monitoring
10729 stats enable
10730 stats uri /admin?stats
10731 stats refresh 5s
10732
10733 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
10734
10735
10736stats enable
10737 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
10738 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010739 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010740 Arguments : none
10741
10742 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
10743 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
10744 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
10745 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
10746 - stats auth : no authentication
10747 - stats scope : no restriction
10748
10749 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10750 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10751 unobvious parameters.
10752
10753 Example :
10754 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10755 backend public_www
10756 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10757 stats enable
10758 stats hide-version
10759 stats scope .
10760 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010761 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010762 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10763 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10764
10765 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10766 backend private_monitoring
10767 stats enable
10768 stats uri /admin?stats
10769 stats refresh 5s
10770
10771 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
10772
10773
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010774stats hide-version
10775 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010776 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010777 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010778 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010779
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010780 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
10781 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
10782 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
10783 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
10784 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
10785 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010786
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +020010787 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10788 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10789 unobvious parameters.
10790
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010791 Example :
10792 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10793 backend public_www
10794 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +020010795 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010796 stats hide-version
10797 stats scope .
10798 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010799 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010800 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10801 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010802
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010803 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10804 backend private_monitoring
10805 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010806 stats uri /admin?stats
10807 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +010010808
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010809 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010810
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010010811
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +020010812stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
10813 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
10814 Access control for statistics
10815
10816 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10817 no | no | yes | yes
10818
10819 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
10820 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
10821 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
10822 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
10823 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
10824 should be asked to enter a username and password.
10825
10826 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
10827 instance.
10828
10829 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
10830 about ACL usage.
10831
10832
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010833stats realm <realm>
10834 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
10835 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010836 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010837 Arguments :
10838 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
10839 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
10840 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
10841
10842 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
10843 using a backslash ('\').
10844
10845 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
10846 only related to authentication.
10847
10848 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10849 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10850 unobvious parameters.
10851
10852 Example :
10853 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10854 backend public_www
10855 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10856 stats enable
10857 stats hide-version
10858 stats scope .
10859 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010860 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010861 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10862 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10863
10864 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10865 backend private_monitoring
10866 stats enable
10867 stats uri /admin?stats
10868 stats refresh 5s
10869
10870 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
10871
10872
10873stats refresh <delay>
10874 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
10875 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010876 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010877 Arguments :
10878 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
10879 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
10880 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
10881 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
10882 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
10883 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
10884
10885 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
10886 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
10887 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
Jackie Tapia749f74c2020-07-22 18:59:40 -050010888 they want automatic refresh of the page or not.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010889
10890 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10891 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10892 unobvious parameters.
10893
10894 Example :
10895 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10896 backend public_www
10897 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10898 stats enable
10899 stats hide-version
10900 stats scope .
10901 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010902 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010903 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10904 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10905
10906 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10907 backend private_monitoring
10908 stats enable
10909 stats uri /admin?stats
10910 stats refresh 5s
10911
10912 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
10913
10914
10915stats scope { <name> | "." }
10916 Enable statistics and limit access scope
10917 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010918 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010919 Arguments :
10920 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
10921 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
10922 section in which the statement appears.
10923
10924 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
10925 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
10926 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
10927 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
10928 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
10929 exists.
10930
10931 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10932 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10933 unobvious parameters.
10934
10935 Example :
10936 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10937 backend public_www
10938 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10939 stats enable
10940 stats hide-version
10941 stats scope .
10942 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010943 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010944 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10945 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10946
10947 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10948 backend private_monitoring
10949 stats enable
10950 stats uri /admin?stats
10951 stats refresh 5s
10952
10953 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
10954
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010955
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010956stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010957 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
10958 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010959 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010960
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010961 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010962 description from global section is automatically used instead.
10963
10964 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
10965 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
10966
10967 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10968 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010969 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010970
10971 Example :
10972 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10973 backend private_monitoring
10974 stats enable
10975 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
10976 stats uri /admin?stats
10977 stats refresh 5s
10978
10979 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
10980 global section.
10981
10982
10983stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010984 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
10985 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10986 yes | yes | yes | yes
10987 Arguments : none
10988
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010989 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010990 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
10991 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
10992 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
10993 - IP (socket, server)
10994 - cookie (backend, server)
10995
10996 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10997 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010998 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010999
11000 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
11001
11002
Amaury Denoyelle0b70a8a2020-10-05 11:49:45 +020011003stats show-modules
11004 Enable display of extra statistics module on the statistics page
11005 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11006 yes | yes | yes | yes
11007 Arguments : none
11008
11009 New columns are added at the end of the line containing the extra statistics
11010 values as a tooltip.
11011
11012 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
11013 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
11014 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
11015
11016 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
11017
11018
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011019stats show-node [ <name> ]
11020 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
11021 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020011022 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011023 Arguments:
11024 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
11025 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
11026
11027 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
11028 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011029 provided for each customer. Default behavior is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011030
11031 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
11032 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
11033 unobvious parameters.
11034
11035 Example:
11036 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
11037 backend private_monitoring
11038 stats enable
11039 stats show-node Europe-1
11040 stats uri /admin?stats
11041 stats refresh 5s
11042
11043 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
11044 section.
11045
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011046
11047stats uri <prefix>
11048 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
11049 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020011050 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011051 Arguments :
11052 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
11053 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
11054 query string.
11055
11056 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
11057 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
11058 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
11059 possible to reach it in the application.
11060
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040011061 The default URI compiled in HAProxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011062 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011063 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
11064 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
11065 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
11066 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
11067
11068 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
11069 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
11070 an address or a port to statistics only.
11071
11072 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
11073 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
11074 unobvious parameters.
11075
11076 Example :
11077 # public access (limited to this backend only)
11078 backend public_www
11079 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
11080 stats enable
11081 stats hide-version
11082 stats scope .
11083 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011084 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011085 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
11086 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
11087
11088 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
11089 backend private_monitoring
11090 stats enable
11091 stats uri /admin?stats
11092 stats refresh 5s
11093
11094 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
11095
11096
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011097stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
11098 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011099 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011100 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011101
11102 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011103 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011104 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011105 will be analyzed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011106 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
11107
11108 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
11109 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
11110 the "stick-table" statement.
11111
11112 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
11113 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
11114 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
11115 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
11116 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
11117
11118 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
11119 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
11120 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
11121 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
11122 transformation rules.
11123
11124 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
11125 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
11126 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
11127 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
11128 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
11129 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
11130 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
11131
11132 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
11133 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
11134 ACL based conditions.
11135
11136 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
11137 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
11138 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
11139 matches can be used as fallbacks.
11140
11141 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
11142 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
11143 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
11144 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
11145
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011146 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
11147 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011148 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011149
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011150 Example :
11151 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
11152 # last 30 minutes
11153 backend pop
11154 mode tcp
11155 balance roundrobin
11156 stick store-request src
11157 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
11158 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
11159 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
11160
11161 backend smtp
11162 mode tcp
11163 balance roundrobin
11164 stick match src table pop
11165 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
11166 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
11167
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011168 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011169 about ACLs and samples fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011170
11171
11172stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
11173 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
11174 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11175 no | no | yes | yes
11176
11177 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
11178 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
11179 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
11180 for writing more maintainable configurations.
11181
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011182 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
11183 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011184 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011185
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011186 Examples :
11187 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +010011188 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011189
11190 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
11191 stick match src table pop if !localhost
11192 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
11193
11194
11195 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
11196 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
11197 backend http
11198 mode http
11199 balance roundrobin
11200 stick on src table https
11201 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
11202 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
11203 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
11204
11205 backend https
11206 mode tcp
11207 balance roundrobin
11208 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
11209 stick on src
11210 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
11211 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
11212
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011213 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011214
11215
11216stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
11217 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
11218 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11219 no | no | yes | yes
11220
11221 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011222 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011223 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011224 will be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011225 server is selected.
11226
11227 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
11228 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
11229 the "stick-table" statement.
11230
11231 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
11232 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
11233 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
11234 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
11235 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
11236 address.
11237
11238 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
11239 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
11240 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
11241 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
11242 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
11243 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
11244 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
11245 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
11246 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
11247 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
11248
11249 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
11250 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
11251 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
11252 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
11253 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
11254 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
11255 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
11256
11257 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
11258 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
11259 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
11260 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
11261
11262 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
11263 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
11264 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
11265 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
11266 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
11267 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +010011268 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
11269 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
11270 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
11271 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
11272 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
11273 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011274
11275 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
11276 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
11277 the request.
11278
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011279 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
11280 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011281 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011282
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011283 Example :
11284 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
11285 # last 30 minutes
11286 backend pop
11287 mode tcp
11288 balance roundrobin
11289 stick store-request src
11290 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
11291 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
11292 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
11293
11294 backend smtp
11295 mode tcp
11296 balance roundrobin
11297 stick match src table pop
11298 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
11299 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
11300
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011301 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011302 about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011303
11304
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020011305stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Thayne McCombs92149f92020-11-20 01:28:26 -070011306 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>] [srvkey <srvkey>]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +020011307 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +080011308 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011309 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +020011310 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011311
11312 Arguments :
11313 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
11314 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
11315 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
11316 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
11317
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +010011318 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
11319 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
11320 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
11321 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
11322
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011323 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
11324 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
11325 instance.
11326
11327 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
11328 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
11329 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
11330 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
11331 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
11332 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020011333 to 32 characters.
11334
11335 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
11336 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
11337 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011338 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020011339 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
11340 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011341
11342 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020011343 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
11344 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011345 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
11346 increase.
11347
11348 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010011349 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
11350 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
11351 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011352
11353 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040011354 is full. When not specified and the table is full when HAProxy
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011355 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
11356 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011357 most often the desired behavior. In some specific cases, it
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011358 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
11359 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
11360 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
11361 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
11362 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
11363 parameter (see below).
11364
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +020011365 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
11366 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
11367 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
11368 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
11369 soft restart.
11370
Willy Tarreau1abc6732015-05-01 19:21:02 +020011371 NOTE : each peers section may be referenced only by tables
11372 belonging to the same unique process.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011373
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011374 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
Emeric Brunad57d202022-05-30 18:08:28 +020011375 was last created, refreshed using 'track-sc' or matched using
11376 'stick match' or 'stick on' rule. The expiration delay is
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011377 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
11378 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +010011379 section 2.5 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020011380 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011381 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
11382 if not expiration delay is specified.
Emeric Brunad57d202022-05-30 18:08:28 +020011383 Note: 'table_*' converters performs lookups but won't update touch
11384 expire since they don't require 'track-sc'.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011385
Thayne McCombs92149f92020-11-20 01:28:26 -070011386 <srvkey> specifies how each server is identified for the purposes of the
11387 stick table. The valid values are "name" and "addr". If "name" is
11388 given, then <name> argument for the server (may be generated by
11389 a template). If "addr" is given, then the server is identified
11390 by its current network address, including the port. "addr" is
11391 especially useful if you are using service discovery to generate
11392 the addresses for servers with peered stick-tables and want
11393 to consistently use the same host across peers for a stickiness
11394 token.
11395
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +020011396 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
11397 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
11398 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
11399 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011400 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
11401 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
11402 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
11403 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
11404 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
11405 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
11406 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
11407 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
11408 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
11409 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
11410 types and their arguments.
11411
11412 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
11413 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
11414 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
11415 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
11416
11417 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
11418 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
11419 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011420 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011421
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020011422 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
11423 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
11424 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011425 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020011426 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011427 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020011428
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010011429 - gpc1 : second General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
11430 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
11431 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
11432 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
11433
11434 - gpc1_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
11435 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
11436 for anything. Just like <gpc1>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
11437 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
11438 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
11439 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
11440
Emeric Bruna5d15312021-07-01 18:34:48 +020011441 - gpt0 : first General Purpose Tag. It is a positive 32-bit integer
11442 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
11443 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
11444 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches
11445
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011446 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
11447 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
11448 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
11449 they were received.
11450
11451 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
11452 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
11453 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
11454 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
11455 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
11456
11457 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11458 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11459 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11460 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
11461 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
11462
11463 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
11464 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
11465 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
11466
11467 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11468 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11469 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11470 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
11471 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
11472
11473 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
11474 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
11475 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
11476 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
11477 the client side.
11478
11479 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11480 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11481 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11482 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
11483 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
11484 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
11485 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
11486
11487 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
11488 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
11489 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
11490 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
11491 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
11492 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011493 (e.g. vulnerability scan).
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011494
11495 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11496 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11497 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11498 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
11499 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
11500 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
11501
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010011502 - http_fail_cnt : HTTP Failure Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
11503 counts the absolute number of HTTP response failures induced by servers
11504 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
11505 responses, as well as any 5xx response other than 501 or 505. It aims at
11506 being used combined with path or URI to detect service failures.
11507
11508 - http_fail_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
11509 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11510 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11511 HTTP response failure rate over that period, in requests per period (see
11512 http_fail_cnt above for what is accounted as a failure). The result is an
11513 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
11514
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011515 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011516 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes received from clients
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011517 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
11518 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
11519
11520 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11521 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11522 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11523 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
11524 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
11525 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
11526 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
11527 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
11528 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
11529 recommended for better fairness.
11530
11531 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011532 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes sent to clients which
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011533 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
11534 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
11535
11536 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
11537 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11538 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11539 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
11540 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
11541 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
11542 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
11543 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
11544 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
11545 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +020011546
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +020011547 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
11548 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011549 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
11550 reference it.
11551
11552 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
11553 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
Baptiste Assmann123ff042016-03-06 23:29:28 +010011554 lost upon restart unless peers are properly configured to transfer such
11555 information upon restart (recommended). In general it can be good as a
11556 complement but not always as an exclusive stickiness.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011557
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011558 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
11559 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
11560 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
11561 something that can be ignored.
11562
11563 Example:
11564 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
11565 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
11566 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
11567 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
11568
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +010011569 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.5
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +010011570 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011571
11572
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011573stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
Baptiste Assmann2f2d2ec2016-03-06 23:27:24 +010011574 Define a response pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011575 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11576 no | no | yes | yes
11577
11578 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011579 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011580 describes what elements of the response or connection will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011581 be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011582 server is selected.
11583
11584 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
11585 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
11586 the "stick-table" statement.
11587
11588 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
11589 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
11590 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
11591 when the response is a SSL server hello.
11592
11593 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
11594 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
11595 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
11596 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
11597 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
11598 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011599 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011600 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
11601 rules.
11602
11603 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
11604 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
11605 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
11606 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
11607 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
11608 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
11609 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
11610
11611 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
11612 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
11613 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
11614 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
11615
11616 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
11617 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
11618 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
11619 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
11620 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
11621 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +010011622 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
11623 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
11624 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
11625 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
11626 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
11627 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
11628 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
11629 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
11630 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011631
11632 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
11633
11634 Example :
11635 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
11636 backend https
11637 mode tcp
11638 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020011639 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011640 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011641
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010011642 acl clienthello req.ssl_hello_type 1
11643 acl serverhello rep.ssl_hello_type 2
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011644
11645 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
11646 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
11647 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
11648
11649 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
11650 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011651
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011652 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
11653 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
11654 # at offset 44.
11655
11656 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010011657 stick on req.payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011658
11659 # Learn on response if server hello.
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010011660 stick store-response resp.payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020011661
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011662 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
11663 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
11664
11665 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
11666 extraction.
11667
11668
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011669tcp-check comment <string>
11670 Defines a comment for the following the tcp-check rule, reported in logs if
11671 it fails.
11672 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11673 yes | no | yes | yes
11674
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011675 Arguments :
11676 <string> is the comment message to add in logs if the following tcp-check
11677 rule fails.
11678
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011679 It only works for connect, send and expect rules. It is useful to make
11680 user-friendly error reporting.
11681
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011682 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send" and
11683 "tcp-check expect".
11684
11685
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011686tcp-check connect [default] [port <expr>] [addr <ip>] [send-proxy] [via-socks4]
11687 [ssl] [sni <sni>] [alpn <alpn>] [linger]
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020011688 [proto <name>] [comment <msg>]
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011689 Opens a new connection
11690 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011691 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011692
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011693 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011694 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
11695
Christopher Faulet4dce5922020-03-30 13:54:42 +020011696 default Use default options of the server line to do the health
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040011697 checks. The server options are used only if not redefined.
Christopher Faulet4dce5922020-03-30 13:54:42 +020011698
Christopher Fauletb7d30092020-03-30 15:19:03 +020011699 port <expr> if not set, check port or server port is used.
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020011700 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
11701 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to
Christopher Fauletb7d30092020-03-30 15:19:03 +020011702 65535 or an sample-fetch expression.
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020011703
11704 addr <ip> defines the IP address to do the health check.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011705
11706 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
11707
Christopher Faulet085426a2020-03-30 13:07:02 +020011708 via-socks4 enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy.
11709
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011710 ssl opens a ciphered connection
11711
Christopher Faulet79b31d42020-03-30 13:00:05 +020011712 sni <sni> specifies the SNI to use to do health checks over SSL.
11713
Christopher Faulet98572322020-03-30 13:16:44 +020011714 alpn <alpn> defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol
11715 list consists in a comma-delimited list of protocol names,
11716 for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
11717 If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
11718
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020011719 proto <name> forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for this connection.
11720 It must be a TCP mux protocol and it must be usable on the
11721 backend side. The list of available protocols is reported in
11722 haproxy -vv.
11723
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020011724 linger cleanly close the connection instead of using a single RST.
Gaetan Rivetf8ba6772020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011725
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011726 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
11727 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
11728 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
11729
11730 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
11731 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
11732 of the sequence.
11733
11734 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
11735 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
11736 do.
11737
11738 When a connect must start the ruleset, if may still be preceded by set-var,
11739 unset-var or comment rules.
11740
11741 Examples :
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011742 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
11743 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
11744 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
11745 option tcp-check
11746 tcp-check connect
11747 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
11748 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
11749 tcp-check send \r\n
11750 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
11751 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
11752 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
11753 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
11754 tcp-check send \r\n
11755 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
11756 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
11757
11758 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
11759 option tcp-check
Gaetan Rivetf8ba6772020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011760 tcp-check connect port 110 linger
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011761 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
11762 tcp-check connect port 143
11763 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
11764 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
11765
11766 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
11767
11768
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011769tcp-check expect [min-recv <int>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011770 [ok-status <st>] [error-status <st>] [tout-status <st>]
Christopher Faulet98cc57c2020-04-01 20:52:31 +020011771 [on-success <fmt>] [on-error <fmt>] [status-code <expr>]
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011772 [!] <match> <pattern>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011773 Specify data to be collected and analyzed during a generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011774 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011775 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011776
11777 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011778 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
11779
Gaetan Rivet1afd8262020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011780 min-recv is optional and can define the minimum amount of data required to
11781 evaluate the current expect rule. If the number of received bytes
11782 is under this limit, the check will wait for more data. This
11783 option can be used to resolve some ambiguous matching rules or to
11784 avoid executing costly regex matches on content known to be still
11785 incomplete. If an exact string (string or binary) is used, the
11786 minimum between the string length and this parameter is used.
11787 This parameter is ignored if it is set to -1. If the expect rule
11788 does not match, the check will wait for more data. If set to 0,
11789 the evaluation result is always conclusive.
11790
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011791 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
Gaetan Rivetefab6c62020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011792 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring", "binary" or
11793 "rbinary".
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011794 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
11795 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
11796 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
11797
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011798 ok-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
11799 the expect rule is successfully evaluated and if it is
11800 the last rule in the tcp-check ruleset. "L7OK", "L7OKC",
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011801 "L6OK" and "L4OK" are supported :
11802 - L7OK : check passed on layer 7
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +010011803 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
11804 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011805 - L6OK : check passed on layer 6
11806 - L4OK : check passed on layer 4
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011807 By default "L7OK" is used.
11808
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011809 error-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
11810 an error occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +010011811 "L7OKC", "L7RSP", "L7STS", "L6RSP" and "L4CON" are
11812 supported :
11813 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
11814 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011815 - L7RSP : layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
11816 - L7STS : layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
11817 - L6RSP : layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
11818 - L4CON : layer 1-4 connection problem
11819 By default "L7RSP" is used.
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011820
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011821 tout-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011822 a timeout occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011823 "L7TOUT", "L6TOUT", and "L4TOUT" are supported :
11824 - L7TOUT : layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
11825 - L6TOUT : layer 6 (SSL) timeout
11826 - L4TOUT : layer 1-4 timeout
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011827 By default "L7TOUT" is used.
11828
Christopher Fauletbe52b4d2020-04-01 16:30:22 +020011829 on-success <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
11830 informational message reported in logs if the expect
11831 rule is successfully evaluated and if it is the last rule
11832 in the tcp-check ruleset. <fmt> is a log-format string.
11833
11834 on-error <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
11835 informational message reported in logs if an error
11836 occurred during the expect rule evaluation. <fmt> is a
11837 log-format string.
11838
Christopher Faulet98cc57c2020-04-01 20:52:31 +020011839 status-code <expr> is optional and can be used to set the check status code
11840 reported in logs, on success or on error. <expr> is a
11841 standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11842 followed by some converters.
11843
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011844 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
11845 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
11846 with the usual backslash ('\').
11847 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011848 a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011849 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
11850 used upper or lower case.
11851
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011852 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
11853
11854 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
11855 A health check response will be considered valid if the
11856 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
11857 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
11858 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
11859 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
11860 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
11861 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
11862
11863 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
11864 A health check response will be considered valid if the
11865 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
11866 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
11867 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
11868 expression.
11869
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +020011870 string-lf <fmt> : test a log-format string match in the response's buffer.
11871 A health check response will be considered valid if the
11872 response's buffer contains the string resulting of the
11873 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format rules.
11874 If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
11875 considered invalid if the buffer contains the string.
11876
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011877 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
11878 in the response buffer. A health check response will
11879 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
11880 this exact hexadecimal string.
11881 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
11882
Gaetan Rivetefab6c62020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011883 rbinary <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer, like
11884 "rstring". However, the response buffer is transformed
11885 into its hexadecimal form, including NUL-bytes. This
11886 allows using all regex engines to match any binary
11887 content. The hexadecimal transformation takes twice the
11888 size of the original response. As such, the expected
11889 pattern should work on at-most half the response buffer
11890 size.
11891
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +020011892 binary-lf <hexfmt> : test a log-format string in its hexadecimal form
11893 match in the response's buffer. A health check response
11894 will be considered valid if the response's buffer
11895 contains the hexadecimal string resulting of the
11896 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format
11897 rules. If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
11898 considered invalid if the buffer contains the
11899 hexadecimal string. The hexadecimal string is converted
11900 in a binary string before matching the response's
11901 buffer.
11902
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011903 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010011904 defined by the global "tune.bufsize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011905 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
11906 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
11907 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
11908 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
11909 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
11910 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
11911 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
11912 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
11913 the null character.
11914
11915 Examples :
11916 # perform a POP check
11917 option tcp-check
11918 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
11919
11920 # perform an IMAP check
11921 option tcp-check
11922 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
11923
11924 # look for the redis master server
11925 option tcp-check
11926 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +020011927 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011928 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
11929 tcp-check expect string role:master
11930 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
11931 tcp-check expect string +OK
11932
11933
11934 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010011935 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011936
11937
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011938tcp-check send <data> [comment <msg>]
11939tcp-check send-lf <fmt> [comment <msg>]
11940 Specify a string or a log-format string to be sent as a question during a
11941 generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011942 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011943 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011944
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011945 Arguments :
11946 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
11947
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011948 <data> is the string that will be sent during a generic health
11949 check session.
Christopher Faulet16fff672020-04-30 07:50:54 +020011950
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011951 <fmt> is the log-format string that will be sent, once evaluated,
11952 during a generic health check session.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011953
11954 Examples :
11955 # look for the redis master server
11956 option tcp-check
11957 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
11958 tcp-check expect string role:master
11959
11960 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010011961 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011962
11963
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011964tcp-check send-binary <hexstring> [comment <msg>]
11965tcp-check send-binary-lf <hexfmt> [comment <msg>]
11966 Specify an hex digits string or an hex digits log-format string to be sent as
11967 a binary question during a raw tcp health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011968 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011969 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011970
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011971 Arguments :
11972 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011973
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011974 <hexstring> is the hexadecimal string that will be send, once converted
11975 to binary, during a generic health check session.
Christopher Faulet16fff672020-04-30 07:50:54 +020011976
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011977 <hexfmt> is the hexadecimal log-format string that will be send, once
11978 evaluated and converted to binary, during a generic health
11979 check session.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011980
11981 Examples :
11982 # redis check in binary
11983 option tcp-check
11984 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
11985 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
11986
11987
11988 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010011989 "tcp-check send", tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011990
11991
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011992tcp-check set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011993 This operation sets the content of a variable. The variable is declared inline.
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011994 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011995 yes | no | yes | yes
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011996
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011997 Arguments :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011998 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
11999 scope. The scopes allowed for tcp-check are:
12000 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
12001 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
12002 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
12003 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
12004 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
12005 and '-'.
12006
12007 <expr> Is a sample-fetch expression potentially followed by converters.
12008
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020012009 Examples :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012010 tcp-check set-var(check.port) int(1234)
12011
12012
12013tcp-check unset-var(<var-name>)
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012014 Free a reference to a variable within its scope.
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012015 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020012016 yes | no | yes | yes
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012017
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020012018 Arguments :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012019 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
12020 scope. The scopes allowed for tcp-check are:
12021 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
12022 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
12023 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
12024 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
12025 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
12026 and '-'.
12027
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020012028 Examples :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012029 tcp-check unset-var(check.port)
12030
12031
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012032tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
12033 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +020012034 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12035 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012036 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020012037 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
12038 below.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +020012039
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012040 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012041
12042 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
12043 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012044 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
12045 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
12046 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
12047 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
12048 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
12049 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012050
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012051 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
12052 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
12053 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
12054 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012055
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +020012056 Four types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012057 - accept :
12058 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
12059 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
12060 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012061
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012062 - reject :
12063 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
12064 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
12065 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
12066 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
12067 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
12068 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
12069 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
12070 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
12071 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
12072 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
12073 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012074 be used instead, as "tcp-request session" rules will not log either.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012075
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020012076 - expect-proxy layer4 :
12077 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
12078 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
12079 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
12080 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
12081 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
12082 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
12083 hosts.
12084
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010012085 - expect-netscaler-cip layer4 :
12086 configures the client-facing connection to receive a NetScaler Client
12087 IP insertion protocol header before any byte is read from the socket.
12088 This is equivalent to having the "accept-netscaler-cip" keyword on the
12089 "bind" line, except that using the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol
12090 to be accepted only for certain IP address ranges using an ACL. This
12091 is convenient when multiple layers of load balancers are passed
12092 through by traffic coming from public hosts.
12093
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020012094 - capture <sample> len <length> :
12095 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
12096 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
12097 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
12098 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
12099 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
12100 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
12101 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
12102 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +020012103 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
12104 request header" for more information.
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020012105
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012106 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012107 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020012108 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The
12109 number of counters that may be simultaneously tracked by the same
12110 connection is set in MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012111 haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3, so the track-sc number is between 0
Matteo Contrini1857b8c2020-10-16 17:35:54 +020012112 and (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). The first "track-sc0" rule executed enables
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020012113 tracking of the counters of the specified table as the first set. The
12114 first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
12115 specified table as the second set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed
12116 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the third
12117 set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of counters for
12118 the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend ones.
12119 But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012120
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012121 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020012122 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012123 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012124 request or connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined,
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012125 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
12126 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
12127 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012128
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012129 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
12130 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
12131 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
12132 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012133
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012134 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
12135 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
12136 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
12137 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
12138 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012139 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
12140 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
12141 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
12142 layer7 information is extracted.
12143
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012144 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
12145 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
12146 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
12147 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
12148 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012149
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020012150 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
12151 The "sc-inc-gpc0" increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
12152 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
12153 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
12154
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010012155 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
12156 The "sc-inc-gpc1" increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
12157 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
12158 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
12159
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010012160 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }:
12161 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky
12162 counter designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The
12163 expected result is a boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently
12164 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020012165
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020012166 - set-src <expr> :
12167 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
12168 expression. Useful if you want to mask source IP for privacy.
12169 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020012170 set-src".
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020012171
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020012172 Arguments:
12173 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
12174 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020012175
12176 Example:
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020012177 tcp-request connection set-src src,ipmask(24)
12178
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020012179 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
12180 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020012181
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020012182 - set-src-port <expr> :
12183 Is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
12184 expression.
12185
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020012186 Arguments:
12187 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
12188 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020012189
12190 Example:
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020012191 tcp-request connection set-src-port int(4000)
12192
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020012193 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long
12194 as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source
12195 address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020012196
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020012197 - set-dst <expr> :
12198 Is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
12199 expression. Useful if you want to mask IP for privacy in log.
12200 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
12201 set-dst". If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
12202 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
12203
12204 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
12205 followed by some converters.
12206
12207 Example:
12208
12209 tcp-request connection set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
12210 tcp-request connection set-dst ipv4(10.0.0.1)
12211
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020012212 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as
12213 the address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
12214
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020012215 - set-dst-port <expr> :
12216 Is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
12217 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
12218 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
12219
12220
12221 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
12222 followed by some converters.
12223
12224 Example:
12225
12226 tcp-request connection set-dst-port int(4000)
12227
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020012228 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
12229 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
12230 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
12231
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012232 - "silent-drop" :
12233 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012234 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012235 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
12236 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
12237 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
12238 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
12239 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012240 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
12241 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012242 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
12243 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012244 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012245 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
12246 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
12247 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
12248 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
12249
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012250 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
12251 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
12252 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012253
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012254 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
12255 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
12256 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012257
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012258 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012259 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012260 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012261
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012262 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
12263 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
12264 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012265
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012266 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012267 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
12268 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012269
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020012270 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
12271
12272 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
12273
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012274 See section 7 about ACL usage.
12275
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012276 See also : "tcp-request session", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012277
12278
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012279tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
12280 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012281 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020012282 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012283 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020012284 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
12285 below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012286
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012287 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012288
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012289 A request's contents can be analyzed at an early stage of request processing
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012290 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
12291 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012292 "accept", a "reject" or a "switch-mode" rule matches, or the TCP request
12293 inspection delay expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012294
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012295 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
12296 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
12297 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
12298 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010012299 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012300 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so HAProxy keeps a record of
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010012301 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
12302 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
12303 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
12304 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012305 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010012306 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012307
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012308 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
12309 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
12310 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
12311 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012312
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020012313 Several types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020012314 - accept : the request is accepted
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +010012315 - do-resolve: perform a DNS resolution
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020012316 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
12317 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -040012318 - set-priority-class <expr> | set-priority-offset <expr>
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012319 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020012320 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010012321 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010012322 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020012323 - set-dst <expr>
12324 - set-dst-port <expr>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012325 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012326 - switch-mode http [ proto <name> ]
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012327 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012328 - silent-drop
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012329 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010012330 - use-service <service-name>
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012331
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012332 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
12333 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +010012334 For "do-resolve" action, please check the "http-request do-resolve"
12335 configuration section.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012336
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010012337 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
12338 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
12339 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
12340 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
12341 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
12342 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012343
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012344 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012345 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
12346 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012347
Christopher Faulet2079a4a2020-10-02 11:48:57 +020012348 Note also that it is recommended to use a "tcp-request session" rule to track
12349 information that does *not* depend on Layer 7 contents, especially for HTTP
12350 frontends. Some HTTP processing are performed at the session level and may
12351 lead to an early rejection of the requests. Thus, the tracking at the content
12352 level may be disturbed in such case. A warning is emitted during startup to
12353 prevent, as far as possible, such unreliable usage.
12354
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012355 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Christopher Faulet7ea509e2020-10-02 11:38:46 +020012356 rules from a TCP proxy, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to
12357 preliminarily parse the contents of a buffer before extracting the required
12358 data. If the buffered contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the
12359 ACL does not match. The parser which is involved there is exactly the same
12360 as for all other HTTP processing, so there is no risk of parsing something
12361 differently. In an HTTP frontend or an HTTP backend, it is guaranteed that
12362 HTTP contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated
12363 first because the HTTP parsing is performed in the early stages of the
12364 connection processing, at the session level. But for such proxies, using
12365 "http-request" rules is much more natural and recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012366
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012367 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020012368 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
12369 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
12370 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012371
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020012372 The "set-dst" and "set-dst-port" are used to set respectively the destination
12373 IP and port. More information on how to use it at "http-request set-dst".
12374
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012375 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012376 declared inline. For "tcp-request session" rules, only session-level
12377 variables can be used, without any layer7 contents.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012378
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012379 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
12380 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012381 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012382 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12383 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012384 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012385 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012386 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012387 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
12388 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012389 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012390 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
12391 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012392
12393 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
12394 followed by some converters.
12395
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012396 The "switch-mode" is used to perform a connection upgrade. Only HTTP
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012397 upgrades are supported for now. The protocol may optionally be
12398 specified. This action is only available for a proxy with the frontend
12399 capability. The connection upgrade is immediately performed, following
12400 "tcp-request content" rules are not evaluated. This upgrade method should be
12401 preferred to the implicit one consisting to rely on the backend mode. When
12402 used, it is possible to set HTTP directives in a frontend without any
Ilya Shipitsin3df59892021-05-10 12:50:00 +050012403 warning. These directives will be conditionally evaluated if the HTTP upgrade
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012404 is performed. However, an HTTP backend must still be selected. It remains
12405 unsupported to route an HTTP connection (upgraded or not) to a TCP server.
12406
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +010012407 See section 4 about Proxies for more details on HTTP upgrades.
12408
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012409 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
12410 <var-name>.
12411
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -040012412 The "set-priority-class" is used to set the queue priority class of the
12413 current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an
12414 integer in the range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be
12415 truncated. The priority class determines the order in which queued requests
12416 are processed. Lower values have higher priority.
12417
12418 The "set-priority-offset" is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset
12419 of the current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts
12420 to an integer in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be
12421 truncated. When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority
12422 class, then by the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in
12423 milliseconds. Lower values have higher priority.
12424 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision for
12425 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
12426 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
12427 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
12428 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
12429
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020012430 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
12431 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
12432 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
12433 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
12434 the SPOE agent name must be used.
12435
12436 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
12437
12438 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
12439
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010012440 The "use-service" is used to executes a TCP service which will reply to the
12441 request and stop the evaluation of the rules. This service may choose to
12442 reply by sending any valid response or it may immediately close the
12443 connection without sending anything. Outside natives services, it is possible
12444 to write your own services in Lua. No further "tcp-request" rules are
12445 evaluated.
12446
12447 Example:
Aurelien DARRAGONdf332122022-10-05 18:09:33 +020012448 tcp-request content use-service lua.deny if { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010012449
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012450 Example:
12451
12452 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012453 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var2)
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012454
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012455 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012456 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012457 # and reject everything else. (Only works for HTTP/1 connections)
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012458 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
12459 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +020012460 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012461 tcp-request content reject
12462
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012463 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
12464 # and reject everything else. (works for HTTP/1 and HTTP/2 connections)
12465 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
12466 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
12467 tcp-request switch-mode http if HTTP
12468 tcp-request reject # non-HTTP traffic is implicit here
12469 ...
12470 http-request reject unless is_host_com
12471
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012472 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012473 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
12474 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010012475 acl content_present req.len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012476 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012477
12478 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
12479 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010012480 acl content_present req.len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012481 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012482 tcp-request content reject
12483
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012484 Example:
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030012485 # Track the last IP(stick-table type string) from X-Forwarded-For
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012486 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020012487 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030012488 # Or track the last IP(stick-table type ip|ipv6) from X-Forwarded-For
12489 tcp-request content track-sc0 req.hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012490
12491 Example:
12492 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
12493 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020012494 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012495
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012496 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030012497 frontend when the backend detects abuse(and marks gpc0).
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012498
12499 frontend http
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012500 # Use General Purpose Counter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012501 # protecting all our sites
12502 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012503 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
12504 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012505 ...
12506 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
12507
12508 backend http_dynamic
12509 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012510 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012511 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012512 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030012513 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0(http) gt 0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012514 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012515 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012516
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012517 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012518
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +030012519 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request session",
12520 "tcp-request inspect-delay", and "http-request".
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012521
12522
12523tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
12524 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
12525 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020012526 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012527 Arguments :
12528 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12529 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12530 as explained at the top of this document.
12531
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012532 People using HAProxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012533 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
12534 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
12535 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
12536 data for at most the specified amount of time.
12537
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020012538 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
12539 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
12540 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
12541 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
12542
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012543 Note that when performing content inspection, HAProxy will evaluate the whole
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012544 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012545 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012546 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012547 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, HAProxy will not wait at all
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +010012548 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
12549 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
12550 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012551
12552 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
12553 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
12554 it pass through unaffected.
12555
12556 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
12557 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
12558 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012559 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012560 before the server (e.g. SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
12561 data to the server (e.g. SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +020012562 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
12563 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
12564 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012565
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020012566 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012567 "timeout client".
12568
12569
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012570tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
12571 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
12572 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12573 no | no | yes | yes
12574 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020012575 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
12576 below.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012577
12578 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
12579
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012580 Response contents can be analyzed at an early stage of response processing
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012581 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
12582 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020012583 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
12584 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012585
12586 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
12587
12588 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
12589 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
12590 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
12591 inserted.
12592
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020012593 Several types of actions are supported :
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012594 - accept :
12595 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
12596 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
12597 the rules evaluation.
12598
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020012599 - close :
12600 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
12601 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
12602 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
12603 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
12604 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
12605 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012606 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020012607 protocols.
12608
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012609 - reject :
12610 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
12611 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012612 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012613
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012614 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Willy Tarreau9de54ba2021-09-02 20:51:21 +020012615 Sets a variable from an expression.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012616
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012617 - unset-var(<var-name>)
12618 Unsets a variable.
12619
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020012620 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
12621 This action increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
12622 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
12623 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
12624
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010012625 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
12626 This action increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
12627 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
12628 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
12629
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010012630 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
12631 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky
12632 counter designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The
12633 expected result is a boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently
12634 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020012635
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012636 - "silent-drop" :
12637 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012638 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012639 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
12640 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
12641 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
12642 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
12643 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012644 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
12645 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012646 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
12647 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012648 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012649 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
12650 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
12651 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
12652 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
12653
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020012654 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
12655 Send a group of SPOE messages.
12656
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012657 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
12658 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
12659 for changing the default action to a reject.
12660
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012661 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
12662 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
12663 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
12664 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012665 period.
12666
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012667 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
12668 declared inline.
12669
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012670 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
12671 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012672 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012673 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12674 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012675 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012676 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012677 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012678 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
12679 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012680 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012681 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
12682 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012683
12684 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
12685 followed by some converters.
12686
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012687 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
12688 <var-name>.
12689
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020012690 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
12691 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
12692 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
12693 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
12694 the SPOE agent name must be used.
12695
12696 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
12697
12698 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
12699
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012700 See section 7 about ACL usage.
12701
12702 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
12703
12704
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012705tcp-request session <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
12706 Perform an action on a validated session depending on a layer 5 condition
12707 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12708 no | yes | yes | no
12709 Arguments :
12710 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
12711 below.
12712
12713 <condition> is a standard layer5-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
12714
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012715 Once a session is validated, (i.e. after all handshakes have been completed),
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012716 it is possible to evaluate some conditions to decide whether this session
12717 must be accepted or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions
12718 cannot make use of any data contents because no buffers are allocated yet and
12719 the processing cannot wait at this stage. The main use case it to copy some
12720 early information into variables (since variables are accessible in the
12721 session), or to keep track of some information collected after the handshake,
12722 such as SSL-level elements (SNI, ciphers, client cert's CN) or information
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012723 from the PROXY protocol header (e.g. track a source forwarded this way). The
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012724 extracted information can thus be copied to a variable or tracked using
12725 "track-sc" rules. Of course it is also possible to decide to accept/reject as
12726 with other rulesets. Most operations performed here could also be performed
12727 in "tcp-request content" rules, except that in HTTP these rules are evaluated
12728 for each new request, and that might not always be acceptable. For example a
12729 rule might increment a counter on each evaluation. It would also be possible
12730 that a country is resolved by geolocation from the source IP address,
12731 assigned to a session-wide variable, then the source address rewritten from
12732 an HTTP header for all requests. If some contents need to be inspected in
12733 order to take the decision, the "tcp-request content" statements must be used
12734 instead.
12735
12736 The "tcp-request session" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
12737 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
12738 accept the incoming session. There is no specific limit to the number of
12739 rules which may be inserted.
12740
12741 Several types of actions are supported :
12742 - accept : the request is accepted
12743 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
12744 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
12745 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010012746 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010012747 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Christopher Faulet57759f32021-06-23 12:19:25 +020012748 - set-dst <expr>
12749 - set-dst-port <expr>
12750 - set-src <expr>
12751 - set-src-port <expr>
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012752 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012753 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012754 - silent-drop
12755
12756 These actions have the same meaning as their respective counter-parts in
12757 "tcp-request connection" and "tcp-request content", so please refer to these
12758 sections for a complete description.
12759
12760 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
12761 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
12762 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
12763
12764 Example: track the original source address by default, or the one advertised
12765 in the PROXY protocol header for connection coming from the local
12766 proxies. The first connection-level rule enables receipt of the
12767 PROXY protocol for these ones, the second rule tracks whatever
12768 address we decide to keep after optional decoding.
12769
12770 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
12771 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
12772
12773 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
12774 sessions without counting them, and track accepted sessions.
12775 This results in session rate being capped from abusive sources.
12776
12777 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
12778 tcp-request session reject if { src_sess_rate gt 10 }
12779 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
12780
12781 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, count all other
12782 sessions and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
12783 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
12784
12785 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
12786 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
12787 tcp-request session reject if { sc0_sess_rate gt 10 }
12788
12789 See section 7 about ACL usage.
12790
12791 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
12792
12793
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012794tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
12795 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
12796 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12797 no | no | yes | yes
12798 Arguments :
12799 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12800 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12801 as explained at the top of this document.
12802
12803 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
12804
12805
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012806timeout check <timeout>
12807 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
12808 established.
12809
12810 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12811 yes | no | yes | yes
12812 Arguments:
12813 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12814 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12815 as explained at the top of this document.
12816
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012817 If set, HAProxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012818 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012819 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (e.g. those
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012820 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +010012821 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
12822 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
12823 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012824
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012825 If "timeout check" is not set HAProxy uses "inter" for complete check
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012826 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
12827
12828 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
12829 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010012830 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012831
12832 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
12833 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12834 forget about it.
12835
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010012836 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
12837 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012838
12839
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012840timeout client <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012841 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
12842 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12843 yes | yes | yes | no
12844 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012845 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012846 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12847 as explained at the top of this document.
12848
12849 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
12850 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
12851 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +010012852 response while it is reading data sent by the server. That said, for the
12853 first phase, it is preferable to set the "timeout http-request" to better
12854 protect HAProxy from Slowloris like attacks. The value is specified in
12855 milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012856 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
12857 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
12858 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010012859 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012860 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012861 (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
12862 sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012863 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
12864 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012865
12866 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
12867 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12868 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
12869 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012870 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012871 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
12872
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020012873 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout http-request".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012874
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012875
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012876timeout client-fin <timeout>
12877 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
12878 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12879 yes | yes | yes | no
12880 Arguments :
12881 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12882 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12883 as explained at the top of this document.
12884
12885 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
12886 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
12887 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
12888 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
12889 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
12890 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
12891 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
Willy Tarreau599391a2017-11-24 10:16:00 +010012892 down in one direction. It is applied to idle HTTP/2 connections once a GOAWAY
12893 frame was sent, often indicating an expectation that the connection quickly
12894 ends.
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012895
12896 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
12897 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
12898 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
12899
12900 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
12901
12902
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012903timeout connect <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012904 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
12905 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12906 yes | no | yes | yes
12907 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012908 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012909 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12910 as explained at the top of this document.
12911
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012912 If the server is located on the same LAN as HAProxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010012913 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012914 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012915 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012916 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
12917 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012918
12919 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
12920 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12921 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
12922 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012923 during startup because it may result in accumulation of failed sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012924 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
12925
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020012926 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012927
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012928
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012929timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
12930 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
12931 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12932 yes | yes | yes | yes
12933 Arguments :
12934 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12935 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12936 as explained at the top of this document.
12937
12938 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
12939 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
12940 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
12941 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
12942 once the request has started to present itself.
12943
12944 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
12945 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
12946 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
12947 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
12948 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
12949
12950 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
12951 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
12952 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
12953 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
12954
12955 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
12956 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012957 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (e.g.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012958 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
12959 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020012960 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012961
12962 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
12963 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
12964 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
12965 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
12966
12967 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
12968
12969
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012970timeout http-request <timeout>
12971 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
12972 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020012973 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012974 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012975 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012976 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12977 as explained at the top of this document.
12978
12979 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
12980 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
12981 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
12982 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
12983 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
12984 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
12985 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020012986 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
12987 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
12988 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
12989 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012990 standard, well-documented behavior, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020012991 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
12992 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012993
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010012994 By default, this timeout only applies to the header part of the request,
12995 and not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is
12996 not used anymore. When combined with "option http-buffer-request", this
12997 timeout also applies to the body of the request..
12998 It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012999 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013000
13001 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
13002 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013003 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (e.g. 50 ms) will
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013004 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
13005 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
13006
13007 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020013008 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
13009 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
13010 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013011
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020013012 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010013013 "timeout client", "option http-buffer-request".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013014
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013015
13016timeout queue <timeout>
13017 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
13018 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13019 yes | no | yes | yes
13020 Arguments :
13021 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
13022 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13023 as explained at the top of this document.
13024
13025 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
13026 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
13027 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
13028 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
13029 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
13030
13031 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
13032 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
13033 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
13034 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
13035
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020013036 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013037
13038
13039timeout server <timeout>
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013040 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
13041 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13042 yes | no | yes | yes
13043 Arguments :
13044 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
13045 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13046 as explained at the top of this document.
13047
13048 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
13049 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
13050 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
13051 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
13052 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
13053 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
13054 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
13055
13056 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
13057 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
13058 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
13059 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
13060 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010013061 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013062 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013063 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
13064 with short-lived sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013065 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
13066 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013067
13068 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
13069 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
13070 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
13071 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013072 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013073 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
13074
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020013075 See also : "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013076
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020013077
13078timeout server-fin <timeout>
13079 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
13080 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13081 yes | no | yes | yes
13082 Arguments :
13083 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
13084 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13085 as explained at the top of this document.
13086
13087 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
13088 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
13089 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
13090 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
13091 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
13092 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
13093 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
13094 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
13095 situations, it should not be needed.
13096
13097 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
13098 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
13099 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
13100
13101 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
13102
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013103
13104timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010013105 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013106 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13107 yes | yes | yes | yes
13108 Arguments :
13109 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
13110 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13111 as explained at the top of this document.
13112
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020013113 When a connection is tarpitted using "http-request tarpit", it is maintained
13114 open with no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout
13115 tarpit" defines how long it will be maintained open.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013116
13117 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
13118 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
13119 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
13120 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010013121 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013122
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020013123 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013124
13125
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013126timeout tunnel <timeout>
13127 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
13128 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13129 yes | no | yes | yes
13130 Arguments :
13131 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
13132 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13133 as explained at the top of this document.
13134
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040013135 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013136 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
13137 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
13138 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013139 analyzer remains attached to either connection (e.g. tcp content rules are
13140 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (e.g.
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013141 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
13142 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
13143 specified.
13144
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020013145 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
13146 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
13147 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
13148 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
13149 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
13150 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
13151 state.
13152
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013153 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
13154 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
13155 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
13156 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013157 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013158
13159 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
13160 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
13161 forget about it.
13162
13163 Example :
13164 defaults http
13165 option http-server-close
13166 timeout connect 5s
13167 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020013168 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013169 timeout server 30s
13170 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
13171
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020013172 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013173
13174
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013175transparent (deprecated)
13176 Enable client-side transparent proxying
13177 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +010013178 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013179 Arguments : none
13180
13181 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
13182 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
13183 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
13184 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
13185 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
13186 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
13187 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
13188 appropriate server.
13189
13190 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
13191
13192 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
13193 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
13194
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013195 See also: "option transparent"
13196
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013197unique-id-format <string>
13198 Generate a unique ID for each request.
13199 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13200 yes | yes | yes | no
13201 Arguments :
13202 <string> is a log-format string.
13203
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013204 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
13205 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
13206 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
13207 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013208
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013209 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013210 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple HAProxy instances
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013211 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
13212 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
13213 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
13214 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
13215 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
13216 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013217
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013218 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
13219 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013220
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013221 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013222
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050013223 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013224
13225 will generate:
13226
13227 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
13228
13229 See also: "unique-id-header"
13230
13231unique-id-header <name>
13232 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
13233 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13234 yes | yes | yes | no
13235 Arguments :
13236 <name> is the name of the header.
13237
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013238 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
13239 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013240
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013241 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013242
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050013243 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013244 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
13245
13246 will generate:
13247
13248 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
13249
13250 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013251
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020013252use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020013253 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013254 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13255 no | yes | yes | no
13256 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010013257 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
13258 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013259
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020013260 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
13261 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013262
13263 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
13264 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
13265 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020013266 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013267 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (e.g.
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020013268 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
13269 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013270
13271 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
13272 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
13273 assign the backend.
13274
13275 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
13276 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
13277 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
13278 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
13279 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
13280 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
13281
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020013282 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013283 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020013284 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
13285 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
13286 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
13287
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010013288 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
13289 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
13290 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
13291 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
13292 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
13293 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
13294 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
13295 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
13296 cannot be forced from the request.
13297
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013298 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010013299 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
13300 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
13301
13302 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
13303 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013304
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020013305use-fcgi-app <name>
13306 Defines the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
13307 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13308 no | no | yes | yes
13309 Arguments :
13310 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
13311
13312 See section 10.1 about FastCGI application setup for details.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013313
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013314use-server <server> if <condition>
13315use-server <server> unless <condition>
13316 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
13317 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13318 no | no | yes | yes
13319 Arguments :
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020013320 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section
13321 or a "log-format" string resolving to a server name.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013322
13323 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
13324
13325 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
13326 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
13327 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
13328
13329 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
13330 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
13331 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
13332 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
13333 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
13334 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
13335 matches will assign the server.
13336
13337 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
13338 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
13339 with the next rules until one matches.
13340
13341 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
13342 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
13343 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
13344 according to other persistence mechanisms.
13345
13346 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
13347 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
13348 stripped.
13349
13350 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
13351 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020013352 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field when using protocols with
Alex18c88772021-06-05 13:23:08 +020013353 implicit TLS (also see "req.ssl_sni"). And if these servers have their weight
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020013354 set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013355
13356 Example :
13357 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
Alex18c88772021-06-05 13:23:08 +020013358 use-server www if { req.ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013359 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
Alex18c88772021-06-05 13:23:08 +020013360 use-server mail if { req.ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020013361 server mail 192.168.0.1:465 weight 0
Alex18c88772021-06-05 13:23:08 +020013362 use-server imap if { req.ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
Lukas Tribus98a3e3f2017-03-26 12:55:35 +000013363 server imap 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013364 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
13365 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
13366
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020013367 When <server> is a simple name, it is checked against existing servers in the
13368 configuration and an error is reported if the specified server does not exist.
13369 If it is a log-format, no check is performed when parsing the configuration,
13370 and if we can't resolve a valid server name at runtime but the use-server rule
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +050013371 was conditioned by an ACL returning true, no other use-server rule is applied
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020013372 and we fall back to load balancing.
13373
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013374 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013375
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013376
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100133775. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013378--------------------------
13379
13380The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
13381depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
13382settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
13383written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
13384described in this section.
13385
13386
133875.1. Bind options
13388-----------------
13389
13390The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
13391as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
13392no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
13393parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
13394while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
13395provided immediately after the setting name.
13396
13397The currently supported settings are the following ones.
13398
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010013399accept-netscaler-cip <magic number>
13400 Enforces the use of the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol over any
13401 connection accepted by any of the TCP sockets declared on the same line. The
13402 NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of
13403 the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used, with the
13404 only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will only see the
13405 real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses indicated in the
13406 protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real address will still
13407 be used. This keyword combined with support from external components can be
13408 used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the X-Forwarded-For
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010013409 mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always usable. See also
13410 "tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip" for a finer-grained setting of
13411 which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010013412
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013413accept-proxy
13414 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +020013415 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
13416 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013417 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
13418 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
13419 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
13420 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013421 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013422 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
13423 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020013424 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
13425 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013426
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020013427allow-0rtt
Bertrand Jacquina25282b2018-08-14 00:56:13 +010013428 Allow receiving early data when using TLSv1.3. This is disabled by default,
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010013429 due to security considerations. Because it is vulnerable to replay attacks,
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013430 you should only allow if for requests that are safe to replay, i.e. requests
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010013431 that are idempotent. You can use the "wait-for-handshake" action for any
13432 request that wouldn't be safe with early data.
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020013433
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020013434alpn <protocols>
13435 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
13436 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
13437 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013438 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020013439 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010013440 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to enable HTTP/2 on an HTTP frontend.
13441 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
13442 now obsolete NPN extension. At the time of writing this, most browsers still
13443 support both ALPN and NPN for HTTP/2 so a fallback to NPN may still work for
13444 a while. But ALPN must be used whenever possible. If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1
13445 are expected to be supported, both versions can be advertised, in order of
13446 preference, like below :
13447
13448 bind :443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020013449
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013450backlog <backlog>
Willy Tarreaue2711c72019-02-27 15:39:41 +010013451 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified or 0, the frontend's
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013452 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
13453
Emmanuel Hocdete7f2b732017-01-09 16:15:54 +010013454curves <curves>
13455 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
13456 the string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve suite")
13457 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format of the
13458 string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
13459 Example: "X25519:P-256" (without quote)
13460 When "curves" is set, "ecdhe" parameter is ignored.
13461
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020013462ecdhe <named curve>
13463 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +010013464 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
13465 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020013466
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020013467ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020013468 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13469 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
13470 client's certificate.
13471
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020013472ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
13473 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
13474 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
13475 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
13476 error is ignored.
13477
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020013478ca-sign-file <cafile>
13479 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13480 designates a PEM file containing both the CA certificate and the CA private
13481 key used to create and sign server's certificates. This is a mandatory
13482 setting when the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
13483 'generate-certificates' for details.
13484
Bertrand Jacquind4d0a232016-11-13 16:37:12 +000013485ca-sign-pass <passphrase>
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020013486 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It is
13487 the CA private key passphrase. This setting is optional and used only when
13488 the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
13489 'generate-certificates' for details.
13490
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010013491ca-verify-file <cafile>
13492 This setting designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to
13493 verify client's certificate. It designates CA certificates which must not be
13494 included in CA names sent in server hello message. Typically, "ca-file" must
13495 be defined with intermediate certificates, and "ca-verify-file" with
13496 certificates to ending the chain, like root CA.
13497
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013498ciphers <ciphers>
13499 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
13500 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +000013501 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000013502 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020013503 information and recommendations see e.g.
13504 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
13505 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
13506 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
13507
13508ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
13509 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
13510 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the string describing
13511 the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated during the
13512 TLSv1.3 handshake. The format of the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000013513 OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section. For cipher configuration
13514 for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers" keyword.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013515
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020013516crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020013517 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13518 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
Remi Tricot-Le Breton02bd6842021-05-04 12:22:34 +020013519 to verify client's certificate. You need to provide a certificate revocation
13520 list for every certificate of your certificate authority chain.
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020013521
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013522crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013523 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13524 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
13525 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
13526 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
13527 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +010013528 file. Intermediate certificate can also be shared in a directory via
13529 "issuers-chain-path" directive.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013530
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +010013531 If the file does not contain a private key, HAProxy will try to load
13532 the key at the same path suffixed by a ".key".
13533
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013534 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
13535 are loaded.
13536
13537 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
William Lallemand3f25ae32020-02-24 16:30:12 +010013538 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends
13539 with '.key', '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). This
13540 directive may be specified multiple times in order to load certificates from
13541 multiple files or directories. The certificates will be presented to clients
13542 who provide a valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their
13543 CN or alt subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*'
13544 is used instead of the first hostname component (e.g. *.example.org matches
William Lallemand929da3e2023-04-04 16:28:58 +020013545 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org). If an empty directory is used,
13546 HAProxy will not start unless the "strict-sni" keyword is used.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013547
13548 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
13549 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
13550 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
13551 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010013552 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
13553 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013554
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +020013555 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013556
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013557 Some CAs (such as GoDaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013558 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013559 choose a web server that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
13560 GoDaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013561 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
13562 clients).
13563
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013564 For each PEM file, HAProxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020013565 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
13566 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
13567 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
13568 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
13569 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
13570 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
13571 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
13572 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
13573 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
13574 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
13575 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
13576 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
13577
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013578 For each PEM file, HAProxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010013579 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
13580 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
13581 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
13582 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
13583
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050013584 There are cases where it is desirable to support multiple key types, e.g. RSA
13585 and ECDSA in the cipher suites offered to the clients. This allows clients
13586 that support EC certificates to be able to use EC ciphers, while
13587 simultaneously supporting older, RSA only clients.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050013588
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +020013589 To achieve this, OpenSSL 1.1.1 is required, you can configure this behavior
13590 by providing one crt entry per certificate type, or by configuring a "cert
13591 bundle" like it was required before HAProxy 1.8. See "ssl-load-extra-files".
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050013592
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020013593crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013594 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013595 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013596 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013597 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020013598
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010013599crt-list <file>
13600 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013601 designates a list of PEM file with an optional ssl configuration and a SNI
13602 filter per certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010013603
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013604 <crtfile> [\[<sslbindconf> ...\]] [[!]<snifilter> ...]
13605
William Lallemand5d036392020-06-30 16:11:36 +020013606 sslbindconf supports "allow-0rtt", "alpn", "ca-file", "ca-verify-file",
13607 "ciphers", "ciphersuites", "crl-file", "curves", "ecdhe", "no-ca-names",
13608 "npn", "verify" configuration. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1
13609 "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" are also supported. It overrides the
13610 configuration set in bind line for the certificate.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010013611
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020013612 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
Joao Moraise51fab02020-11-21 07:42:20 -030013613 useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI, or
13614 after the first certificate to exclude a pattern from its CN or Subject Alt
13615 Name (SAN). The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid
13616 TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI
13617 filter is specified, the CN and SAN are used. This directive may be specified
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020013618 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
13619 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
13620 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010013621
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +020013622 Multi-cert bundling (see "ssl-load-extra-files") is supported with crt-list,
13623 as long as only the base name is given in the crt-list. SNI filter will do
13624 the same work on all bundled certificates.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050013625
William Lallemand7c26ed72020-06-03 17:34:48 +020013626 Empty lines as well as lines beginning with a hash ('#') will be ignored.
13627
Joao Moraisaa8fcc42020-11-24 08:24:30 -030013628 The first declared certificate of a bind line is used as the default
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013629 certificate, either from crt or crt-list option, which HAProxy should use in
Joao Moraisaa8fcc42020-11-24 08:24:30 -030013630 the TLS handshake if no other certificate matches. This certificate will also
13631 be used if the provided SNI matches its CN or SAN, even if a matching SNI
13632 filter is found on any crt-list. The SNI filter !* can be used after the first
13633 declared certificate to not include its CN and SAN in the SNI tree, so it will
13634 never match except if no other certificate matches. This way the first
13635 declared certificate act as a fallback.
Joao Moraise51fab02020-11-21 07:42:20 -030013636
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013637 crt-list file example:
Joao Moraise51fab02020-11-21 07:42:20 -030013638 cert1.pem !*
William Lallemand7c26ed72020-06-03 17:34:48 +020013639 # comment
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010013640 cert2.pem [alpn h2,http/1.1]
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013641 certW.pem *.domain.tld !secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010013642 certS.pem [curves X25519:P-256 ciphers ECDHE-ECDSA-AES256-GCM-SHA384] secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013643
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013644defer-accept
13645 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
13646 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
13647 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013648 for which the client talks first (e.g. HTTP). It can slightly improve
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013649 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
13650 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
13651 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
13652 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
13653 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
13654 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
13655 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
13656
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020013657expose-fd listeners
13658 This option is only usable with the stats socket. It gives your stats socket
13659 the capability to pass listeners FD to another HAProxy process.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +020013660 During a reload with the master-worker mode, the process is automatically
13661 reexecuted adding -x and one of the stats socket with this option.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013662 See also "-x" in the management guide.
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020013663
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013664force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013665 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013666 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013667 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013668 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013669
13670force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013671 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013672 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013673 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013674
13675force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013676 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013677 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013678 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013679
13680force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013681 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013682 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013683 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013684
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013685force-tlsv13
13686 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
13687 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013688 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013689
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020013690generate-certificates
13691 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13692 enables the dynamic SSL certificates generation. A CA certificate and its
13693 private key are necessary (see 'ca-sign-file'). When HAProxy is configured as
13694 a transparent forward proxy, SSL requests generate errors because of a common
13695 name mismatch on the certificate presented to the client. With this option
13696 enabled, HAProxy will try to forge a certificate using the SNI hostname
13697 indicated by the client. This is done only if no certificate matches the SNI
13698 hostname (see 'crt-list'). If an error occurs, the default certificate is
13699 used, else the 'strict-sni' option is set.
13700 It can also be used when HAProxy is configured as a reverse proxy to ease the
13701 deployment of an architecture with many backends.
13702
13703 Creating a SSL certificate is an expensive operation, so a LRU cache is used
13704 to store forged certificates (see 'tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size'). It
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013705 increases the HAProxy's memory footprint to reduce latency when the same
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020013706 certificate is used many times.
13707
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013708gid <gid>
13709 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
13710 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
13711 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
13712 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
13713 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
13714
13715group <group>
13716 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
13717 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
13718 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
13719 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
13720 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
13721
13722id <id>
13723 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
13724 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
13725 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
13726 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
13727
13728interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +010013729 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
13730 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
13731 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
13732 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
13733 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
13734 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
Jérôme Magnin61275192018-02-07 11:39:58 +010013735 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets. When specified, return traffic
13736 uses the same interface as inbound traffic, and its associated routing table,
13737 even if there are explicit routes through different interfaces configured.
13738 This can prove useful to address asymmetric routing issues when the same
13739 client IP addresses need to be able to reach frontends hosted on different
13740 interfaces.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013741
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020013742level <level>
13743 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
13744 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
13745 sockets. <level> can be one of :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013746 - "user" is the least privileged level; only non-sensitive stats can be
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020013747 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
13748 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
13749 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013750 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (e.g. clear max
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020013751 counters).
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013752 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (e.g. clear
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020013753 all counters).
13754
Andjelko Iharosc4df59e2017-07-20 11:59:48 +020013755severity-output <format>
13756 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to configure severity
13757 level output prepended to informational feedback messages. Severity
13758 level of messages can range between 0 and 7, conforming to syslog
13759 rfc5424. Valid and successful socket commands requesting data
13760 (i.e. "show map", "get acl foo" etc.) will never have a severity level
13761 prepended. It is ignored by other sockets. <format> can be one of :
13762 - "none" (default) no severity level is prepended to feedback messages.
13763 - "number" severity level is prepended as a number.
13764 - "string" severity level is prepended as a string following the
13765 rfc5424 convention.
13766
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013767maxconn <maxconn>
13768 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
13769 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
13770 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
13771 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
13772 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
13773 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
13774 eat all memory.
13775
13776mode <mode>
13777 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
13778 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
13779 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
13780 UNIX sockets.
13781
13782mss <maxseg>
13783 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
13784 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
13785 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
13786 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
13787 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
13788 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
13789 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
13790 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
13791 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
13792 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
13793 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
13794
13795name <name>
13796 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
13797 page.
13798
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020013799namespace <name>
13800 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
13801 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a listener to
13802 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
13803 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
13804
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013805nice <nice>
13806 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
13807 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
13808 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
13809 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
13810 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
13811 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
13812 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
13813 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
13814 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
13815 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
13816 one for an RDP socket.
13817
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020013818no-ca-names
13819 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13820 prevents from send CA names in server hello message when ca-file is used.
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010013821 Use "ca-verify-file" instead of "ca-file" with "no-ca-names".
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020013822
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013823no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013824 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013825 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013826 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013827 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013828 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver" and
13829 "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013830
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020013831no-tls-tickets
13832 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13833 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
13834 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013835 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
13836 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010013837 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
13838 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
13839 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020013840
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013841no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013842 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013843 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013844 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013845 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013846 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
13847 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013848
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013849no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013850 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013851 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013852 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013853 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013854 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
13855 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013856
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013857no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013858 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013859 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013860 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013861 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013862 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
13863 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013864
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013865no-tlsv13
13866 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13867 disables support for TLSv1.3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
13868 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
13869 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013870 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
13871 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013872
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020013873npn <protocols>
13874 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
13875 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
13876 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013877 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020013878 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010013879 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
13880 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2. If HTTP/2 is desired on an older
13881 version of OpenSSL, NPN might still be used as most clients still support it
13882 at the time of writing this. It is possible to enable both NPN and ALPN
13883 though it probably doesn't make any sense out of testing.
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020013884
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000013885prefer-client-ciphers
13886 Use the client's preference when selecting the cipher suite, by default
13887 the server's preference is enforced. This option is also available on
13888 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribus926594f2018-05-18 17:55:57 +020013889 Note that with OpenSSL >= 1.1.1 ChaCha20-Poly1305 is reprioritized anyway
13890 (without setting this option), if a ChaCha20-Poly1305 cipher is at the top of
13891 the client cipher list.
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000013892
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010013893process <process-set>[/<thread-set>]
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010013894 This restricts the list of processes or threads on which this listener is
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010013895 allowed to run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013896 not match. If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010013897 between the two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run
13898 on any remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either
13899 run on the first process of the listener if a single process was specified,
13900 or on all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. If a thread
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013901 set is specified, it limits the threads allowed to process incoming
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010013902 connections for this listener, for the the process set. If multiple processes
13903 and threads are configured, a warning is emitted, as it either results from a
13904 configuration error or a misunderstanding of these models. For the unlikely
13905 case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be repeated.
13906 <process-set> and <thread-set> must use the format
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010013907
13908 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
13909
13910 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
13911 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value. The main purpose of
13912 this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have one different
13913 socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind lines sharing
13914 the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so that the system
13915 can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues and allow a
13916 smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and above is known
13917 for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +020013918
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020013919proto <name>
13920 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the incoming connections. It
13921 must be compatible with the mode of the frontend (TCP or HTTP). It must also
13922 be usable on the frontend side. The list of available protocols is reported
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010013923 in haproxy -vv. The protocols properties are reported : the mode (TCP/HTTP),
13924 the side (FE/BE), the mux name and its flags.
13925
13926 Some protocols report errors on aborts (flag=CLEAN_ABRT). Some others are
13927 subject to the head-of-line blocking on server side (flag=HOL_RISK). Finally
13928 some protocols don't support upgrades (flag=NO_UPG). The HTX compatibility is
13929 also reported (flag=HTX).
13930
13931 Here are the protocols that may be used as argument to a "proto" directive on
13932 a bind line :
13933
13934 h2 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H2 flags=HTX|CLEAN_ABRT|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
13935 h1 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H1 flags=HTX|NO_UPG
13936 none : mode=TCP side=FE|BE mux=PASS flags=NO_UPG
13937
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040013938 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020013939 protocol for all connections instantiated from this listening socket. For
Joseph Herlant71b4b152018-11-13 16:55:16 -080013940 instance, it is possible to force the http/2 on clear TCP by specifying "proto
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020013941 h2" on the bind line.
13942
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013943ssl
13944 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013945 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013946 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
13947 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
Emmanuel Hocdetbd695fe2017-05-15 15:53:41 +020013948 to deciphered contents. SSLv3 is disabled per default, use "ssl-min-ver SSLv3"
13949 to enable it.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013950
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013951ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
13952 This option enforces use of <version> or lower on SSL connections instantiated
William Lallemand50df1cb2020-06-02 10:52:24 +020013953 from this listener. Using this setting without "ssl-min-ver" can be
13954 ambiguous because the default ssl-min-ver value could change in future HAProxy
13955 versions. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013956 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
13957
13958ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
William Lallemand50df1cb2020-06-02 10:52:24 +020013959 This option enforces use of <version> or upper on SSL connections
13960 instantiated from this listener. The default value is "TLSv1.2". This option
13961 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
13962 See also "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013963
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +010013964strict-sni
13965 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
13966 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
William Lallemand929da3e2023-04-04 16:28:58 +020013967 a certificate. The default certificate is not used. This option also allows
13968 to start without any certificate on a bind line, so an empty directory could
13969 be used and filled later from the stats socket.
13970 See the "crt" option for more information. See "add ssl crt-list" command in
13971 the management guide.
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +010013972
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010013973tcp-ut <delay>
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010013974 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instantiated from this
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010013975 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013976 allows HAProxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013977 receiving an acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010013978 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
13979 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
13980 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
13981 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
13982 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
13983 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
13984 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
13985
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020013986tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +010013987 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020013988 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
13989 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
13990 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
13991 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
13992 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
13993 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
13994 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +020013995 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
13996 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
13997 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020013998
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010013999tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
14000 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
Emeric Brun9e754772019-01-10 17:51:55 +010014001 or 80 bytes long, depending if aes128 or aes256 is used, encoded with base64
14002 with one line per key (ex. openssl rand 80 | openssl base64 -A | xargs echo).
14003 The first key determines the key length used for next keys: you can't mix
14004 aes128 and aes256 keys. Number of keys is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO
14005 build option (default 3) and at least as many keys need to be present in
14006 the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be used for decryption and the
14007 penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy key rotation by just
14008 appending new key to the file and reloading the process. Keys must be
14009 periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy is
14010 compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010014011 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
14012 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
14013
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014014transparent
14015 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
14016 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
14017 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
14018 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
14019 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
14020 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
14021 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
14022 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
14023 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
14024 so check for support with your vendor.
14025
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010014026v4v6
14027 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
14028 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
14029 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
14030 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014031 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010014032
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010014033v6only
14034 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
14035 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
14036 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010014037 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
14038 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010014039
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014040uid <uid>
14041 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
14042 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
14043 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
14044 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
14045 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
14046
14047user <user>
14048 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
14049 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
14050 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
14051 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
14052 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
14053
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020014054verify [none|optional|required]
14055 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
14056 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
14057 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
14058 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
14059 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020014060 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
14061 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
14062 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
14063 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020014064
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200140655.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010014066------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014067
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010014068The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
14069which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
14070arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
14071settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
14072after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
14073Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
14074address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014075
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014076 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010014077 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014078
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014079Note that all these settings are supported both by "server" and "default-server"
14080keywords, except "id" which is only supported by "server".
14081
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014082The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014083
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020014084addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014085 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
Baptiste Assmann13f83532016-03-06 23:14:36 +010014086 to send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
14087 desirable to dedicate an IP address to specific component able to perform
14088 complex tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application.
14089 This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the
14090 "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014091
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014092agent-check
14093 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014094 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
Willy Tarreau7a0139e2018-12-16 08:42:56 +010014095 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string
14096 terminated by the first '\r' or '\n' met. The string is made of a series of
14097 words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas in any order, each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014098
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014099 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014100 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014101 weight of a server as configured when HAProxy starts. Note that a zero
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +020014102 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
14103 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014104
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014105 - The string "maxconn:" followed by an integer (no space between). Values
14106 in this format will set the maxconn of a server. The maximum number of
14107 connections advertised needs to be multiplied by the number of load
14108 balancers and different backends that use this health check to get the
14109 total number of connections the server might receive. Example: maxconn:30
Nenad Merdanovic174dd372016-04-24 23:10:06 +020014110
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014111 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014112 READY mode, thus canceling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014113
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014114 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
14115 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
14116 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014117
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014118 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
14119 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
14120 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014121
William Dauchyf8e795c2020-09-26 13:35:51 +020014122 - The words "down", "fail", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014123 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
14124 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
14125 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
14126 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014127 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (e.g. missing process,
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014128 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014129
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014130 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
14131 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014132
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014133 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
14134 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
14135 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
14136 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
14137 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
14138 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
14139 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
14140 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
14141 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014142
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090014143 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
14144 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014145 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
14146 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
14147 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +010014148 force an agent's result in order to work around a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090014149
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014150 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014151 and "no-agent-check" parameters.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014152
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070014153agent-send <string>
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014154 If this option is specified, HAProxy will send the given string (verbatim)
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070014155 to the agent server upon connection. You could, for example, encode
14156 the backend name into this string, which would enable your agent to send
14157 different responses based on the backend. Make sure to include a '\n' if
14158 you want to terminate your request with a newline.
14159
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014160agent-inter <delay>
14161 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
14162 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
14163
14164 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
14165 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
14166 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
14167 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
14168 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
14169 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
14170 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
14171 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
14172 of backends use the same servers.
14173
14174 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
14175
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010014176agent-addr <addr>
14177 The "agent-addr" parameter sets address for agent check.
14178
14179 You can offload agent-check to another target, so you can make single place
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014180 managing status and weights of servers defined in HAProxy in case you can't
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010014181 make self-aware and self-managing services. You can specify both IP or
14182 hostname, it will be resolved.
14183
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014184agent-port <port>
14185 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
14186
14187 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
14188
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020014189allow-0rtt
14190 Allow sending early data to the server when using TLS 1.3.
Olivier Houchard22c9b442019-05-06 19:01:04 +020014191 Note that early data will be sent only if the client used early data, or
14192 if the backend uses "retry-on" with the "0rtt-rejected" keyword.
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020014193
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010014194alpn <protocols>
14195 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
14196 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
14197 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014198 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010014199 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
14200 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to connect to HTTP/2 servers.
14201 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
14202 now obsolete NPN extension.
14203 If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1 are expected to be supported, both versions can
14204 be advertised, in order of preference, like below :
14205
14206 server 127.0.0.1:443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
14207
Amaury Denoyelle69352ec2021-10-18 14:40:29 +020014208 See also "ws" to use an alternative ALPN for websocket streams.
14209
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014210backup
14211 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
14212 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
14213 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
14214 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014215 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "no-backup" and
14216 "allbackups" options.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014217
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020014218ca-file <cafile>
14219 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14220 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
14221 server's certificate.
14222
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014223check
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020014224 This option enables health checks on a server:
14225 - when not set, no health checking is performed, and the server is always
14226 considered available.
14227 - when set and no other check method is configured, the server is considered
14228 available when a connection can be established at the highest configured
14229 transport layer. This means TCP by default, or SSL/TLS when "ssl" or
14230 "check-ssl" are set, both possibly combined with connection prefixes such
14231 as a PROXY protocol header when "send-proxy" or "check-send-proxy" are
14232 set.
14233 - when set and an application-level health check is defined, the
14234 application-level exchanges are performed on top of the configured
14235 transport layer and the server is considered available if all of the
14236 exchanges succeed.
14237
14238 By default, health checks are performed on the same address and port as
14239 configured on the server, using the same encapsulation parameters (SSL/TLS,
14240 proxy-protocol header, etc... ). It is possible to change the destination
14241 address using "addr" and the port using "port". When done, it is assumed the
14242 server isn't checked on the service port, and configured encapsulation
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +050014243 parameters are not reused. One must explicitly set "check-send-proxy" to send
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020014244 connection headers, "check-ssl" to use SSL/TLS.
14245
14246 When "sni" or "alpn" are set on the server line, their value is not used for
14247 health checks and one must use "check-sni" or "check-alpn".
14248
14249 The default source address for health check traffic is the same as the one
14250 defined in the backend. It can be changed with the "source" keyword.
14251
14252 The interval between checks can be set using the "inter" keyword, and the
14253 "rise" and "fall" keywords can be used to define how many successful or
14254 failed health checks are required to flag a server available or not
14255 available.
14256
14257 Optional application-level health checks can be configured with "option
14258 httpchk", "option mysql-check" "option smtpchk", "option pgsql-check",
14259 "option ldap-check", or "option redis-check".
14260
14261 Example:
14262 # simple tcp check
14263 backend foo
14264 server s1 192.168.0.1:80 check
14265 # this does a tcp connect + tls handshake
14266 backend foo
14267 server s1 192.168.0.1:443 ssl check
14268 # simple tcp check is enough for check success
14269 backend foo
14270 option tcp-check
14271 tcp-check connect
14272 server s1 192.168.0.1:443 ssl check
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014273
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +020014274check-send-proxy
14275 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
14276 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
14277 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
14278 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
14279 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
14280 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
14281 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
14282
Olivier Houchard92150142018-12-21 19:47:01 +010014283check-alpn <protocols>
14284 Defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol list consists in
14285 a comma-delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0"
14286 (without quotes). If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
14287
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020014288check-proto <name>
14289 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the server's health-check
14290 connections. It must be compatible with the health-check type (TCP or
14291 HTTP). It must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010014292 protocols is reported in haproxy -vv. The protocols properties are
14293 reported : the mode (TCP/HTTP), the side (FE/BE), the mux name and its flags.
14294
14295 Some protocols report errors on aborts (flag=CLEAN_ABRT). Some others are
14296 subject to the head-of-line blocking on server side (flag=HOL_RISK). Finally
14297 some protocols don't support upgrades (flag=NO_UPG). The HTX compatibility is
14298 also reported (flag=HTX).
14299
14300 Here are the protocols that may be used as argument to a "check-proto"
14301 directive on a server line:
14302
14303 h2 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H2 flags=HTX|CLEAN_ABRT|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
14304 fcgi : mode=HTTP side=BE mux=FCGI flags=HTX|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
14305 h1 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H1 flags=HTX|NO_UPG
14306 none : mode=TCP side=FE|BE mux=PASS flags=NO_UPG
14307
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040014308 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020014309 protocol for health-check connections established to this server.
14310 If not defined, the server one will be used, if set.
14311
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010014312check-sni <sni>
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020014313 This option allows you to specify the SNI to be used when doing health checks
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010014314 over SSL. It is only possible to use a string to set <sni>. If you want to
14315 set a SNI for proxied traffic, see "sni".
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020014316
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014317check-ssl
14318 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
14319 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
14320 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
14321 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014322 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014323 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
14324 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014325 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (e.g. ciphers).
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014326 See the "ssl" option for more information and "no-check-ssl" to disable
14327 this option.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014328
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080014329check-via-socks4
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014330 This option enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy. By
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080014331 default, the health checks won't go through socks tunnel even it was enabled
14332 for normal traffic.
14333
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014334ciphers <ciphers>
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020014335 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. This
14336 option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
14337 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000014338 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
14339 information and recommendations see e.g.
14340 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
14341 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
14342 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014343
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020014344ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
14345 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
14346 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. This option sets the string
14347 describing the list of cipher algorithms that is negotiated during the TLS
14348 1.3 handshake with the server. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000014349 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section.
14350 For cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers"
14351 keyword.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020014352
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014353cookie <value>
14354 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
14355 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
14356 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
14357 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
14358 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
14359 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
14360 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
14361
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020014362crl-file <crlfile>
14363 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14364 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
14365 to verify server's certificate.
14366
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +020014367crt <cert>
14368 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
14369 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
14370 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
14371 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
14372 certificate request.
14373
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +020014374 If the file does not contain a private key, HAProxy will try to load the key
14375 at the same path suffixed by a ".key" (provided the "ssl-load-extra-files"
14376 option is set accordingly).
14377
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020014378disabled
14379 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
14380 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
14381 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
14382 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
14383 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014384 See also "enabled" setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020014385
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014386enabled
14387 This option may be used as 'server' setting to reset any 'disabled'
14388 setting which would have been inherited from 'default-server' directive as
14389 default value.
14390 It may also be used as 'default-server' setting to reset any previous
14391 'default-server' 'disabled' setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020014392
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014393error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010014394 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
14395 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
14396 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014397
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014398 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014399
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014400fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014401 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
14402 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
14403 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
14404
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014405force-sslv3
14406 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
14407 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014408 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014409 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014410
14411force-tlsv10
14412 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014413 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014414 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014415
14416force-tlsv11
14417 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014418 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014419 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014420
14421force-tlsv12
14422 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014423 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014424 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014425
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020014426force-tlsv13
14427 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
14428 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014429 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020014430
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014431id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +020014432 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
14433 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
14434 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014435
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010014436init-addr {last | libc | none | <ip>},[...]*
14437 Indicate in what order the server's address should be resolved upon startup
14438 if it uses an FQDN. Attempts are made to resolve the address by applying in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014439 turn each of the methods mentioned in the comma-delimited list. The first
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010014440 method which succeeds is used. If the end of the list is reached without
14441 finding a working method, an error is thrown. Method "last" suggests to pick
14442 the address which appears in the state file (see "server-state-file"). Method
14443 "libc" uses the libc's internal resolver (gethostbyname() or getaddrinfo()
14444 depending on the operating system and build options). Method "none"
14445 specifically indicates that the server should start without any valid IP
14446 address in a down state. It can be useful to ignore some DNS issues upon
14447 startup, waiting for the situation to get fixed later. Finally, an IP address
14448 (IPv4 or IPv6) may be provided. It can be the currently known address of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014449 server (e.g. filled by a configuration generator), or the address of a dummy
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010014450 server used to catch old sessions and present them with a decent error
14451 message for example. When the "first" load balancing algorithm is used, this
14452 IP address could point to a fake server used to trigger the creation of new
14453 instances on the fly. This option defaults to "last,libc" indicating that the
14454 previous address found in the state file (if any) is used first, otherwise
14455 the libc's resolver is used. This ensures continued compatibility with the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014456 historic behavior.
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010014457
14458 Example:
14459 defaults
14460 # never fail on address resolution
14461 default-server init-addr last,libc,none
14462
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014463inter <delay>
14464fastinter <delay>
14465downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014466 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
14467 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
14468 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
14469 between checks depending on the server state :
14470
Pieter Baauw44fc9df2015-09-17 21:30:46 +020014471 Server state | Interval used
14472 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
14473 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
14474 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
14475 Transitionally UP (going down "fall"), | "fastinter" if set,
14476 Transitionally DOWN (going up "rise"), | "inter" otherwise.
14477 or yet unchecked. |
14478 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
14479 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set,
14480 | "inter" otherwise.
14481 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010014482
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014483 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
14484 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
14485 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
14486 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014487 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
14488 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
14489 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
14490 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
14491 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014492
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +020014493log-proto <logproto>
14494 The "log-proto" specifies the protocol used to forward event messages to
14495 a server configured in a ring section. Possible values are "legacy"
14496 and "octet-count" corresponding respectively to "Non-transparent-framing"
14497 and "Octet counting" in rfc6587. "legacy" is the default.
14498
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014499maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014500 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
14501 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010014502 concurrent connections goes higher than this value, they will be queued,
14503 waiting for a slot to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014504 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
14505 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
14506 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
14507 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
14508
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010014509 In HTTP mode this parameter limits the number of concurrent requests instead
14510 of the number of connections. Multiple requests might be multiplexed over a
14511 single TCP connection to the server. As an example if you specify a maxconn
14512 of 50 you might see between 1 and 50 actual server connections, but no more
14513 than 50 concurrent requests.
14514
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014515maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014516 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
14517 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
14518 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
14519 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
Willy Tarreau8ae8c482020-10-22 17:19:07 +020014520 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. Some load
14521 balancing algorithms such as leastconn take this into account and accept to
14522 add requests into a server's queue up to this value if it is explicitly set
14523 to a value greater than zero, which often allows to better smooth the load
14524 when dealing with single-digit maxconn values. The default value is "0" which
14525 means the queue is unlimited. See also the "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters
14526 and "balance leastconn".
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014527
Willy Tarreau9c538e02019-01-23 10:21:49 +010014528max-reuse <count>
14529 The "max-reuse" argument indicates the HTTP connection processors that they
14530 should not reuse a server connection more than this number of times to send
14531 new requests. Permitted values are -1 (the default), which disables this
14532 limit, or any positive value. Value zero will effectively disable keep-alive.
14533 This is only used to work around certain server bugs which cause them to leak
14534 resources over time. The argument is not necessarily respected by the lower
14535 layers as there might be technical limitations making it impossible to
14536 enforce. At least HTTP/2 connections to servers will respect it.
14537
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014538minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014539 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
14540 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
14541 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
14542 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
14543 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
14544 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010014545 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014546 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014547
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020014548namespace <name>
14549 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
14550 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a server to
14551 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
14552 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
14553
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014554no-agent-check
14555 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "agent-check"
14556 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14557 default value.
14558 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14559 "default-server" "agent-check" setting.
14560
14561no-backup
14562 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "backup"
14563 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14564 default value.
14565 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14566 "default-server" "backup" setting.
14567
14568no-check
14569 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check"
14570 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14571 default value.
14572 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14573 "default-server" "check" setting.
14574
14575no-check-ssl
14576 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check-ssl"
14577 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14578 default value.
14579 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14580 "default-server" "check-ssl" setting.
14581
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014582no-send-proxy
14583 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy"
14584 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14585 default value.
14586 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14587 "default-server" "send-proxy" setting.
14588
14589no-send-proxy-v2
14590 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2"
14591 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14592 default value.
14593 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14594 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2" setting.
14595
14596no-send-proxy-v2-ssl
14597 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl"
14598 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14599 default value.
14600 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14601 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl" setting.
14602
14603no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
14604 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"
14605 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14606 default value.
14607 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14608 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" setting.
14609
14610no-ssl
14611 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "ssl"
14612 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14613 default value.
14614 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14615 "default-server" "ssl" setting.
14616
William Dauchyf6370442020-11-14 19:25:33 +010014617 Note that using `default-server ssl` setting and `no-ssl` on server will
14618 however init SSL connection, so it can be later be enabled through the
14619 runtime API: see `set server` commands in management doc.
14620
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +010014621no-ssl-reuse
14622 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
14623 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
14624 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
14625 and for paranoid users.
14626
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014627no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014628 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
14629 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014630 using any configuration option. Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014631
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020014632 Supported in default-server: No
14633
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020014634no-tls-tickets
14635 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14636 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
14637 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014638 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
14639 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010014640 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
14641 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
14642 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014643 See also "tls-tickets".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020014644
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014645no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014646 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020014647 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
14648 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014649 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
14650 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014651 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014652
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020014653 Supported in default-server: No
14654
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014655no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014656 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020014657 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
14658 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014659 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
14660 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014661 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014662
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020014663 Supported in default-server: No
14664
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014665no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014666 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014667 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
14668 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014669 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
14670 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014671 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020014672
14673 Supported in default-server: No
14674
14675no-tlsv13
14676 This option disables support for TLSv1.3 when SSL is used to communicate with
14677 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
14678 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
14679 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
14680 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014681 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014682
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020014683 Supported in default-server: No
14684
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014685no-verifyhost
14686 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "verifyhost"
14687 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14688 default value.
14689 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14690 "default-server" "verifyhost" setting.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014691
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020014692no-tfo
14693 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "tfo"
14694 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14695 default value.
14696 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14697 "default-server" "tfo" setting.
14698
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +090014699non-stick
14700 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
14701 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
14702 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
14703
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010014704npn <protocols>
14705 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
14706 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
14707 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014708 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010014709 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
14710 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
14711 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2.
14712
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014713observe <mode>
14714 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
14715 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
14716 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
14717 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
14718 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
14719 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +010014720 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014721
14722 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
14723
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014724on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014725 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
14726 Currently, four modes are available:
14727 - fastinter: force fastinter
14728 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
14729 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
14730 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
14731 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
14732
14733 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
14734
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090014735on-marked-down <action>
14736 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
14737 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070014738 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
14739 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
14740 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
14741 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
14742 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
14743 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
14744 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
14745 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090014746
14747 Actions are disabled by default
14748
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070014749on-marked-up <action>
14750 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
14751 Currently one action is available:
14752 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
14753 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
14754 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
14755 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014756 with long sessions (e.g. LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
14757 than it tries to solve (e.g. incomplete transactions), so use this feature
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070014758 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
14759 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
14760
14761 Actions are disabled by default
14762
Willy Tarreau2f3f4d32020-07-01 07:43:51 +020014763pool-low-conn <max>
14764 Set a low threshold on the number of idling connections for a server, below
14765 which a thread will not try to steal a connection from another thread. This
14766 can be useful to improve CPU usage patterns in scenarios involving many very
14767 fast servers, in order to ensure all threads will keep a few idle connections
14768 all the time instead of letting them accumulate over one thread and migrating
14769 them from thread to thread. Typical values of twice the number of threads
14770 seem to show very good performance already with sub-millisecond response
14771 times. The default is zero, indicating that any idle connection can be used
14772 at any time. It is the recommended setting for normal use. This only applies
14773 to connections that can be shared according to the same principles as those
Willy Tarreau0784db82021-02-19 11:45:22 +010014774 applying to "http-reuse". In case connection sharing between threads would
14775 be disabled via "tune.idle-pool.shared", it can become very important to use
14776 this setting to make sure each thread always has a few connections, or the
14777 connection reuse rate will decrease as thread count increases.
Willy Tarreau2f3f4d32020-07-01 07:43:51 +020014778
Olivier Houchard006e3102018-12-10 18:30:32 +010014779pool-max-conn <max>
14780 Set the maximum number of idling connections for a server. -1 means unlimited
14781 connections, 0 means no idle connections. The default is -1. When idle
14782 connections are enabled, orphaned idle connections which do not belong to any
14783 client session anymore are moved to a dedicated pool so that they remain
14784 usable by future clients. This only applies to connections that can be shared
14785 according to the same principles as those applying to "http-reuse".
14786
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010014787pool-purge-delay <delay>
14788 Sets the delay to start purging idle connections. Each <delay> interval, half
Olivier Houcharda56eebf2019-03-19 16:44:02 +010014789 of the idle connections are closed. 0 means we don't keep any idle connection.
Willy Tarreaufb553652019-06-04 14:06:31 +020014790 The default is 5s.
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010014791
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014792port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014793 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
William Dauchy4858fb22021-02-03 22:30:09 +010014794 send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
14795 desirable to dedicate a port to a specific component able to perform complex
14796 tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application. It is
14797 common to run a simple script in inetd for instance. This parameter is
14798 ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the "addr" parameter.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014799
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020014800proto <name>
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020014801 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the outgoing connections to this
14802 server. It must be compatible with the mode of the backend (TCP or HTTP). It
14803 must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available protocols is
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010014804 reported in haproxy -vv.The protocols properties are reported : the mode
14805 (TCP/HTTP), the side (FE/BE), the mux name and its flags.
14806
14807 Some protocols report errors on aborts (flag=CLEAN_ABRT). Some others are
14808 subject to the head-of-line blocking on server side (flag=HOL_RISK). Finally
14809 some protocols don't support upgrades (flag=NO_UPG). The HTX compatibility is
14810 also reported (flag=HTX).
14811
14812 Here are the protocols that may be used as argument to a "proto" directive on
14813 a server line :
14814
14815 h2 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H2 flags=HTX|CLEAN_ABRT|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
14816 fcgi : mode=HTTP side=BE mux=FCGI flags=HTX|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
14817 h1 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H1 flags=HTX|NO_UPG
14818 none : mode=TCP side=FE|BE mux=PASS flags=NO_UPG
14819
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040014820 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020014821 protocol for all connections established to this server.
14822
Amaury Denoyelle69352ec2021-10-18 14:40:29 +020014823 See also "ws" to use an alternative protocol for websocket streams.
14824
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014825redir <prefix>
14826 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
14827 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
14828 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
14829 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
14830 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
14831 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
14832 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
14833 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010014834 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014835 requests are still analyzed, making this solution completely usable to direct
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014836 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
14837 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
14838 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
14839 loop between the client and HAProxy!
14840
14841 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
14842
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014843rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014844 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
14845 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
14846 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
14847
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020014848resolve-opts <option>,<option>,...
14849 Comma separated list of options to apply to DNS resolution linked to this
14850 server.
14851
14852 Available options:
14853
14854 * allow-dup-ip
14855 By default, HAProxy prevents IP address duplication in a backend when DNS
14856 resolution at runtime is in operation.
14857 That said, for some cases, it makes sense that two servers (in the same
14858 backend, being resolved by the same FQDN) have the same IP address.
14859 For such case, simply enable this option.
14860 This is the opposite of prevent-dup-ip.
14861
Daniel Corbettf8716912019-11-17 09:48:56 -050014862 * ignore-weight
14863 Ignore any weight that is set within an SRV record. This is useful when
14864 you would like to control the weights using an alternate method, such as
14865 using an "agent-check" or through the runtime api.
14866
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020014867 * prevent-dup-ip
14868 Ensure HAProxy's default behavior is enforced on a server: prevent re-using
14869 an IP address already set to a server in the same backend and sharing the
14870 same fqdn.
14871 This is the opposite of allow-dup-ip.
14872
14873 Example:
14874 backend b_myapp
14875 default-server init-addr none resolvers dns
14876 server s1 myapp.example.com:80 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
14877 server s2 myapp.example.com:81 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
14878
14879 With the option allow-dup-ip set:
14880 * if the nameserver returns a single IP address, then both servers will use
14881 it
14882 * If the nameserver returns 2 IP addresses, then each server will pick up a
14883 different address
14884
14885 Default value: not set
14886
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014887resolve-prefer <family>
14888 When DNS resolution is enabled for a server and multiple IP addresses from
14889 different families are returned, HAProxy will prefer using an IP address
14890 from the family mentioned in the "resolve-prefer" parameter.
14891 Available families: "ipv4" and "ipv6"
14892
Baptiste Assmannc4aabae2015-08-04 22:43:06 +020014893 Default value: ipv6
14894
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014895 Example:
14896
14897 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-prefer ipv6
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014898
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010014899resolve-net <network>[,<network[,...]]
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014900 This option prioritizes the choice of an ip address matching a network. This is
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010014901 useful with clouds to prefer a local ip. In some cases, a cloud high
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010014902 availability service can be announced with many ip addresses on many
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014903 different datacenters. The latency between datacenter is not negligible, so
14904 this patch permits to prefer a local datacenter. If no address matches the
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010014905 configured network, another address is selected.
14906
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014907 Example:
14908
14909 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-net 10.0.0.0/8
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010014910
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014911resolvers <id>
14912 Points to an existing "resolvers" section to resolve current server's
14913 hostname.
14914
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014915 Example:
14916
14917 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 check resolvers mydns
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014918
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014919 See also section 5.3
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014920
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010014921send-proxy
14922 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
14923 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
14924 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
14925 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010014926 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" or
14927 "accept-netscaler-cip" listener, the advertised address will be used. Only
14928 TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families are supported. Other families such as
14929 Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN family. Servers using this option can
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014930 fully be chained to another instance of HAProxy listening with an
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010014931 "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be used if the server isn't
14932 aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent to the server, the PROXY
14933 protocol is automatically used when this option is set, unless there is an
14934 explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an explicit
14935 "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014936 See also the "no-send-proxy" option of this section and "accept-proxy" and
14937 "accept-netscaler-cip" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010014938
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014939send-proxy-v2
14940 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
14941 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
14942 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
14943 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
Emmanuel Hocdet404d9782017-10-24 10:55:14 +020014944 whatever the upper layer protocol. It also send ALPN information if an alpn
14945 have been negotiated. This setting must not be used if the server isn't aware
14946 of this version of the protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2" option of
14947 this section and send-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014948
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010014949proxy-v2-options <option>[,<option>]*
Tim Duesterhuscf6e0c82020-03-13 12:34:24 +010014950 The "proxy-v2-options" parameter add options to send in PROXY protocol
14951 version 2 when "send-proxy-v2" is used. Options available are:
14952
14953 - ssl : See also "send-proxy-v2-ssl".
14954 - cert-cn : See also "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn".
14955 - ssl-cipher: Name of the used cipher.
14956 - cert-sig : Signature algorithm of the used certificate.
14957 - cert-key : Key algorithm of the used certificate
14958 - authority : Host name value passed by the client (only SNI from a TLS
14959 connection is supported).
14960 - crc32c : Checksum of the PROXYv2 header.
14961 - unique-id : Send a unique ID generated using the frontend's
14962 "unique-id-format" within the PROXYv2 header.
14963 This unique-id is primarily meant for "mode tcp". It can
14964 lead to unexpected results in "mode http", because the
14965 generated unique ID is also used for the first HTTP request
14966 within a Keep-Alive connection.
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010014967
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014968send-proxy-v2-ssl
14969 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
14970 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
14971 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
14972 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
14973 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
14974 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
14975 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014976 See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl" option of this section and the
14977 "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014978
14979send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
14980 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
14981 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
14982 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
14983 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
14984 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
14985 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
14986 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
14987 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014988 protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" option of this section and
14989 the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014990
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014991slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014992 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
14993 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
14994 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
14995 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
14996 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
14997 parameters :
14998
14999 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
15000 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
15001
15002 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
15003 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
15004 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
15005 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
15006
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015007 The slowstart never applies when HAProxy starts, otherwise it would cause
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015008 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
15009 seen as failed.
15010
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020015011sni <expression>
15012 The "sni" parameter evaluates the sample fetch expression, converts it to a
15013 string and uses the result as the host name sent in the SNI TLS extension to
15014 the server. A typical use case is to send the SNI received from the client in
Willy Tarreau000d4002022-11-25 10:12:12 +010015015 a bridged TCP/SSL scenario, using the "ssl_fc_sni" sample fetch for the
15016 expression. THIS MUST NOT BE USED FOR HTTPS, where req.hdr(host) should be
15017 used instead, since SNI in HTTPS must always match the Host field and clients
15018 are allowed to use different host names over the same connection). If
Willy Tarreau2ab88672017-07-05 18:23:03 +020015019 "verify required" is set (which is the recommended setting), the resulting
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020015020 name will also be matched against the server certificate's names. See the
Jérôme Magninb36a6d22018-12-09 16:03:40 +010015021 "verify" directive for more details. If you want to set a SNI for health
15022 checks, see the "check-sni" directive for more details.
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020015023
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020015024source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020015025source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020015026source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015027 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
15028 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
15029 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
15030 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
15031
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020015032 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
15033 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
15034 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
15035 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
15036 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
15037 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
15038 server.
15039
Lukas Tribus7d56c6d2016-09-13 09:51:15 +000015040 Since Linux 4.2/libc 2.23 IP_BIND_ADDRESS_NO_PORT is set for connections
15041 specifying the source address without port(s).
15042
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020015043ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020015044 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
15045 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
15046 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
15047 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
15048 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
15049 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015050 See the "no-ssl" to disable "ssl" option and "check-ssl" option to force
15051 SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020015052
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020015053ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
15054 This option enforces use of <version> or lower when SSL is used to communicate
15055 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
15056 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
15057
15058ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
15059 This option enforces use of <version> or upper when SSL is used to communicate
15060 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
15061 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
15062
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015063ssl-reuse
15064 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-ssl-reuse"
15065 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
15066 default value.
15067 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
15068 "default-server" "no-ssl-reuse" setting.
15069
15070stick
15071 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "non-stick"
15072 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
15073 default value.
15074 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
15075 "default-server" "non-stick" setting.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020015076
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080015077socks4 <addr>:<port>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015078 This option enables upstream socks4 tunnel for outgoing connections to the
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080015079 server. Using this option won't force the health check to go via socks4 by
15080 default. You will have to use the keyword "check-via-socks4" to enable it.
15081
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020015082tcp-ut <delay>
15083 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all outgoing connections to this server. This
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015084 option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It allows HAProxy to
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020015085 configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not receiving an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015086 acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially useful on
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020015087 long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as remote
15088 terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server timeouts
15089 must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is important to
15090 detect that the server has disappeared in order to release all resources
15091 associated with its connection (and the client's session). One typical use
15092 case is also to force dead server connections to die when health checks are
15093 too slow or during a soft reload since health checks are then disabled. The
15094 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works for
15095 regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
15096
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010015097tfo
15098 This option enables using TCP fast open when connecting to servers, on
15099 systems that support it (currently only the Linux kernel >= 4.11).
15100 See the "tfo" bind option for more information about TCP fast open.
15101 Please note that when using tfo, you should also use the "conn-failure",
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015102 "empty-response" and "response-timeout" keywords for "retry-on", or HAProxy
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020015103 won't be able to retry the connection on failure. See also "no-tfo".
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010015104
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015105track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +020015106 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
15107 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
15108 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
15109 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015110 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
15111
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015112tls-tickets
15113 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-tls-tickets"
15114 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
15115 default value.
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010015116 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
15117 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
15118 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015119 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
Bjoern Jacke5ab7eb62020-02-13 14:16:16 +010015120 "default-server" "no-tls-tickets" setting.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010015121
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020015122verify [none|required]
15123 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +010015124 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020015125 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file' and
15126 optional CRLs from 'crl-file' after having checked that the names provided in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015127 the certificate's subject and subjectAlternateNames attributes match either
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020015128 the name passed using the "sni" directive, or if not provided, the static
15129 host name passed using the "verifyhost" directive. When no name is found, the
15130 certificate's names are ignored. For this reason, without SNI it's important
15131 to use "verifyhost". On verification failure the handshake is aborted. It is
15132 critically important to verify server certificates when using SSL to connect
15133 to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man-in-the-middle
15134 attacks rendering SSL totally useless. Unless "ssl_server_verify" appears in
15135 the global section, "verify" is set to "required" by default.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020015136
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070015137verifyhost <hostname>
15138 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020015139 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. This directive sets
15140 a default static hostname to check the server's certificate against when no
15141 SNI was used to connect to the server. If SNI is not used, this is the only
15142 way to enable hostname verification. This static hostname, when set, will
15143 also be used for health checks (which cannot provide an SNI value). If none
15144 of the hostnames in the certificate match the specified hostname, the
15145 handshake is aborted. The hostnames in the server-provided certificate may
15146 include wildcards. See also "verify", "sni" and "no-verifyhost" options.
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070015147
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010015148weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015149 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
15150 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
15151 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +020015152 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
15153 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
15154 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
15155 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
15156 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
15157 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015158
Amaury Denoyelle69352ec2021-10-18 14:40:29 +020015159ws { auto | h1 | h2 }
15160 This option allows to configure the protocol used when relaying websocket
15161 streams. This is most notably useful when using an HTTP/2 backend without the
15162 support for H2 websockets through the RFC8441.
15163
15164 The default mode is "auto". This will reuse the same protocol as the main
15165 one. The only difference is when using ALPN. In this case, it can try to
15166 downgrade the ALPN to "http/1.1" only for websocket streams if the configured
15167 server ALPN contains it.
15168
15169 The value "h1" is used to force HTTP/1.1 for websockets streams, through ALPN
15170 if SSL ALPN is activated for the server. Similarly, "h2" can be used to
15171 force HTTP/2.0 websockets. Use this value with care : the server must support
15172 RFC8441 or an error will be reported by haproxy when relaying websockets.
15173
15174 Note that NPN is not taken into account as its usage has been deprecated in
15175 favor of the ALPN extension.
15176
15177 See also "alpn" and "proto".
15178
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015179
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200151805.3. Server IP address resolution using DNS
15181-------------------------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015182
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015183HAProxy allows using a host name on the server line to retrieve its IP address
15184using name servers. By default, HAProxy resolves the name when parsing the
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -070015185configuration file, at startup and cache the result for the process's life.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015186This is not sufficient in some cases, such as in Amazon where a server's IP
15187can change after a reboot or an ELB Virtual IP can change based on current
15188workload.
15189This chapter describes how HAProxy can be configured to process server's name
15190resolution at run time.
15191Whether run time server name resolution has been enable or not, HAProxy will
15192carry on doing the first resolution when parsing the configuration.
15193
15194
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200151955.3.1. Global overview
15196----------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015197
15198As we've seen in introduction, name resolution in HAProxy occurs at two
15199different steps of the process life:
15200
15201 1. when starting up, HAProxy parses the server line definition and matches a
15202 host name. It uses libc functions to get the host name resolved. This
15203 resolution relies on /etc/resolv.conf file.
15204
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015205 2. at run time, HAProxy performs periodically name resolutions for servers
15206 requiring DNS resolutions.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015207
15208A few other events can trigger a name resolution at run time:
15209 - when a server's health check ends up in a connection timeout: this may be
15210 because the server has a new IP address. So we need to trigger a name
15211 resolution to know this new IP.
15212
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015213When using resolvers, the server name can either be a hostname, or a SRV label.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015214HAProxy considers anything that starts with an underscore as a SRV label. If a
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015215SRV label is specified, then the corresponding SRV records will be retrieved
15216from the DNS server, and the provided hostnames will be used. The SRV label
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015217will be checked periodically, and if any server are added or removed, HAProxy
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015218will automatically do the same.
Olivier Houchardecfa18d2017-08-07 17:30:03 +020015219
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015220A few things important to notice:
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015221 - all the name servers are queried in the meantime. HAProxy will process the
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015222 first valid response.
15223
15224 - a resolution is considered as invalid (NX, timeout, refused), when all the
15225 servers return an error.
15226
15227
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200152285.3.2. The resolvers section
15229----------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015230
15231This section is dedicated to host information related to name resolution in
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015232HAProxy. There can be as many as resolvers section as needed. Each section can
15233contain many name servers.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015234
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015235When multiple name servers are configured in a resolvers section, then HAProxy
15236uses the first valid response. In case of invalid responses, only the last one
15237is treated. Purpose is to give the chance to a slow server to deliver a valid
15238answer after a fast faulty or outdated server.
15239
15240When each server returns a different error type, then only the last error is
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015241used by HAProxy. The following processing is applied on this error:
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015242
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015243 1. HAProxy retries the same DNS query with a new query type. The A queries are
15244 switch to AAAA or the opposite. SRV queries are not concerned here. Timeout
15245 errors are also excluded.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015246
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015247 2. When the fallback on the query type was done (or not applicable), HAProxy
15248 retries the original DNS query, with the preferred query type.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015249
Thierry Fournierfc13f792021-12-15 19:03:52 +010015250 3. HAProxy retries previous steps <resolve_retries> times. If no valid
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015251 response is received after that, it stops the DNS resolution and reports
15252 the error.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015253
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015254For example, with 2 name servers configured in a resolvers section, the
15255following scenarios are possible:
15256
15257 - First response is valid and is applied directly, second response is
15258 ignored
15259
15260 - First response is invalid and second one is valid, then second response is
15261 applied
15262
15263 - First response is a NX domain and second one a truncated response, then
15264 HAProxy retries the query with a new type
15265
15266 - First response is a NX domain and second one is a timeout, then HAProxy
15267 retries the query with a new type
15268
15269 - Query timed out for both name servers, then HAProxy retries it with the
15270 same query type
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015271
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015272As a DNS server may not answer all the IPs in one DNS request, HAProxy keeps
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020015273a cache of previous answers, an answer will be considered obsolete after
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015274<hold obsolete> seconds without the IP returned.
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020015275
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015276
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015277resolvers <resolvers id>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015278 Creates a new name server list labeled <resolvers id>
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015279
15280A resolvers section accept the following parameters:
15281
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020015282accepted_payload_size <nb>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015283 Defines the maximum payload size accepted by HAProxy and announced to all the
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015284 name servers configured in this resolvers section.
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020015285 <nb> is in bytes. If not set, HAProxy announces 512. (minimal value defined
15286 by RFC 6891)
15287
Emeric Brun4c751952021-03-08 16:41:29 +010015288 Note: the maximum allowed value is 65535. Recommended value for UDP is
15289 4096 and it is not recommended to exceed 8192 except if you are sure
15290 that your system and network can handle this (over 65507 makes no sense
15291 since is the maximum UDP payload size). If you are using only TCP
15292 nameservers to handle huge DNS responses, you should put this value
15293 to the max: 65535.
Baptiste Assmann9d8dbbc2017-08-18 23:35:08 +020015294
Emeric Brunc8f3e452021-04-07 16:04:54 +020015295nameserver <name> <address>[:port] [param*]
15296 Used to configure a nameserver. <name> of the nameserver should ne unique.
15297 By default the <address> is considered of type datagram. This means if an
15298 IPv4 or IPv6 is configured without special address prefixes (paragraph 11.)
15299 the UDP protocol will be used. If an stream protocol address prefix is used,
15300 the nameserver will be considered as a stream server (TCP for instance) and
15301 "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph which are relevant for DNS
15302 resolving will be considered. Note: currently, in TCP mode, 4 queries are
15303 pipelined on the same connections. A batch of idle connections are removed
15304 every 5 seconds. "maxconn" can be configured to limit the amount of those
Emeric Brun56fc5d92021-02-12 20:05:45 +010015305 concurrent connections and TLS should also usable if the server supports.
15306
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060015307parse-resolv-conf
15308 Adds all nameservers found in /etc/resolv.conf to this resolvers nameservers
15309 list. Ordered as if each nameserver in /etc/resolv.conf was individually
15310 placed in the resolvers section in place of this directive.
15311
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015312hold <status> <period>
Christopher Fauletcd978582023-02-27 17:53:31 +010015313 Upon receiving the DNS response <status>, determines whether a server's state
15314 should change from UP to DOWN. To make that determination, it checks whether
15315 any valid status has been received during the past <period> in order to
15316 counteract the just received invalid status.
15317
15318 <status> : last name resolution status.
15319 nx After receiving an NXDOMAIN status, check for any valid
15320 status during the concluding period.
15321
15322 refused After receiving a REFUSED status, check for any valid
15323 status during the concluding period.
15324
15325 timeout After the "timeout retry" has struck, check for any
15326 valid status during the concluding period.
15327
15328 other After receiving any other invalid status, check for any
15329 valid status during the concluding period.
15330
15331 valid Applies only to "http-request do-resolve" and
15332 "tcp-request content do-resolve" actions. It defines the
15333 period for which the server will maintain a valid response
15334 before triggering another resolution. It does not affect
15335 dynamic resolution of servers.
15336
15337 obsolete Defines how long to wait before removing obsolete DNS
15338 records after an updated answer record is received. It
15339 applies to SRV records.
15340
15341 <period> : Amount of time into the past during which a valid response must
15342 have been received. It follows the HAProxy time format and is in
15343 milliseconds by default.
15344
15345 For a server that relies on dynamic DNS resolution to determine its IP
15346 address, receiving an invalid DNS response, such as NXDOMAIN, will lead to
15347 changing the server's state from UP to DOWN. The hold directives define how
15348 far into the past to look for a valid response. If a valid response has been
15349 received within <period>, the just received invalid status will be ignored.
15350
15351 Unless a valid response has been receiving during the concluding period, the
15352 server will be marked as DOWN. For example, if "hold nx 30s" is set and the
15353 last received DNS response was NXDOMAIN, the server will be marked DOWN
15354 unless a valid response has been received during the last 30 seconds.
15355
15356 A server in the DOWN state will be marked UP immediately upon receiving a
15357 valid status from the DNS server.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015358
Christopher Fauletcd978582023-02-27 17:53:31 +010015359 A separate behavior exists for "hold valid" and "hold obsolete".
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015360
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015361resolve_retries <nb>
15362 Defines the number <nb> of queries to send to resolve a server name before
15363 giving up.
15364 Default value: 3
15365
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015366 A retry occurs on name server timeout or when the full sequence of DNS query
15367 type failover is over and we need to start up from the default ANY query
15368 type.
15369
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015370timeout <event> <time>
15371 Defines timeouts related to name resolution
15372 <event> : the event on which the <time> timeout period applies to.
15373 events available are:
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010015374 - resolve : default time to trigger name resolutions when no
15375 other time applied.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015376 Default value: 1s
15377 - retry : time between two DNS queries, when no valid response
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010015378 have been received.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015379 Default value: 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015380 <time> : time related to the event. It follows the HAProxy time format.
15381 <time> is expressed in milliseconds.
15382
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020015383 Example:
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015384
15385 resolvers mydns
15386 nameserver dns1 10.0.0.1:53
15387 nameserver dns2 10.0.0.2:53
Emeric Brunc8f3e452021-04-07 16:04:54 +020015388 nameserver dns3 tcp@10.0.0.3:53
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060015389 parse-resolv-conf
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015390 resolve_retries 3
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015391 timeout resolve 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015392 timeout retry 1s
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010015393 hold other 30s
15394 hold refused 30s
15395 hold nx 30s
15396 hold timeout 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015397 hold valid 10s
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020015398 hold obsolete 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015399
15400
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200154016. Cache
15402---------
15403
15404HAProxy provides a cache, which was designed to perform cache on small objects
15405(favicon, css...). This is a minimalist low-maintenance cache which runs in
15406RAM.
15407
15408The cache is based on a memory which is shared between processes and threads,
15409this memory is split in blocks of 1k.
15410
15411If an object is not used anymore, it can be deleted to store a new object
15412independently of its expiration date. The oldest objects are deleted first
15413when we try to allocate a new one.
15414
15415The cache uses a hash of the host header and the URI as the key.
15416
15417It's possible to view the status of a cache using the Unix socket command
15418"show cache" consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide
15419for more details.
15420
15421When an object is delivered from the cache, the server name in the log is
15422replaced by "<CACHE>".
15423
15424
154256.1. Limitation
15426----------------
15427
15428The cache won't store and won't deliver objects in these cases:
15429
15430- If the response is not a 200
Remi Tricot-Le Breton4f730832020-11-26 15:51:50 +010015431- If the response contains a Vary header and either the process-vary option is
15432 disabled, or a currently unmanaged header is specified in the Vary value (only
15433 accept-encoding and referer are managed for now)
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020015434- If the Content-Length + the headers size is greater than "max-object-size"
15435- If the response is not cacheable
Remi Tricot-Le Bretond493bc82020-11-26 15:51:29 +010015436- If the response does not have an explicit expiration time (s-maxage or max-age
15437 Cache-Control directives or Expires header) or a validator (ETag or Last-Modified
15438 headers)
Remi Tricot-Le Breton5853c0c2020-12-10 17:58:43 +010015439- If the process-vary option is enabled and there are already max-secondary-entries
15440 entries with the same primary key as the current response
Remi Tricot-Le Breton6ca89162021-01-07 14:50:51 +010015441- If the process-vary option is enabled and the response has an unknown encoding (not
15442 mentioned in https://www.iana.org/assignments/http-parameters/http-parameters.xhtml)
15443 while varying on the accept-encoding client header
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020015444
15445- If the request is not a GET
15446- If the HTTP version of the request is smaller than 1.1
15447- If the request contains an Authorization header
15448
15449
154506.2. Setup
15451-----------
15452
15453To setup a cache, you must define a cache section and use it in a proxy with
15454the corresponding http-request and response actions.
15455
15456
154576.2.1. Cache section
15458---------------------
15459
15460cache <name>
15461 Declare a cache section, allocate a shared cache memory named <name>, the
15462 size of cache is mandatory.
15463
15464total-max-size <megabytes>
15465 Define the size in RAM of the cache in megabytes. This size is split in
15466 blocks of 1kB which are used by the cache entries. Its maximum value is 4095.
15467
15468max-object-size <bytes>
15469 Define the maximum size of the objects to be cached. Must not be greater than
15470 an half of "total-max-size". If not set, it equals to a 256th of the cache size.
15471 All objects with sizes larger than "max-object-size" will not be cached.
15472
15473max-age <seconds>
Remi Tricot-Le Breton5853c0c2020-12-10 17:58:43 +010015474 Define the maximum expiration duration. The expiration is set as the lowest
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020015475 value between the s-maxage or max-age (in this order) directive in the
15476 Cache-Control response header and this value. The default value is 60
15477 seconds, which means that you can't cache an object more than 60 seconds by
15478 default.
15479
Remi Tricot-Le Bretone6cc5b52020-12-23 18:13:53 +010015480process-vary <on/off>
15481 Enable or disable the processing of the Vary header. When disabled, a response
Remi Tricot-Le Breton754b2422020-11-16 15:56:10 +010015482 containing such a header will never be cached. When enabled, we need to calculate
15483 a preliminary hash for a subset of request headers on all the incoming requests
15484 (which might come with a cpu cost) which will be used to build a secondary key
Remi Tricot-Le Bretone6cc5b52020-12-23 18:13:53 +010015485 for a given request (see RFC 7234#4.1). The default value is off (disabled).
Remi Tricot-Le Breton754b2422020-11-16 15:56:10 +010015486
Remi Tricot-Le Breton5853c0c2020-12-10 17:58:43 +010015487max-secondary-entries <number>
15488 Define the maximum number of simultaneous secondary entries with the same primary
15489 key in the cache. This needs the vary support to be enabled. Its default value is 10
15490 and should be passed a strictly positive integer.
15491
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020015492
154936.2.2. Proxy section
15494---------------------
15495
15496http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
15497 Try to deliver a cached object from the cache <name>. This directive is also
15498 mandatory to store the cache as it calculates the cache hash. If you want to
15499 use a condition for both storage and delivering that's a good idea to put it
15500 after this one.
15501
15502http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
15503 Store an http-response within the cache. The storage of the response headers
15504 is done at this step, which means you can use others http-response actions
15505 to modify headers before or after the storage of the response. This action
15506 is responsible for the setup of the cache storage filter.
15507
15508
15509Example:
15510
15511 backend bck1
15512 mode http
15513
15514 http-request cache-use foobar
15515 http-response cache-store foobar
15516 server srv1 127.0.0.1:80
15517
15518 cache foobar
15519 total-max-size 4
15520 max-age 240
15521
15522
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200155237. Using ACLs and fetching samples
15524----------------------------------
15525
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015526HAProxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015527client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
15528The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
15529these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
15530but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
15531data called patterns.
15532
15533
155347.1. ACL basics
15535---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015536
15537The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
15538content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
15539from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
15540simple :
15541
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015542 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015543 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015544 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
15545 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015546
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015547The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
15548adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015549
15550In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
15551
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015552 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015553
15554This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
15555Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
15556and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015557an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
15558conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
15559as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
15560are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015561
15562ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
15563'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
15564which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
15565
15566There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
15567performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
15568
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015569The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
15570specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
15571this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015572methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
15573ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015574
15575Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
15576 - boolean
15577 - integer (signed or unsigned)
15578 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
15579 - string
15580 - data block
15581
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015582Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
15583converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
15584would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
15585The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
15586which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
15587
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015588Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
15589keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
15590fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
15591which are summarized in the table below :
15592
15593 +---------------------+-----------------+
15594 | Sample or converter | Default |
15595 | output type | matching method |
15596 +---------------------+-----------------+
15597 | boolean | bool |
15598 +---------------------+-----------------+
15599 | integer | int |
15600 +---------------------+-----------------+
15601 | ip | ip |
15602 +---------------------+-----------------+
15603 | string | str |
15604 +---------------------+-----------------+
15605 | binary | none, use "-m" |
15606 +---------------------+-----------------+
15607
15608Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
15609matching method, see below.
15610
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015611The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
15612 - boolean
15613 - integer or integer range
15614 - IP address / network
15615 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
15616 - regular expression
15617 - hex block
15618
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015619The following ACL flags are currently supported :
15620
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015621 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
15622 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015623 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010015624 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010015625 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010015626 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015627 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
15628
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015629The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
15630read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
15631if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
15632lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
15633will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
15634beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015635a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, HAProxy may load the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015636lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
15637exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
15638
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010015639The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
15640parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
15641ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
15642a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
15643check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
15644
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010015645The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
15646socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
15647file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
15648
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015649Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
15650loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
15651
15652 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
15653
15654In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
15655the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
15656case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
15657as well.
15658
15659The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
15660sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
15661do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
15662methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
15663is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015664obvious matching method (e.g. string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015665followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
15666default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
15667that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
15668string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
15669
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010015670The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
15671By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
15672string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
15673resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015674server is not reachable, the HAProxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015675waiting for the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010015676flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
15677function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
15678
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015679There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
15680sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
15681be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015682
15683 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
15684 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015685 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
15686 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
15687 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
15688 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015689
15690 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
15691 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015692 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015693
15694 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015695 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015696
15697 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015698 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015699
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015700 - "bin" : match the contents against a hexadecimal string representing a
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015701 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
15702
15703 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
15704 binary or string samples.
15705
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015706 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
15707 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015708
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015709 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
15710 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
15711 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015712
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015713 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
15714 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015715
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015716 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
15717 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015718
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015719 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
15720 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015721
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015722 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
15723 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015724 This may be used with binary or string samples.
15725
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015726 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
15727 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
15728 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015729
15730For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
15731request, it is possible to do :
15732
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010015733 acl jsess_present req.cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015734
15735In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
15736buffer, one would use the following acl :
15737
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010015738 acl script_tag req.payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015739
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015740On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
15741possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
15742
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010015743 acl script_tag req.payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015744
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015745All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
15746criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
15747method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
Willy Tarreauedbeab12022-11-25 10:49:41 +010015748to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. This matching method is only
15749usable when the keyword is used alone, without any converter. In case any such
15750converter were to be applied after such an ACL keyword, the default matching
15751method from the ACL keyword is simply ignored since what will matter for the
15752matching is the output type of the last converter. Since all ACL-specific
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015753criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
15754the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015755
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015756If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015757the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
15758For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015759
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015760 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
15761 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
15762 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
15763 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015764
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015765
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015766The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
15767types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
15768combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
15769brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
15770default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015771
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015772 +-------------------------------------------------+
15773 | Input sample type |
15774 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015775 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015776 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
15777 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
15778 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015779 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015780 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015781 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015782 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015783 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015784 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015785 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015786 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015787 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015788 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015789 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015790 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015791 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015792 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015793 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015794 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015795 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015796 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015797 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015798 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015799 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015800 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
15801 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
15802 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015803
15804
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200158057.1.1. Matching booleans
15806------------------------
15807
15808In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
15809Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
15810When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
15811that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
15812
15813Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
15814return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
15815"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
15816
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015817
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200158187.1.2. Matching integers
15819------------------------
15820
15821Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
15822enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
15823to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
15824
15825Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
15826matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
15827lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015828
15829For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
15830unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
15831representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
15832
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015833As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
15834two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
15835instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
15836ranges and operators.
15837
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015838For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015839operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
15840Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
15841of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015842
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015843Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015844
15845 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
15846 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
15847 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
15848 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
15849 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
15850
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015851For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015852
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010015853 acl negative-length req.hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015854
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015855This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
15856
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010015857 acl sslv3 req.ssl_ver 3:3.1
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015858
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015859
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200158607.1.3. Matching strings
15861-----------------------
15862
15863String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
15864different forms :
15865
15866 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015867 patterns;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015868
15869 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015870 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015871
15872 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
15873 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
15874
15875 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
15876 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
15877
Willy Tarreau71e58732022-11-25 12:02:25 +010015878 - subdir match (-m dir) : the patterns are looked up anywhere inside the
15879 extracted string, delimited with slashes ("/"), the beginning or the end
15880 of the string. The ACL matches if any of them matches. As such, the string
15881 "/images/png/logo/32x32.png", would match "/images", "/images/png",
15882 "images/png", "/png/logo", "logo/32x32.png" or "32x32.png" but not "png"
15883 nor "32x32".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015884
Willy Tarreau71e58732022-11-25 12:02:25 +010015885 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up anywhere inside the
15886 extracted string, delimited with dots ("."), colons (":"), slashes ("/"),
15887 question marks ("?"), the beginning or the end of the string. This is made
15888 to be used with URLs. Leading and trailing delimiters in the pattern are
15889 ignored. The ACL matches if any of them matches. As such, in the example
15890 string "http://www1.dc-eu.example.com:80/blah", the patterns "http",
15891 "www1", ".www1", "dc-eu", "example", "com", "80", "dc-eu.example",
15892 "blah", ":www1:", "dc-eu.example:80" would match, but not "eu" nor "dc".
15893 Using it to match domain suffixes for filtering or routing is generally
15894 not a good idea, as the routing could easily be fooled by prepending the
15895 matching prefix in front of another domain for example.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015896
15897String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
15898exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
15899characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
15900string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
15901to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015902before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015903
Mathias Weiersmuellercb250fc2019-12-02 09:43:40 +010015904Do not use string matches for binary fetches which might contain null bytes
15905(0x00), as the comparison stops at the occurrence of the first null byte.
15906Instead, convert the binary fetch to a hex string with the hex converter first.
15907
15908Example:
15909 # matches if the string <tag> is present in the binary sample
15910 acl tag_found req.payload(0,0),hex -m sub 3C7461673E
15911
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015912
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200159137.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
15914---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015915
15916Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
15917they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
15918possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
15919passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
15920the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015921the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
15922match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015923
15924
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200159257.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
15926-------------------------------------
15927
15928It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
15929not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
15930a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
15931to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
15932digits may be used upper or lower case.
15933
15934Example :
15935 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010015936 acl hello req.payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015937
15938
159397.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
15940---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015941
15942IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
15943netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
15944within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010015945host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015946difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
15947at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
15948does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
15949parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015950
Daniel Schnellereba56342016-04-13 00:26:52 +020015951The dotted IPv4 address notation is supported in both regular as well as the
15952abbreviated form with all-0-octets omitted:
15953
15954 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
15955 | Example 1 | Example 2 | Example 3 |
15956 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
15957 | 192.168.0.1 | 10.0.0.12 | 127.0.0.1 |
15958 | 192.168.1 | 10.12 | 127.1 |
15959 | 192.168.0.1/22 | 10.0.0.12/8 | 127.0.0.1/8 |
15960 | 192.168.1/22 | 10.12/8 | 127.1/8 |
15961 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
15962
15963Notice that this is different from RFC 4632 CIDR address notation in which
15964192.168.42/24 would be equivalent to 192.168.42.0/24.
15965
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020015966IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
15967Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
15968trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
15969IPv6 patterns.
15970
15971HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
15972following situations :
15973 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
15974 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
15975 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
15976 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
15977 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
15978 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
15979 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
15980 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
15981 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
15982 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
15983
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015984
159857.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
15986----------------------------------
15987
15988Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
15989combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
15990
15991 - AND (implicit)
15992 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
15993 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015994
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015995A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015996
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015997 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020015998
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015999Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
16000indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020016001
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016002For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
16003"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
16004requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
16005is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
16006
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010016007 acl missing_cl req.hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030016008 http-request deny if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
16009 http-request deny if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
16010 http-request deny unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016011
16012To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
16013and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
16014
16015 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
16016 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
16017 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
16018 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
16019
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016020 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static URLs
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016021 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
16022 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
16023 use_backend www if host_www
16024
16025It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
16026expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
16027be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
16028the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
16029
16030 The following rule :
16031
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010016032 acl missing_cl req.hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030016033 http-request deny if METH_POST missing_cl
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016034
16035 Can also be written that way :
16036
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010016037 http-request deny if METH_POST { req.hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016038
16039It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
16040to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
16041simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
16042sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
16043good use is the following :
16044
16045 With named ACLs :
16046
16047 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
16048 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
16049 monitor fail if site_dead
16050
16051 With anonymous ACLs :
16052
16053 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
16054
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030016055See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "http-request deny" and "use_backend"
16056keywords.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016057
16058
160597.3. Fetching samples
16060---------------------
16061
16062Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
16063against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
16064sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
16065ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
16066of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
16067available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
16068
16069This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
16070Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
16071compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
16072deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
16073
16074The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
16075matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
16076method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
16077indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
16078
16079As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
16080when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
16081mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
16082the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
16083ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
16084
16085Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
16086multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
16087when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016088incorrect argument (e.g. an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
16089are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016090is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
16091all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
16092
16093Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
16094 - name
16095 - name(arg1)
16096 - name(arg1,arg2)
16097
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016098
160997.3.1. Converters
16100-----------------
16101
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010016102Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
16103of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
16104is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
16105was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016106has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (ACLs, log-format,
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010016107unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
16108
16109These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
16110sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
16111the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016112support some arguments (e.g. a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016113
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016114A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
16115support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
16116supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
16117(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
16118bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
16119
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016120The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016121
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001612251d.single(<prop>[,<prop>*])
16123 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
16124 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
16125 The device is identified using the User-Agent header passed to the
16126 converter. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
16127 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
16128
16129 Example :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016130 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request,
16131 # containing values for the three properties requested by using the
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +000016132 # User-Agent passed to the converter.
16133 frontend http-in
16134 bind *:8081
16135 default_backend servers
16136 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
16137 %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),51d.single(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
16138
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016139add(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016140 Adds <value> to the input value of type signed integer, and returns the
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016141 result as a signed integer. <value> can be a numeric value or a variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016142 name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
16143 scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016144 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016145 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16146 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16147 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16148 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016149 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016150 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016151
Nenad Merdanovicc31499d2019-03-23 11:00:32 +010016152aes_gcm_dec(<bits>,<nonce>,<key>,<aead_tag>)
16153 Decrypts the raw byte input using the AES128-GCM, AES192-GCM or
16154 AES256-GCM algorithm, depending on the <bits> parameter. All other parameters
16155 need to be base64 encoded and the returned result is in raw byte format.
16156 If the <aead_tag> validation fails, the converter doesn't return any data.
16157 The <nonce>, <key> and <aead_tag> can either be strings or variables. This
16158 converter requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.1.
16159
16160 Example:
16161 http-response set-header X-Decrypted-Text %[var(txn.enc),\
16162 aes_gcm_dec(128,txn.nonce,Zm9vb2Zvb29mb29wZm9vbw==,txn.aead_tag)]
16163
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016164and(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016165 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016166 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016167 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
16168 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016169 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016170 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16171 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16172 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16173 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016174 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016175 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016176
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020016177b64dec
16178 Converts (decodes) a base64 encoded input string to its binary
16179 representation. It performs the inverse operation of base64().
Moemen MHEDHBI92f7d432021-04-01 20:53:59 +020016180 For base64url("URL and Filename Safe Alphabet" (RFC 4648)) variant
16181 see "ub64dec".
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020016182
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020016183base64
16184 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016185 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g.
Moemen MHEDHBI92f7d432021-04-01 20:53:59 +020016186 an SSL ID can be copied in a header). For base64url("URL and Filename
16187 Safe Alphabet" (RFC 4648)) variant see "ub64enc".
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020016188
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016189bool
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016190 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016191 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016192 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016193 presence of a flag).
16194
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010016195bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
16196 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
16197 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010016198 optionally truncated at the given length.
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010016199
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010016200concat([<start>],[<var>],[<end>])
16201 Concatenates up to 3 fields after the current sample which is then turned to
16202 a string. The first one, <start>, is a constant string, that will be appended
16203 immediately after the existing sample. It may be omitted if not used. The
16204 second one, <var>, is a variable name. The variable will be looked up, its
16205 contents converted to a string, and it will be appended immediately after the
16206 <first> part. If the variable is not found, nothing is appended. It may be
16207 omitted as well. The third field, <end> is a constant string that will be
16208 appended after the variable. It may also be omitted. Together, these elements
16209 allow to concatenate variables with delimiters to an existing set of
16210 variables. This can be used to build new variables made of a succession of
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010016211 other variables, such as colon-delimited values. If commas or closing
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040016212 parenthesis are needed as delimiters, they must be protected by quotes or
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010016213 backslashes, themselves protected so that they are not stripped by the first
16214 level parser. See examples below.
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010016215
16216 Example:
16217 tcp-request session set-var(sess.src) src
16218 tcp-request session set-var(sess.dn) ssl_c_s_dn
16219 tcp-request session set-var(txn.sig) str(),concat(<ip=,sess.ip,>),concat(<dn=,sess.dn,>)
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010016220 tcp-request session set-var(txn.ipport) "str(),concat('addr=(',sess.ip),concat(',',sess.port,')')"
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010016221 http-request set-header x-hap-sig %[var(txn.sig)]
16222
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016223cpl
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016224 Takes the input value of type signed integer, applies a ones-complement
16225 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an signed integer.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016226
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010016227crc32([<avalanche>])
16228 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
16229 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
16230 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
16231 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
16232 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
16233 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
16234 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
16235 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
16236 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
16237 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010016238 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c" and the "hash-type" directive.
16239
16240crc32c([<avalanche>])
16241 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32C
16242 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
16243 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
16244 converter uses the same functions as described in RFC4960, Appendix B [8].
16245 It is provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32C to be
16246 computed on some input keys. It is slower than the other algorithms and it must
16247 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
16248 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32" and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010016249
Christopher Fauletea159d62020-04-01 16:21:44 +020016250cut_crlf
16251 Cuts the string representation of the input sample on the first carriage
16252 return ('\r') or newline ('\n') character found. Only the string length is
16253 updated.
16254
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +010016255da-csv-conv(<prop>[,<prop>*])
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020016256 Asks the DeviceAtlas converter to identify the User Agent string passed on
16257 input, and to emit a string made of the concatenation of the properties
16258 enumerated in argument, delimited by the separator defined by the global
16259 keyword "deviceatlas-property-separator", or by default the pipe character
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016260 ('|'). There's a limit of 12 different properties imposed by the HAProxy
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020016261 configuration language.
16262
16263 Example:
16264 frontend www
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020016265 bind *:8881
16266 default_backend servers
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000016267 http-request set-header X-DeviceAtlas-Data %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),da-csv(primaryHardwareType,osName,osVersion,browserName,browserVersion,browserRenderingEngine)]
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020016268
Willy Tarreau0851fd52019-12-17 10:07:25 +010016269debug([<prefix][,<destination>])
16270 This converter is used as debug tool. It takes a capture of the input sample
16271 and sends it to event sink <destination>, which may designate a ring buffer
16272 such as "buf0", as well as "stdout", or "stderr". Available sinks may be
16273 checked at run time by issuing "show events" on the CLI. When not specified,
16274 the output will be "buf0", which may be consulted via the CLI's "show events"
16275 command. An optional prefix <prefix> may be passed to help distinguish
16276 outputs from multiple expressions. It will then appear before the colon in
16277 the output message. The input sample is passed as-is on the output, so that
16278 it is safe to insert the debug converter anywhere in a chain, even with non-
16279 printable sample types.
16280
16281 Example:
16282 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src,debug(track-sc)
Thierry FOURNIER9687c772015-05-07 15:46:29 +020016283
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020016284digest(<algorithm>)
16285 Converts a binary input sample to a message digest. The result is a binary
16286 sample. The <algorithm> must be an OpenSSL message digest name (e.g. sha256).
16287
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016288 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020016289 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
16290
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016291div(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016292 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
16293 result as an signed integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016294 integer is returned (typically 2^63-1). <value> can be a numeric value or a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016295 variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
16296 scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016297 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016298 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16299 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16300 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16301 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016302 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016303 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016304
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016305djb2([<avalanche>])
16306 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
16307 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
16308 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
16309 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
16310 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
16311 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
16312 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010016313 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c",
16314 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016315
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016316even
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016317 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is even
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016318 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
16319
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020016320field(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
16321 Extracts the substring at the given index counting from the beginning
16322 (positive index) or from the end (negative index) considering given delimiters
16323 from an input string. Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string
16324 formatted list of chars. Optionally you can specify <count> of fields to
16325 extract (default: 1). Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining
16326 fields.
16327
16328 Example :
16329 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(5,_) # f5
16330 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
16331 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,2) # f2_f3
16332 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-2,_,3) # f2_f3_
16333 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-3,_,0) # f1_f2_f3
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010016334
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020016335fix_is_valid
16336 Parses a binary payload and performs sanity checks regarding FIX (Financial
16337 Information eXchange):
16338
16339 - checks that all tag IDs and values are not empty and the tags IDs are well
16340 numeric
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +050016341 - checks the BeginString tag is the first tag with a valid FIX version
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020016342 - checks the BodyLength tag is the second one with the right body length
Christopher Fauleted4bef72021-03-18 17:40:56 +010016343 - checks the MsgType tag is the third tag.
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020016344 - checks that last tag in the message is the CheckSum tag with a valid
16345 checksum
16346
16347 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
16348 the server can be parsed.
16349
16350 This converter returns a boolean, true if the payload contains a valid FIX
16351 message, false if not.
16352
16353 See also the fix_tag_value converter.
16354
16355 Example:
16356 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
16357 tcp-request content reject unless { req.payload(0,0),fix_is_valid }
16358
16359fix_tag_value(<tag>)
16360 Parses a FIX (Financial Information eXchange) message and extracts the value
16361 from the tag <tag>. <tag> can be a string or an integer pointing to the
16362 desired tag. Any integer value is accepted, but only the following strings
16363 are translated into their integer equivalent: BeginString, BodyLength,
Daniel Corbettbefef702021-03-09 23:00:34 -050016364 MsgType, SenderCompID, TargetCompID, CheckSum. More tag names can be easily
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020016365 added.
16366
16367 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
16368 the server can be parsed. No message validation is performed by this
16369 converter. It is highly recommended to validate the message first using
16370 fix_is_valid converter.
16371
16372 See also the fix_is_valid converter.
16373
16374 Example:
16375 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
16376 tcp-request content reject unless { req.payload(0,0),fix_is_valid }
16377 # MsgType tag ID is 35, so both lines below will return the same content
16378 tcp-request content set-var(txn.foo) req.payload(0,0),fix_tag_value(35)
16379 tcp-request content set-var(txn.bar) req.payload(0,0),fix_tag_value(MsgType)
16380
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016381hex
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016382 Converts a binary input sample to a hex string containing two hex digits per
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016383 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016384 in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g. an SSL ID can be copied in a
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016385 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010016386
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020016387hex2i
16388 Converts a hex string containing two hex digits per input byte to an
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050016389 integer. If the input value cannot be converted, then zero is returned.
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020016390
Christopher Faulet4ccc12f2020-04-01 09:08:32 +020016391htonl
16392 Converts the input integer value to its 32-bit binary representation in the
16393 network byte order. Because sample fetches own signed 64-bit integer, when
16394 this converter is used, the input integer value is first casted to an
16395 unsigned 32-bit integer.
16396
Tim Duesterhusa3082092021-01-21 17:40:49 +010016397hmac(<algorithm>,<key>)
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020016398 Converts a binary input sample to a message authentication code with the given
16399 key. The result is a binary sample. The <algorithm> must be one of the
16400 registered OpenSSL message digest names (e.g. sha256). The <key> parameter must
16401 be base64 encoded and can either be a string or a variable.
16402
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016403 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020016404 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
16405
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010016406http_date([<offset],[<unit>])
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016407 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
16408 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000016409 an offset value is specified, then it is added to the date before the
16410 conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to emit Date header fields,
16411 Expires values in responses when combined with a positive offset, or
16412 Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
16413 If a unit value is specified, then consider the timestamp as either
16414 "s" for seconds (default behavior), "ms" for milliseconds, or "us" for
16415 microseconds since epoch. Offset is assumed to have the same unit as
16416 input timestamp.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016417
Tim Duesterhus3943e4f2020-09-11 14:25:23 +020016418iif(<true>,<false>)
16419 Returns the <true> string if the input value is true. Returns the <false>
16420 string otherwise.
16421
16422 Example:
Tim Duesterhus870713b2020-09-11 17:13:12 +020016423 http-request set-header x-forwarded-proto %[ssl_fc,iif(https,http)]
Tim Duesterhus3943e4f2020-09-11 14:25:23 +020016424
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016425in_table(<table>)
16426 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16427 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
16428 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016429 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (e.g. whether
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016430 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
16431
Tim Duesterhusa3082092021-01-21 17:40:49 +010016432ipmask(<mask4>,[<mask6>])
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010016433 Apply a mask to an IP address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020016434 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010016435 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask4 can be passed in
16436 dotted form (e.g. 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (e.g. 24). The mask6 can
16437 be passed in quadruplet form (e.g. ffff:ffff::) or in CIDR form (e.g. 64).
16438 If no mask6 is given IPv6 addresses will fail to convert for backwards
16439 compatibility reasons.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020016440
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016441json([<input-code>])
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016442 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII output string ready to use as a
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016443 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020016444 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8p" or
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016445 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
16446 of errors:
16447 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
16448 bytes, ...)
16449 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
16450 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
16451
16452 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
16453 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
16454 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
16455 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
16456 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
16457 are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016458 - "ascii" : never fails;
16459 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors;
16460 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016461 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016462 error;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016463 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
16464 characters corresponding to the other errors.
16465
16466 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016467 logging to servers which consume JSON-formatted traffic logs.
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016468
16469 Example:
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016470 capture request header Host len 15
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020016471 capture request header user-agent len 150
16472 log-format '{"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json(utf8s)]"}'
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016473
16474 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
16475 GET / HTTP/1.0
16476 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
16477
16478 Output log:
16479 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
16480
Alex51c8ad42021-04-15 16:45:15 +020016481json_query(<json_path>,[<output_type>])
16482 The json_query converter supports the JSON types string, boolean and
16483 number. Floating point numbers will be returned as a string. By
16484 specifying the output_type 'int' the value will be converted to an
16485 Integer. If conversion is not possible the json_query converter fails.
16486
16487 <json_path> must be a valid JSON Path string as defined in
16488 https://datatracker.ietf.org/doc/draft-ietf-jsonpath-base/
16489
16490 Example:
16491 # get a integer value from the request body
16492 # "{"integer":4}" => 5
16493 http-request set-var(txn.pay_int) req.body,json_query('$.integer','int'),add(1)
16494
16495 # get a key with '.' in the name
16496 # {"my.key":"myvalue"} => myvalue
16497 http-request set-var(txn.pay_mykey) req.body,json_query('$.my\\.key')
16498
16499 # {"boolean-false":false} => 0
16500 http-request set-var(txn.pay_boolean_false) req.body,json_query('$.boolean-false')
16501
16502 # get the value of the key 'iss' from a JWT Bearer token
16503 http-request set-var(txn.token_payload) req.hdr(Authorization),word(2,.),ub64dec,json_query('$.iss')
16504
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016505language(<value>[,<default>])
16506 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
16507 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
16508 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
16509 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
16510 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
16511 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
16512 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
16513 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
16514 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016515 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016516 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
16517 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020016518
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016519 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020016520
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016521 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
16522 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020016523
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016524 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
16525 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
16526 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
16527 use_backend spanish if es
16528 use_backend french if fr
16529 use_backend english if en
16530 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020016531
Willy Tarreau60a2ee72017-12-15 07:13:48 +010016532length
Etienne Carriereed0d24e2017-12-13 13:41:34 +010016533 Get the length of the string. This can only be placed after a string
16534 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
16535 type. The result is of type integer.
16536
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020016537lower
16538 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
16539 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
16540 type. The result is of type string.
16541
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020016542ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
16543 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
16544 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
16545 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
16546 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
16547 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
16548 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
16549
16550 Example :
16551
16552 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016553 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020016554 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
16555
Christopher Faulet51fc9d12020-04-01 17:24:41 +020016556ltrim(<chars>)
16557 Skips any characters from <chars> from the beginning of the string
16558 representation of the input sample.
16559
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016560map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
16561map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
16562map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
16563 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
16564 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
16565 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
16566 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
16567 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
16568 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
16569 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
16570 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016571
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016572 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
16573 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
16574 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016575
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010016576 The following array contains the list of all map functions available sorted by
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016577 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016578
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016579 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
16580 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16581 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
16582 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020016583 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
16584 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016585 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
16586 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16587 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
16588 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16589 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
16590 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16591 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
16592 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Ruoshan Huang3c5e3742016-12-02 16:25:31 +080016593 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
16594 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16595 str | reg | map_regm | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016596 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16597 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
16598 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16599 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
16600 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016601
Thierry Fournier8feaa662016-02-10 22:55:20 +010016602 The special map called "map_regm" expect matching zone in the regular
16603 expression and modify the output replacing back reference (like "\1") by
16604 the corresponding match text.
16605
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016606 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
16607 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
16608 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
16609 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
16610 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016611
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016612 Example :
16613
16614 # this is a comment and is ignored
16615 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
16616 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
16617 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
16618 | | | `---------- value
16619 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
16620 | `---------------------------- key
16621 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
16622
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016623mod(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016624 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
16625 remainder as an signed integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016626 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016627 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016628 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016629 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16630 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16631 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16632 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016633 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016634 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016635
Alexbf1bd5a2021-04-24 13:02:21 +020016636mqtt_field_value(<packettype>,<fieldname_or_property_ID>)
Baptiste Assmanne279ca62020-10-27 18:10:06 +010016637 Returns value of <fieldname> found in input MQTT payload of type
16638 <packettype>.
16639 <packettype> can be either a string (case insensitive matching) or a numeric
16640 value corresponding to the type of packet we're supposed to extract data
16641 from.
16642 Supported string and integers can be found here:
16643 https://docs.oasis-open.org/mqtt/mqtt/v3.1.1/os/mqtt-v3.1.1-os.html#_Toc398718021
16644 https://docs.oasis-open.org/mqtt/mqtt/v5.0/os/mqtt-v5.0-os.html#_Toc3901022
16645
16646 <fieldname> depends on <packettype> and can be any of the following below.
16647 (note that <fieldname> matching is case insensitive).
16648 <property id> can only be found in MQTT v5.0 streams. check this table:
16649 https://docs.oasis-open.org/mqtt/mqtt/v5.0/os/mqtt-v5.0-os.html#_Toc3901029
16650
16651 - CONNECT (or 1): flags, protocol_name, protocol_version, client_identifier,
16652 will_topic, will_payload, username, password, keepalive
16653 OR any property ID as a numeric value (for MQTT v5.0
16654 packets only):
16655 17: Session Expiry Interval
16656 33: Receive Maximum
16657 39: Maximum Packet Size
16658 34: Topic Alias Maximum
16659 25: Request Response Information
16660 23: Request Problem Information
16661 21: Authentication Method
16662 22: Authentication Data
16663 18: Will Delay Interval
16664 1: Payload Format Indicator
16665 2: Message Expiry Interval
16666 3: Content Type
16667 8: Response Topic
16668 9: Correlation Data
16669 Not supported yet:
16670 38: User Property
16671
16672 - CONNACK (or 2): flags, protocol_version, reason_code
16673 OR any property ID as a numeric value (for MQTT v5.0
16674 packets only):
16675 17: Session Expiry Interval
16676 33: Receive Maximum
16677 36: Maximum QoS
16678 37: Retain Available
16679 39: Maximum Packet Size
16680 18: Assigned Client Identifier
16681 34: Topic Alias Maximum
16682 31: Reason String
16683 40; Wildcard Subscription Available
16684 41: Subscription Identifiers Available
16685 42: Shared Subscription Available
16686 19: Server Keep Alive
16687 26: Response Information
16688 28: Server Reference
16689 21: Authentication Method
16690 22: Authentication Data
16691 Not supported yet:
16692 38: User Property
16693
16694 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
16695 the server can be parsed. Thus this converter can extract data only from
16696 CONNECT and CONNACK packet types. CONNECT is the first message sent by the
16697 client and CONNACK is the first response sent by the server.
16698
16699 Example:
16700
16701 acl data_in_buffer req.len ge 4
16702 tcp-request content set-var(txn.username) \
16703 req.payload(0,0),mqtt_field_value(connect,protocol_name) \
16704 if data_in_buffer
16705 # do the same as above
16706 tcp-request content set-var(txn.username) \
16707 req.payload(0,0),mqtt_field_value(1,protocol_name) \
16708 if data_in_buffer
16709
16710mqtt_is_valid
16711 Checks that the binary input is a valid MQTT packet. It returns a boolean.
16712
16713 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
16714 the server can be parsed. Thus this converter can extract data only from
16715 CONNECT and CONNACK packet types. CONNECT is the first message sent by the
16716 client and CONNACK is the first response sent by the server.
16717
Christopher Fauletc7907732022-03-22 09:41:11 +010016718 Only MQTT 3.1, 3.1.1 and 5.0 are supported.
16719
Baptiste Assmanne279ca62020-10-27 18:10:06 +010016720 Example:
16721
16722 acl data_in_buffer req.len ge 4
Daniel Corbettcc9d9b02021-05-13 10:46:07 -040016723 tcp-request content reject unless { req.payload(0,0),mqtt_is_valid }
Baptiste Assmanne279ca62020-10-27 18:10:06 +010016724
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016725mul(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016726 Multiplies the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns
Thierry FOURNIER00c005c2015-07-08 01:10:21 +020016727 the product as an signed integer. In case of overflow, the largest possible
16728 value for the sign is returned so that the operation doesn't wrap around.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016729 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016730 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016731 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016732 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16733 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16734 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16735 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016736 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016737 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016738
Nenad Merdanovicb7e7c472017-03-12 21:56:55 +010016739nbsrv
16740 Takes an input value of type string, interprets it as a backend name and
16741 returns the number of usable servers in that backend. Can be used in places
16742 where we want to look up a backend from a dynamic name, like a result of a
16743 map lookup.
16744
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016745neg
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016746 Takes the input value of type signed integer, computes the opposite value,
16747 and returns the remainder as an signed integer. 0 is identity. This operator
16748 is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input from a
16749 constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016750
16751not
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016752 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016753 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016754 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016755 absence of a flag).
16756
16757odd
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016758 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is odd
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016759 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
16760
16761or(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016762 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016763 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016764 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
16765 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016766 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016767 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16768 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16769 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16770 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016771 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016772 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016773
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010016774protobuf(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
16775 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
16776 sample representation of a protocol buffer message with <field_number> as field
16777 number (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample
16778 if this field is present (see also "ungrpc" below).
16779 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
16780 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
16781 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
16782 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
16783 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
16784 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
16785 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
16786
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010016787regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010016788 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
16789 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
16790 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
16791 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
16792 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
16793 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
16794 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
16795 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
16796 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010016797 The first use of this converter is to replace certain characters or sequence
16798 of characters with other ones.
16799
16800 It is highly recommended to enclose the regex part using protected quotes to
16801 improve clarity and never have a closing parenthesis from the regex mixed up
16802 with the parenthesis from the function. Just like in Bourne shell, the first
16803 level of quotes is processed when delimiting word groups on the line, a
16804 second level is usable for argument. It is recommended to use single quotes
16805 outside since these ones do not try to resolve backslashes nor dollar signs.
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010016806
Willy Tarreaucd0d2ed2020-02-14 17:33:06 +010016807 Examples:
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010016808
16809 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
16810 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
16811 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010016812 http-request set-header x-path "%[hdr(x-path),regsub('/+','/','g')]"
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010016813
Willy Tarreaucd0d2ed2020-02-14 17:33:06 +010016814 # copy query string to x-query and drop all leading '?', ';' and '&'
16815 http-request set-header x-query "%[query,regsub([?;&]*,'')]"
16816
Jerome Magnin07e1e3c2020-02-16 19:20:19 +010016817 # capture groups and backreferences
16818 # both lines do the same.
Willy Tarreau465dc7d2020-10-08 18:05:56 +020016819 http-request redirect location %[url,'regsub("(foo|bar)([0-9]+)?","\2\1",i)']
Jerome Magnin07e1e3c2020-02-16 19:20:19 +010016820 http-request redirect location %[url,regsub(\"(foo|bar)([0-9]+)?\",\"\2\1\",i)]
16821
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020016822capture-req(<id>)
16823 Capture the string entry in the request slot <id> and returns the entry as
16824 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
16825
16826 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020016827 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
16828 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020016829
16830capture-res(<id>)
16831 Capture the string entry in the response slot <id> and returns the entry as
16832 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
16833
16834 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020016835 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
16836 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020016837
Christopher Faulet568415a2020-04-01 17:24:47 +020016838rtrim(<chars>)
16839 Skips any characters from <chars> from the end of the string representation
16840 of the input sample.
16841
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016842sdbm([<avalanche>])
16843 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
16844 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
16845 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
16846 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
16847 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
16848 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
16849 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010016850 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6", "crc32c",
16851 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016852
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020016853secure_memcmp(<var>)
16854 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value. Both values are treated
16855 as a binary string. Returns a boolean indicating whether both binary strings
16856 match.
16857
16858 If both binary strings have the same length then the comparison will be
16859 performed in constant time.
16860
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016861 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020016862 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
16863
16864 Example :
16865
16866 http-request set-var(txn.token) hdr(token)
16867 # Check whether the token sent by the client matches the secret token
16868 # value, without leaking the contents using a timing attack.
16869 acl token_given str(my_secret_token),secure_memcmp(txn.token)
16870
Tim Duesterhusef4e45c2021-01-21 17:40:50 +010016871set-var(<var>)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016872 Sets a variable with the input content and returns the content on the output
16873 as-is. The variable keeps the value and the associated input type. The name of
16874 the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016875 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016876 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16877 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016878 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016879 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
16880 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016881 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016882 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016883
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020016884sha1
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020016885 Converts a binary input sample to a SHA-1 digest. The result is a binary
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020016886 sample with length of 20 bytes.
16887
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020016888sha2([<bits>])
16889 Converts a binary input sample to a digest in the SHA-2 family. The result
16890 is a binary sample with length of <bits>/8 bytes.
16891
16892 Valid values for <bits> are 224, 256, 384, 512, each corresponding to
16893 SHA-<bits>. The default value is 256.
16894
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016895 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020016896 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
16897
Nenad Merdanovic177adc92019-08-27 01:58:13 +020016898srv_queue
16899 Takes an input value of type string, either a server name or <backend>/<server>
16900 format and returns the number of queued sessions on that server. Can be used
16901 in places where we want to look up queued sessions from a dynamic name, like a
16902 cookie value (e.g. req.cook(SRVID),srv_queue) and then make a decision to break
16903 persistence or direct a request elsewhere.
16904
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020016905strcmp(<var>)
16906 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value of type string. Returns
16907 the result as a signed integer compatible with strcmp(3): 0 if both strings
16908 are identical. A value less than 0 if the left string is lexicographically
16909 smaller than the right string or if the left string is shorter. A value greater
16910 than 0 otherwise (right string greater than left string or the right string is
16911 shorter).
16912
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020016913 See also the secure_memcmp converter if you need to compare two binary
16914 strings in constant time.
16915
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020016916 Example :
16917
16918 http-request set-var(txn.host) hdr(host)
16919 # Check whether the client is attempting domain fronting.
16920 acl ssl_sni_http_host_match ssl_fc_sni,strcmp(txn.host) eq 0
16921
16922
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016923sub(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016924 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type signed integer, and returns
16925 the result as an signed integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016926 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)". <value> can be a numeric value
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016927 or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about
16928 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016929 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016930 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16931 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016932 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016933 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
16934 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016935 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016936 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016937
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016938table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
16939 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16940 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16941 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
16942 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
16943 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
16944 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
16945
16946
16947table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
16948 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16949 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16950 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
16951 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
16952 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
16953 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
16954
16955table_conn_cnt(<table>)
16956 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16957 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016958 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016959 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
16960 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
16961
16962table_conn_cur(<table>)
16963 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16964 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16965 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
16966 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
16967 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
16968
16969table_conn_rate(<table>)
16970 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16971 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16972 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
16973 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
16974 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
16975
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020016976table_gpt0(<table>)
16977 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16978 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
16979 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
16980 general purpose tag associated with the input sample in the designated table.
16981 See also the sc_get_gpt0 sample fetch keyword.
16982
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016983table_gpc0(<table>)
16984 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16985 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16986 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
16987 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
16988 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
16989
16990table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
16991 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16992 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16993 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
16994 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
16995 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
16996 sample fetch keyword.
16997
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016998table_gpc1(<table>)
16999 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17000 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17001 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the second
17002 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
17003 table. See also the sc_get_gpc1 sample fetch keyword.
17004
17005table_gpc1_rate(<table>)
17006 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17007 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17008 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc1
17009 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
17010 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc1_rate
17011 sample fetch keyword.
17012
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020017013table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
17014 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17015 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017016 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020017017 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
17018 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
17019
17020table_http_err_rate(<table>)
17021 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17022 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17023 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
17024 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
17025 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
17026 keyword.
17027
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010017028table_http_fail_cnt(<table>)
17029 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17030 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17031 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
17032 failures associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
17033 the sc_http_fail_cnt sample fetch keyword.
17034
17035table_http_fail_rate(<table>)
17036 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17037 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17038 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP failures associated with the
17039 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of failures over the
17040 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_fail_rate sample fetch
17041 keyword.
17042
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020017043table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
17044 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17045 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017046 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020017047 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
17048 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
17049
17050table_http_req_rate(<table>)
17051 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17052 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17053 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
17054 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
17055 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
17056 keyword.
17057
17058table_kbytes_in(<table>)
17059 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17060 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017061 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of client-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020017062 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
17063 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
17064 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
17065 keyword.
17066
17067table_kbytes_out(<table>)
17068 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17069 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017070 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of server-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020017071 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
17072 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
17073 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
17074 keyword.
17075
17076table_server_id(<table>)
17077 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17078 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17079 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
17080 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
17081 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
17082 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
17083
17084table_sess_cnt(<table>)
17085 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17086 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017087 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020017088 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
17089 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
17090 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
17091 keyword.
17092
17093table_sess_rate(<table>)
17094 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17095 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17096 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
17097 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
17098 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
17099 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
17100 keyword.
17101
17102table_trackers(<table>)
17103 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17104 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17105 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
17106 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
17107 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
17108 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
17109 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
17110 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
17111 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
17112 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
17113
Moemen MHEDHBI92f7d432021-04-01 20:53:59 +020017114ub64dec
17115 This converter is the base64url variant of b64dec converter. base64url
17116 encoding is the "URL and Filename Safe Alphabet" variant of base64 encoding.
17117 It is also the encoding used in JWT (JSON Web Token) standard.
17118
17119 Example:
17120 # Decoding a JWT payload:
17121 http-request set-var(txn.token_payload) req.hdr(Authorization),word(2,.),ub64dec
17122
17123ub64enc
17124 This converter is the base64url variant of base64 converter.
17125
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020017126upper
17127 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
17128 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
17129 type. The result is of type string.
17130
Willy Tarreau62ba9ba2020-04-23 17:54:47 +020017131url_dec([<in_form>])
17132 Takes an url-encoded string provided as input and returns the decoded version
17133 as output. The input and the output are of type string. If the <in_form>
17134 argument is set to a non-zero integer value, the input string is assumed to
17135 be part of a form or query string and the '+' character will be turned into a
17136 space (' '). Otherwise this will only happen after a question mark indicating
17137 a query string ('?').
Thierry FOURNIER82ff3c92015-05-07 15:46:20 +020017138
William Dauchy888b0ae2021-01-06 23:39:50 +010017139url_enc([<enc_type>])
17140 Takes a string provided as input and returns the encoded version as output.
17141 The input and the output are of type string. By default the type of encoding
17142 is meant for `query` type. There is no other type supported for now but the
17143 optional argument is here for future changes.
17144
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017145ungrpc(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010017146 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010017147 sample representation of a gRPC message with <field_number> as field number
17148 (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample if this
17149 field is present.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017150 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
17151 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
17152 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
17153 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010017154 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017155 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
17156 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010017157
17158 Example:
17159 // with such a protocol buffer .proto file content adapted from
17160 // https://github.com/grpc/grpc/blob/master/examples/protos/route_guide.proto
17161
17162 message Point {
17163 int32 latitude = 1;
17164 int32 longitude = 2;
17165 }
17166
17167 message PPoint {
17168 Point point = 59;
17169 }
17170
17171 message Rectangle {
17172 // One corner of the rectangle.
17173 PPoint lo = 48;
17174 // The other corner of the rectangle.
17175 PPoint hi = 49;
17176 }
17177
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020017178 let's say a body request is made of a "Rectangle" object value (two PPoint
17179 protocol buffers messages), the four protocol buffers fields could be
17180 extracted with these "ungrpc" directives:
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010017181
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017182 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
17183 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "lo" first PPoint
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050017184 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "hi" second PPoint
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017185 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "hi" second PPoint
17186
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020017187 We could also extract the intermediary 48.59 field as a binary sample as follows:
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017188
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010017189 req.body,ungrpc(48.59)
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017190
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020017191 As a gRPC message is always made of a gRPC header followed by protocol buffers
17192 messages, in the previous example the "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
17193 could be extracted with these equivalent directives:
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010017194
17195 req.body,ungrpc(48.59),protobuf(1,int32)
17196 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59.1,int32)
17197 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59),protobuf(1,int32)
17198
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020017199 Note that the first convert must be "ungrpc", the remaining ones must be
17200 "protobuf" and only the last one may have or not a second argument to
17201 interpret the previous binary sample.
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010017202
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010017203
Tim Duesterhusef4e45c2021-01-21 17:40:50 +010017204unset-var(<var>)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010017205 Unsets a variable if the input content is defined. The name of the variable
17206 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
17207 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
17208 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
17209 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
17210 response),
17211 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
17212 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
17213 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
17214 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
17215
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020017216utime(<format>[,<offset>])
17217 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
17218 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
17219 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
17220 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
17221 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
17222 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
17223
17224 Example :
17225
17226 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017227 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020017228 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
17229
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020017230word(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
17231 Extracts the nth word counting from the beginning (positive index) or from
17232 the end (negative index) considering given delimiters from an input string.
17233 Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
Jerome Magnin88209322020-01-28 13:33:44 +010017234 Delimiters at the beginning or end of the input string are ignored.
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020017235 Optionally you can specify <count> of words to extract (default: 1).
17236 Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining words.
17237
17238 Example :
17239 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(4,_) # f5
17240 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
17241 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(3,_,2) # f3__f5
17242 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-2,_,3) # f1_f2_f3
17243 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-3,_,0) # f1_f2
Jerome Magnin88209322020-01-28 13:33:44 +010017244 str(/f1/f2/f3/f4),word(1,/) # f1
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010017245
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020017246wt6([<avalanche>])
17247 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
17248 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
17249 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
17250 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
17251 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
17252 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
17253 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010017254 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", "crc32c",
17255 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020017256
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017257xor(<value>)
17258 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020017259 of type signed integer, and returns the result as an signed integer.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020017260 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017261 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010017262 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017263 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
17264 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020017265 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017266 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
17267 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020017268 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010017269 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017270
Dragan Dosen04bf0cc2020-12-22 21:44:33 +010017271xxh3([<seed>])
17272 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the XXH3
17273 64-bit variant of the XXhash hash function. This hash supports a seed which
17274 defaults to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument.
17275 This hash is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash
17276 URLs and/or URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics
17277 with a low collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not
17278 considered as cryptographically secure.
17279
Thierry FOURNIER01e09742016-12-26 11:46:11 +010017280xxh32([<seed>])
17281 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the 32-bit
17282 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
17283 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
17284 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
17285 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
17286 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
17287 as cryptographically secure.
17288
17289xxh64([<seed>])
17290 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the 64-bit
17291 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
17292 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
17293 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
17294 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
17295 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
17296 as cryptographically secure.
17297
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010017298
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200172997.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017300--------------------------------------------
17301
17302A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
17303not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
17304"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
17305The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
17306
17307always_false : boolean
17308 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
17309 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
17310
17311always_true : boolean
17312 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
17313 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
17314
17315avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017316 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017317 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
17318 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
17319 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
17320 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
17321 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
17322 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
17323 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
17324 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
17325 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
17326 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
17327 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
17328 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
17329 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010017330
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017331be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020017332 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
17333 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
17334 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
17335 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040017336 See also the "fe_conn", "queue", "be_conn_free", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
17337
17338be_conn_free([<backend>]) : integer
17339 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
17340 across available servers in the backend. Queue slots are not included. Backup
17341 servers are also not included, unless all other servers are down. If no
17342 backend name is specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible
17343 to check another backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040017344 nominal one is full. See also the "be_conn", "connslots", and "srv_conn_free"
17345 criteria.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040017346
17347 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0
17348 (meaning unlimited), then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which
17349 case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017350
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017351be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
17352 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
17353 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
17354 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017355 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent sucking of an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017356 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
17357 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017358
17359 Example :
17360 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
17361 backend dynamic
17362 mode http
17363 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
17364 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017365
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017366bin(<hex>) : bin
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020017367 Returns a binary chain. The input is the hexadecimal representation
17368 of the string.
17369
17370bool(<bool>) : bool
17371 Returns a boolean value. <bool> can be 'true', 'false', '1' or '0'.
17372 'false' and '0' are the same. 'true' and '1' are the same.
17373
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017374connslots([<backend>]) : integer
17375 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017376 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017377 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
17378 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050017379
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080017380 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017381 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080017382 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
17383
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017384 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
17385 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080017386
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020017387 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017388 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017389 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017390 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017391 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017392 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020017393 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080017394
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017395 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
17396 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017397 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017398 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080017399
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010017400cpu_calls : integer
17401 Returns the number of calls to the task processing the stream or current
17402 request since it was allocated. This number is reset for each new request on
17403 the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value should usually be
17404 low and stable (around 2 calls for a typically simple request) but may become
17405 high if some processing (compression, caching or analysis) is performed. This
17406 is purely for performance monitoring purposes.
17407
17408cpu_ns_avg : integer
17409 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
17410 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
17411 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
17412 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
17413 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
17414 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
17415 and may affect other connection's apparent response time. Certain operations
17416 like compression, complex regex matching or heavy Lua operations may directly
17417 affect this value, and having it in the logs will make it easier to spot the
17418 faulty processing that needs to be fixed to recover decent performance.
17419 Note: this value is exactly cpu_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
17420
17421cpu_ns_tot : integer
17422 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
17423 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
17424 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
17425 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
17426 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
17427 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
17428 induces CPU costs on the machine, and may affect other connection's apparent
17429 response time. Certain operations like compression, complex regex matching or
17430 heavy Lua operations may directly affect this value, and having it in the
17431 logs will make it easier to spot the faulty processing that needs to be fixed
17432 to recover decent performance. The value may be artificially high due to a
17433 high cpu_calls count, for example when processing many HTTP chunks, and for
17434 this reason it is often preferred to log cpu_ns_avg instead.
17435
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010017436date([<offset>],[<unit>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020017437 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000017438
17439 If an offset value is specified, then it is added to the current date before
17440 returning the value. This is particularly useful to compute relative dates,
17441 as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020017442 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
17443
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000017444 <unit> is facultative, and can be set to "s" for seconds (default behavior),
17445 "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds.
17446 If unit is set, return value is an integer reflecting either seconds,
17447 milliseconds or microseconds since epoch, plus offset.
17448 It is useful when a time resolution of less than a second is needed.
17449
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020017450 Example :
17451
17452 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
17453 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020017454
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000017455 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response, with
17456 # millisecond granularity
17457 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600000,ms),http_date(0,ms)]
17458
Etienne Carrierea792a0a2018-01-17 13:43:24 +010017459date_us : integer
17460 Return the microseconds part of the date (the "second" part is returned by
17461 date sample). This sample is coherent with the date sample as it is comes
17462 from the same timeval structure.
17463
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020017464distcc_body(<token>[,<occ>]) : binary
17465 Parses a distcc message and returns the body associated to occurrence #<occ>
17466 of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified, any may
17467 match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This can be
17468 used to extract file names or arguments in files built using distcc through
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017469 HAProxy. Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020017470 list of supported tokens.
17471
17472distcc_param(<token>[,<occ>]) : integer
17473 Parses a distcc message and returns the parameter associated to occurrence
17474 #<occ> of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified,
17475 any may match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This
17476 can be used to extract certain information such as the protocol version, the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017477 file size or the argument in files built using distcc through HAProxy.
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020017478 Another use case consists in waiting for the start of the preprocessed file
17479 contents before connecting to the server to avoid keeping idle connections.
17480 Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete list of
17481 supported tokens.
17482
17483 Example :
17484 # wait up to 20s for the pre-processed file to be uploaded
17485 tcp-request inspect-delay 20s
17486 tcp-request content accept if { distcc_param(DOTI) -m found }
17487 # send large files to the big farm
17488 use_backend big_farm if { distcc_param(DOTI) gt 1000000 }
17489
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020017490env(<name>) : string
17491 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
17492 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
17493 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
17494 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
17495 certain way.
17496
17497 Examples :
17498 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
17499 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
17500
17501 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010017502 http-request deny if !{ req.cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020017503
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017504fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
17505 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017506 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
17507 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017508 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
17509 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017510 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017511 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
17512 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020017513
Nenad Merdanovicad9a7e92016-10-03 04:57:37 +020017514fe_req_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
17515 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of HTTP requests per
17516 second sent to a frontend. This number can differ from "fe_sess_rate" in
17517 situations where client-side keep-alive is enabled.
17518
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017519fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
17520 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
17521 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
17522 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
17523 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
17524 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
17525 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
17526 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
17527 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010017528
17529 Example :
17530 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
17531 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
17532 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
17533 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
17534 frontend mail
17535 bind :25
17536 mode tcp
17537 maxconn 100
17538 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
17539 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
17540 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
17541 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017542
Nenad Merdanovic807a6e72017-03-12 22:00:00 +010017543hostname : string
17544 Returns the system hostname.
17545
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020017546int(<integer>) : signed integer
17547 Returns a signed integer.
17548
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020017549ipv4(<ipv4>) : ipv4
17550 Returns an ipv4.
17551
17552ipv6(<ipv6>) : ipv6
17553 Returns an ipv6.
17554
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010017555lat_ns_avg : integer
17556 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
17557 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
17558 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
17559 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
17560 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
17561 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
17562 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
17563 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
17564 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +020017565 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, to enable low
17566 latency scheduling using "tune.sched.low-latency", or to look for other heavy
17567 requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"), whose
17568 processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers could
17569 be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: this value is
17570 exactly lat_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010017571
17572lat_ns_tot : integer
17573 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
17574 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
17575 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
17576 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
17577 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
17578 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
17579 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
17580 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
17581 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +020017582 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, to enable low
17583 latency scheduling using "tune.sched.low-latency", or to look for other heavy
17584 requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"), whose
17585 processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers could
17586 be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: while it
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010017587 may intuitively seem that the total latency adds to a transfer time, it is
17588 almost never true because while a task waits for the CPU, network buffers
17589 continue to fill up and the next call will process more at once. The value
17590 may be artificially high due to a high cpu_calls count, for example when
17591 processing many HTTP chunks, and for this reason it is often preferred to log
17592 lat_ns_avg instead, which is a more relevant performance indicator.
17593
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020017594meth(<method>) : method
17595 Returns a method.
17596
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010017597nbproc : integer
17598 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of processes that were
17599 started (it equals the global "nbproc" setting). This is useful for logging
17600 and debugging purposes.
17601
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017602nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
17603 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
17604 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
17605 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017606 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
17607 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
17608 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010017609
Patrick Hemmerfabb24f2018-08-13 14:07:57 -040017610prio_class : integer
17611 Returns the priority class of the current session for http mode or connection
17612 for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to "http-request
17613 set-priority-class" or "tcp-request content set-priority-class".
17614
17615prio_offset : integer
17616 Returns the priority offset of the current session for http mode or
17617 connection for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to
17618 "http-request set-priority-offset" or "tcp-request content
17619 set-priority-offset".
17620
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010017621proc : integer
17622 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the process calling
17623 the function, between 1 and global.nbproc. This is useful for logging and
17624 debugging purposes.
17625
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017626queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017627 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
17628 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
17629 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017630 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
17631 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
17632 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
17633 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
17634 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
17635
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010017636rand([<range>]) : integer
17637 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
17638 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
17639 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
17640 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
17641 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
17642
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017643srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
17644 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
17645 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
17646 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
17647 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
17648 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040017649 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn", "queue", and
17650 "srv_conn_free" fetch methods.
17651
17652srv_conn_free([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
17653 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
17654 on the designated server, possibly including the connection being evaluated.
17655 The value does not include queue slots. If <backend> is omitted, then the
17656 server is looked up in the current backend. It can be used to use a specific
17657 farm when one server is full, or to inform the server about our view of the
17658 number of active connections with it. See also the "be_conn_free" and
17659 "srv_conn" fetch methods.
17660
17661 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: If the server maxconn is 0, then this fetch clearly
17662 does not make sense, in which case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017663
17664srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
17665 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
17666 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
17667 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017668 an external status reported via a health check (e.g. a geographical site's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017669 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
17670 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
17671 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
17672
Willy Tarreauff2b7af2017-10-13 11:46:26 +020017673srv_queue([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
17674 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connections currently
17675 pending in the designated server's queue. If <backend> is omitted, then the
17676 server is looked up in the current backend. It can sometimes be used together
17677 with the "use-server" directive to force to use a known faster server when it
17678 is not much loaded. See also the "srv_conn", "avg_queue" and "queue" sample
17679 fetch methods.
17680
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017681srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
17682 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
17683 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017684 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017685 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
17686 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017687 rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent latent requests from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017688 overloading servers).
17689
17690 Example :
17691 # Redirect to a separate back
17692 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
17693 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
17694 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
17695
Alexbf1bd5a2021-04-24 13:02:21 +020017696srv_iweight([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
Christopher Faulet1bea8652020-07-10 16:03:45 +020017697 Returns an integer corresponding to the server's initial weight. If <backend>
17698 is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. See also
17699 "srv_weight" and "srv_uweight".
17700
Alexbf1bd5a2021-04-24 13:02:21 +020017701srv_uweight([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
Christopher Faulet1bea8652020-07-10 16:03:45 +020017702 Returns an integer corresponding to the user visible server's weight. If
17703 <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current
17704 backend. See also "srv_weight" and "srv_iweight".
17705
Alexbf1bd5a2021-04-24 13:02:21 +020017706srv_weight([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
Christopher Faulet1bea8652020-07-10 16:03:45 +020017707 Returns an integer corresponding to the current (or effective) server's
17708 weight. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current
17709 backend. See also "srv_iweight" and "srv_uweight".
17710
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010017711stopping : boolean
17712 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
17713 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
17714 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
17715
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020017716str(<string>) : string
17717 Returns a string.
17718
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017719table_avl([<table>]) : integer
17720 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
17721 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
17722
17723table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17724 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
17725 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
17726 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
17727
Christopher Faulet34adb2a2017-11-21 21:45:38 +010017728thread : integer
17729 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the thread calling
17730 the function, between 0 and (global.nbthread-1). This is useful for logging
17731 and debugging purposes.
17732
Alexandar Lazica429ad32021-06-01 00:27:01 +020017733uuid([<version>]) : string
17734 Returns a UUID following the RFC4122 standard. If the version is not
17735 specified, a UUID version 4 (fully random) is returned.
17736 Currently, only version 4 is supported.
17737
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020017738var(<var-name>) : undefined
17739 Returns a variable with the stored type. If the variable is not set, the
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017740 sample fetch fails. The name of the variable starts with an indication
17741 about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010017742 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017743 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
17744 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020017745 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017746 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
17747 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020017748 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010017749 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020017750
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200177517.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017752----------------------------------
17753
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017754The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in HAProxy is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017755closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
17756methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
17757sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
17758TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017759the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
17760counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020017761"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix. These three pre-defined prefixes can only be
17762used if MAX_SESS_STKCTR value does not exceed 3, otherwise the counter number
17763can be specified as the first integer argument when using the "sc_" prefix.
17764Starting from "sc_0" to "sc_N" where N is (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). An optional
17765table may be specified with the "sc*" form, in which case the currently
17766tracked key will be looked up into this alternate table instead of the table
17767currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017768
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020017769bc_dst : ip
17770 This is the destination ip address of the connection on the server side,
17771 which is the server address HAProxy connected to. It is of type IP and works
17772 on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its
17773 IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291.
17774
17775bc_dst_port : integer
17776 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017777 connection on the server side, which is the port HAProxy connected to.
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020017778
Jérôme Magnin35e53a62019-01-16 14:38:37 +010017779bc_http_major : integer
Jérôme Magnin86577422018-12-07 09:03:11 +010017780 Returns the backend connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
17781 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
17782 encoding and not the version present in the request header.
17783
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020017784bc_src : ip
17785 This is the source ip address of the connection on the server side, which is
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017786 the server address HAProxy connected from. It is of type IP and works on both
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020017787 IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are mapped to their IPv6
17788 equivalent, according to RFC 4291.
17789
17790bc_src_port : integer
17791 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017792 connection on the server side, which is the port HAProxy connected from.
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020017793
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017794be_id : integer
17795 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020017796 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request. It can
17797 also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017798
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010017799be_name : string
17800 Returns a string containing the current backend's name. It can be used in
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020017801 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request. It can
17802 also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010017803
Amaury Denoyelled91d7792020-12-10 13:43:56 +010017804be_server_timeout : integer
17805 Returns the configuration value in millisecond for the server timeout of the
17806 current backend. This timeout can be overwritten by a "set-timeout" rule. See
17807 also the "cur_server_timeout".
17808
17809be_tunnel_timeout : integer
17810 Returns the configuration value in millisecond for the tunnel timeout of the
17811 current backend. This timeout can be overwritten by a "set-timeout" rule. See
17812 also the "cur_tunnel_timeout".
17813
Amaury Denoyellef7719a22020-12-10 13:43:58 +010017814cur_server_timeout : integer
17815 Returns the currently applied server timeout in millisecond for the stream.
17816 In the default case, this will be equal to be_server_timeout unless a
17817 "set-timeout" rule has been applied. See also "be_server_timeout".
17818
17819cur_tunnel_timeout : integer
17820 Returns the currently applied tunnel timeout in millisecond for the stream.
17821 In the default case, this will be equal to be_tunnel_timeout unless a
17822 "set-timeout" rule has been applied. See also "be_tunnel_timeout".
17823
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017824dst : ip
17825 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
17826 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
17827 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
17828 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010017829 RFC 4291. When the incoming connection passed through address translation or
17830 redirection involving connection tracking, the original destination address
17831 before the redirection will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and
17832 destination may seldom appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl
17833 is set, because a late response may reopen a timed out connection and switch
17834 what is believed to be the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017835
17836dst_conn : integer
17837 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
17838 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
17839 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
17840 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
17841 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
17842 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
17843 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
17844 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017845
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020017846dst_is_local : boolean
17847 Returns true if the destination address of the incoming connection is local
17848 to the system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning
17849 that it was intercepted in transparent mode. It can be useful to apply
17850 certain rules by default to forwarded traffic and other rules to the traffic
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017851 targeting the real address of the machine. For example the stats page could
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020017852 be delivered only on this address, or SSH access could be locally redirected.
17853 Please note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do
17854 it only once per connection.
17855
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017856dst_port : integer
17857 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
17858 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
17859 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
17860 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
17861 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
17862 an HTTP header.
17863
Christopher Faulet9f074f62021-10-25 16:18:15 +020017864fc_fackets : integer
17865 Returns the fack counter measured by the kernel for the client
17866 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
17867 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
17868 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17869
Willy Tarreau60ca10a2017-08-18 15:26:54 +020017870fc_http_major : integer
17871 Reports the front connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
17872 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
17873 encoding and not on the version present in the request header.
17874
Christopher Faulet9f074f62021-10-25 16:18:15 +020017875fc_lost : integer
17876 Returns the lost counter measured by the kernel for the client
17877 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
17878 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
17879 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17880
Geoff Simmons7185b782019-08-27 18:31:16 +020017881fc_pp_authority : string
17882 Returns the authority TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
17883 if any.
17884
Tim Duesterhusd1b15b62020-03-13 12:34:23 +010017885fc_pp_unique_id : string
17886 Returns the unique ID TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
17887 if any.
17888
Emeric Brun4f603012017-01-05 15:11:44 +010017889fc_rcvd_proxy : boolean
17890 Returns true if the client initiated the connection with a PROXY protocol
17891 header.
17892
Christopher Faulet9f074f62021-10-25 16:18:15 +020017893fc_reordering : integer
17894 Returns the reordering counter measured by the kernel for the client
17895 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
17896 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
17897 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17898
17899fc_retrans : integer
17900 Returns the retransmits counter measured by the kernel for the client
17901 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
17902 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
17903 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17904
Thierry Fournier / OZON.IO6310bef2016-07-24 20:16:50 +020017905fc_rtt(<unit>) : integer
17906 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) measured by the kernel for the client
17907 connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds. <unit>
17908 can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the server
17909 connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
17910 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
17911 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17912
17913fc_rttvar(<unit>) : integer
17914 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) variance measured by the kernel for the
17915 client connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds.
17916 <unit> can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the
17917 server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
17918 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
17919 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17920
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020017921fc_sacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070017922 Returns the sacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
17923 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
17924 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
17925 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17926
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070017927
Christopher Faulet9f074f62021-10-25 16:18:15 +020017928fc_unacked : integer
17929 Returns the unacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
17930 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
17931 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
17932 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070017933
Marcin Deranek9a66dfb2018-04-13 14:37:50 +020017934fe_defbe : string
17935 Returns a string containing the frontend's default backend name. It can be
17936 used in frontends to check which backend will handle requests by default.
17937
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017938fe_id : integer
17939 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
Marcin Deranek6e413ed2016-12-13 12:40:01 +010017940 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017941 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
17942
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010017943fe_name : string
17944 Returns a string containing the current frontend's name. It can be used in
17945 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
17946 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
17947
Amaury Denoyelleda184d52020-12-10 13:43:55 +010017948fe_client_timeout : integer
17949 Returns the configuration value in millisecond for the client timeout of the
17950 current frontend.
17951
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017952sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017953sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
17954sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
17955sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017956 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
17957 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
17958 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
17959
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017960sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017961sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
17962sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
17963sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017964 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
17965 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
17966 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
17967
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017968sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017969sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17970sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17971sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020017972 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
17973 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010017974 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
17975 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
17976 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020017977
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030017978 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020017979 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
17980 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020017981 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
17982 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
17983 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020017984 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
17985 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
17986
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017987sc_clr_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
17988sc0_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17989sc1_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17990sc2_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17991 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
17992 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
17993 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
17994 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
17995 when a first ACL was verified.
17996
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017997sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017998sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17999sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18000sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018001 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections from currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018002 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
18003
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018004sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018005sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
18006sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
18007sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018008 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
18009 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
18010 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
18011
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018012sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018013sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
18014sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
18015sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018016 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
18017 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
18018 See also src_conn_rate.
18019
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018020sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018021sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
18022sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
18023sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018024 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018025 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020018026
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018027sc_get_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18028sc0_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18029sc1_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18030sc2_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18031 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
18032 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc1 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1.
18033
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020018034sc_get_gpt0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18035sc0_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
18036sc1_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
18037sc2_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
18038 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
18039 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpt0.
18040
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018041sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018042sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
18043sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
18044sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020018045 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
18046 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
18047 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018048 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
18049 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
18050 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018051
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018052sc_gpc1_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18053sc0_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
18054sc1_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
18055sc2_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
18056 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
18057 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
18058 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
18059 src_gpcA_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
18060 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
18061 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
18062
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018063sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018064sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18065sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18066sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018067 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018068 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
18069 See also src_http_err_cnt.
18070
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018071sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018072sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
18073sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
18074sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018075 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
18076 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
18077 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
18078 src_http_err_rate.
18079
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010018080sc_http_fail_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18081sc0_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18082sc1_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18083sc2_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18084 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP response failures from the currently
18085 tracked counters. This includes the both response errors and 5xx status codes
18086 other than 501 and 505. See also src_http_fail_cnt.
18087
18088sc_http_fail_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18089sc0_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
18090sc1_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
18091sc2_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
18092 Returns the average rate of HTTP response failures from the currently tracked
18093 counters, measured in amount of failures over the period configured in the
18094 table. This includes the both response errors and 5xx status codes other than
18095 501 and 505. See also src_http_fail_rate.
18096
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018097sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018098sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18099sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18100sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018101 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018102 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
18103 src_http_req_cnt.
18104
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018105sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018106sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
18107sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
18108sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018109 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
18110 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
18111 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
18112 src_http_req_rate.
18113
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018114sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018115sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
18116sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
18117sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018118 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010018119 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
18120 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
18121 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
18122 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018123
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030018124 Example:
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020018125 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
18126 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018127 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
18128
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018129sc_inc_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18130sc0_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18131sc1_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18132sc2_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18133 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
18134 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
18135 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
18136 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
18137 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified.
18138
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018139sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018140sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
18141sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
18142sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020018143 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
18144 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
18145 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018146
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018147sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018148sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
18149sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
18150sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020018151 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
18152 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
18153 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018154
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018155sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018156sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18157sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18158sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018159 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections that were transformed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018160 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
18161 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
18162 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040018163 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018164 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
18165
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018166sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018167sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
18168sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
18169sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018170 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
18171 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
18172 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
18173 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
18174 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040018175 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018176
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018177sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018178sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
18179sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
18180sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020018181 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
18182 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
18183 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
18184
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018185sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018186sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
18187sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
18188sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010018189 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
18190 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020018191 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010018192 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
18193 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018194 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
18195 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
18196 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010018197
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018198so_id : integer
18199 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
18200 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
18201 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018202
Jerome Magnineb421b22020-03-27 22:08:40 +010018203so_name : string
18204 Returns a string containing the current listening socket's name, as defined
18205 with name on a "bind" line. It can serve the same purposes as so_id but with
18206 strings instead of integers.
18207
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018208src : ip
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018209 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018210 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
18211 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
18212 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010018213 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" or "accept-netscaler-cip" bind
18214 directive is used, it can be the address of a client behind another
18215 PROXY-protocol compatible component for all rule sets except
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010018216 "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address. When the incoming
18217 connection passed through address translation or redirection involving
18218 connection tracking, the original destination address before the redirection
18219 will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and destination may seldom
18220 appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl is set, because a late
18221 response may reopen a timed out connection and switch what is believed to be
18222 the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018223
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010018224 Example:
18225 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
18226 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
18227
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018228src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
18229 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
18230 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
18231 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018232 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018233
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018234src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
18235 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
18236 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018237 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018238 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018239
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018240src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
18241 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
18242 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18243 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
18244 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
18245 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
18246 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020018247
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030018248 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020018249 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
18250 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
18251 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
18252 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010018253 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020018254 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
18255 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
18256
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018257src_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18258 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
18259 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18260 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
18261 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
18262 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
18263 was verified.
18264
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018265src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018266 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018267 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018268 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018269 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018270
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018271src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018272 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018273 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
18274 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018275 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018276
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018277src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
18278 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
18279 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
18280 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018281 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018282
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018283src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018284 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018285 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018286 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018287 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018288
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018289src_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18290 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
18291 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
18292 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
18293 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1 and src_inc_gpc1.
18294
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020018295src_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
18296 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
18297 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
18298 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
18299 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpt0.
18300
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018301src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020018302 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018303 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020018304 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
18305 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018306 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
18307 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
18308 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020018309
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018310src_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
18311 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
18312 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
18313 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
18314 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
18315 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc1_rate, src_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
18316 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
18317 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
18318
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018319src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018320 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018321 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018322 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018323 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018324 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018325
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018326src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
18327 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
18328 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
18329 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
18330 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018331 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018332
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010018333src_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18334 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP response failures triggered by the
18335 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Ilya Shipitsin0de36ad2021-02-20 00:23:36 +050018336 the designated stick-table. This includes the both response errors and 5xx
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010018337 status codes other than 501 and 505. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_fail_cnt.
18338 If the address is not found, zero is returned.
18339
18340src_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
18341 Returns the average rate of HTTP response failures triggered by the incoming
18342 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18343 designated stick-table, measured in amount of failures over the period
18344 configured in the table. This includes the both response errors and 5xx
18345 status codes other than 501 and 505. If the address is not found, zero is
18346 returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_fail_rate.
18347
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018348src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018349 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018350 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
18351 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018352 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018353
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018354src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
18355 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
18356 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
18357 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018358 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018359 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018360
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018361src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
18362 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
18363 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18364 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020018365 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018366 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
18367 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018368
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030018369 Example:
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018370 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010018371 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018372 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018373
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018374src_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18375 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
18376 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18377 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
18378 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc1.
18379 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
18380 connection when a first ACL was verified.
18381
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020018382src_is_local : boolean
18383 Returns true if the source address of the incoming connection is local to the
18384 system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning that it
18385 comes from a remote machine. Note that UNIX addresses are considered local.
18386 It can be useful to apply certain access restrictions based on where the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018387 client comes from (e.g. require auth or https for remote machines). Please
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020018388 note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do it only
18389 once per connection.
18390
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018391src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020018392 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
18393 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
18394 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
18395 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
18396 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018397
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018398src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020018399 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
18400 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
18401 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
18402 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
18403 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020018404
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018405src_port : integer
18406 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
18407 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
18408 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
18409 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010018410
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018411src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018412 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018413 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18414 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
18415 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018416 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018417
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018418src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
18419 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
18420 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
18421 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
18422 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018423 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018424
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018425src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18426 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
18427 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
18428 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
18429 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
18430 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
18431 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
18432 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
18433 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020018434
18435 Example :
18436 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
18437 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
18438 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
18439 listen ssh
18440 bind :22
18441 mode tcp
18442 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018443 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018444 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020018445 server local 127.0.0.1:22
18446
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018447srv_id : integer
18448 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
18449 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020018450 debugging. It can also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020018451
vkill1dfd1652019-10-30 16:58:14 +080018452srv_name : string
18453 Returns a string containing the server's name when processing the response.
18454 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020018455 debugging. It can also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
vkill1dfd1652019-10-30 16:58:14 +080018456
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200184577.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018458----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020018459
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040018460The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in HAProxy is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018461closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
18462when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
18463usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018464future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020018465
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001846651d.all(<prop>[,<prop>*]) : string
18467 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
18468 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
18469 The device is identified using all the important HTTP headers from the
18470 request. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
18471 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
18472
18473 Example :
18474 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request
18475 # containing the three properties requested using all relevant headers from
18476 # the request.
18477 frontend http-in
18478 bind *:8081
18479 default_backend servers
18480 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
18481 %[51d.all(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
18482
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018483ssl_bc : boolean
18484 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
18485 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018486 other a server with the "ssl" option. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
18487 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018488
18489ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
18490 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018491 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a
18492 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018493
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018494ssl_bc_alpn : string
18495 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
18496 outgoing connection made via a TLS transport layer.
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020018497 The result is a string containing the protocol name negotiated with the
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018498 server. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
18499 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
18500 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "server" line specifies a
18501 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to pick a protocol from this
18502 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018503 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_bc_npn". It can be used in a
18504 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018505
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018506ssl_bc_cipher : string
18507 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018508 over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
18509 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018510
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018511ssl_bc_client_random : binary
18512 Returns the client random of the back connection when the incoming connection
18513 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
18514 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018515 It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018516
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010018517ssl_bc_is_resumed : boolean
18518 Returns true when the back connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
18519 layer and the newly created SSL session was resumed using a cached
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018520 session or a TLS ticket. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check
18521 ruleset.
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010018522
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018523ssl_bc_npn : string
18524 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an outgoing connection
18525 made via a TLS transport layer. The result is a string containing the
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020018526 protocol name negotiated with the server . The SSL library must have been
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018527 built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that
18528 the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the "npn" keyword on the
18529 "server" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to
18530 pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be used. Please note that
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018531 the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN. It can be used in a tcp-check
18532 or an http-check ruleset.
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018533
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018534ssl_bc_protocol : string
18535 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018536 over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
18537 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018538
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020018539ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018540 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020018541 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018542 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64". It
18543 can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018544
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018545ssl_bc_server_random : binary
18546 Returns the server random of the back connection when the incoming connection
18547 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
18548 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018549 It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018550
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018551ssl_bc_session_id : binary
18552 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
18553 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018554 if session was reused or not. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check
18555 ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018556
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040018557ssl_bc_session_key : binary
18558 Returns the SSL session master key of the back connection when the outgoing
18559 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
18560 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018561 BoringSSL. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040018562
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018563ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
18564 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018565 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a
18566 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018567
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018568ssl_c_ca_err : integer
18569 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18570 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
18571 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
18572 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
18573 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020018574
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018575ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
18576 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18577 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
18578 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
18579 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010018580
Christopher Faulet70d10d12020-11-06 12:10:33 +010018581ssl_c_chain_der : binary
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020018582 Returns the DER formatted chain certificate presented by the client when the
18583 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18584 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form. One
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +050018585 can parse the result with any lib accepting ASN.1 DER data. It currently
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020018586 does not support resumed sessions.
18587
Christopher Faulet70d10d12020-11-06 12:10:33 +010018588ssl_c_der : binary
18589 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
18590 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18591 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
18592
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018593ssl_c_err : integer
18594 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18595 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
18596 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
18597 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
18598 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020018599
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018600ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018601 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18602 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
18603 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
18604 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
18605 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
18606 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
18607 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
18608 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018609 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
18610 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
18611 LDAP v3.
18612 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
18613 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020018614
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018615ssl_c_key_alg : string
18616 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
18617 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18618 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020018619
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018620ssl_c_notafter : string
18621 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
18622 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18623 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020018624
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018625ssl_c_notbefore : string
18626 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
18627 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18628 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010018629
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018630ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018631 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18632 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
18633 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
18634 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
18635 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
18636 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
18637 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
18638 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018639 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
18640 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
18641 LDAP v3.
18642 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
18643 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010018644
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018645ssl_c_serial : binary
18646 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
18647 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18648 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018649
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018650ssl_c_sha1 : binary
18651 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
18652 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
18653 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020018654 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
18655 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
18656
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030018657 Example:
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020018658 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018659
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018660ssl_c_sig_alg : string
18661 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
18662 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
18663 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020018664
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018665ssl_c_used : boolean
18666 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
18667 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020018668
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018669ssl_c_verify : integer
18670 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
18671 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
18672 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
18673 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020018674
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018675ssl_c_version : integer
18676 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
18677 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020018678
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010018679ssl_f_der : binary
18680 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
18681 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18682 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
18683
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018684ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018685 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18686 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
18687 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
18688 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020018689 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018690 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
18691 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
18692 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018693 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
18694 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
18695 LDAP v3.
18696 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
18697 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020018698
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018699ssl_f_key_alg : string
18700 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
18701 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
18702 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020018703
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018704ssl_f_notafter : string
18705 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
18706 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18707 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018708
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018709ssl_f_notbefore : string
18710 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
18711 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18712 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020018713
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018714ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018715 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18716 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
18717 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
18718 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
18719 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
18720 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
18721 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
18722 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018723 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
18724 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
18725 LDAP v3.
18726 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
18727 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020018728
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018729ssl_f_serial : binary
18730 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
18731 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18732 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020018733
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020018734ssl_f_sha1 : binary
18735 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
18736 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
18737 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
18738
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018739ssl_f_sig_alg : string
18740 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
18741 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
18742 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020018743
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018744ssl_f_version : integer
18745 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
18746 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
18747
18748ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018749 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
18750 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
18751 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
18752
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018753 Example :
18754 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
18755 listen http-https
18756 bind :80
18757 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
18758 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
18759
18760ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
18761 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
18762 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
18763
18764ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018765 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018766 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040018767 HAProxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018768 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
18769 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
18770 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
18771 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
18772 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
18773 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
18774
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018775ssl_fc_cipher : string
18776 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
18777 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020018778
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010018779ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin : binary
18780 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum returned
18781 value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010018782 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010018783
18784ssl_fc_cipherlist_hex : string
18785 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list encoded as
18786 hexadecimal. The maximum returned value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010018787 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010018788
18789ssl_fc_cipherlist_str : string
18790 Returns the decoded text form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum
18791 number of ciphers returned is according with the value of
18792 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size". Note that this sample-fetch is only
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018793 available with OpenSSL >= 1.0.2. If the function is not enabled, this
Emmanuel Hocdetddcde192017-09-01 17:32:08 +020018794 sample-fetch returns the hash like "ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010018795
18796ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh : integer
18797 Returns a xxh64 of the cipher list. This hash can be return only is the value
18798 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size" is set greater than 0, however the hash
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010018799 take in account all the data of the cipher list.
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010018800
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018801ssl_fc_client_random : binary
18802 Returns the client random of the front connection when the incoming connection
18803 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
18804 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
18805
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +020018806ssl_fc_client_early_traffic_secret : string
18807 Return the CLIENT_EARLY_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
18808 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
18809 transport layer.
18810 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18811 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18812 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18813 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18814
18815ssl_fc_client_handshake_traffic_secret : string
18816 Return the CLIENT_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
18817 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
18818 transport layer.
18819 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18820 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18821 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18822 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18823
18824ssl_fc_client_traffic_secret_0 : string
18825 Return the CLIENT_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 as an hexadecimal string for the
18826 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
18827 transport layer.
18828 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18829 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18830 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18831 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18832
18833ssl_fc_exporter_secret : string
18834 Return the EXPORTER_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
18835 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
18836 transport layer.
18837 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18838 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18839 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18840 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18841
18842ssl_fc_early_exporter_secret : string
18843 Return the EARLY_EXPORTER_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
18844 front connection when the incoming connection was made over an TLS 1.3
18845 transport layer.
18846 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18847 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18848 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18849 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18850
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018851ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018852 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
18853 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010018854 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
18855 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
18856 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
18857 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018858
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +020018859ssl_fc_has_early : boolean
18860 Returns true if early data were sent, and the handshake didn't happen yet. As
18861 it has security implications, it is useful to be able to refuse those, or
18862 wait until the handshake happened.
18863
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018864ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
18865 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020018866 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
18867 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050018868 that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020018869 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020018870
Nenad Merdanovic1516fe32016-05-17 03:31:21 +020018871ssl_fc_is_resumed : boolean
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020018872 Returns true if the SSL/TLS session has been resumed through the use of
Jérôme Magnin4a326cb2018-01-15 14:01:17 +010018873 SSL session cache or TLS tickets on an incoming connection over an SSL/TLS
18874 transport layer.
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020018875
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018876ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018877 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040018878 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by HAProxy. The result
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018879 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
18880 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
18881 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
18882 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
18883 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
18884 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020018885
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018886ssl_fc_protocol : string
18887 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
18888 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020018889
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020018890ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040018891 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020018892 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
Christopher Fauletc5de4192021-11-09 14:23:36 +010018893 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_fc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040018894
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +020018895ssl_fc_server_handshake_traffic_secret : string
18896 Return the SERVER_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
18897 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
18898 transport layer.
18899 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18900 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18901 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18902 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18903
18904ssl_fc_server_traffic_secret_0 : string
18905 Return the SERVER_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 as an hexadecimal string for the
18906 front connection when the incoming connection was made over an TLS 1.3
18907 transport layer.
18908 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18909 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18910 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18911 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18912
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018913ssl_fc_server_random : binary
18914 Returns the server random of the front connection when the incoming connection
18915 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
18916 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
18917
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018918ssl_fc_session_id : binary
18919 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
18920 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
18921 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
18922 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020018923
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040018924ssl_fc_session_key : binary
18925 Returns the SSL session master key of the front connection when the incoming
18926 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
18927 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
18928 BoringSSL.
18929
18930
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018931ssl_fc_sni : string
18932 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
18933 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040018934 deciphered by HAProxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018935 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
18936 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
18937
Alex18c88772021-06-05 13:23:08 +020018938 This fetch is different from "req.ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040018939 connection being deciphered by HAProxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018940 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050018941 requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020018942 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020018943
Willy Tarreau000d4002022-11-25 10:12:12 +010018944 CAUTION! Except under very specific conditions, it is normally not correct to
18945 use this field as a substitute for the HTTP "Host" header field. For example,
18946 when forwarding an HTTPS connection to a server, the SNI field must be set
18947 from the HTTP Host header field using "req.hdr(host)" and not from the front
18948 SNI value. The reason is that SNI is solely used to select the certificate
18949 the server side will present, and that clients are then allowed to send
18950 requests with different Host values as long as they match the names in the
18951 certificate. As such, "ssl_fc_sni" should normally not be used as an argument
18952 to the "sni" server keyword, unless the backend works in TCP mode.
18953
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018954 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018955 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
18956 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020018957
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018958ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
18959 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
18960 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020018961
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020018962ssl_s_der : binary
18963 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the server when the
18964 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18965 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
18966
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020018967ssl_s_chain_der : binary
18968 Returns the DER formatted chain certificate presented by the server when the
18969 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18970 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form. One
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +050018971 can parse the result with any lib accepting ASN.1 DER data. It currently
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020018972 does not support resumed sessions.
18973
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020018974ssl_s_key_alg : string
18975 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
18976 presented by the server when the outgoing connection was made over an
18977 SSL/TLS transport layer.
18978
18979ssl_s_notafter : string
18980 Returns the end date presented by the server as a formatted string
18981 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18982 transport layer.
18983
18984ssl_s_notbefore : string
18985 Returns the start date presented by the server as a formatted string
18986 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18987 transport layer.
18988
18989ssl_s_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
18990 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18991 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
18992 presented by the server when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
18993 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
18994 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
18995 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
William Lallemand8f600c82020-06-26 09:55:06 +020018996 For instance, "ssl_s_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
18997 "ssl_s_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020018998 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
18999 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
19000 LDAP v3.
19001 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
19002 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_s_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
19003
19004ssl_s_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
19005 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
19006 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
19007 presented by the server when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
19008 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
19009 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
19010 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
William Lallemand8f600c82020-06-26 09:55:06 +020019011 For instance, "ssl_s_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
19012 "ssl_s_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020019013 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
19014 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
19015 LDAP v3.
19016 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
19017 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_s_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
19018
19019ssl_s_serial : binary
19020 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the server when the
19021 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
19022 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
19023
19024ssl_s_sha1 : binary
19025 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the server
19026 when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
19027 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
19028
19029ssl_s_sig_alg : string
19030 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
19031 the server when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
19032 layer.
19033
19034ssl_s_version : integer
19035 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the server when the
19036 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020019037
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200190387.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019039------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020019040
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019041Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
19042sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
19043only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
19044For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
19045be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
19046can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
19047sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
19048for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
19049content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020019050
Christopher Fauleta434a002021-03-25 11:58:51 +010019051Warning : Following sample fetches are ignored if used from HTTP proxies. They
19052 only deal with raw contents found in the buffers. On their side,
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040019053 HTTP proxies use structured content. Thus raw representation of
Christopher Fauleta434a002021-03-25 11:58:51 +010019054 these data are meaningless. A warning is emitted if an ACL relies on
19055 one of the following sample fetches. But it is not possible to detect
19056 all invalid usage (for instance inside a log-format string or a
19057 sample expression). So be careful.
19058
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019059payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019060 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (e.g.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019061 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
19062 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010019063
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019064payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
19065 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019066 (e.g. "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019067 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010019068
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019069req.len : integer
19070req_len : integer (deprecated)
19071 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
19072 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
19073 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
19074 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
19075 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040019076 that data to come in and return false only when HAProxy is certain that no
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019077 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
19078 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020019079
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019080req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
19081 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020019082 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
19083 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
19084 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
19085 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020019086
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010019087 ACL derivatives :
19088 req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020019089
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019090req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
19091 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
19092 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
19093 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
19094 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020019095
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010019096 ACL derivatives :
19097 req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020019098
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019099 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020019100
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019101req.proto_http : boolean
19102req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
19103 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
19104 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
19105 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
19106 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
19107 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
19108 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
19109 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020019110
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019111 Example:
19112 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
19113 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
19114 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020019115 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020019116
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019117req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
19118rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
19119 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
19120 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
19121 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
19122 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
19123 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
19124 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
19125 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019126
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019127 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
19128 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
19129 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
19130 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
19131 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
19132 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019133
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019134 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010019135 req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019136
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019137 Example :
19138 listen tse-farm
19139 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
19140 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
19141 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
19142 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
19143 # apply RDP cookie persistence
19144 persist rdp-cookie
19145 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
19146 # This is only useful makes sense if
19147 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
19148 stick-table type string size 204800
19149 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
19150 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
19151 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019152
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019153 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010019154 "req.rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019155
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019156req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
19157rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
19158 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
19159 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
19160 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
19161 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019162
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019163 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010019164 req.rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019165
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110019166req.ssl_alpn : string
19167 Returns a string containing the values of the Application-Layer Protocol
19168 Negotiation (ALPN) TLS extension (RFC7301), sent by the client within the SSL
19169 ClientHello message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the
19170 request buffer and not to the contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so
19171 this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This is useful
19172 in ACL to make a routing decision based upon the ALPN preferences of a TLS
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020019173 client, like in the example below. See also "ssl_fc_alpn".
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110019174
19175 Examples :
19176 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
19177 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010019178 tcp-request content accept if { req.ssl_hello_type 1 }
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020019179 use_backend bk_acme if { req.ssl_alpn acme-tls/1 }
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110019180 default_backend bk_default
19181
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020019182req.ssl_ec_ext : boolean
19183 Returns a boolean identifying if client sent the Supported Elliptic Curves
19184 Extension as defined in RFC4492, section 5.1. within the SSL ClientHello
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020019185 message. This can be used to present ECC compatible clients with EC
19186 certificate and to use RSA for all others, on the same IP address. Note that
19187 this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and not to
19188 contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind"
19189 lines having the "ssl" option.
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020019190
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019191req.ssl_hello_type : integer
19192req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
19193 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
19194 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
19195 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
19196 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
19197 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
19198 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
19199 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019200
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019201req.ssl_sni : string
19202req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
19203 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
19204 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
19205 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
19206 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
19207 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020019208 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This will only work for actual
19209 implicit TLS based protocols like HTTPS (443), IMAPS (993), SMTPS (465),
19210 however it will not work for explicit TLS based protocols, like SMTP (25/587)
19211 or IMAP (143). SNI normally contains the name of the host the client tries to
19212 connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is useful for allowing or denying access
19213 to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used by the client. This test was designed to
19214 be used with TCP request content inspection. If content switching is needed,
19215 it is recommended to first wait for a complete client hello (type 1), like in
19216 the example below. See also "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019217
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019218 ACL derivatives :
Alex18c88772021-06-05 13:23:08 +020019219 req.ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019220
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019221 Examples :
19222 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
19223 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010019224 tcp-request content accept if { req.ssl_hello_type 1 }
Alex18c88772021-06-05 13:23:08 +020019225 use_backend bk_allow if { req.ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019226 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019227
Pradeep Jindalbb2acf52015-09-29 10:12:57 +053019228req.ssl_st_ext : integer
19229 Returns 0 if the client didn't send a SessionTicket TLS Extension (RFC5077)
19230 Returns 1 if the client sent SessionTicket TLS Extension
19231 Returns 2 if the client also sent non-zero length TLS SessionTicket
19232 Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and
19233 not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with
19234 "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This can for example be used to detect
19235 whether the client sent a SessionTicket or not and stick it accordingly, if
19236 no SessionTicket then stick on SessionID or don't stick as there's no server
19237 side state is there when SessionTickets are in use.
19238
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019239req.ssl_ver : integer
19240req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
19241 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
19242 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
19243 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
19244 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
19245 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
19246 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
19247 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019248 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (e.g. 3.1). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019249 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019250
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019251 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010019252 req.ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019253
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020019254res.len : integer
19255 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
19256 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
19257 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
19258 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
19259 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040019260 that data to come in and return false only when HAProxy is certain that no
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020019261 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019262 content inspection. But it may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020019263
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019264res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
19265 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020019266 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019267 the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020019268 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019269 any location. It may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019270
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019271res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
19272 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
19273 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
19274 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019275 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign. It may also be used in tcp-check based
19276 expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019277
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019278 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019279
Willy Tarreau971f7b62015-09-29 14:06:59 +020019280res.ssl_hello_type : integer
19281rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
19282 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
19283 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
19284 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
19285 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
19286 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
19287 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
19288 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
19289
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019290wait_end : boolean
19291 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
19292 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019293 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019294 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
19295 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019296 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019297 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
19298 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019299
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019300 Examples :
19301 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
19302 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
19303 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019304
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019305 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
19306 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
19307 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
19308 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
19309 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
19310 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
19311 tcp-request content reject
19312
19313
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200193147.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019315--------------------------------------
19316
19317It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
19318This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
19319data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
19320its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
19321HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
19322content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
19323to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
19324more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
19325response are indexed.
19326
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +010019327Note : Regarding HTTP processing from the tcp-request content rules, everything
19328 will work as expected from an HTTP proxy. However, from a TCP proxy,
19329 without an HTTP upgrade, it will only work for HTTP/1 content. For
19330 HTTP/2 content, only the preface is visible. Thus, it is only possible
19331 to rely to "req.proto_http", "req.ver" and eventually "method" sample
19332 fetches. All other L7 sample fetches will fail. After an HTTP upgrade,
19333 they will work in the same manner than from an HTTP proxy.
19334
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019335base : string
19336 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
19337 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
19338 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
19339 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
19340 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
19341 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
19342 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
19343 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
19344
19345 ACL derivatives :
19346 base : exact string match
19347 base_beg : prefix match
19348 base_dir : subdir match
19349 base_dom : domain match
19350 base_end : suffix match
19351 base_len : length match
19352 base_reg : regex match
19353 base_sub : substring match
19354
19355base32 : integer
19356 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
19357 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
19358 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020019359 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
19360 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
19361 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019362
19363base32+src : binary
19364 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
19365 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
19366 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
19367 per-URL counters.
19368
Yves Lafonb4d37082021-02-11 11:01:28 +010019369baseq : string
19370 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
19371 the request with the query-string, which starts at the first slash. Using this
19372 instead of "base" allows one to properly identify the target resource, for
19373 statistics or caching use cases. See also "path", "pathq" and "base".
19374
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010019375capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
19376 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
19377 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
19378 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
19379
19380capture.req.method : string
19381 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
19382 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
19383 because it's allocated.
19384
19385capture.req.uri : string
19386 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
19387 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
19388 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
19389 allocated.
19390
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020019391capture.req.ver : string
19392 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
19393 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
19394 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
19395
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010019396capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
19397 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
19398 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
19399 The first entry is an index of 0.
19400 See also: "capture response header"
19401
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020019402capture.res.ver : string
19403 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
19404 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
19405 persistent flag.
19406
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020019407req.body : binary
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020019408 This returns the HTTP request's available body as a block of data. It is
19409 recommended to use "option http-buffer-request" to be sure to wait, as much
19410 as possible, for the request's body.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020019411
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020019412req.body_param([<name>) : string
19413 This fetch assumes that the body of the POST request is url-encoded. The user
19414 can check if the "content-type" contains the value
19415 "application/x-www-form-urlencoded". This extracts the first occurrence of the
19416 parameter <name> in the body, which ends before '&'. The parameter name is
19417 case-sensitive. If no name is given, any parameter will match, and the first
19418 one will be returned. The result is a string corresponding to the value of the
19419 parameter <name> as presented in the request body (no URL decoding is
19420 performed). Note that the ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple
19421 parameters and will iteratively report all parameters values if no name is
19422 given.
19423
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020019424req.body_len : integer
19425 This returns the length of the HTTP request's available body in bytes. It may
19426 be lower than the advertised length if the body is larger than the buffer. It
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020019427 is recommended to use "option http-buffer-request" to be sure to wait, as
19428 much as possible, for the request's body.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020019429
19430req.body_size : integer
19431 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP request's body in bytes. It
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020019432 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the
19433 available data in case of chunked encoding.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020019434
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019435req.cook([<name>]) : string
19436cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
19437 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
19438 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
19439 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
19440 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
19441 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
19442 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
19443 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
19444 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
19445
19446 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010019447 req.cook([<name>]) : exact string match
19448 req.cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
19449 req.cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
19450 req.cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
19451 req.cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
19452 req.cook_len([<name>]) : length match
19453 req.cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
19454 req.cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019455
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019456req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
19457cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
19458 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
19459 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019460
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019461req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
19462cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
19463 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
19464 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
19465 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
19466 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020019467
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019468cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
19469 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
19470 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
19471 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
19472 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020019473 "appsession" did with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019474 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
19475 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
19476 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
19477 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019478
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019479hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
19480 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
19481 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
19482 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
19483 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030019484 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019485
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019486req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019487 This returns the full value of the last occurrence of header <name> in an
19488 HTTP request. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas present in the
19489 value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is sometimes useful
19490 with headers such as User-Agent.
19491
19492 When used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is
19493 found.
19494
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019495 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
19496 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
19497 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019498 with -1 being the last one.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019499
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019500req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
19501 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
19502 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019503 not specified. Like req.fhdr() it differs from res.hdr_cnt() by not splitting
19504 headers at commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019505
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019506req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019507 This returns the last comma-separated value of the header <name> in an HTTP
19508 request. The fetch considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values.
19509 This is useful if you need to process headers that are defined to be a list
19510 of values, such as Accept, or X-Forwarded-For. If full-line headers are
19511 desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC 7231 to know how
19512 certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
19513 insensitive (e.g. Connection).
19514
19515 When used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is
19516 found.
19517
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019518 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
19519 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
19520 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019521 with -1 being the last one.
19522
19523 A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header once converted to IP,
19524 associated with an IP stick-table.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019525
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019526 ACL derivatives :
19527 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
19528 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
19529 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
19530 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
19531 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
19532 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
19533 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
19534 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
19535
19536req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
19537hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
19538 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
19539 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019540 <name> is not specified. Like req.hdr() it counts each comma separated
19541 part of the header's value. If counting of full-line headers is desired,
19542 then req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead.
19543
19544 With ACLs, it can be used to detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific
19545 header, as well as to block request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests
19546 which contain more than one of certain headers.
19547
19548 Refer to req.hdr() for more information on header matching.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019549
19550req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
19551hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
19552 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
19553 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
19554 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
Willy Tarreau7b0e00d2021-03-25 14:12:29 +010019555 of every header is checked. The parser strictly adheres to the format
19556 described in RFC7239, with the extension that IPv4 addresses may optionally
19557 be followed by a colon (':') and a valid decimal port number (0 to 65535),
19558 which will be silently dropped. All other forms will not match and will
19559 cause the address to be ignored.
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019560
19561 The <occ> parameter is processed as with req.hdr().
19562
19563 A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019564
19565req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
19566hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
19567 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
19568 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
19569 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019570
19571 The <occ> parameter is processed as with req.hdr().
19572
19573 A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019574
Christopher Faulet687a68e2020-11-24 17:13:24 +010019575req.hdrs : string
19576 Returns the current request headers as string including the last empty line
19577 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
19578 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
19579 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
19580
19581req.hdrs_bin : binary
19582 Returns the current request headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
19583 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. Each string is described
19584 by a length followed by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The
19585 length is represented using the variable integer encoding detailed in the
19586 SPOE documentation. The end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header
19587 names and values (length of 0 for both).
19588
19589 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010019590
Christopher Faulet687a68e2020-11-24 17:13:24 +010019591 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
19592 str: <int:length><bytes>
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010019593
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019594http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
19595 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
19596 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
19597 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
19598 basic auth is supported.
19599
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010019600http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
19601 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
19602 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
19603 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
19604 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019605 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
19606 basic auth is supported.
19607
19608 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010019609 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
19610 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
19611 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
19612 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019613
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020019614http_auth_pass : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010019615 Returns the user's password found in the authentication data received from
19616 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
19617 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020019618
19619http_auth_type : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010019620 Returns the authentication method found in the authentication data received from
19621 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
19622 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020019623
19624http_auth_user : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010019625 Returns the user name found in the authentication data received from the
19626 client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are performed by
19627 this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020019628
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019629http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020019630 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
19631 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019632 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
19633 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020019634
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019635method : integer + string
19636 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
19637 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
19638 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
19639 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
19640 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
19641 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
19642 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019643
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019644 ACL derivatives :
19645 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019646
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019647 Example :
19648 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
19649 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
19650 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019651
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019652path : string
19653 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
19654 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
19655 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
19656 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
19657 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019658 used to match exact file names (e.g. "/login.php"), or directory parts using
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019659 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019660
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019661 ACL derivatives :
19662 path : exact string match
19663 path_beg : prefix match
19664 path_dir : subdir match
19665 path_dom : domain match
19666 path_end : suffix match
19667 path_len : length match
19668 path_reg : regex match
19669 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019670
Christopher Faulete720c322020-09-02 17:25:18 +020019671pathq : string
19672 This extracts the request's URL path with the query-string, which starts at
19673 the first slash. This sample fetch is pretty handy to always retrieve a
19674 relative URI, excluding the scheme and the authority part, if any. Indeed,
19675 while it is the common representation for an HTTP/1.1 request target, in
19676 HTTP/2, an absolute URI is often used. This sample fetch will return the same
19677 result in both cases.
19678
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010019679query : string
19680 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
19681 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
19682 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
19683 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010019684 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the complement of "path"
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010019685 which stops before the question mark.
19686
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010019687req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
19688 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
19689 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
19690 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
19691 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
19692
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019693req.ver : string
19694req_ver : string (deprecated)
19695 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
19696 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
19697 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019698
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019699 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010019700 req.ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020019701
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019702res.body : binary
19703 This returns the HTTP response's available body as a block of data. Unlike
19704 the request side, there is no directive to wait for the response's body. This
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019705 sample fetch is really useful (and usable) in the health-check context.
19706
19707 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019708
19709res.body_len : integer
19710 This returns the length of the HTTP response available body in bytes. Unlike
19711 the request side, there is no directive to wait for the response's body. This
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019712 sample fetch is really useful (and usable) in the health-check context.
19713
19714 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019715
19716res.body_size : integer
19717 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP response body in bytes. It
19718 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the
19719 available data in case of chunked encoding. Unlike the request side, there is
19720 no directive to wait for the response body. This sample fetch is really
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019721 useful (and usable) in the health-check context.
19722
19723 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019724
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonbf971212020-10-27 11:55:57 +010019725res.cache_hit : boolean
19726 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been built out of an
19727 HTTP cache entry, otherwise returns boolean "false".
19728
19729res.cache_name : string
19730 Returns a string containing the name of the HTTP cache that was used to
19731 build the HTTP response if res.cache_hit is true, otherwise returns an
19732 empty string.
19733
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019734res.comp : boolean
19735 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
19736 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
19737 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019738
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019739res.comp_algo : string
19740 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
19741 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
19742 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019743
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019744res.cook([<name>]) : string
19745scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
19746 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
19747 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019748 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
19749
19750 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020019751
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019752 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010019753 res.scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020019754
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019755res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
19756scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
19757 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
19758 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019759 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
19760
19761 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019762
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019763res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
19764scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
19765 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
19766 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019767 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
19768
19769 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019770
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019771res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019772 This fetch works like the req.fhdr() fetch with the difference that it acts
19773 on the headers within an HTTP response.
19774
19775 Like req.fhdr() the res.fhdr() fetch returns full values. If the header is
19776 defined to be a list you should use res.hdr().
19777
19778 This fetch is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or Expires.
19779
19780 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019781
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019782res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019783 This fetch works like the req.fhdr_cnt() fetch with the difference that it
19784 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
19785
19786 Like req.fhdr_cnt() the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch acts on full values. If the
19787 header is defined to be a list you should use res.hdr_cnt().
19788
19789 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019790
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019791res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
19792shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019793 This fetch works like the req.hdr() fetch with the difference that it acts
19794 on the headers within an HTTP response.
19795
Ilya Shipitsinacf84592021-02-06 22:29:08 +050019796 Like req.hdr() the res.hdr() fetch considers the comma to be a delimiter. If
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019797 this is not desired res.fhdr() should be used.
19798
19799 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019800
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019801 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010019802 res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
19803 res.hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
19804 res.hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
19805 res.hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
19806 res.hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
19807 res.hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
19808 res.hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
19809 res.hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019810
19811res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
19812shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019813 This fetch works like the req.hdr_cnt() fetch with the difference that it
19814 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
19815
19816 Like req.hdr_cnt() the res.hdr_cnt() fetch considers the comma to be a
Ilya Shipitsinacf84592021-02-06 22:29:08 +050019817 delimiter. If this is not desired res.fhdr_cnt() should be used.
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019818
19819 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019820
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019821res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
19822shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019823 This fetch works like the req.hdr_ip() fetch with the difference that it
19824 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
19825
19826 This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
19827
19828 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019829
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010019830res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
19831 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
19832 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
19833 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019834 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
19835
19836 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010019837
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019838res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
19839shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019840 This fetch works like the req.hdr_val() fetch with the difference that it
19841 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
19842
19843 This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
19844
19845 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019846
19847res.hdrs : string
19848 Returns the current response headers as string including the last empty line
19849 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
19850 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019851 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
19852
19853 It may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019854
19855res.hdrs_bin : binary
19856 Returns the current response headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
19857 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. It may be used in
19858 tcp-check based expect rules. Each string is described by a length followed
19859 by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The length is represented
19860 using the variable integer encoding detailed in the SPOE documentation. The
19861 end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header names and values
19862 (length of 0 for both).
19863
19864 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
19865
19866 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
19867 str: <int:length><bytes>
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010019868
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019869res.ver : string
19870resp_ver : string (deprecated)
19871 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019872 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
19873
19874 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020019875
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019876 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010019877 resp.ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010019878
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019879set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
19880 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
19881 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020019882 can be comparable to what "appsession" did with default options, but with
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019883 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010019884
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019885 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
19886 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010019887
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019888status : integer
19889 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
19890 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019891 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
19892
19893 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019894
Thierry Fournier0e00dca2016-04-07 15:47:40 +020019895unique-id : string
19896 Returns the unique-id attached to the request. The directive
19897 "unique-id-format" must be set. If it is not set, the unique-id sample fetch
19898 fails. Note that the unique-id is usually used with HTTP requests, however this
19899 sample fetch can be used with other protocols. Obviously, if it is used with
19900 other protocols than HTTP, the unique-id-format directive must not contain
19901 HTTP parts. See: unique-id-format and unique-id-header
19902
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019903url : string
19904 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
19905 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
19906 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
19907 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
19908 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
19909 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
19910 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019911
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019912 ACL derivatives :
19913 url : exact string match
19914 url_beg : prefix match
19915 url_dir : subdir match
19916 url_dom : domain match
19917 url_end : suffix match
19918 url_len : length match
19919 url_reg : regex match
19920 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019921
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019922url_ip : ip
19923 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
19924 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
19925 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
19926 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
19927 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
19928 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
19929 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019930
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019931url_port : integer
19932 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
19933 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
19934 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
19935 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019936
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020019937urlp([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
19938url_param([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019939 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
19940 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020019941 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. If no name is given,
19942 any parameter will match, and the first one will be returned. The result is
19943 a string corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in
19944 the request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019945 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
19946 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020019947 this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and will iteratively report all
19948 parameters values if no name is given
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019949
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019950 ACL derivatives :
19951 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
19952 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
19953 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
19954 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
19955 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
19956 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
19957 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
19958 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019959
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019960
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019961 Example :
19962 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
19963 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
19964 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
19965 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019966
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030019967urlp_val([<name>[,<delim>]]) : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019968 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
19969 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
19970 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020019971
Dragan Dosen0070cd52016-06-16 12:19:49 +020019972url32 : integer
19973 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value obtained by concatenating the first
19974 Host header and the whole URL including parameters (not only the path part of
19975 the request, as in the "base32" fetch above). This is useful to track per-URL
19976 activity. A shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of memory. The output type
19977 is an unsigned integer.
19978
19979url32+src : binary
19980 This returns the concatenation of the "url32" fetch and the "src" fetch. The
19981 resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes depending on
19982 the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP, per-URL counters.
19983
Christopher Faulet16032ab2020-04-30 11:30:00 +020019984
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +0200199857.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019986---------------------------------------
19987
19988This set of sample fetch methods is reserved to developers and must never be
19989used on a production environment, except on developer demand, for debugging
19990purposes. Moreover, no special care will be taken on backwards compatibility.
19991There is no warranty the following sample fetches will never change, be renamed
19992or simply removed. So be really careful if you should use one of them. To avoid
19993any ambiguity, these sample fetches are placed in the dedicated scope "internal",
19994for instance "internal.strm.is_htx".
19995
19996internal.htx.data : integer
19997 Returns the size in bytes used by data in the HTX message associated to a
19998 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
19999
20000internal.htx.free : integer
20001 Returns the free space (size - used) in bytes in the HTX message associated
20002 to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
20003
20004internal.htx.free_data : integer
20005 Returns the free space for the data in bytes in the HTX message associated to
20006 a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
20007
20008internal.htx.has_eom : boolean
Christopher Fauletd1ac2b92020-12-02 19:12:22 +010020009 Returns true if the HTX message associated to a channel contains the
20010 end-of-message flag (EOM). Otherwise, it returns false. The channel is chosen
20011 depending on the sample direction.
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010020012
20013internal.htx.nbblks : integer
20014 Returns the number of blocks present in the HTX message associated to a
20015 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
20016
20017internal.htx.size : integer
20018 Returns the total size in bytes of the HTX message associated to a
20019 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
20020
20021internal.htx.used : integer
20022 Returns the total size used in bytes (data + metadata) in the HTX message
20023 associated to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
20024 direction.
20025
20026internal.htx_blk.size(<idx>) : integer
20027 Returns the size of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
20028 associated to a channel or 0 if it does not exist. The channel is chosen
20029 depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one
20030 of the special value :
20031 * head : The oldest inserted block
20032 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050020033 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010020034
20035internal.htx_blk.type(<idx>) : string
20036 Returns the type of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
20037 associated to a channel or "HTX_BLK_UNUSED" if it does not exist. The channel
20038 is chosen depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive
20039 integer or one of the special value :
20040 * head : The oldest inserted block
20041 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050020042 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010020043
20044internal.htx_blk.data(<idx>) : binary
20045 Returns the value of the DATA block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
20046 associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if it is
20047 not a DATA block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
20048 <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
20049
20050 * head : The oldest inserted block
20051 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050020052 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010020053
20054internal.htx_blk.hdrname(<idx>) : string
20055 Returns the header name of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
20056 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
20057 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
20058 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
20059
20060 * head : The oldest inserted block
20061 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050020062 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010020063
20064internal.htx_blk.hdrval(<idx>) : string
20065 Returns the header value of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
20066 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
20067 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
20068 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
20069
20070 * head : The oldest inserted block
20071 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050020072 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010020073
20074internal.htx_blk.start_line(<idx>) : string
20075 Returns the value of the REQ_SL or RES_SL block at the position <idx> in the
20076 HTX message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist
20077 or if it is not a SL block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
20078 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
20079
20080 * head : The oldest inserted block
20081 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050020082 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010020083
20084internal.strm.is_htx : boolean
20085 Returns true if the current stream is an HTX stream. It means the data in the
20086 channels buffers are stored using the internal HTX representation. Otherwise,
20087 it returns false.
20088
20089
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200200907.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020091---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010020092
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020093Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
20094every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020020095order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010020096
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020097ACL name Equivalent to Usage
Christopher Faulet779184e2021-04-01 17:24:04 +020020098---------------+----------------------------------+------------------------------------------------------
20099FALSE always_false never match
20100HTTP req.proto_http match if request protocol is valid HTTP
20101HTTP_1.0 req.ver 1.0 match if HTTP request version is 1.0
20102HTTP_1.1 req.ver 1.1 match if HTTP request version is 1.1
Christopher Faulet8043e832021-03-26 16:00:54 +010020103HTTP_2.0 req.ver 2.0 match if HTTP request version is 2.0
Christopher Faulet779184e2021-04-01 17:24:04 +020020104HTTP_CONTENT req.hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length in the HTTP request
20105HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
20106HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
20107HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
20108LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
20109METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
20110METH_DELETE method DELETE match HTTP DELETE method
20111METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
20112METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
20113METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
20114METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
20115METH_PUT method PUT match HTTP PUT method
20116METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
20117RDP_COOKIE req.rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie in the request buffer
20118REQ_CONTENT req.len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
20119TRUE always_true always match
20120WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
20121---------------+----------------------------------+------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010020122
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010020123
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200201248. Logging
20125----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010020126
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020127One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
20128provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
20129very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
20130provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
20131state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010020132to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020133headers.
20134
20135In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
20136about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
20137send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
20138
20139 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
20140 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
20141 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
20142 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
20143 at the termination.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020144 - per-request control of log-level, e.g.
Jim Freeman9e8714b2015-05-26 09:16:34 -060020145 http-request set-log-level silent if sensitive_request
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020146
20147The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
20148allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
20149as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
20150while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
20151real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
20152delay.
20153
20154
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200201558.1. Log levels
20156---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020157
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090020158TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020159source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090020160HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
20161in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
20162track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
20163syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
20164about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020165
20166
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200201678.2. Log formats
20168----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020169
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020170HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090020171and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
20172slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
20173options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020174
20175 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
20176 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
20177 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
20178 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
20179 extents.
20180
20181 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
20182 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
20183 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
20184 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
20185 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
20186
20187 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
20188 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
20189 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
20190 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
20191 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
20192
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020020193 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
20194 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
20195 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
20196 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
20197
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020198 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
20199
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020200Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
20201specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
20202field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
20203servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
20204always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
20205identifier.
20206
20207Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
20208 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
20209 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
20210 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
20211 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
20212
20213
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200202148.2.1. Default log format
20215-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020216
20217This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
20218as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
20219format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
20220
20221 Example :
20222 listen www
20223 mode http
20224 log global
20225 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
20226
20227 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
20228 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
20229 (www/HTTP)
20230
20231 Field Format Extract from the example above
20232 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
20233 2 'Connect from' Connect from
20234 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
20235 4 'to' to
20236 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
20237 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
20238
20239Detailed fields description :
20240 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
20241 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
20242 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
20243 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
20244 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
20245 and processed the connection.
20246 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
20247
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010020248In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
20249"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
20250connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
20251
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020252It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
20253will eventually disappear.
20254
20255
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200202568.2.2. TCP log format
20257---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020258
20259The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
20260is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
20261information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
20262counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
20263emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
20264environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
20265the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
20266sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020020267specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
20268not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
20269fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
20270marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020271
20272 Example :
20273 frontend fnt
20274 mode tcp
20275 option tcplog
20276 log global
20277 default_backend bck
20278
20279 backend bck
20280 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
20281
20282 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
20283 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
20284 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
20285
20286 Field Format Extract from the example above
20287 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
20288 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
20289 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
20290 4 frontend_name fnt
20291 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
20292 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
20293 7 bytes_read* 212
20294 8 termination_state --
20295 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
20296 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
20297
20298Detailed fields description :
20299 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020300 connection to HAProxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010020301 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
20302 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010020303 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020304 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010020305 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020306
20307 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010020308 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
20309 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
20310 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020311
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020312 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by HAProxy
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020313 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
20314 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020315 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. When used in
20316 HTTP mode, the accept_date field will be reset to the first moment the
20317 connection is ready to receive a new request (end of previous response for
20318 HTTP/1, immediately after previous request for HTTP/2).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020319
20320 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
20321 and processed the connection.
20322
20323 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
20324 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
20325 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
20326 applications.
20327
20328 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
20329 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
20330 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
20331 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
20332 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
20333
20334 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
20335 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
20336 See "Timers" below for more details.
20337
20338 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
20339 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
20340 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
20341 "Timers" below for more details.
20342
20343 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030020344 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020345 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
20346 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
20347 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
20348 details.
20349
20350 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
20351 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
20352 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
20353 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
20354 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
20355
20356 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
20357 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
20358 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
20359 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
20360 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
20361 for more details.
20362
20363 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040020364 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020365 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
20366 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
20367 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020368 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020369
20370 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
20371 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
20372 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
20373 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
20374 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
20375 caused by a denial of service attack.
20376
20377 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
20378 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
20379 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
20380 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
20381 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
20382 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
20383 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
20384 denial of service attack.
20385
20386 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
20387 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
20388 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
20389 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
20390 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
20391 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
20392 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
20393 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
20394 be processed than on other servers.
20395
20396 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
20397 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
20398 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
20399 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020400 HAProxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020401 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
20402 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
20403 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
20404 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
20405 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
20406 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
20407 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
20408 should not be attributed to the logged server.
20409
20410 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
20411 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
20412 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
20413 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
20414 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
20415 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020416 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020417 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
20418
20419 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
20420 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
20421 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
20422 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
20423 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
20424 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020425 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020426 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
20427 occurs.
20428
20429
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200204308.2.3. HTTP log format
20431----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020432
20433The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
20434is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
20435the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
20436are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
20437emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
20438generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
20439"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
20440which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020020441frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
20442is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020443
20444Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
20445slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
20446with a star ('*') after the field name below.
20447
20448 Example :
20449 frontend http-in
20450 mode http
20451 option httplog
20452 log global
20453 default_backend bck
20454
20455 backend static
20456 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
20457
20458 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
20459 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
20460 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010020461 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020462
20463 Field Format Extract from the example above
20464 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
20465 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020466 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020467 4 frontend_name http-in
20468 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020469 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020470 7 status_code 200
20471 8 bytes_read* 2750
20472 9 captured_request_cookie -
20473 10 captured_response_cookie -
20474 11 termination_state ----
20475 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
20476 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
20477 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
20478 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
20479 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010020480
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020481Detailed fields description :
20482 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020483 connection to HAProxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010020484 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
20485 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010020486 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020487 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010020488 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020489
20490 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010020491 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
20492 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
20493 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020494
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020495 - "request_date" is the exact date when the first byte of the HTTP request
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020496 was received by HAProxy (log field %tr).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020497
20498 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
20499 and processed the connection.
20500
20501 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
20502 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
20503 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
20504
20505 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
20506 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
20507 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
20508 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
20509 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
20510 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
20511
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020512 - "TR" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for a full HTTP
20513 request from the client (not counting body) after the first byte was
20514 received. It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before a complete
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050020515 request could be received or a bad request was received. It should
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020516 always be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet.
20517 Large times here generally indicate network issues between the client and
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020518 HAProxy or requests being typed by hand. See section 8.4 "Timing Events"
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020519 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020520
20521 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
20522 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020523 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020524
20525 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
20526 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020527 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See section
20528 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020529
20530 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
20531 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
20532 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
20533 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
20534 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020535 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See section 8.4
20536 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020537
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020538 - "Ta" is the time the request remained active in HAProxy, which is the total
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020539 time in milliseconds elapsed between the first byte of the request was
20540 received and the last byte of response was sent. It covers all possible
20541 processing except the handshake (see Th) and idle time (see Ti). There is
20542 one exception, if "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting
20543 stops at the moment the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is
20544 prepended before the value, indicating that the final one will be larger.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020545 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020546
20547 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020548 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by HAProxy when
20549 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by HAProxy.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020550
20551 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
20552 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050020553 specified, this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020554 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
20555 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
20556 overflowing.
20557
20558 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
20559 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
20560 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
20561 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
20562 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
20563 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
20564 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
20565 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
20566
20567 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
20568 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
20569 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
20570 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
20571 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
20572 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
20573 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
20574 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
20575
20576 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
20577 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
20578 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
20579 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
20580 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
20581 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
20582 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
20583
20584 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040020585 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020586 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
20587 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
20588 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020589 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020590 system.
20591
20592 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
20593 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
20594 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
20595 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
20596 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
20597 caused by a denial of service attack.
20598
20599 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
20600 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
20601 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
20602 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
20603 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
20604 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
20605 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
20606 denial of service attack.
20607
20608 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
20609 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
20610 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
20611 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
20612 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
20613 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
20614 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
20615 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
20616 processed than on other servers.
20617
20618 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
20619 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
20620 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
20621 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020622 HAProxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020623 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
20624 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
20625 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
20626 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
20627 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
20628 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
20629 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
20630 should not be attributed to the logged server.
20631
20632 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
20633 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
20634 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
20635 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
20636 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
20637 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020638 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020639 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
20640
20641 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
20642 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
20643 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
20644 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
20645 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
20646 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020647 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020648 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
20649 occurs.
20650
20651 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
20652 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
20653 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
20654 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
20655 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
20656 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
20657 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
20658 cookies" below for more details.
20659
20660 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
20661 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
20662 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
20663 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
20664 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
20665 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
20666 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
20667 and cookies" below for more details.
20668
20669 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
20670 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
20671 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
20672 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
20673 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
20674 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
20675 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
20676 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
20677
20678
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200206798.2.4. Custom log format
20680------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020681
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020682The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020683mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020684
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020685HAProxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020686Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
20687separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
20688prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
20689
20690Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
20691variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010020692("Q") and escaped ("E") string formats.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020693
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010020694If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020020695as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010020696less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
20697the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
20698
Dragan Dosen1e3b16f2020-06-23 18:16:44 +020020699Note: spaces must be escaped. In configuration directives "log-format",
20700"log-format-sd" and "unique-id-format", spaces are considered as
20701delimiters and are merged. In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be
20702preceded by another '%' resulting in '%%'.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020703
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010020704Note: when using the RFC5424 syslog message format, the characters '"',
20705'\' and ']' inside PARAM-VALUE should be escaped with '\' as prefix (see
20706https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3.3 for more details). In
20707such cases, the use of the flag "E" should be considered.
20708
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020709Flags are :
20710 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040020711 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010020712 * E: escape characters '"', '\' and ']' in a string with '\' as prefix
20713 (intended purpose is for the RFC5424 structured-data log formats)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020714
20715 Example:
20716
20717 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
20718 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
20719
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010020720 log-format-sd %{+Q,+E}o\ [exampleSDID@1234\ header=%[capture.req.hdr(0)]]
20721
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020722At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
20723
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020724 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
20725 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020726
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020727the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020728
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020729 log-format "%{+Q}o %{-Q}ci - - [%trg] %r %ST %B \"\" \"\" %cp \
20730 %ms %ft %b %s %TR %Tw %Tc %Tr %Ta %tsc %ac %fc \
20731 %bc %sc %rc %sq %bq %CC %CS %hrl %hsl"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020732
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020733and the default TCP format is defined this way :
20734
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020735 log-format "%ci:%cp [%t] %ft %b/%s %Tw/%Tc/%Tt %B %ts \
20736 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq"
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020737
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020738Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
20739
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020740 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020020741 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020742 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
20743 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
20744 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020745 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
20746 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
20747 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020020748 | | %H | hostname | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000020749 | H | %HM | HTTP method (ex: POST) | string |
Maciej Zdeb21acc332020-11-26 10:45:52 +000020750 | H | %HP | HTTP request URI without query string | string |
Maciej Zdebfcdfd852020-11-30 18:27:47 +000020751 | H | %HPO | HTTP path only (without host nor query string)| string |
Andrew Hayworthe63ac872015-07-31 16:14:16 +000020752 | H | %HQ | HTTP request URI query string (ex: ?bar=baz) | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000020753 | H | %HU | HTTP request URI (ex: /foo?bar=baz) | string |
20754 | H | %HV | HTTP version (ex: HTTP/1.0) | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010020755 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020020756 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020020757 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
Christopher Faulet3f177162021-12-03 10:48:36 +010020758 | H | %Ta | Active time of the request (from TR to end) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020759 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Willy Tarreau27b639d2016-05-17 17:55:27 +020020760 | | %Td | Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr) | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080020761 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020762 | | %Th | connection handshake time (SSL, PROXY proto) | numeric |
20763 | H | %Ti | idle time before the HTTP request | numeric |
20764 | H | %Tq | Th + Ti + TR | numeric |
20765 | H | %TR | time to receive the full request from 1st byte| numeric |
20766 | H | %Tr | Tr (response time) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020020767 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020768 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000020769 | | %Tu | Tu | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020770 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020771 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020772 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
20773 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020774 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
20775 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
20776 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020777 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020778 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
20779 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020780 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020781 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
20782 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
20783 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020020784 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020020785 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020020786 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
20787 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
20788 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
20789 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
Willy Tarreau812c88e2015-08-09 10:56:35 +020020790 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds (left-padded with 0) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020020791 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020020792 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020793 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010020794 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020795 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020796 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
20797 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
20798 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020799 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020020800 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
20801 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020802 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020803 | H | %tr | date_time of HTTP request | date |
20804 | H | %trg | gmt_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
Jens Bissinger15c64ff2018-08-23 14:11:27 +020020805 | H | %trl | local_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020806 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020020807 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020808 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020809
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020020810 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020811
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010020812
208138.2.5. Error log format
20814-----------------------
20815
20816When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020817protocol header, HAProxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010020818By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
20819"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020820will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (e.g. probes) are not
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010020821logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
20822
20823The format looks like this :
20824
20825 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
20826 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
20827 Connection error during SSL handshake
20828
20829 Field Format Extract from the example above
20830 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
20831 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
20832 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
20833 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
20834 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
20835
20836These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
20837failures.
20838
20839
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200208408.3. Advanced logging options
20841-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020842
20843Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
20844just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
20845options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
20846for more information about their usage.
20847
20848
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200208498.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
20850------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020851
20852It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020853HAProxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020854commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
20855monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
20856ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
20857
20858 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
20859 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
20860 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
20861 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
20862
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +020020863 - it is possible to use the "http-request set-log-level silent" action using
20864 a variety of conditions (source networks, paths, user-agents, etc).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020865
20866 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
20867 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
20868 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
20869
20870
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200208718.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
20872----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020873
20874The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
20875what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
20876or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020877"option logasap" in the frontend. HAProxy will then log as soon as possible,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020878just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
20879log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
20880after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
20881is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
20882with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
20883with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
20884
20885
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200208868.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
20887------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020020888
20889Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
20890for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
20891"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
20892retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
20893raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
20894a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
20895file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
20896you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
20897"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
20898
20899
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200209008.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
20901--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020020902
20903Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
20904multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
20905them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
20906"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
20907logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
20908error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
20909and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
20910too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
20911useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
20912alternative.
20913
20914
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200209158.4. Timing events
20916------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020917
20918Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
20919reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
20920the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
20921frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020922mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/Ta". In
20923addition, three other measures are provided, "Th", "Ti", and "Tq".
20924
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010020925Timings events in HTTP mode:
20926
20927 first request 2nd request
20928 |<-------------------------------->|<-------------- ...
20929 t tr t tr ...
20930 ---|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|--
20931 : Th Ti TR Tw Tc Tr Td : Ti ...
20932 :<---- Tq ---->: :
20933 :<-------------- Tt -------------->:
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000020934 :<-- -----Tu--------------->:
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010020935 :<--------- Ta --------->:
20936
20937Timings events in TCP mode:
20938
20939 TCP session
20940 |<----------------->|
20941 t t
20942 ---|----|----|----|----|---
20943 | Th Tw Tc Td |
20944 |<------ Tt ------->|
20945
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020946 - Th: total time to accept tcp connection and execute handshakes for low level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020947 protocols. Currently, these protocols are proxy-protocol and SSL. This may
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020948 only happen once during the whole connection's lifetime. A large time here
20949 may indicate that the client only pre-established the connection without
20950 speaking, that it is experiencing network issues preventing it from
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020951 completing a handshake in a reasonable time (e.g. MTU issues), or that an
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020952 SSL handshake was very expensive to compute. Please note that this time is
20953 reported only before the first request, so it is safe to average it over
20954 all request to calculate the amortized value. The second and subsequent
20955 request will always report zero here.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020956
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020957 - Ti: is the idle time before the HTTP request (HTTP mode only). This timer
20958 counts between the end of the handshakes and the first byte of the HTTP
20959 request. When dealing with a second request in keep-alive mode, it starts
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020960 to count after the end of the transmission the previous response. When a
20961 multiplexed protocol such as HTTP/2 is used, it starts to count immediately
20962 after the previous request. Some browsers pre-establish connections to a
20963 server in order to reduce the latency of a future request, and keep them
20964 pending until they need it. This delay will be reported as the idle time. A
20965 value of -1 indicates that nothing was received on the connection.
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020966
20967 - TR: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
20968 elapsed between the first bytes received and the moment the proxy received
20969 the empty line marking the end of the HTTP headers. The value "-1"
20970 indicates that the end of headers has never been seen. This happens when
20971 the client closes prematurely or times out. This time is usually very short
20972 since most requests fit in a single packet. A large time may indicate a
20973 request typed by hand during a test.
20974
20975 - Tq: total time to get the client request from the accept date or since the
20976 emission of the last byte of the previous response (HTTP mode only). It's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020977 exactly equal to Th + Ti + TR unless any of them is -1, in which case it
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020978 returns -1 as well. This timer used to be very useful before the arrival of
20979 HTTP keep-alive and browsers' pre-connect feature. It's recommended to drop
20980 it in favor of TR nowadays, as the idle time adds a lot of noise to the
20981 reports.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020982
20983 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
20984 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
20985 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
20986 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
20987 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
20988
20989 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
20990 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
20991 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
20992 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
20993 connection never established.
20994
20995 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
20996 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
20997 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
20998 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
20999 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
21000 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
21001 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
21002 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
21003 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
21004 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
21005 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
21006
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021007 - Ta: total active time for the HTTP request, between the moment the proxy
21008 received the first byte of the request header and the emission of the last
21009 byte of the response body. The exception is when the "logasap" option is
21010 specified. In this case, it only equals (TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is prefixed with
21011 a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data transmission time,
21012 by subtracting other timers when valid :
21013
21014 Td = Ta - (TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
21015
21016 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. Note that
21017 "Ta" can never be negative.
21018
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021019 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
21020 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021021 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+Ti+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and
21022 is prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030021023 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021024
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021025 Td = Tt - (Th + Ti + TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021026
21027 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021028 mode, "Ti", "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never
21029 be negative and that for HTTP, Tt is simply equal to (Th+Ti+Ta).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021030
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000021031 - Tu: total estimated time as seen from client, between the moment the proxy
21032 accepted it and the moment both ends were closed, without idle time.
21033 This is useful to roughly measure end-to-end time as a user would see it,
21034 without idle time pollution from keep-alive time between requests. This
21035 timer in only an estimation of time seen by user as it assumes network
21036 latency is the same in both directions. The exception is when the "logasap"
21037 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is
21038 prefixed with a '+' sign.
21039
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021040These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
21041protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
21042that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021043due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Ta" or
21044"Tt" is close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means
21045that a session has been aborted on timeout.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021046
21047Most common cases :
21048
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021049 - If "Th" or "Ti" are close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between
21050 the client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might
21051 happen when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It
21052 may happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network
21053 cause. Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021054 ended, HAProxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds.
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021055 The time spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay
21056 processing of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the
21057 order of a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of
21058 new connections have been accepted at once. Using one of the keep-alive
21059 modes may display larger idle times since "Ti" measures the time spent
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020021060 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021061
21062 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
21063 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
21064 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
21065 of ms on remote networks.
21066
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020021067 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
21068 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
21069 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021070
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021071 - If "Ta" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
21072 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection while
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021073 HAProxy is running in tunnel mode and both have agreed on a keep-alive
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021074 connection mode. In order to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify
21075 one of the HTTP options to manipulate keep-alive or close options on either
21076 the frontend or the backend. Having the smallest possible 'Ta' or 'Tt' is
21077 important when connection regulation is used with the "maxconn" option on
21078 the servers, since no new connection will be sent to the server until
21079 another one is released.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021080
21081Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
21082
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021083 TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Ta The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021084 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021085 except "Ta" which is shorter than reality.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021086
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021087 -1/xx/xx/xx/Ta The client was not able to send a complete request in time
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021088 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
21089 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
21090
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021091 TR/-1/xx/xx/Ta It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021092 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
21093 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
21094 flags.
21095
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021096 TR/Tw/-1/xx/Ta The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
21097 actively refused it or it timed out after Ta-(TR+Tw) ms.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021098 Check the session termination flags, then check the
21099 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
21100 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
21101 the client connection was maintained open.
21102
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021103 TR/Tw/Tc/-1/Ta The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030021104 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021105 unexpectedly after Ta-(TR+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021106 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
21107
21108
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200211098.5. Session state at disconnection
21110-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021111
21112TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
21113"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
211142-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
21115each of which has a special meaning :
21116
21117 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
21118 session to terminate :
21119
21120 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
21121
21122 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
21123 server explicitly refused it.
21124
21125 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
21126 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
21127 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
21128 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021129 (e.g. cacheable cookie).
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020021130
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021131 L : the session was locally processed by HAProxy and was not passed to
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020021132 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021133
21134 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
21135 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
21136 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
21137 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
21138 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
21139
21140 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
21141 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
21142 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
21143 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
21144 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
21145
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021146 D : the session was killed by HAProxy because the server was detected
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090021147 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
21148
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021149 U : the session was killed by HAProxy on this backup server because an
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070021150 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
21151 backup connections when going up.
21152
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021153 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on HAProxy.
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020021154
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021155 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
21156 send or receive data.
21157
21158 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
21159 send or receive data.
21160
21161 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
21162 with nothing left in the buffers.
21163
21164 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
21165
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010021166 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021167 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
21168
21169 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
21170 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
21171 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
21172 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
21173 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
21174
21175 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
21176 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
21177
21178 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
21179 server (HTTP only).
21180
21181 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
21182
21183 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
21184 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
21185 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
21186
21187 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
21188 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
21189 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
21190
21191 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
21192
21193 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
21194 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
21195
21196 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
21197 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
21198 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
21199
21200 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
21201 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020021202 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
21203 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021204
21205 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
21206 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
21207 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
21208 another server.
21209
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021210 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021211 server.
21212
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021213 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
21214 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
21215 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
21216 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
21217
21218 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
21219 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
21220 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
21221 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
21222
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020021223 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
21224 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
21225 "use-server" rule).
21226
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021227 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
21228
21229 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
21230 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
21231
21232 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
21233
21234 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
21235 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
21236 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
21237
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021238 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
21239 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030021240 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021241 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
21242 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
21243
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021244 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
21245
21246 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
21247 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
21248
21249 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
21250
21251 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
21252
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021253The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
21254was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021255helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
21256starvation, attacks, etc...
21257
21258The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
21259alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
21260easier finding and understanding.
21261
21262 Flags Reason
21263
21264 -- Normal termination.
21265
21266 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021267 server. This can happen when HAProxy tries to connect to a recently
21268 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while HAProxy is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021269 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
21270
21271 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
21272 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021273 client and HAProxy which decided to actively break the connection,
21274 by network routing issues between the client and HAProxy, or by a
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021275 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
21276 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010021277
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021278 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
21279 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020021280 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021281
21282 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
21283 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
21284 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
21285
21286 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
21287 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
21288 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
21289 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
21290 the server takes too long to respond.
21291
21292 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
21293 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
21294 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
21295 long a time to respond.
21296
21297 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
21298 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
21299 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021300 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between HAProxy
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020021301 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
21302 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021303
21304 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
21305 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
21306 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
21307 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
21308 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020021309 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020021310 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
21311 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
21312 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
21313 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
21314 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
21315 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
21316 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
21317 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021318 around the undesirable effects of this behavior by adding "option
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020021319 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
21320 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
21321 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021322
21323 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
21324 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020021325 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
21326 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
21327 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
21328 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021329
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021330 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by HAProxy. Generally
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020021331 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
21332
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021333 SC The server or an equipment between it and HAProxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021334 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
21335 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021336 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (e.g. no route,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021337 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
21338 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
21339
21340 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
21341 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
21342 503 or 504 here.
21343
21344 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021345 transfer. This usually means that HAProxy has received an RST from
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021346 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
21347 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
21348 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
21349
21350 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
21351 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021352 by too short timeouts on L4 equipment before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021353 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021354 between the client and the server expiring first on HAProxy.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021355
21356 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
21357 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
21358 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
21359 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
21360 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
21361 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021362 between HAProxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021363
21364 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
21365 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
21366 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
21367 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
21368 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
21369 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
21370 solution is to fix the application.
21371
21372 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
21373 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
21374 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
21375 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
21376 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
21377 external attacks.
21378
21379 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -070021380 process's socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020021381 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021382 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
21383 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
21384
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010021385 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
21386 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
21387 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021388 the client. HAProxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020021389 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010021390
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021391 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
21392 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
21393 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
21394 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010021395 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
21396 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
21397 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
21398 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
Christopher Fauletae72ae42022-05-05 12:27:07 +020021399 logs. Finally, it may be due to an HTTP header rewrite failure on the
21400 response. In this case, an HTTP 500 error is sent (see
21401 "tune.maxrewrite" and "http-response strict-mode" for more
21402 inforomation).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021403
21404 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
21405 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
21406 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
Christopher Fauletae72ae42022-05-05 12:27:07 +020021407 returned an HTTP 403 error. It may also be due to an HTTP header
21408 rewrite failure on the request. In this case, an HTTP 500 error is
21409 sent (see "tune.maxrewrite" and "http-request strict-mode" for more
21410 inforomation).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021411
21412 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
21413 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
21414 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
21415 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
21416
21417 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
21418 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
21419 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
21420 only be solved by proper system tuning.
21421
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021422The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021423persistence was handled by the client, the server and by HAProxy. This is very
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021424important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
21425re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
21426
21427 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
21428
21429 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
21430 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
21431 set on a GET request.
21432
21433 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
21434 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040021435 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021436 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
21437
21438 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
21439 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
21440 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
21441
21442 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
21443 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
21444 already got a cookie.
21445
21446 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
21447 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
21448 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
21449 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
21450 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
21451
21452 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
21453 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
21454 new cookie was inserted in the response.
21455
21456 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
21457 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
21458 new cookie was inserted in the response.
21459
21460 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
21461 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
21462
21463 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
21464 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
21465 then advertised in the response.
21466
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021467
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200214688.6. Non-printable characters
21469-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021470
21471In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
21472consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
21473converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
21474prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
21475being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
21476escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
21477is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
21478'}' when logging headers.
21479
21480Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
21481issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
21482containing spaces is "User-Agent".
21483
21484Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
21485the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
21486performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
21487
21488
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200214898.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
21490---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021491
21492Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
21493achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021494section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021495cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
21496the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
21497the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021498locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021499not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
21500user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
21501a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
21502wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
21503
21504 Examples :
21505 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
21506 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
21507
21508 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
21509 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
21510
21511
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200215128.8. Capturing HTTP headers
21513---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021514
21515Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
21516proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
21517the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
21518server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
21519
21520Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
21521response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021522section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021523
21524It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010021525time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
21526appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021527are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
21528and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
21529follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
21530request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
21531in the logs.
21532
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020021533As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
21534frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
21535an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
21536
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021537 Example :
21538 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
21539 listen proxy-out
21540 mode http
21541 option httplog
21542 option logasap
21543 log global
21544 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
21545
21546 # log the name of the virtual server
21547 capture request header Host len 20
21548
21549 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
21550 capture request header Content-Length len 10
21551
21552 # log the beginning of the referrer
21553 capture request header Referer len 20
21554
21555 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
21556 capture response header Server len 20
21557
21558 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
21559 capture response header Content-Length len 10
21560
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021561 # log the expected cache behavior on the response
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021562 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
21563
21564 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
21565 capture response header Via len 20
21566
21567 # log the URL location during a redirection
21568 capture response header Location len 20
21569
21570 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
21571 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
21572 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
21573 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
21574 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
21575
21576 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
21577 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
21578 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
21579 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010021580 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021581
21582 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
21583 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
21584 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
21585 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
21586 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010021587 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021588
21589
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200215908.9. Examples of logs
21591---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021592
21593These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
21594them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
21595reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
21596
21597 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
21598 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
21599 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
21600
21601 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
21602 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
21603
21604 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
21605 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
21606 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
21607
21608 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
21609 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
21610
21611 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
21612 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
21613 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
21614
21615 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010021616 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021617 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
21618 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
21619
21620 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
21621 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
21622 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
21623
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020021624 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "http-response
21625 deny" rule, or because the response was improperly formatted and not
21626 HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which risked
21627 being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502 bad
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021628 gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was HAProxy who decided to
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020021629 return the 502 and not the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021630
21631 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010021632 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021633
21634 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
21635 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
21636 Nothing was sent to any server.
21637
21638 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
21639 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
21640
21641 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
21642 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021643 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021644 send a 408 return code to the client.
21645
21646 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
21647 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
21648
21649 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
21650 5 seconds ("c----").
21651
21652 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
21653 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010021654 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021655
21656 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021657 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021658 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
21659 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
21660 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
21661 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
21662 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010021663
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020021664
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200216659. Supported filters
21666--------------------
21667
21668Here are listed officially supported filters with the list of parameters they
21669accept. Depending on compile options, some of these filters might be
21670unavailable. The list of available filters is reported in haproxy -vv.
21671
21672See also : "filter"
21673
216749.1. Trace
21675----------
21676
Christopher Fauletc41d8bd2020-11-17 10:43:26 +010021677filter trace [name <name>] [random-forwarding] [hexdump]
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020021678
21679 Arguments:
21680 <name> is an arbitrary name that will be reported in
21681 messages. If no name is provided, "TRACE" is used.
21682
Christopher Faulet96a577a2020-11-17 10:45:05 +010021683 <quiet> inhibits trace messages.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020021684
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021685 <random-forwarding> enables the random forwarding of parsed data. By
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020021686 default, this filter forwards all previously parsed
21687 data. With this parameter, it only forwards a random
21688 amount of the parsed data.
21689
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021690 <hexdump> dumps all forwarded data to the server and the client.
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010021691
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020021692This filter can be used as a base to develop new filters. It defines all
21693callbacks and print a message on the standard error stream (stderr) with useful
21694information for all of them. It may be useful to debug the activity of other
21695filters or, quite simply, HAProxy's activity.
21696
21697Using <random-parsing> and/or <random-forwarding> parameters is a good way to
21698tests the behavior of a filter that parses data exchanged between a client and
21699a server by adding some latencies in the processing.
21700
21701
217029.2. HTTP compression
21703---------------------
21704
21705filter compression
21706
21707The HTTP compression has been moved in a filter in HAProxy 1.7. "compression"
21708keyword must still be used to enable and configure the HTTP compression. And
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021709when no other filter is used, it is enough. When used with the cache or the
21710fcgi-app enabled, it is also enough. In this case, the compression is always
21711done after the response is stored in the cache. But it is mandatory to
21712explicitly use a filter line to enable the HTTP compression when at least one
21713filter other than the cache or the fcgi-app is used for the same
21714listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
21715order.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020021716
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021717See also : "compression", section 9.4 about the cache filter and section 9.5
21718 about the fcgi-app filter.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020021719
21720
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +0200217219.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
21722--------------------------------------------
21723
21724filter spoe [engine <name>] config <file>
21725
21726 Arguments :
21727
21728 <name> is the engine name that will be used to find the right scope in
21729 the configuration file. If not provided, all the file will be
21730 parsed.
21731
21732 <file> is the path of the engine configuration file. This file can
21733 contain configuration of several engines. In this case, each
21734 part must be placed in its own scope.
21735
21736The Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE) is a filter communicating with
21737external components. It allows the offload of some specifics processing on the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021738streams in tiered applications. These external components and information
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020021739exchanged with them are configured in dedicated files, for the main part. It
21740also requires dedicated backends, defined in HAProxy configuration.
21741
21742SPOE communicates with external components using an in-house binary protocol,
21743the Stream Processing Offload Protocol (SPOP).
21744
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010021745For all information about the SPOE configuration and the SPOP specification, see
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020021746"doc/SPOE.txt".
21747
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +0100217489.4. Cache
21749----------
21750
21751filter cache <name>
21752
21753 Arguments :
21754
21755 <name> is name of the cache section this filter will use.
21756
21757The cache uses a filter to store cacheable responses. The HTTP rules
21758"cache-store" and "cache-use" must be used to define how and when to use a
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050021759cache. By default the corresponding filter is implicitly defined. And when no
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021760other filters than fcgi-app or compression are used, it is enough. In such
21761case, the compression filter is always evaluated after the cache filter. But it
21762is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to use a cache when at least one
21763filter other than the compression or the fcgi-app is used for the same
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010021764listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
21765order.
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010021766
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021767See also : section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.5 about the
21768 fcgi-app filter and section 6 about cache.
21769
21770
217719.5. Fcgi-app
21772-------------
21773
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040021774filter fcgi-app <name>
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021775
21776 Arguments :
21777
21778 <name> is name of the fcgi-app section this filter will use.
21779
21780The FastCGI application uses a filter to evaluate all custom parameters on the
21781request path, and to process the headers on the response path. the <name> must
21782reference an existing fcgi-app section. The directive "use-fcgi-app" should be
21783used to define the application to use. By default the corresponding filter is
21784implicitly defined. And when no other filters than cache or compression are
21785used, it is enough. But it is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to a
21786fcgi-app when at least one filter other than the compression or the cache is
21787used for the same backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
21788order.
21789
21790See also: "use-fcgi-app", section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.4
21791 about the cache filter and section 10 about FastCGI application.
21792
21793
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +0100217949.6. OpenTracing
21795----------------
21796
21797The OpenTracing filter adds native support for using distributed tracing in
21798HAProxy. This is enabled by sending an OpenTracing compliant request to one
21799of the supported tracers such as Datadog, Jaeger, Lightstep and Zipkin tracers.
21800Please note: tracers are not listed by any preference, but alphabetically.
21801
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021802This feature is only enabled when HAProxy was built with USE_OT=1.
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +010021803
21804The OpenTracing filter activation is done explicitly by specifying it in the
21805HAProxy configuration. If this is not done, the OpenTracing filter in no way
21806participates in the work of HAProxy.
21807
21808filter opentracing [id <id>] config <file>
21809
21810 Arguments :
21811
21812 <id> is the OpenTracing filter id that will be used to find the
21813 right scope in the configuration file. If no filter id is
21814 specified, 'ot-filter' is used as default. If scope is not
21815 specified in the configuration file, it applies to all defined
21816 OpenTracing filters.
21817
21818 <file> is the path of the OpenTracing configuration file. The same
21819 file can contain configurations for multiple OpenTracing
21820 filters simultaneously. In that case we do not need to define
21821 scope so the same configuration applies to all filters or each
21822 filter must have its own scope defined.
21823
21824More detailed documentation related to the operation, configuration and use
Willy Tarreaua63d1a02021-04-02 17:16:46 +020021825of the filter can be found in the addons/ot directory.
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +010021826
21827
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02002182810. FastCGI applications
21829-------------------------
21830
21831HAProxy is able to send HTTP requests to Responder FastCGI applications. This
21832feature was added in HAProxy 2.1. To do so, servers must be configured to use
21833the FastCGI protocol (using the keyword "proto fcgi" on the server line) and a
21834FastCGI application must be configured and used by the backend managing these
21835servers (using the keyword "use-fcgi-app" into the proxy section). Several
21836FastCGI applications may be defined, but only one can be used at a time by a
21837backend.
21838
21839HAProxy implements all features of the FastCGI specification for Responder
21840application. Especially it is able to multiplex several requests on a simple
21841connection.
21842
2184310.1. Setup
21844-----------
21845
2184610.1.1. Fcgi-app section
21847--------------------------
21848
21849fcgi-app <name>
21850 Declare a FastCGI application named <name>. To be valid, at least the
21851 document root must be defined.
21852
21853acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
21854 Declare or complete an access list.
21855
21856 See "acl" keyword in section 4.2 and section 7 about ACL usage for
21857 details. ACLs defined for a FastCGI application are private. They cannot be
21858 used by any other application or by any proxy. In the same way, ACLs defined
21859 in any other section are not usable by a FastCGI application. However,
21860 Pre-defined ACLs are available.
21861
21862docroot <path>
21863 Define the document root on the remote host. <path> will be used to build
21864 the default value of FastCGI parameters SCRIPT_FILENAME and
21865 PATH_TRANSLATED. It is a mandatory setting.
21866
21867index <script-name>
21868 Define the script name that will be appended after an URI that ends with a
21869 slash ("/") to set the default value of the FastCGI parameter SCRIPT_NAME. It
21870 is an optional setting.
21871
21872 Example :
21873 index index.php
21874
21875log-stderr global
21876log-stderr <address> [len <length>] [format <format>]
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +010021877 [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>] <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021878 Enable logging of STDERR messages reported by the FastCGI application.
21879
21880 See "log" keyword in section 4.2 for details. It is an optional setting. By
21881 default STDERR messages are ignored.
21882
21883pass-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
21884 Specify the name of a request header which will be passed to the FastCGI
21885 application. It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based condition, in
21886 which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
21887
21888 Most request headers are already available to the FastCGI application,
21889 prefixed with "HTTP_". Thus, this directive is only required to pass headers
21890 that are purposefully omitted. Currently, the headers "Authorization",
21891 "Proxy-Authorization" and hop-by-hop headers are omitted.
21892
21893 Note that the headers "Content-type" and "Content-length" are never passed to
21894 the FastCGI application because they are already converted into parameters.
21895
21896path-info <regex>
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010021897 Define a regular expression to extract the script-name and the path-info from
Christopher Faulet6c57f2d2020-02-14 16:55:52 +010021898 the URL-decoded path. Thus, <regex> may have two captures: the first one to
21899 capture the script name and the second one to capture the path-info. The
21900 first one is mandatory, the second one is optional. This way, it is possible
21901 to extract the script-name from the path ignoring the path-info. It is an
21902 optional setting. If it is not defined, no matching is performed on the
21903 path. and the FastCGI parameters PATH_INFO and PATH_TRANSLATED are not
21904 filled.
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010021905
21906 For security reason, when this regular expression is defined, the newline and
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050021907 the null characters are forbidden from the path, once URL-decoded. The reason
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010021908 to such limitation is because otherwise the matching always fails (due to a
21909 limitation one the way regular expression are executed in HAProxy). So if one
21910 of these two characters is found in the URL-decoded path, an error is
21911 returned to the client. The principle of least astonishment is applied here.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021912
21913 Example :
Christopher Faulet6c57f2d2020-02-14 16:55:52 +010021914 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$ # both script-name and path-info may be set
21915 path-info ^(/.+\.php) # the path-info is ignored
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021916
21917option get-values
21918no option get-values
21919 Enable or disable the retrieve of variables about connection management.
21920
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040021921 HAProxy is able to send the record FCGI_GET_VALUES on connection
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021922 establishment to retrieve the value for following variables:
21923
21924 * FCGI_MAX_REQS The maximum number of concurrent requests this
21925 application will accept.
21926
William Lallemand93e548e2019-09-30 13:54:02 +020021927 * FCGI_MPXS_CONNS "0" if this application does not multiplex connections,
21928 "1" otherwise.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021929
21930 Some FastCGI applications does not support this feature. Some others close
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +050021931 the connection immediately after sending their response. So, by default, this
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021932 option is disabled.
21933
21934 Note that the maximum number of concurrent requests accepted by a FastCGI
21935 application is a connection variable. It only limits the number of streams
21936 per connection. If the global load must be limited on the application, the
21937 server parameters "maxconn" and "pool-max-conn" must be set. In addition, if
21938 an application does not support connection multiplexing, the maximum number
21939 of concurrent requests is automatically set to 1.
21940
21941option keep-conn
21942no option keep-conn
21943 Instruct the FastCGI application to keep the connection open or not after
21944 sending a response.
21945
21946 If disabled, the FastCGI application closes the connection after responding
21947 to this request. By default, this option is enabled.
21948
21949option max-reqs <reqs>
21950 Define the maximum number of concurrent requests this application will
21951 accept.
21952
21953 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MAX_REQS is retrieved
21954 during connection establishment. Furthermore, if the application does not
21955 support connection multiplexing, this option will be ignored. By default set
21956 to 1.
21957
21958option mpxs-conns
21959no option mpxs-conns
21960 Enable or disable the support of connection multiplexing.
21961
21962 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MPXS_CONNS is retrieved
21963 during connection establishment. It is disabled by default.
21964
21965set-param <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
21966 Set a FastCGI parameter that should be passed to this application. Its
21967 value, defined by <fmt> must follows the log-format rules (see section 8.2.4
21968 "Custom Log format"). It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based
21969 condition, in which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
21970
21971 With this directive, it is possible to overwrite the value of default FastCGI
21972 parameters. If the value is evaluated to an empty string, the rule is
21973 ignored. These directives are evaluated in their declaration order.
21974
21975 Example :
21976 # PHP only, required if PHP was built with --enable-force-cgi-redirect
21977 set-param REDIRECT_STATUS 200
21978
21979 set-param PHP_AUTH_DIGEST %[req.hdr(Authorization)]
21980
21981
2198210.1.2. Proxy section
21983---------------------
21984
21985use-fcgi-app <name>
21986 Define the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
21987
21988 Arguments :
21989 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
21990
21991 This keyword is only available for HTTP proxies with the backend capability
21992 and with at least one FastCGI server. However, FastCGI servers can be mixed
21993 with HTTP servers. But except there is a good reason to do so, it is not
21994 recommended (see section 10.3 about the limitations for details). Only one
21995 application may be defined at a time per backend.
21996
21997 Note that, once a FastCGI application is referenced for a backend, depending
21998 on the configuration some processing may be done even if the request is not
21999 sent to a FastCGI server. Rules to set parameters or pass headers to an
22000 application are evaluated.
22001
22002
2200310.1.3. Example
22004---------------
22005
22006 frontend front-http
22007 mode http
22008 bind *:80
22009 bind *:
22010
22011 use_backend back-dynamic if { path_reg ^/.+\.php(/.*)?$ }
22012 default_backend back-static
22013
22014 backend back-static
22015 mode http
22016 server www A.B.C.D:80
22017
22018 backend back-dynamic
22019 mode http
22020 use-fcgi-app php-fpm
22021 server php-fpm A.B.C.D:9000 proto fcgi
22022
22023 fcgi-app php-fpm
22024 log-stderr global
22025 option keep-conn
22026
22027 docroot /var/www/my-app
22028 index index.php
22029 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$
22030
22031
2203210.2. Default parameters
22033------------------------
22034
22035A Responder FastCGI application has the same purpose as a CGI/1.1 program. In
22036the CGI/1.1 specification (RFC3875), several variables must be passed to the
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050022037script. So HAProxy set them and some others commonly used by FastCGI
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020022038applications. All these variables may be overwritten, with caution though.
22039
22040 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22041 | AUTH_TYPE | Identifies the mechanism, if any, used by HAProxy |
22042 | | to authenticate the user. Concretely, only the |
22043 | | BASIC authentication mechanism is supported. |
22044 | | |
22045 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22046 | CONTENT_LENGTH | Contains the size of the message-body attached to |
22047 | | the request. It means only requests with a known |
22048 | | size are considered as valid and sent to the |
22049 | | application. |
22050 | | |
22051 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22052 | CONTENT_TYPE | Contains the type of the message-body attached to |
22053 | | the request. It may not be set. |
22054 | | |
22055 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22056 | DOCUMENT_ROOT | Contains the document root on the remote host under |
22057 | | which the script should be executed, as defined in |
22058 | | the application's configuration. |
22059 | | |
22060 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22061 | GATEWAY_INTERFACE | Contains the dialect of CGI being used by HAProxy |
22062 | | to communicate with the FastCGI application. |
22063 | | Concretely, it is set to "CGI/1.1". |
22064 | | |
22065 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22066 | PATH_INFO | Contains the portion of the URI path hierarchy |
22067 | | following the part that identifies the script |
22068 | | itself. To be set, the directive "path-info" must |
22069 | | be defined. |
22070 | | |
22071 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22072 | PATH_TRANSLATED | If PATH_INFO is set, it is its translated version. |
22073 | | It is the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and |
22074 | | PATH_INFO. If PATH_INFO is not set, this parameters |
22075 | | is not set too. |
22076 | | |
22077 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22078 | QUERY_STRING | Contains the request's query string. It may not be |
22079 | | set. |
22080 | | |
22081 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22082 | REMOTE_ADDR | Contains the network address of the client sending |
22083 | | the request. |
22084 | | |
22085 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22086 | REMOTE_USER | Contains the user identification string supplied by |
22087 | | client as part of user authentication. |
22088 | | |
22089 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22090 | REQUEST_METHOD | Contains the method which should be used by the |
22091 | | script to process the request. |
22092 | | |
22093 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22094 | REQUEST_URI | Contains the request's URI. |
22095 | | |
22096 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22097 | SCRIPT_FILENAME | Contains the absolute pathname of the script. it is |
22098 | | the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and SCRIPT_NAME. |
22099 | | |
22100 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22101 | SCRIPT_NAME | Contains the name of the script. If the directive |
22102 | | "path-info" is defined, it is the first part of the |
22103 | | URI path hierarchy, ending with the script name. |
22104 | | Otherwise, it is the entire URI path. |
22105 | | |
22106 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22107 | SERVER_NAME | Contains the name of the server host to which the |
22108 | | client request is directed. It is the value of the |
22109 | | header "Host", if defined. Otherwise, the |
22110 | | destination address of the connection on the client |
22111 | | side. |
22112 | | |
22113 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22114 | SERVER_PORT | Contains the destination TCP port of the connection |
22115 | | on the client side, which is the port the client |
22116 | | connected to. |
22117 | | |
22118 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22119 | SERVER_PROTOCOL | Contains the request's protocol. |
22120 | | |
22121 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
Christopher Fauletb2a50292021-06-11 13:34:42 +020022122 | SERVER_SOFTWARE | Contains the string "HAProxy" followed by the |
22123 | | current HAProxy version. |
22124 | | |
22125 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020022126 | HTTPS | Set to a non-empty value ("on") if the script was |
22127 | | queried through the HTTPS protocol. |
22128 | | |
22129 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22130
22131
2213210.3. Limitations
22133------------------
22134
22135The current implementation have some limitations. The first one is about the
22136way some request headers are hidden to the FastCGI applications. This happens
22137during the headers analysis, on the backend side, before the connection
22138establishment. At this stage, HAProxy know the backend is using a FastCGI
22139application but it don't know if the request will be routed to a FastCGI server
22140or not. But to hide request headers, it simply removes them from the HTX
22141message. So, if the request is finally routed to an HTTP server, it never see
22142these headers. For this reason, it is not recommended to mix FastCGI servers
22143and HTTP servers under the same backend.
22144
22145Similarly, the rules "set-param" and "pass-header" are evaluated during the
22146request headers analysis. So the evaluation is always performed, even if the
22147requests is finally forwarded to an HTTP server.
22148
22149About the rules "set-param", when a rule is applied, a pseudo header is added
22150into the HTX message. So, the same way than for HTTP header rewrites, it may
22151fail if the buffer is full. The rules "set-param" will compete with
22152"http-request" ones.
22153
22154Finally, all FastCGI params and HTTP headers are sent into a unique record
22155FCGI_PARAM. Encoding of this record must be done in one pass, otherwise a
22156processing error is returned. It means the record FCGI_PARAM, once encoded,
22157must not exceeds the size of a buffer. However, there is no reserve to respect
22158here.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010022159
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020022160
2216111. Address formats
22162-------------------
22163
22164Several statements as "bind, "server", "nameserver" and "log" requires an
22165address.
22166
22167This address can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6 address, or '*'.
22168The '*' is equal to the special address "0.0.0.0" and can be used, in the case
22169of "bind" or "dgram-bind" to listen on all IPv4 of the system.The IPv6
22170equivalent is '::'.
22171
22172Depending of the statement, a port or port range follows the IP address. This
22173is mandatory on 'bind' statement, optional on 'server'.
22174
22175This address can also begin with a slash '/'. It is considered as the "unix"
22176family, and '/' and following characters must be present the path.
22177
22178Default socket type or transport method "datagram" or "stream" depends on the
22179configuration statement showing the address. Indeed, 'bind' and 'server' will
22180use a "stream" socket type by default whereas 'log', 'nameserver' or
22181'dgram-bind' will use a "datagram".
22182
22183Optionally, a prefix could be used to force the address family and/or the
22184socket type and the transport method.
22185
22186
Daniel Corbette95f3072023-01-17 18:32:31 -05002218711.1. Address family prefixes
22188-----------------------------
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020022189
22190'abns@<name>' following <name> is an abstract namespace (Linux only).
22191
22192'fd@<n>' following address is a file descriptor <n> inherited from the
22193 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already be
22194 listening.
22195
22196'ip@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is considered as an IPv4 or
22197 IPv6 address depending on the syntax. Depending
22198 on the statement using this address, a port or
22199 a port range may or must be specified.
22200
22201'ipv4@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
22202 an IPv4 address. Depending on the statement
22203 using this address, a port or a port range
22204 may or must be specified.
22205
22206'ipv6@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
22207 an IPv6 address. Depending on the statement
22208 using this address, a port or a port range
22209 may or must be specified.
22210
22211'sockpair@<n>' following address is the file descriptor of a connected unix
22212 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the initiator
22213 creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes one of them
22214 over the FD to the other end. The listener waits to receive
22215 the FD from the unix socket and uses it as if it were the FD
22216 of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
22217
22218'unix@<path>' following string is considered as a UNIX socket <path>. this
22219 prefix is useful to declare an UNIX socket path which don't
22220 start by slash '/'.
22221
22222
Daniel Corbette95f3072023-01-17 18:32:31 -05002222311.2. Socket type prefixes
22224--------------------------
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020022225
22226Previous "Address family prefixes" can also be prefixed to force the socket
22227type and the transport method. The default depends of the statement using
22228this address but in some cases the user may force it to a different one.
22229This is the case for "log" statement where the default is syslog over UDP
22230but we could force to use syslog over TCP.
22231
22232Those prefixes were designed for internal purpose and users should
Willy Tarreaudc2b3f82023-01-16 12:07:12 +010022233instead use aliases of the next section "11.3 Protocol prefixes".
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020022234
22235If users need one those prefixes to perform what they expect because
22236they can not configure the same using the protocol prefixes, they should
22237report this to the maintainers.
22238
22239'stream+<family>@<address>' forces socket type and transport method
22240 to "stream"
22241
22242'dgram+<family>@<address>' forces socket type and transport method
22243 to "datagram".
22244
22245
Daniel Corbette95f3072023-01-17 18:32:31 -05002224611.3. Protocol prefixes
22247-----------------------
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020022248
22249'tcp@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is considered as an IPv4
22250 or IPv6 address depending of the syntax but
22251 socket type and transport method is forced to
22252 "stream". Depending on the statement using
22253 this address, a port or a port range can or
22254 must be specified. It is considered as an alias
22255 of 'stream+ip@'.
22256
22257'tcp4@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
22258 an IPv4 address but socket type and transport
22259 method is forced to "stream". Depending on the
22260 statement using this address, a port or port
22261 range can or must be specified.
22262 It is considered as an alias of 'stream+ipv4@'.
22263
22264'tcp6@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
22265 an IPv6 address but socket type and transport
22266 method is forced to "stream". Depending on the
22267 statement using this address, a port or port
22268 range can or must be specified.
22269 It is considered as an alias of 'stream+ipv4@'.
22270
22271'udp@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is considered as an IPv4
22272 or IPv6 address depending of the syntax but
22273 socket type and transport method is forced to
22274 "datagram". Depending on the statement using
22275 this address, a port or a port range can or
22276 must be specified. It is considered as an alias
22277 of 'dgram+ip@'.
22278
22279'udp4@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
22280 an IPv4 address but socket type and transport
22281 method is forced to "datagram". Depending on
22282 the statement using this address, a port or
22283 port range can or must be specified.
Willy Tarreau26460482023-01-16 12:11:38 +010022284 It is considered as an alias of 'dgram+ipv4@'.
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020022285
22286'udp6@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
22287 an IPv6 address but socket type and transport
22288 method is forced to "datagram". Depending on
22289 the statement using this address, a port or
22290 port range can or must be specified.
Willy Tarreau26460482023-01-16 12:11:38 +010022291 It is considered as an alias of 'dgram+ipv4@'.
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020022292
22293'uxdg@<path>' following string is considered as a unix socket <path> but
22294 transport method is forced to "datagram". It is considered as
22295 an alias of 'dgram+unix@'.
22296
22297'uxst@<path>' following string is considered as a unix socket <path> but
22298 transport method is forced to "stream". It is considered as
22299 an alias of 'stream+unix@'.
22300
22301In future versions, other prefixes could be used to specify protocols like
22302QUIC which proposes stream transport based on socket of type "datagram".
22303
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010022304/*
22305 * Local variables:
22306 * fill-column: 79
22307 * End:
22308 */